Makefile.in: Add optinfo.texi.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / invoke.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @ignore
6 @c man begin INCLUDE
7 @include gcc-vers.texi
8 @c man end
9
10 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
11 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
14 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
15 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
16 Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
17 Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
18 the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below). A copy of the license is
19 included in the gfdl(7) man page.
20
21 (a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
22
23 A GNU Manual
24
25 (b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
26
27 You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
28 software. Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
29 funds for GNU development.
30 @c man end
31 @c Set file name and title for the man page.
32 @setfilename gcc
33 @settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
34 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
35 gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
36 [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
37 [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-Wpedantic}]
38 [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
39 [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
40 [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
41 [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] [@@@var{file}] @var{infile}@dots{}
42
43 Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
44 remainder. @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
45 @c man end
46 @c man begin SEEALSO
47 gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
48 cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
49 and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{as},
50 @file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
51 @c man end
52 @c man begin BUGS
53 For instructions on reporting bugs, see
54 @w{@value{BUGURL}}.
55 @c man end
56 @c man begin AUTHOR
57 See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
58 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
59 for contributors to GCC@.
60 @c man end
61 @end ignore
62
63 @node Invoking GCC
64 @chapter GCC Command Options
65 @cindex GCC command options
66 @cindex command options
67 @cindex options, GCC command
68
69 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
70 When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
71 assembly and linking. The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
72 process at an intermediate stage. For example, the @option{-c} option
73 says not to run the linker. Then the output consists of object files
74 output by the assembler.
75
76 Other options are passed on to one stage of processing. Some options
77 control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself. Yet other
78 options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
79 documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
80
81 @cindex C compilation options
82 Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful
83 for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
84 (usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly. If the description
85 for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
86 that option with all supported languages.
87
88 @cindex C++ compilation options
89 @xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
90 options for compiling C++ programs.
91
92 @cindex grouping options
93 @cindex options, grouping
94 The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands. Many
95 options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
96 may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dv} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
97 -v}}.
98
99 @cindex order of options
100 @cindex options, order
101 You can mix options and other arguments. For the most part, the order
102 you use doesn't matter. Order does matter when you use several
103 options of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more
104 than once, the directories are searched in the order specified. Also,
105 the placement of the @option{-l} option is significant.
106
107 Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
108 @samp{-W}---for example,
109 @option{-fmove-loop-invariants}, @option{-Wformat} and so on. Most of
110 these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
111 @option{-ffoo} is @option{-fno-foo}. This manual documents
112 only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
113
114 @c man end
115
116 @xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
117
118 @menu
119 * Option Summary:: Brief list of all options, without explanations.
120 * Overall Options:: Controlling the kind of output:
121 an executable, object files, assembler files,
122 or preprocessed source.
123 * Invoking G++:: Compiling C++ programs.
124 * C Dialect Options:: Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
125 * C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
126 * Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
127 and Objective-C++.
128 * Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
129 formatted.
130 * Warning Options:: How picky should the compiler be?
131 * Debugging Options:: Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
132 * Optimize Options:: How much optimization?
133 * Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
134 Also, getting dependency information for Make.
135 * Assembler Options:: Passing options to the assembler.
136 * Link Options:: Specifying libraries and so on.
137 * Directory Options:: Where to find header files and libraries.
138 Where to find the compiler executable files.
139 * Spec Files:: How to pass switches to sub-processes.
140 * Target Options:: Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
141 * Submodel Options:: Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
142 such as 68010 vs 68020.
143 * Code Gen Options:: Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
144 and register usage.
145 * Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
146 * Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
147 @end menu
148
149 @c man begin OPTIONS
150
151 @node Option Summary
152 @section Option Summary
153
154 Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type. Explanations are
155 in the following sections.
156
157 @table @emph
158 @item Overall Options
159 @xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
160 @gccoptlist{-c -S -E -o @var{file} -no-canonical-prefixes @gol
161 -pipe -pass-exit-codes @gol
162 -x @var{language} -v -### --help@r{[}=@var{class}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]]} --target-help @gol
163 --version -wrapper @@@var{file} -fplugin=@var{file} -fplugin-arg-@var{name}=@var{arg} @gol
164 -fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]} -fada-spec-parent=@var{arg} -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}}
165
166 @item C Language Options
167 @xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
168 @gccoptlist{-ansi -std=@var{standard} -fgnu89-inline @gol
169 -aux-info @var{filename} -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions @gol
170 -fno-asm -fno-builtin -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
171 -fhosted -ffreestanding -fopenmp -fopenmp-simd -fms-extensions @gol
172 -fplan9-extensions -trigraphs -traditional -traditional-cpp @gol
173 -fallow-single-precision -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions @gol
174 -fsigned-bitfields -fsigned-char @gol
175 -funsigned-bitfields -funsigned-char}
176
177 @item C++ Language Options
178 @xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
179 @gccoptlist{-fabi-version=@var{n} -fno-access-control -fcheck-new @gol
180 -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n} -ffriend-injection @gol
181 -fno-elide-constructors @gol
182 -fno-enforce-eh-specs @gol
183 -ffor-scope -fno-for-scope -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
184 -fno-implicit-templates @gol
185 -fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
186 -fno-implement-inlines -fms-extensions @gol
187 -fno-nonansi-builtins -fnothrow-opt -fno-operator-names @gol
188 -fno-optional-diags -fpermissive @gol
189 -fno-pretty-templates @gol
190 -frepo -fno-rtti -fstats -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=@var{n} @gol
191 -ftemplate-depth=@var{n} @gol
192 -fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit -fno-weak -nostdinc++ @gol
193 -fvisibility-inlines-hidden @gol
194 -fvtable-verify=@var{std|preinit|none} @gol
195 -fvtv-counts -fvtv-debug @gol
196 -fvisibility-ms-compat @gol
197 -fext-numeric-literals @gol
198 -Wabi -Wconversion-null -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
199 -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor -Wliteral-suffix -Wnarrowing @gol
200 -Wnoexcept -Wnon-virtual-dtor -Wreorder @gol
201 -Weffc++ -Wstrict-null-sentinel @gol
202 -Wno-non-template-friend -Wold-style-cast @gol
203 -Woverloaded-virtual -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
204 -Wsign-promo}
205
206 @item Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
207 @xref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling
208 Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects}.
209 @gccoptlist{-fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
210 -fgnu-runtime -fnext-runtime @gol
211 -fno-nil-receivers @gol
212 -fobjc-abi-version=@var{n} @gol
213 -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors @gol
214 -fobjc-direct-dispatch @gol
215 -fobjc-exceptions @gol
216 -fobjc-gc @gol
217 -fobjc-nilcheck @gol
218 -fobjc-std=objc1 @gol
219 -freplace-objc-classes @gol
220 -fzero-link @gol
221 -gen-decls @gol
222 -Wassign-intercept @gol
223 -Wno-protocol -Wselector @gol
224 -Wstrict-selector-match @gol
225 -Wundeclared-selector}
226
227 @item Language Independent Options
228 @xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
229 @gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=@var{n} @gol
230 -fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]} @gol
231 -fdiagnostics-color=@r{[}auto@r{|}never@r{|}always@r{]} @gol
232 -fno-diagnostics-show-option -fno-diagnostics-show-caret}
233
234 @item Warning Options
235 @xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
236 @gccoptlist{-fsyntax-only -fmax-errors=@var{n} -Wpedantic @gol
237 -pedantic-errors @gol
238 -w -Wextra -Wall -Waddress -Waggregate-return @gol
239 -Waggressive-loop-optimizations -Warray-bounds @gol
240 -Wno-attributes -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined @gol
241 -Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat -Wcast-align -Wcast-qual @gol
242 -Wchar-subscripts -Wclobbered -Wcomment -Wconditionally-supported @gol
243 -Wconversion -Wcoverage-mismatch -Wdate-time -Wdelete-incomplete -Wno-cpp @gol
244 -Wno-deprecated -Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wdisabled-optimization @gol
245 -Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body -Wenum-compare @gol
246 -Wno-endif-labels -Werror -Werror=* @gol
247 -Wfatal-errors -Wfloat-equal -Wformat -Wformat=2 @gol
248 -Wno-format-contains-nul -Wno-format-extra-args -Wformat-nonliteral @gol
249 -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k @gol
250 -Wframe-larger-than=@var{len} -Wno-free-nonheap-object -Wjump-misses-init @gol
251 -Wignored-qualifiers @gol
252 -Wimplicit -Wimplicit-function-declaration -Wimplicit-int @gol
253 -Winit-self -Winline -Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
254 -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast -Wno-invalid-offsetof @gol
255 -Winvalid-pch -Wlarger-than=@var{len} -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations @gol
256 -Wlogical-op -Wlong-long @gol
257 -Wmain -Wmaybe-uninitialized -Wmissing-braces -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
258 -Wmissing-include-dirs @gol
259 -Wno-multichar -Wnonnull -Wno-overflow -Wopenmp-simd @gol
260 -Woverlength-strings -Wpacked -Wpacked-bitfield-compat -Wpadded @gol
261 -Wparentheses -Wpedantic-ms-format -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @gol
262 -Wpointer-arith -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @gol
263 -Wredundant-decls -Wno-return-local-addr @gol
264 -Wreturn-type -Wsequence-point -Wshadow @gol
265 -Wsign-compare -Wsign-conversion -Wfloat-conversion @gol
266 -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess @gol
267 -Wstack-protector -Wstack-usage=@var{len} -Wstrict-aliasing @gol
268 -Wstrict-aliasing=n @gol -Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n} @gol
269 -Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{|}format@r{]} @gol
270 -Wmissing-format-attribute @gol
271 -Wswitch -Wswitch-default -Wswitch-enum -Wsync-nand @gol
272 -Wsystem-headers -Wtrampolines -Wtrigraphs -Wtype-limits -Wundef @gol
273 -Wuninitialized -Wunknown-pragmas -Wno-pragmas @gol
274 -Wunsuffixed-float-constants -Wunused -Wunused-function @gol
275 -Wunused-label -Wunused-local-typedefs -Wunused-parameter @gol
276 -Wno-unused-result -Wunused-value @gol -Wunused-variable @gol
277 -Wunused-but-set-parameter -Wunused-but-set-variable @gol
278 -Wuseless-cast -Wvariadic-macros -Wvector-operation-performance @gol
279 -Wvla -Wvolatile-register-var -Wwrite-strings -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant}
280
281 @item C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
282 @gccoptlist{-Wbad-function-cast -Wmissing-declarations @gol
283 -Wmissing-parameter-type -Wmissing-prototypes -Wnested-externs @gol
284 -Wold-style-declaration -Wold-style-definition @gol
285 -Wstrict-prototypes -Wtraditional -Wtraditional-conversion @gol
286 -Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign}
287
288 @item Debugging Options
289 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
290 @gccoptlist{-d@var{letters} -dumpspecs -dumpmachine -dumpversion @gol
291 -fsanitize=@var{style} @gol
292 -fdbg-cnt-list -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list} @gol
293 -fdisable-ipa-@var{pass_name} @gol
294 -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass_name} @gol
295 -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
296 -fdisable-tree-@var{pass_name} @gol
297 -fdisable-tree-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
298 -fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-unnumbered-links @gol
299 -fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
300 -fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
301 -fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph -fdump-ipa-inline @gol
302 -fdump-passes @gol
303 -fdump-statistics @gol
304 -fdump-tree-all @gol
305 -fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
306 -fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
307 -fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-alias @gol
308 -fdump-tree-ch @gol
309 -fdump-tree-ssa@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-pre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
310 -fdump-tree-ccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-dce@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
311 -fdump-tree-gimple@r{[}-raw@r{]} @gol
312 -fdump-tree-dom@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
313 -fdump-tree-dse@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
314 -fdump-tree-phiprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
315 -fdump-tree-phiopt@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
316 -fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
317 -fdump-tree-copyrename@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
318 -fdump-tree-nrv -fdump-tree-vect @gol
319 -fdump-tree-sink @gol
320 -fdump-tree-sra@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
321 -fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
322 -fdump-tree-fre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
323 -fdump-tree-vtable-verify @gol
324 -fdump-tree-vrp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
325 -fdump-tree-storeccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
326 -fdump-final-insns=@var{file} @gol
327 -fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]} -fcompare-debug-second @gol
328 -feliminate-dwarf2-dups -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types @gol
329 -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always @gol
330 -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass} @gol
331 -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list} @gol
332 -fdebug-types-section -fmem-report-wpa @gol
333 -fmem-report -fpre-ipa-mem-report -fpost-ipa-mem-report -fprofile-arcs @gol
334 -fopt-info @gol
335 -fopt-info-@var{options}@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]} @gol
336 -frandom-seed=@var{string} -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
337 -fsel-sched-verbose -fsel-sched-dump-cfg -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose @gol
338 -fstack-usage -ftest-coverage -ftime-report -fvar-tracking @gol
339 -fvar-tracking-assignments -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle @gol
340 -g -g@var{level} -gtoggle -gcoff -gdwarf-@var{version} @gol
341 -ggdb -grecord-gcc-switches -gno-record-gcc-switches @gol
342 -gstabs -gstabs+ -gstrict-dwarf -gno-strict-dwarf @gol
343 -gvms -gxcoff -gxcoff+ @gol
344 -fno-merge-debug-strings -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm @gol
345 -fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new} @gol
346 -femit-struct-debug-baseonly -femit-struct-debug-reduced @gol
347 -femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]} @gol
348 -p -pg -print-file-name=@var{library} -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
349 -print-multi-directory -print-multi-lib -print-multi-os-directory @gol
350 -print-prog-name=@var{program} -print-search-dirs -Q @gol
351 -print-sysroot -print-sysroot-headers-suffix @gol
352 -save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}}
353
354 @item Optimization Options
355 @xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
356 @gccoptlist{-faggressive-loop-optimizations -falign-functions[=@var{n}] @gol
357 -falign-jumps[=@var{n}] @gol
358 -falign-labels[=@var{n}] -falign-loops[=@var{n}] @gol
359 -fassociative-math -fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-probabilities @gol
360 -fbranch-target-load-optimize -fbranch-target-load-optimize2 @gol
361 -fbtr-bb-exclusive -fcaller-saves @gol
362 -fcheck-data-deps -fcombine-stack-adjustments -fconserve-stack @gol
363 -fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fcrossjumping @gol
364 -fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fcx-fortran-rules @gol
365 -fcx-limited-range @gol
366 -fdata-sections -fdce -fdelayed-branch @gol
367 -fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize -fdevirtualize-speculatively -fdse @gol
368 -fearly-inlining -fipa-sra -fexpensive-optimizations -ffat-lto-objects @gol
369 -ffast-math -ffinite-math-only -ffloat-store -fexcess-precision=@var{style} @gol
370 -fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=@var{style} -ffunction-sections @gol
371 -fgcse -fgcse-after-reload -fgcse-las -fgcse-lm -fgraphite-identity @gol
372 -fgcse-sm -fhoist-adjacent-loads -fif-conversion @gol
373 -fif-conversion2 -findirect-inlining @gol
374 -finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once -finline-limit=@var{n} @gol
375 -finline-small-functions -fipa-cp -fipa-cp-clone @gol
376 -fipa-pta -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const -fipa-reference @gol
377 -fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm} @gol
378 -fira-region=@var{region} -fira-hoist-pressure @gol
379 -fira-loop-pressure -fno-ira-share-save-slots @gol
380 -fno-ira-share-spill-slots -fira-verbose=@var{n} @gol
381 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute
382 -fivopts -fkeep-inline-functions -fkeep-static-consts -flive-range-shrinkage @gol
383 -floop-block -floop-interchange -floop-strip-mine -floop-nest-optimize @gol
384 -floop-parallelize-all -flto -flto-compression-level @gol
385 -flto-partition=@var{alg} -flto-report -flto-report-wpa -fmerge-all-constants @gol
386 -fmerge-constants -fmodulo-sched -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves @gol
387 -fmove-loop-invariants -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
388 -fno-defer-pop -fno-function-cse -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
389 -fno-inline -fno-math-errno -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 @gol
390 -fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fno-signed-zeros @gol
391 -fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
392 -fomit-frame-pointer -foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
393 -fpartial-inlining -fpeel-loops -fpredictive-commoning @gol
394 -fprefetch-loop-arrays -fprofile-report @gol
395 -fprofile-correction -fprofile-dir=@var{path} -fprofile-generate @gol
396 -fprofile-generate=@var{path} @gol
397 -fprofile-use -fprofile-use=@var{path} -fprofile-values -fprofile-reorder-functions @gol
398 -freciprocal-math -free -frename-registers -freorder-blocks @gol
399 -freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions @gol
400 -frerun-cse-after-loop -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops @gol
401 -frounding-math -fsched2-use-superblocks -fsched-pressure @gol
402 -fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
403 -fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=@var{n}] -fsched-stalled-insns[=@var{n}] @gol
404 -fsched-group-heuristic -fsched-critical-path-heuristic @gol
405 -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic -fsched-rank-heuristic @gol
406 -fsched-last-insn-heuristic -fsched-dep-count-heuristic @gol
407 -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 -fsection-anchors @gol
408 -fselective-scheduling -fselective-scheduling2 @gol
409 -fsel-sched-pipelining -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops @gol
410 -fshrink-wrap -fsignaling-nans -fsingle-precision-constant @gol
411 -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -fsplit-wide-types -fstack-protector @gol
412 -fstack-protector-all -fstack-protector-strong -fstrict-aliasing @gol
413 -fstrict-overflow -fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp @gol
414 -ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch @gol
415 -ftree-coalesce-inline-vars -ftree-coalesce-vars -ftree-copy-prop @gol
416 -ftree-copyrename -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse @gol
417 -ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre -ftree-loop-if-convert @gol
418 -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores -ftree-loop-im @gol
419 -ftree-phiprop -ftree-loop-distribution -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns @gol
420 -ftree-loop-ivcanon -ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-optimize @gol
421 -ftree-loop-vectorize @gol
422 -ftree-parallelize-loops=@var{n} -ftree-pre -ftree-partial-pre -ftree-pta @gol
423 -ftree-reassoc -ftree-sink -ftree-slsr -ftree-sra @gol
424 -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge -ftree-ter @gol
425 -ftree-vectorize -ftree-vrp @gol
426 -funit-at-a-time -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops @gol
427 -funsafe-loop-optimizations -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops @gol
428 -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb @gol
429 -fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-ld=@var{linker} -fuse-linker-plugin @gol
430 --param @var{name}=@var{value}
431 -O -O0 -O1 -O2 -O3 -Os -Ofast -Og}
432
433 @item Preprocessor Options
434 @xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
435 @gccoptlist{-A@var{question}=@var{answer} @gol
436 -A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
437 -C -dD -dI -dM -dN @gol
438 -D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]} -E -H @gol
439 -idirafter @var{dir} @gol
440 -include @var{file} -imacros @var{file} @gol
441 -iprefix @var{file} -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
442 -iwithprefixbefore @var{dir} -isystem @var{dir} @gol
443 -imultilib @var{dir} -isysroot @var{dir} @gol
444 -M -MM -MF -MG -MP -MQ -MT -nostdinc @gol
445 -P -fdebug-cpp -ftrack-macro-expansion -fworking-directory @gol
446 -remap -trigraphs -undef -U@var{macro} @gol
447 -Wp,@var{option} -Xpreprocessor @var{option} -no-integrated-cpp}
448
449 @item Assembler Option
450 @xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
451 @gccoptlist{-Wa,@var{option} -Xassembler @var{option}}
452
453 @item Linker Options
454 @xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
455 @gccoptlist{@var{object-file-name} -l@var{library} @gol
456 -nostartfiles -nodefaultlibs -nostdlib -pie -rdynamic @gol
457 -s -static -static-libgcc -static-libstdc++ @gol
458 -static-libasan -static-libtsan -static-liblsan -static-libubsan @gol
459 -shared -shared-libgcc -symbolic @gol
460 -T @var{script} -Wl,@var{option} -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
461 -u @var{symbol}}
462
463 @item Directory Options
464 @xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
465 @gccoptlist{-B@var{prefix} -I@var{dir} -iplugindir=@var{dir} @gol
466 -iquote@var{dir} -L@var{dir} -specs=@var{file} -I- @gol
467 --sysroot=@var{dir} --no-sysroot-suffix}
468
469 @item Machine Dependent Options
470 @xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
471 @c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
472 @c Try and put the significant identifier (CPU or system) first,
473 @c so users have a clue at guessing where the ones they want will be.
474
475 @emph{AArch64 Options}
476 @gccoptlist{-mabi=@var{name} -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian @gol
477 -mgeneral-regs-only @gol
478 -mcmodel=tiny -mcmodel=small -mcmodel=large @gol
479 -mstrict-align @gol
480 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
481 -mtls-dialect=desc -mtls-dialect=traditional @gol
482 -march=@var{name} -mcpu=@var{name} -mtune=@var{name}}
483
484 @emph{Adapteva Epiphany Options}
485 @gccoptlist{-mhalf-reg-file -mprefer-short-insn-regs @gol
486 -mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcmove -mnops=@var{num} -msoft-cmpsf @gol
487 -msplit-lohi -mpost-inc -mpost-modify -mstack-offset=@var{num} @gol
488 -mround-nearest -mlong-calls -mshort-calls -msmall16 @gol
489 -mfp-mode=@var{mode} -mvect-double -max-vect-align=@var{num} @gol
490 -msplit-vecmove-early -m1reg-@var{reg}}
491
492 @emph{ARC Options}
493 @gccoptlist{-mbarrel-shifter @gol
494 -mcpu=@var{cpu} -mA6 -mARC600 -mA7 -mARC700 @gol
495 -mdpfp -mdpfp-compact -mdpfp-fast -mno-dpfp-lrsr @gol
496 -mea -mno-mpy -mmul32x16 -mmul64 @gol
497 -mnorm -mspfp -mspfp-compact -mspfp-fast -msimd -msoft-float -mswap @gol
498 -mcrc -mdsp-packa -mdvbf -mlock -mmac-d16 -mmac-24 -mrtsc -mswape @gol
499 -mtelephony -mxy -misize -mannotate-align -marclinux -marclinux_prof @gol
500 -mepilogue-cfi -mlong-calls -mmedium-calls -msdata @gol
501 -mucb-mcount -mvolatile-cache @gol
502 -malign-call -mauto-modify-reg -mbbit-peephole -mno-brcc @gol
503 -mcase-vector-pcrel -mcompact-casesi -mno-cond-exec -mearly-cbranchsi @gol
504 -mexpand-adddi -mindexed-loads -mlra -mlra-priority-none @gol
505 -mlra-priority-compact mlra-priority-noncompact -mno-millicode @gol
506 -mmixed-code -mq-class -mRcq -mRcw -msize-level=@var{level} @gol
507 -mtune=@var{cpu} -mmultcost=@var{num} -munalign-prob-threshold=@var{probability}}
508
509 @emph{ARM Options}
510 @gccoptlist{-mapcs-frame -mno-apcs-frame @gol
511 -mabi=@var{name} @gol
512 -mapcs-stack-check -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
513 -mapcs-float -mno-apcs-float @gol
514 -mapcs-reentrant -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
515 -msched-prolog -mno-sched-prolog @gol
516 -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -mwords-little-endian @gol
517 -mfloat-abi=@var{name} @gol
518 -mfp16-format=@var{name}
519 -mthumb-interwork -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
520 -mcpu=@var{name} -march=@var{name} -mfpu=@var{name} @gol
521 -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
522 -mabort-on-noreturn @gol
523 -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls @gol
524 -msingle-pic-base -mno-single-pic-base @gol
525 -mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
526 -mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
527 -mpoke-function-name @gol
528 -mthumb -marm @gol
529 -mtpcs-frame -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
530 -mcaller-super-interworking -mcallee-super-interworking @gol
531 -mtp=@var{name} -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect} @gol
532 -mword-relocations @gol
533 -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd @gol
534 -munaligned-access @gol
535 -mneon-for-64bits @gol
536 -mslow-flash-data @gol
537 -mrestrict-it}
538
539 @emph{AVR Options}
540 @gccoptlist{-mmcu=@var{mcu} -maccumulate-args -mbranch-cost=@var{cost} @gol
541 -mcall-prologues -mint8 -mno-interrupts -mrelax @gol
542 -mstrict-X -mtiny-stack -Waddr-space-convert}
543
544 @emph{Blackfin Options}
545 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]} @gol
546 -msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
547 -mspecld-anomaly -mno-specld-anomaly -mcsync-anomaly -mno-csync-anomaly @gol
548 -mlow-64k -mno-low64k -mstack-check-l1 -mid-shared-library @gol
549 -mno-id-shared-library -mshared-library-id=@var{n} @gol
550 -mleaf-id-shared-library -mno-leaf-id-shared-library @gol
551 -msep-data -mno-sep-data -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls @gol
552 -mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore -mcorea -mcoreb -msdram @gol
553 -micplb}
554
555 @emph{C6X Options}
556 @gccoptlist{-mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -march=@var{cpu} @gol
557 -msim -msdata=@var{sdata-type}}
558
559 @emph{CRIS Options}
560 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -march=@var{cpu} -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
561 -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n} -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
562 -metrax4 -metrax100 -mpdebug -mcc-init -mno-side-effects @gol
563 -mstack-align -mdata-align -mconst-align @gol
564 -m32-bit -m16-bit -m8-bit -mno-prologue-epilogue -mno-gotplt @gol
565 -melf -maout -melinux -mlinux -sim -sim2 @gol
566 -mmul-bug-workaround -mno-mul-bug-workaround}
567
568 @emph{CR16 Options}
569 @gccoptlist{-mmac @gol
570 -mcr16cplus -mcr16c @gol
571 -msim -mint32 -mbit-ops
572 -mdata-model=@var{model}}
573
574 @emph{Darwin Options}
575 @gccoptlist{-all_load -allowable_client -arch -arch_errors_fatal @gol
576 -arch_only -bind_at_load -bundle -bundle_loader @gol
577 -client_name -compatibility_version -current_version @gol
578 -dead_strip @gol
579 -dependency-file -dylib_file -dylinker_install_name @gol
580 -dynamic -dynamiclib -exported_symbols_list @gol
581 -filelist -flat_namespace -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
582 -force_flat_namespace -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
583 -iframework @gol
584 -image_base -init -install_name -keep_private_externs @gol
585 -multi_module -multiply_defined -multiply_defined_unused @gol
586 -noall_load -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms @gol
587 -nofixprebinding -nomultidefs -noprebind -noseglinkedit @gol
588 -pagezero_size -prebind -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
589 -private_bundle -read_only_relocs -sectalign @gol
590 -sectobjectsymbols -whyload -seg1addr @gol
591 -sectcreate -sectobjectsymbols -sectorder @gol
592 -segaddr -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
593 -seg_addr_table -seg_addr_table_filename -seglinkedit @gol
594 -segprot -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
595 -single_module -static -sub_library -sub_umbrella @gol
596 -twolevel_namespace -umbrella -undefined @gol
597 -unexported_symbols_list -weak_reference_mismatches @gol
598 -whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version} @gol
599 -mkernel -mone-byte-bool}
600
601 @emph{DEC Alpha Options}
602 @gccoptlist{-mno-fp-regs -msoft-float @gol
603 -mieee -mieee-with-inexact -mieee-conformant @gol
604 -mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode} -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
605 -mtrap-precision=@var{mode} -mbuild-constants @gol
606 -mcpu=@var{cpu-type} -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
607 -mbwx -mmax -mfix -mcix @gol
608 -mfloat-vax -mfloat-ieee @gol
609 -mexplicit-relocs -msmall-data -mlarge-data @gol
610 -msmall-text -mlarge-text @gol
611 -mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
612
613 @emph{FR30 Options}
614 @gccoptlist{-msmall-model -mno-lsim}
615
616 @emph{FRV Options}
617 @gccoptlist{-mgpr-32 -mgpr-64 -mfpr-32 -mfpr-64 @gol
618 -mhard-float -msoft-float @gol
619 -malloc-cc -mfixed-cc -mdword -mno-dword @gol
620 -mdouble -mno-double @gol
621 -mmedia -mno-media -mmuladd -mno-muladd @gol
622 -mfdpic -minline-plt -mgprel-ro -multilib-library-pic @gol
623 -mlinked-fp -mlong-calls -malign-labels @gol
624 -mlibrary-pic -macc-4 -macc-8 @gol
625 -mpack -mno-pack -mno-eflags -mcond-move -mno-cond-move @gol
626 -moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar @gol
627 -mscc -mno-scc -mcond-exec -mno-cond-exec @gol
628 -mvliw-branch -mno-vliw-branch @gol
629 -mmulti-cond-exec -mno-multi-cond-exec -mnested-cond-exec @gol
630 -mno-nested-cond-exec -mtomcat-stats @gol
631 -mTLS -mtls @gol
632 -mcpu=@var{cpu}}
633
634 @emph{GNU/Linux Options}
635 @gccoptlist{-mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid @gol
636 -tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld}
637
638 @emph{H8/300 Options}
639 @gccoptlist{-mrelax -mh -ms -mn -mexr -mno-exr -mint32 -malign-300}
640
641 @emph{HPPA Options}
642 @gccoptlist{-march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
643 -mdisable-fpregs -mdisable-indexing @gol
644 -mfast-indirect-calls -mgas -mgnu-ld -mhp-ld @gol
645 -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
646 -mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
647 -mlong-load-store -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
648 -mno-disable-indexing -mno-fast-indirect-calls -mno-gas @gol
649 -mno-jump-in-delay -mno-long-load-store @gol
650 -mno-portable-runtime -mno-soft-float @gol
651 -mno-space-regs -msoft-float -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
652 -mpa-risc-1-1 -mpa-risc-2-0 -mportable-runtime @gol
653 -mschedule=@var{cpu-type} -mspace-regs -msio -mwsio @gol
654 -munix=@var{unix-std} -nolibdld -static -threads}
655
656 @emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
657 @gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
658 -mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list} -mdump-tune-features -mno-default @gol
659 -mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
660 -masm=@var{dialect} -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
661 -mno-fp-ret-in-387 -msoft-float @gol
662 -mno-wide-multiply -mrtd -malign-double @gol
663 -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
664 -mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
665 -mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe -mcrc32 @gol
666 -mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} @gol
667 -mvzeroupper -mprefer-avx128 @gol
668 -mmmx -msse -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx @gol
669 -mavx2 -mavx512f -mavx512pf -mavx512er -mavx512cd @gol
670 -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfma @gol
671 -msse4a -m3dnow -mpopcnt -mabm -mbmi -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop -mlzcnt @gol
672 -mbmi2 -mfxsr -mxsave -mxsaveopt -mrtm -mlwp -mthreads @gol
673 -mno-align-stringops -minline-all-stringops @gol
674 -minline-stringops-dynamically -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg} @gol
675 -mmemcpy-strategy=@var{strategy} -mmemset-strategy=@var{strategy}
676 -mpush-args -maccumulate-outgoing-args -m128bit-long-double @gol
677 -m96bit-long-double -mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-80 @gol
678 -mregparm=@var{num} -msseregparm @gol
679 -mveclibabi=@var{type} -mvect8-ret-in-mem @gol
680 -mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign @gol
681 -momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs @gol
682 -mcmodel=@var{code-model} -mabi=@var{name} -maddress-mode=@var{mode} @gol
683 -m32 -m64 -mx32 -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{num} @gol
684 -msse2avx -mfentry -m8bit-idiv @gol
685 -mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store @gol
686 -mstack-protector-guard=@var{guard}}
687
688 @emph{i386 and x86-64 Windows Options}
689 @gccoptlist{-mconsole -mcygwin -mno-cygwin -mdll @gol
690 -mnop-fun-dllimport -mthread @gol
691 -municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable}
692
693 @emph{IA-64 Options}
694 @gccoptlist{-mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mgnu-as -mgnu-ld -mno-pic @gol
695 -mvolatile-asm-stop -mregister-names -msdata -mno-sdata @gol
696 -mconstant-gp -mauto-pic -mfused-madd @gol
697 -minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
698 -minline-float-divide-max-throughput @gol
699 -mno-inline-float-divide @gol
700 -minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
701 -minline-int-divide-max-throughput @gol
702 -mno-inline-int-divide @gol
703 -minline-sqrt-min-latency -minline-sqrt-max-throughput @gol
704 -mno-inline-sqrt @gol
705 -mdwarf2-asm -mearly-stop-bits @gol
706 -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} -mtls-size=@var{tls-size} @gol
707 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} -milp32 -mlp64 @gol
708 -msched-br-data-spec -msched-ar-data-spec -msched-control-spec @gol
709 -msched-br-in-data-spec -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec @gol
710 -msched-spec-ldc -msched-spec-control-ldc @gol
711 -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns @gol
712 -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path @gol
713 -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost @gol
714 -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}}
715
716 @emph{LM32 Options}
717 @gccoptlist{-mbarrel-shift-enabled -mdivide-enabled -mmultiply-enabled @gol
718 -msign-extend-enabled -muser-enabled}
719
720 @emph{M32R/D Options}
721 @gccoptlist{-m32r2 -m32rx -m32r @gol
722 -mdebug @gol
723 -malign-loops -mno-align-loops @gol
724 -missue-rate=@var{number} @gol
725 -mbranch-cost=@var{number} @gol
726 -mmodel=@var{code-size-model-type} @gol
727 -msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
728 -mno-flush-func -mflush-func=@var{name} @gol
729 -mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=@var{number} @gol
730 -G @var{num}}
731
732 @emph{M32C Options}
733 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -msim -memregs=@var{number}}
734
735 @emph{M680x0 Options}
736 @gccoptlist{-march=@var{arch} -mcpu=@var{cpu} -mtune=@var{tune}
737 -m68000 -m68020 -m68020-40 -m68020-60 -m68030 -m68040 @gol
738 -m68060 -mcpu32 -m5200 -m5206e -m528x -m5307 -m5407 @gol
739 -mcfv4e -mbitfield -mno-bitfield -mc68000 -mc68020 @gol
740 -mnobitfield -mrtd -mno-rtd -mdiv -mno-div -mshort @gol
741 -mno-short -mhard-float -m68881 -msoft-float -mpcrel @gol
742 -malign-int -mstrict-align -msep-data -mno-sep-data @gol
743 -mshared-library-id=n -mid-shared-library -mno-id-shared-library @gol
744 -mxgot -mno-xgot}
745
746 @emph{MCore Options}
747 @gccoptlist{-mhardlit -mno-hardlit -mdiv -mno-div -mrelax-immediates @gol
748 -mno-relax-immediates -mwide-bitfields -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
749 -m4byte-functions -mno-4byte-functions -mcallgraph-data @gol
750 -mno-callgraph-data -mslow-bytes -mno-slow-bytes -mno-lsim @gol
751 -mlittle-endian -mbig-endian -m210 -m340 -mstack-increment}
752
753 @emph{MeP Options}
754 @gccoptlist{-mabsdiff -mall-opts -maverage -mbased=@var{n} -mbitops @gol
755 -mc=@var{n} -mclip -mconfig=@var{name} -mcop -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 @gol
756 -mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax @gol
757 -mmult -mno-opts -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf @gol
758 -mtiny=@var{n}}
759
760 @emph{MicroBlaze Options}
761 @gccoptlist{-msoft-float -mhard-float -msmall-divides -mcpu=@var{cpu} @gol
762 -mmemcpy -mxl-soft-mul -mxl-soft-div -mxl-barrel-shift @gol
763 -mxl-pattern-compare -mxl-stack-check -mxl-gp-opt -mno-clearbss @gol
764 -mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt @gol
765 -mbig-endian -mlittle-endian -mxl-reorder -mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}
766
767 @emph{MIPS Options}
768 @gccoptlist{-EL -EB -march=@var{arch} -mtune=@var{arch} @gol
769 -mips1 -mips2 -mips3 -mips4 -mips32 -mips32r2 @gol
770 -mips64 -mips64r2 @gol
771 -mips16 -mno-mips16 -mflip-mips16 @gol
772 -minterlink-compressed -mno-interlink-compressed @gol
773 -minterlink-mips16 -mno-interlink-mips16 @gol
774 -mabi=@var{abi} -mabicalls -mno-abicalls @gol
775 -mshared -mno-shared -mplt -mno-plt -mxgot -mno-xgot @gol
776 -mgp32 -mgp64 -mfp32 -mfp64 -mhard-float -msoft-float @gol
777 -mno-float -msingle-float -mdouble-float @gol
778 -mabs=@var{mode} -mnan=@var{encoding} @gol
779 -mdsp -mno-dsp -mdspr2 -mno-dspr2 @gol
780 -mmcu -mmno-mcu @gol
781 -meva -mno-eva @gol
782 -mmicromips -mno-micromips @gol
783 -mfpu=@var{fpu-type} @gol
784 -msmartmips -mno-smartmips @gol
785 -mpaired-single -mno-paired-single -mdmx -mno-mdmx @gol
786 -mips3d -mno-mips3d -mmt -mno-mt -mllsc -mno-llsc @gol
787 -mlong64 -mlong32 -msym32 -mno-sym32 @gol
788 -G@var{num} -mlocal-sdata -mno-local-sdata @gol
789 -mextern-sdata -mno-extern-sdata -mgpopt -mno-gopt @gol
790 -membedded-data -mno-embedded-data @gol
791 -muninit-const-in-rodata -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
792 -mcode-readable=@var{setting} @gol
793 -msplit-addresses -mno-split-addresses @gol
794 -mexplicit-relocs -mno-explicit-relocs @gol
795 -mcheck-zero-division -mno-check-zero-division @gol
796 -mdivide-traps -mdivide-breaks @gol
797 -mmemcpy -mno-memcpy -mlong-calls -mno-long-calls @gol
798 -mmad -mno-mad -mimadd -mno-imadd -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -nocpp @gol
799 -mfix-24k -mno-fix-24k @gol
800 -mfix-r4000 -mno-fix-r4000 -mfix-r4400 -mno-fix-r4400 @gol
801 -mfix-r10000 -mno-fix-r10000 -mfix-rm7000 -mno-fix-rm7000 @gol
802 -mfix-vr4120 -mno-fix-vr4120 @gol
803 -mfix-vr4130 -mno-fix-vr4130 -mfix-sb1 -mno-fix-sb1 @gol
804 -mflush-func=@var{func} -mno-flush-func @gol
805 -mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mbranch-likely -mno-branch-likely @gol
806 -mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions @gol
807 -mvr4130-align -mno-vr4130-align -msynci -mno-synci @gol
808 -mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address}
809
810 @emph{MMIX Options}
811 @gccoptlist{-mlibfuncs -mno-libfuncs -mepsilon -mno-epsilon -mabi=gnu @gol
812 -mabi=mmixware -mzero-extend -mknuthdiv -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
813 -melf -mbranch-predict -mno-branch-predict -mbase-addresses @gol
814 -mno-base-addresses -msingle-exit -mno-single-exit}
815
816 @emph{MN10300 Options}
817 @gccoptlist{-mmult-bug -mno-mult-bug @gol
818 -mno-am33 -mam33 -mam33-2 -mam34 @gol
819 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
820 -mreturn-pointer-on-d0 @gol
821 -mno-crt0 -mrelax -mliw -msetlb}
822
823 @emph{Moxie Options}
824 @gccoptlist{-meb -mel -mno-crt0}
825
826 @emph{MSP430 Options}
827 @gccoptlist{-msim -masm-hex -mmcu= -mlarge -msmall -mrelax}
828
829 @emph{NDS32 Options}
830 @gccoptlist{-mbig-endian -mlittle-endian @gol
831 -mreduced-regs -mfull-regs @gol
832 -mcmov -mno-cmov @gol
833 -mperf-ext -mno-perf-ext @gol
834 -mv3push -mno-v3push @gol
835 -m16bit -mno-16bit @gol
836 -mgp-direct -mno-gp-direct @gol
837 -misr-vector-size=@var{num} @gol
838 -mcache-block-size=@var{num} @gol
839 -march=@var{arch} @gol
840 -mforce-fp-as-gp -mforbid-fp-as-gp @gol
841 -mex9 -mctor-dtor -mrelax}
842
843 @emph{PDP-11 Options}
844 @gccoptlist{-mfpu -msoft-float -mac0 -mno-ac0 -m40 -m45 -m10 @gol
845 -mbcopy -mbcopy-builtin -mint32 -mno-int16 @gol
846 -mint16 -mno-int32 -mfloat32 -mno-float64 @gol
847 -mfloat64 -mno-float32 -mabshi -mno-abshi @gol
848 -mbranch-expensive -mbranch-cheap @gol
849 -munix-asm -mdec-asm}
850
851 @emph{picoChip Options}
852 @gccoptlist{-mae=@var{ae_type} -mvliw-lookahead=@var{N} @gol
853 -msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings}
854
855 @emph{PowerPC Options}
856 See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
857
858 @emph{RL78 Options}
859 @gccoptlist{-msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=rl78}
860
861 @emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
862 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
863 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
864 -mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
865 -mpowerpc64 @gol
866 -maltivec -mno-altivec @gol
867 -mpowerpc-gpopt -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
868 -mpowerpc-gfxopt -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
869 -mmfcrf -mno-mfcrf -mpopcntb -mno-popcntb -mpopcntd -mno-popcntd @gol
870 -mfprnd -mno-fprnd @gol
871 -mcmpb -mno-cmpb -mmfpgpr -mno-mfpgpr -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
872 -mfull-toc -mminimal-toc -mno-fp-in-toc -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
873 -m64 -m32 -mxl-compat -mno-xl-compat -mpe @gol
874 -malign-power -malign-natural @gol
875 -msoft-float -mhard-float -mmultiple -mno-multiple @gol
876 -msingle-float -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu @gol
877 -mstring -mno-string -mupdate -mno-update @gol
878 -mavoid-indexed-addresses -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses @gol
879 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -mbit-align -mno-bit-align @gol
880 -mstrict-align -mno-strict-align -mrelocatable @gol
881 -mno-relocatable -mrelocatable-lib -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
882 -mtoc -mno-toc -mlittle -mlittle-endian -mbig -mbig-endian @gol
883 -mdynamic-no-pic -maltivec -mswdiv -msingle-pic-base @gol
884 -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority} @gol
885 -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type} @gol
886 -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme} @gol
887 -mcall-sysv -mcall-netbsd @gol
888 -maix-struct-return -msvr4-struct-return @gol
889 -mabi=@var{abi-type} -msecure-plt -mbss-plt @gol
890 -mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num} @gol
891 -misel -mno-isel @gol
892 -misel=yes -misel=no @gol
893 -mspe -mno-spe @gol
894 -mspe=yes -mspe=no @gol
895 -mpaired @gol
896 -mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode @gol
897 -mvrsave -mno-vrsave @gol
898 -mmulhw -mno-mulhw @gol
899 -mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb @gol
900 -mfloat-gprs=yes -mfloat-gprs=no -mfloat-gprs=single -mfloat-gprs=double @gol
901 -mprototype -mno-prototype @gol
902 -msim -mmvme -mads -myellowknife -memb -msdata @gol
903 -msdata=@var{opt} -mvxworks -G @var{num} -pthread @gol
904 -mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} -mno-recip -mrecip-precision @gol
905 -mno-recip-precision @gol
906 -mveclibabi=@var{type} -mfriz -mno-friz @gol
907 -mpointers-to-nested-functions -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions @gol
908 -msave-toc-indirect -mno-save-toc-indirect @gol
909 -mpower8-fusion -mno-mpower8-fusion -mpower8-vector -mno-power8-vector @gol
910 -mcrypto -mno-crypto -mdirect-move -mno-direct-move @gol
911 -mquad-memory -mno-quad-memory @gol
912 -mcompat-align-parm -mno-compat-align-parm}
913
914 @emph{RX Options}
915 @gccoptlist{-m64bit-doubles -m32bit-doubles -fpu -nofpu@gol
916 -mcpu=@gol
917 -mbig-endian-data -mlittle-endian-data @gol
918 -msmall-data @gol
919 -msim -mno-sim@gol
920 -mas100-syntax -mno-as100-syntax@gol
921 -mrelax@gol
922 -mmax-constant-size=@gol
923 -mint-register=@gol
924 -mpid@gol
925 -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts@gol
926 -msave-acc-in-interrupts}
927
928 @emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
929 @gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
930 -mhard-float -msoft-float -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
931 -mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 @gol
932 -mbackchain -mno-backchain -mpacked-stack -mno-packed-stack @gol
933 -msmall-exec -mno-small-exec -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
934 -m64 -m31 -mdebug -mno-debug -mesa -mzarch @gol
935 -mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd @gol
936 -mwarn-framesize -mwarn-dynamicstack -mstack-size -mstack-guard @gol
937 -mhotpatch[=@var{halfwords}] -mno-hotpatch}
938
939 @emph{Score Options}
940 @gccoptlist{-meb -mel @gol
941 -mnhwloop @gol
942 -muls @gol
943 -mmac @gol
944 -mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d}
945
946 @emph{SH Options}
947 @gccoptlist{-m1 -m2 -m2e @gol
948 -m2a-nofpu -m2a-single-only -m2a-single -m2a @gol
949 -m3 -m3e @gol
950 -m4-nofpu -m4-single-only -m4-single -m4 @gol
951 -m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al @gol
952 -m5-64media -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
953 -m5-32media -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
954 -m5-compact -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
955 -mb -ml -mdalign -mrelax @gol
956 -mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave @gol
957 -mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops -misize -minline-ic_invalidate -mpadstruct @gol
958 -mspace -mprefergot -musermode -multcost=@var{number} -mdiv=@var{strategy} @gol
959 -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name} -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
960 -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=@var{number} -mpt-fixed @gol
961 -maccumulate-outgoing-args -minvalid-symbols @gol
962 -matomic-model=@var{atomic-model} @gol
963 -mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mzdcbranch -mno-zdcbranch @gol
964 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd -mfsca -mno-fsca -mfsrra -mno-fsrra @gol
965 -mpretend-cmove -mtas}
966
967 @emph{Solaris 2 Options}
968 @gccoptlist{-mimpure-text -mno-impure-text @gol
969 -pthreads -pthread}
970
971 @emph{SPARC Options}
972 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
973 -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
974 -mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
975 -mmemory-model=@var{mem-model} @gol
976 -m32 -m64 -mapp-regs -mno-app-regs @gol
977 -mfaster-structs -mno-faster-structs -mflat -mno-flat @gol
978 -mfpu -mno-fpu -mhard-float -msoft-float @gol
979 -mhard-quad-float -msoft-quad-float @gol
980 -mstack-bias -mno-stack-bias @gol
981 -munaligned-doubles -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
982 -mv8plus -mno-v8plus -mvis -mno-vis @gol
983 -mvis2 -mno-vis2 -mvis3 -mno-vis3 @gol
984 -mcbcond -mno-cbcond @gol
985 -mfmaf -mno-fmaf -mpopc -mno-popc @gol
986 -mfix-at697f -mfix-ut699}
987
988 @emph{SPU Options}
989 @gccoptlist{-mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc @gol
990 -msafe-dma -munsafe-dma @gol
991 -mbranch-hints @gol
992 -msmall-mem -mlarge-mem -mstdmain @gol
993 -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
994 -mea32 -mea64 @gol
995 -maddress-space-conversion -mno-address-space-conversion @gol
996 -mcache-size=@var{cache-size} @gol
997 -matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates}
998
999 @emph{System V Options}
1000 @gccoptlist{-Qy -Qn -YP,@var{paths} -Ym,@var{dir}}
1001
1002 @emph{TILE-Gx Options}
1003 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32 -m64 -mcmodel=@var{code-model}}
1004
1005 @emph{TILEPro Options}
1006 @gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32}
1007
1008 @emph{V850 Options}
1009 @gccoptlist{-mlong-calls -mno-long-calls -mep -mno-ep @gol
1010 -mprolog-function -mno-prolog-function -mspace @gol
1011 -mtda=@var{n} -msda=@var{n} -mzda=@var{n} @gol
1012 -mapp-regs -mno-app-regs @gol
1013 -mdisable-callt -mno-disable-callt @gol
1014 -mv850e2v3 -mv850e2 -mv850e1 -mv850es @gol
1015 -mv850e -mv850 -mv850e3v5 @gol
1016 -mloop @gol
1017 -mrelax @gol
1018 -mlong-jumps @gol
1019 -msoft-float @gol
1020 -mhard-float @gol
1021 -mgcc-abi @gol
1022 -mrh850-abi @gol
1023 -mbig-switch}
1024
1025 @emph{VAX Options}
1026 @gccoptlist{-mg -mgnu -munix}
1027
1028 @emph{VMS Options}
1029 @gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64 @gol
1030 -mpointer-size=@var{size}}
1031
1032 @emph{VxWorks Options}
1033 @gccoptlist{-mrtp -non-static -Bstatic -Bdynamic @gol
1034 -Xbind-lazy -Xbind-now}
1035
1036 @emph{x86-64 Options}
1037 See i386 and x86-64 Options.
1038
1039 @emph{Xstormy16 Options}
1040 @gccoptlist{-msim}
1041
1042 @emph{Xtensa Options}
1043 @gccoptlist{-mconst16 -mno-const16 @gol
1044 -mfused-madd -mno-fused-madd @gol
1045 -mforce-no-pic @gol
1046 -mserialize-volatile -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
1047 -mtext-section-literals -mno-text-section-literals @gol
1048 -mtarget-align -mno-target-align @gol
1049 -mlongcalls -mno-longcalls}
1050
1051 @emph{zSeries Options}
1052 See S/390 and zSeries Options.
1053
1054 @item Code Generation Options
1055 @xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
1056 @gccoptlist{-fcall-saved-@var{reg} -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
1057 -ffixed-@var{reg} -fexceptions @gol
1058 -fnon-call-exceptions -fdelete-dead-exceptions -funwind-tables @gol
1059 -fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
1060 -finhibit-size-directive -finstrument-functions @gol
1061 -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{} @gol
1062 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{} @gol
1063 -fno-common -fno-ident @gol
1064 -fpcc-struct-return -fpic -fPIC -fpie -fPIE @gol
1065 -fno-jump-tables @gol
1066 -frecord-gcc-switches @gol
1067 -freg-struct-return -fshort-enums @gol
1068 -fshort-double -fshort-wchar @gol
1069 -fverbose-asm -fpack-struct[=@var{n}] -fstack-check @gol
1070 -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg} -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
1071 -fno-stack-limit -fsplit-stack @gol
1072 -fleading-underscore -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
1073 -fstack-reuse=@var{reuse_level} @gol
1074 -ftrapv -fwrapv -fbounds-check @gol
1075 -fvisibility -fstrict-volatile-bitfields -fsync-libcalls}
1076 @end table
1077
1078 @menu
1079 * Overall Options:: Controlling the kind of output:
1080 an executable, object files, assembler files,
1081 or preprocessed source.
1082 * C Dialect Options:: Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
1083 * C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
1084 * Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
1085 and Objective-C++.
1086 * Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
1087 formatted.
1088 * Warning Options:: How picky should the compiler be?
1089 * Debugging Options:: Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
1090 * Optimize Options:: How much optimization?
1091 * Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
1092 Also, getting dependency information for Make.
1093 * Assembler Options:: Passing options to the assembler.
1094 * Link Options:: Specifying libraries and so on.
1095 * Directory Options:: Where to find header files and libraries.
1096 Where to find the compiler executable files.
1097 * Spec Files:: How to pass switches to sub-processes.
1098 * Target Options:: Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
1099 @end menu
1100
1101 @node Overall Options
1102 @section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
1103
1104 Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
1105 proper, assembly and linking, always in that order. GCC is capable of
1106 preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
1107 assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then each
1108 assembler input file produces an object file, and linking combines all
1109 the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input)
1110 into an executable file.
1111
1112 @cindex file name suffix
1113 For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
1114 compilation is done:
1115
1116 @table @gcctabopt
1117 @item @var{file}.c
1118 C source code that must be preprocessed.
1119
1120 @item @var{file}.i
1121 C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1122
1123 @item @var{file}.ii
1124 C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1125
1126 @item @var{file}.m
1127 Objective-C source code. Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1128 library to make an Objective-C program work.
1129
1130 @item @var{file}.mi
1131 Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1132
1133 @item @var{file}.mm
1134 @itemx @var{file}.M
1135 Objective-C++ source code. Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1136 library to make an Objective-C++ program work. Note that @samp{.M} refers
1137 to a literal capital M@.
1138
1139 @item @var{file}.mii
1140 Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1141
1142 @item @var{file}.h
1143 C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a
1144 precompiled header (default), or C, C++ header file to be turned into an
1145 Ada spec (via the @option{-fdump-ada-spec} switch).
1146
1147 @item @var{file}.cc
1148 @itemx @var{file}.cp
1149 @itemx @var{file}.cxx
1150 @itemx @var{file}.cpp
1151 @itemx @var{file}.CPP
1152 @itemx @var{file}.c++
1153 @itemx @var{file}.C
1154 C++ source code that must be preprocessed. Note that in @samp{.cxx},
1155 the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}. Likewise,
1156 @samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
1157
1158 @item @var{file}.mm
1159 @itemx @var{file}.M
1160 Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.
1161
1162 @item @var{file}.mii
1163 Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1164
1165 @item @var{file}.hh
1166 @itemx @var{file}.H
1167 @itemx @var{file}.hp
1168 @itemx @var{file}.hxx
1169 @itemx @var{file}.hpp
1170 @itemx @var{file}.HPP
1171 @itemx @var{file}.h++
1172 @itemx @var{file}.tcc
1173 C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.
1174
1175 @item @var{file}.f
1176 @itemx @var{file}.for
1177 @itemx @var{file}.ftn
1178 Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1179
1180 @item @var{file}.F
1181 @itemx @var{file}.FOR
1182 @itemx @var{file}.fpp
1183 @itemx @var{file}.FPP
1184 @itemx @var{file}.FTN
1185 Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional
1186 preprocessor).
1187
1188 @item @var{file}.f90
1189 @itemx @var{file}.f95
1190 @itemx @var{file}.f03
1191 @itemx @var{file}.f08
1192 Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1193
1194 @item @var{file}.F90
1195 @itemx @var{file}.F95
1196 @itemx @var{file}.F03
1197 @itemx @var{file}.F08
1198 Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
1199 traditional preprocessor).
1200
1201 @item @var{file}.go
1202 Go source code.
1203
1204 @c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
1205 @c @var{file}.java
1206 @c @var{file}.class
1207 @c @var{file}.zip
1208 @c @var{file}.jar
1209
1210 @item @var{file}.ads
1211 Ada source code file that contains a library unit declaration (a
1212 declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
1213 instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
1214 generic, or subprogram renaming declaration). Such files are also
1215 called @dfn{specs}.
1216
1217 @item @var{file}.adb
1218 Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
1219 package body). Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
1220
1221 @c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
1222 @c Pascal:
1223 @c @var{file}.p
1224 @c @var{file}.pas
1225 @c Ratfor:
1226 @c @var{file}.r
1227
1228 @item @var{file}.s
1229 Assembler code.
1230
1231 @item @var{file}.S
1232 @itemx @var{file}.sx
1233 Assembler code that must be preprocessed.
1234
1235 @item @var{other}
1236 An object file to be fed straight into linking.
1237 Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
1238 @end table
1239
1240 @opindex x
1241 You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
1242
1243 @table @gcctabopt
1244 @item -x @var{language}
1245 Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
1246 (rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
1247 name suffix). This option applies to all following input files until
1248 the next @option{-x} option. Possible values for @var{language} are:
1249 @smallexample
1250 c c-header cpp-output
1251 c++ c++-header c++-cpp-output
1252 objective-c objective-c-header objective-c-cpp-output
1253 objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
1254 assembler assembler-with-cpp
1255 ada
1256 f77 f77-cpp-input f95 f95-cpp-input
1257 go
1258 java
1259 @end smallexample
1260
1261 @item -x none
1262 Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
1263 handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
1264 has not been used at all).
1265
1266 @item -pass-exit-codes
1267 @opindex pass-exit-codes
1268 Normally the @command{gcc} program exits with the code of 1 if any
1269 phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code. If you specify
1270 @option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program instead returns with
1271 the numerically highest error produced by any phase returning an error
1272 indication. The C, C++, and Fortran front ends return 4 if an internal
1273 compiler error is encountered.
1274 @end table
1275
1276 If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
1277 @option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
1278 one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
1279 @command{gcc} is to stop. Note that some combinations (for example,
1280 @samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
1281
1282 @table @gcctabopt
1283 @item -c
1284 @opindex c
1285 Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link. The linking
1286 stage simply is not done. The ultimate output is in the form of an
1287 object file for each source file.
1288
1289 By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
1290 the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
1291
1292 Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
1293 ignored.
1294
1295 @item -S
1296 @opindex S
1297 Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble. The output
1298 is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
1299 file specified.
1300
1301 By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
1302 replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
1303
1304 Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1305
1306 @item -E
1307 @opindex E
1308 Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper. The
1309 output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
1310 standard output.
1311
1312 Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1313
1314 @cindex output file option
1315 @item -o @var{file}
1316 @opindex o
1317 Place output in file @var{file}. This applies to whatever
1318 sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
1319 an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1320
1321 If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable
1322 file in @file{a.out}, the object file for
1323 @file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in @file{@var{source}.o}, its
1324 assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, a precompiled header file in
1325 @file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}.gch}, and all preprocessed C source on
1326 standard output.
1327
1328 @item -v
1329 @opindex v
1330 Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
1331 of compilation. Also print the version number of the compiler driver
1332 program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
1333
1334 @item -###
1335 @opindex ###
1336 Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and arguments
1337 are quoted unless they contain only alphanumeric characters or @code{./-_}.
1338 This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated command lines.
1339
1340 @item -pipe
1341 @opindex pipe
1342 Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1343 various stages of compilation. This fails to work on some systems where
1344 the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
1345 no trouble.
1346
1347 @item --help
1348 @opindex help
1349 Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line options
1350 understood by @command{gcc}. If the @option{-v} option is also specified
1351 then @option{--help} is also passed on to the various processes
1352 invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command-line options
1353 they accept. If the @option{-Wextra} option has also been specified
1354 (prior to the @option{--help} option), then command-line options that
1355 have no documentation associated with them are also displayed.
1356
1357 @item --target-help
1358 @opindex target-help
1359 Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command-line
1360 options for each tool. For some targets extra target-specific
1361 information may also be printed.
1362
1363 @item --help=@{@var{class}@r{|[}^@r{]}@var{qualifier}@}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]}
1364 Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1365 options understood by the compiler that fit into all specified classes
1366 and qualifiers. These are the supported classes:
1367
1368 @table @asis
1369 @item @samp{optimizers}
1370 Display all of the optimization options supported by the
1371 compiler.
1372
1373 @item @samp{warnings}
1374 Display all of the options controlling warning messages
1375 produced by the compiler.
1376
1377 @item @samp{target}
1378 Display target-specific options. Unlike the
1379 @option{--target-help} option however, target-specific options of the
1380 linker and assembler are not displayed. This is because those
1381 tools do not currently support the extended @option{--help=} syntax.
1382
1383 @item @samp{params}
1384 Display the values recognized by the @option{--param}
1385 option.
1386
1387 @item @var{language}
1388 Display the options supported for @var{language}, where
1389 @var{language} is the name of one of the languages supported in this
1390 version of GCC@.
1391
1392 @item @samp{common}
1393 Display the options that are common to all languages.
1394 @end table
1395
1396 These are the supported qualifiers:
1397
1398 @table @asis
1399 @item @samp{undocumented}
1400 Display only those options that are undocumented.
1401
1402 @item @samp{joined}
1403 Display options taking an argument that appears after an equal
1404 sign in the same continuous piece of text, such as:
1405 @samp{--help=target}.
1406
1407 @item @samp{separate}
1408 Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate word
1409 following the original option, such as: @samp{-o output-file}.
1410 @end table
1411
1412 Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific
1413 switches supported by the compiler, use:
1414
1415 @smallexample
1416 --help=target,undocumented
1417 @end smallexample
1418
1419 The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the
1420 @samp{^} character, so for example to display all binary warning
1421 options (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
1422 argument) that have a description, use:
1423
1424 @smallexample
1425 --help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented
1426 @end smallexample
1427
1428 The argument to @option{--help=} should not consist solely of inverted
1429 qualifiers.
1430
1431 Combining several classes is possible, although this usually
1432 restricts the output so much that there is nothing to display. One
1433 case where it does work, however, is when one of the classes is
1434 @var{target}. For example, to display all the target-specific
1435 optimization options, use:
1436
1437 @smallexample
1438 --help=target,optimizers
1439 @end smallexample
1440
1441 The @option{--help=} option can be repeated on the command line. Each
1442 successive use displays its requested class of options, skipping
1443 those that have already been displayed.
1444
1445 If the @option{-Q} option appears on the command line before the
1446 @option{--help=} option, then the descriptive text displayed by
1447 @option{--help=} is changed. Instead of describing the displayed
1448 options, an indication is given as to whether the option is enabled,
1449 disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
1450 knows this at the point where the @option{--help=} option is used).
1451
1452 Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of @command{gcc}:
1453
1454 @smallexample
1455 % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
1456 The following options are target specific:
1457 -mabi= 2
1458 -mabort-on-noreturn [disabled]
1459 -mapcs [disabled]
1460 @end smallexample
1461
1462 The output is sensitive to the effects of previous command-line
1463 options, so for example it is possible to find out which optimizations
1464 are enabled at @option{-O2} by using:
1465
1466 @smallexample
1467 -Q -O2 --help=optimizers
1468 @end smallexample
1469
1470 Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled
1471 by @option{-O3} by using:
1472
1473 @smallexample
1474 gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
1475 gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
1476 diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled
1477 @end smallexample
1478
1479 @item -no-canonical-prefixes
1480 @opindex no-canonical-prefixes
1481 Do not expand any symbolic links, resolve references to @samp{/../}
1482 or @samp{/./}, or make the path absolute when generating a relative
1483 prefix.
1484
1485 @item --version
1486 @opindex version
1487 Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC@.
1488
1489 @item -wrapper
1490 @opindex wrapper
1491 Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program. The name of the
1492 wrapper program and its parameters are passed as a comma separated
1493 list.
1494
1495 @smallexample
1496 gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args
1497 @end smallexample
1498
1499 @noindent
1500 This invokes all subprograms of @command{gcc} under
1501 @samp{gdb --args}, thus the invocation of @command{cc1} is
1502 @samp{gdb --args cc1 @dots{}}.
1503
1504 @item -fplugin=@var{name}.so
1505 @opindex fplugin
1506 Load the plugin code in file @var{name}.so, assumed to be a
1507 shared object to be dlopen'd by the compiler. The base name of
1508 the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the
1509 purposes of argument parsing (See
1510 @option{-fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}} below).
1511 Each plugin should define the callback functions specified in the
1512 Plugins API.
1513
1514 @item -fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}
1515 @opindex fplugin-arg
1516 Define an argument called @var{key} with a value of @var{value}
1517 for the plugin called @var{name}.
1518
1519 @item -fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]}
1520 @opindex fdump-ada-spec
1521 For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada
1522 specs. @xref{Generating Ada Bindings for C and C++ headers,,, gnat_ugn,
1523 GNAT User's Guide}, which provides detailed documentation on this feature.
1524
1525 @item -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}
1526 @opindex fdump-go-spec
1527 For input files in any language, generate corresponding Go
1528 declarations in @var{file}. This generates Go @code{const},
1529 @code{type}, @code{var}, and @code{func} declarations which may be a
1530 useful way to start writing a Go interface to code written in some
1531 other language.
1532
1533 @include @value{srcdir}/../libiberty/at-file.texi
1534 @end table
1535
1536 @node Invoking G++
1537 @section Compiling C++ Programs
1538
1539 @cindex suffixes for C++ source
1540 @cindex C++ source file suffixes
1541 C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
1542 @samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
1543 @samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh}, @samp{.hpp},
1544 @samp{.H}, or (for shared template code) @samp{.tcc}; and
1545 preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}. GCC recognizes
1546 files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
1547 call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
1548 with the name @command{gcc}).
1549
1550 @findex g++
1551 @findex c++
1552 However, the use of @command{gcc} does not add the C++ library.
1553 @command{g++} is a program that calls GCC and automatically specifies linking
1554 against the C++ library. It treats @samp{.c},
1555 @samp{.h} and @samp{.i} files as C++ source files instead of C source
1556 files unless @option{-x} is used. This program is also useful when
1557 precompiling a C header file with a @samp{.h} extension for use in C++
1558 compilations. On many systems, @command{g++} is also installed with
1559 the name @command{c++}.
1560
1561 @cindex invoking @command{g++}
1562 When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1563 command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1564 language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1565 languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1566 @xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
1567 explanations of options for languages related to C@.
1568 @xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
1569 explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1570
1571 @node C Dialect Options
1572 @section Options Controlling C Dialect
1573 @cindex dialect options
1574 @cindex language dialect options
1575 @cindex options, dialect
1576
1577 The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1578 from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1579 accepts:
1580
1581 @table @gcctabopt
1582 @cindex ANSI support
1583 @cindex ISO support
1584 @item -ansi
1585 @opindex ansi
1586 In C mode, this is equivalent to @option{-std=c90}. In C++ mode, it is
1587 equivalent to @option{-std=c++98}.
1588
1589 This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1590 C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1591 such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1592 predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1593 type of system you are using. It also enables the undesirable and
1594 rarely used ISO trigraph feature. For the C compiler,
1595 it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1596 the @code{inline} keyword.
1597
1598 The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1599 @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1600 @option{-ansi}. You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1601 course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1602 in compilations done with @option{-ansi}. Alternate predefined macros
1603 such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1604 without @option{-ansi}.
1605
1606 The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1607 rejected gratuitously. For that, @option{-Wpedantic} is required in
1608 addition to @option{-ansi}. @xref{Warning Options}.
1609
1610 The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1611 option is used. Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1612 from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1613 ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1614 programs that might use these names for other things.
1615
1616 Functions that are normally built in but do not have semantics
1617 defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1618 functions when @option{-ansi} is used. @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1619 built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1620 affected.
1621
1622 @item -std=
1623 @opindex std
1624 Determine the language standard. @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
1625 Supported by GCC}, for details of these standard versions. This option
1626 is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.
1627
1628 The compiler can accept several base standards, such as @samp{c90} or
1629 @samp{c++98}, and GNU dialects of those standards, such as
1630 @samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu++98}. When a base standard is specified, the
1631 compiler accepts all programs following that standard plus those
1632 using GNU extensions that do not contradict it. For example,
1633 @option{-std=c90} turns off certain features of GCC that are
1634 incompatible with ISO C90, such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof}
1635 keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in
1636 ISO C90, such as omitting the middle term of a @code{?:}
1637 expression. On the other hand, when a GNU dialect of a standard is
1638 specified, all features supported by the compiler are enabled, even when
1639 those features change the meaning of the base standard. As a result, some
1640 strict-conforming programs may be rejected. The particular standard
1641 is used by @option{-Wpedantic} to identify which features are GNU
1642 extensions given that version of the standard. For example
1643 @option{-std=gnu90 -Wpedantic} warns about C++ style @samp{//}
1644 comments, while @option{-std=gnu99 -Wpedantic} does not.
1645
1646 A value for this option must be provided; possible values are
1647
1648 @table @samp
1649 @item c90
1650 @itemx c89
1651 @itemx iso9899:1990
1652 Support all ISO C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict
1653 with ISO C90 are disabled). Same as @option{-ansi} for C code.
1654
1655 @item iso9899:199409
1656 ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1657
1658 @item c99
1659 @itemx c9x
1660 @itemx iso9899:1999
1661 @itemx iso9899:199x
1662 ISO C99. This standard is substantially completely supported, modulo
1663 bugs, extended identifiers (supported except for corner cases when
1664 @option{-fextended-identifiers} is used) and floating-point issues
1665 (mainly but not entirely relating to optional C99 features from
1666 Annexes F and G). See
1667 @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/c99status.html}} for more information. The
1668 names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1669
1670 @item c11
1671 @itemx c1x
1672 @itemx iso9899:2011
1673 ISO C11, the 2011 revision of the ISO C standard. This standard is
1674 substantially completely supported, modulo bugs, extended identifiers
1675 (supported except for corner cases when
1676 @option{-fextended-identifiers} is used), floating-point issues
1677 (mainly but not entirely relating to optional C11 features from
1678 Annexes F and G) and the optional Annexes K (Bounds-checking
1679 interfaces) and L (Analyzability). The name @samp{c1x} is deprecated.
1680
1681 @item gnu90
1682 @itemx gnu89
1683 GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This
1684 is the default for C code.
1685
1686 @item gnu99
1687 @itemx gnu9x
1688 GNU dialect of ISO C99. The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1689
1690 @item gnu11
1691 @itemx gnu1x
1692 GNU dialect of ISO C11. This is intended to become the default in a
1693 future release of GCC. The name @samp{gnu1x} is deprecated.
1694
1695 @item c++98
1696 @itemx c++03
1697 The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus the 2003 technical corrigendum and some
1698 additional defect reports. Same as @option{-ansi} for C++ code.
1699
1700 @item gnu++98
1701 @itemx gnu++03
1702 GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++98}. This is the default for
1703 C++ code.
1704
1705 @item c++11
1706 @itemx c++0x
1707 The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. Support for C++11 is still
1708 experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1709 The name @samp{c++0x} is deprecated.
1710
1711 @item gnu++11
1712 @itemx gnu++0x
1713 GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++11}. Support for C++11 is still
1714 experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1715 The name @samp{gnu++0x} is deprecated.
1716
1717 @item c++1y
1718 The next revision of the ISO C++ standard, tentatively planned for
1719 2014. Support is highly experimental, and will almost certainly
1720 change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1721
1722 @item gnu++1y
1723 GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++1y}. Support is highly experimental,
1724 and will almost certainly change in incompatible ways in future
1725 releases.
1726 @end table
1727
1728 @item -fgnu89-inline
1729 @opindex fgnu89-inline
1730 The option @option{-fgnu89-inline} tells GCC to use the traditional
1731 GNU semantics for @code{inline} functions when in C99 mode.
1732 @xref{Inline,,An Inline Function is As Fast As a Macro}. This option
1733 is accepted and ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including
1734 4.3. In GCC versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in
1735 C99 mode. Using this option is roughly equivalent to adding the
1736 @code{gnu_inline} function attribute to all inline functions
1737 (@pxref{Function Attributes}).
1738
1739 The option @option{-fno-gnu89-inline} explicitly tells GCC to use the
1740 C99 semantics for @code{inline} when in C99 or gnu99 mode (i.e., it
1741 specifies the default behavior). This option was first supported in
1742 GCC 4.3. This option is not supported in @option{-std=c90} or
1743 @option{-std=gnu90} mode.
1744
1745 The preprocessor macros @code{__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__} and
1746 @code{__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__} may be used to check which semantics are
1747 in effect for @code{inline} functions. @xref{Common Predefined
1748 Macros,,,cpp,The C Preprocessor}.
1749
1750 @item -aux-info @var{filename}
1751 @opindex aux-info
1752 Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1753 declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1754 files. This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1755
1756 Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1757 each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1758 implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1759 @samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1760 number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1761 definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1762 character). In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1763 arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1764 comments, after the declaration.
1765
1766 @item -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1767 @opindex fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1768 Accept variadic functions without named parameters.
1769
1770 Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very
1771 useful as it is not possible to read the arguments. This is only
1772 supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.
1773
1774 @item -fno-asm
1775 @opindex fno-asm
1776 Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1777 keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers. You can use
1778 the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1779 instead. @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1780
1781 In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1782 @code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords. You may want to
1783 use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1784 effect. In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1785 switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1786 @code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1787
1788 @item -fno-builtin
1789 @itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1790 @opindex fno-builtin
1791 @cindex built-in functions
1792 Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1793 @samp{__builtin_} as prefix. @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1794 functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1795 including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1796 @option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1797 do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1798
1799 GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1800 more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1801 instructions which adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1802 may become inline copy loops. The resulting code is often both smaller
1803 and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1804 cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1805 of the functions by linking with a different library. In addition,
1806 when a function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use
1807 information about that function to warn about problems with calls to
1808 that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the
1809 resulting code still contains calls to that function. For example,
1810 warnings are given with @option{-Wformat} for bad calls to
1811 @code{printf} when @code{printf} is built in and @code{strlen} is
1812 known not to modify global memory.
1813
1814 With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1815 only the built-in function @var{function} is
1816 disabled. @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}. If a
1817 function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1818 option is ignored. There is no corresponding
1819 @option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1820 built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1821 @option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1822
1823 @smallexample
1824 #define abs(n) __builtin_abs ((n))
1825 #define strcpy(d, s) __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1826 @end smallexample
1827
1828 @item -fhosted
1829 @opindex fhosted
1830 @cindex hosted environment
1831
1832 Assert that compilation targets a hosted environment. This implies
1833 @option{-fbuiltin}. A hosted environment is one in which the
1834 entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1835 type of @code{int}. Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1836 This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1837
1838 @item -ffreestanding
1839 @opindex ffreestanding
1840 @cindex hosted environment
1841
1842 Assert that compilation targets a freestanding environment. This
1843 implies @option{-fno-builtin}. A freestanding environment
1844 is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1845 not necessarily be at @code{main}. The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1846 This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1847
1848 @xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1849 freestanding and hosted environments.
1850
1851 @item -fopenmp
1852 @opindex fopenmp
1853 @cindex OpenMP parallel
1854 Enable handling of OpenMP directives @code{#pragma omp} in C/C++ and
1855 @code{!$omp} in Fortran. When @option{-fopenmp} is specified, the
1856 compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application
1857 Program Interface v4.0 @w{@uref{http://www.openmp.org/}}. This option
1858 implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets that
1859 have support for @option{-pthread}. @option{-fopenmp} implies
1860 @option{-fopenmp-simd}.
1861
1862 @item -fopenmp-simd
1863 @opindex fopenmp-simd
1864 @cindex OpenMP SIMD
1865 @cindex SIMD
1866 Enable handling of OpenMP's SIMD directives with @code{#pragma omp}
1867 in C/C++ and @code{!$omp} in Fortran. Other OpenMP directives
1868 are ignored.
1869
1870 @item -fcilkplus
1871 @opindex fcilkplus
1872 @cindex Enable Cilk Plus
1873 Enable the usage of Cilk Plus language extension features for C/C++.
1874 When the option @option{-fcilkplus} is specified, enable the usage of
1875 the Cilk Plus Language extension features for C/C++. The present
1876 implementation follows ABI version 0.9. This is an experimental
1877 feature that is only partially complete, and whose interface may
1878 change in future versions of GCC as the official specification
1879 changes. Currently only the array notation feature of the language
1880 specification has been implemented. More features will be implemented
1881 in subsequent release cycles.
1882
1883 @item -fgnu-tm
1884 @opindex fgnu-tm
1885 When the option @option{-fgnu-tm} is specified, the compiler
1886 generates code for the Linux variant of Intel's current Transactional
1887 Memory ABI specification document (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009). This is
1888 an experimental feature whose interface may change in future versions
1889 of GCC, as the official specification changes. Please note that not
1890 all architectures are supported for this feature.
1891
1892 For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,
1893 @xref{Enabling libitm,,The GNU Transactional Memory Library,libitm,GNU
1894 Transactional Memory Library}.
1895
1896 Note that the transactional memory feature is not supported with
1897 non-call exceptions (@option{-fnon-call-exceptions}).
1898
1899 @item -fms-extensions
1900 @opindex fms-extensions
1901 Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1902
1903 In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar
1904 to previous types declarations.
1905
1906 @smallexample
1907 typedef int UOW;
1908 struct ABC @{
1909 UOW UOW;
1910 @};
1911 @end smallexample
1912
1913 Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1914 accepted with this option. @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed struct/union
1915 fields within structs/unions}, for details.
1916
1917 Note that this option is off for all targets but i?86 and x86_64
1918 targets using ms-abi.
1919 @item -fplan9-extensions
1920 Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.
1921
1922 This enables @option{-fms-extensions}, permits passing pointers to
1923 structures with anonymous fields to functions that expect pointers to
1924 elements of the type of the field, and permits referring to anonymous
1925 fields declared using a typedef. @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed
1926 struct/union fields within structs/unions}, for details. This is only
1927 supported for C, not C++.
1928
1929 @item -trigraphs
1930 @opindex trigraphs
1931 Support ISO C trigraphs. The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1932 options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1933
1934 @cindex traditional C language
1935 @cindex C language, traditional
1936 @item -traditional
1937 @itemx -traditional-cpp
1938 @opindex traditional-cpp
1939 @opindex traditional
1940 Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1941 C compiler. They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1942 The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode. See the GNU
1943 CPP manual for details.
1944
1945 @item -fcond-mismatch
1946 @opindex fcond-mismatch
1947 Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1948 third arguments. The value of such an expression is void. This option
1949 is not supported for C++.
1950
1951 @item -flax-vector-conversions
1952 @opindex flax-vector-conversions
1953 Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers of
1954 elements and/or incompatible element types. This option should not be
1955 used for new code.
1956
1957 @item -funsigned-char
1958 @opindex funsigned-char
1959 Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1960
1961 Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1962 be. It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1963 @code{signed char} by default.
1964
1965 Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1966 @code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1967 But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1968 expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1969 machines they were written for. This option, and its inverse, let you
1970 make such a program work with the opposite default.
1971
1972 The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1973 @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1974 is always just like one of those two.
1975
1976 @item -fsigned-char
1977 @opindex fsigned-char
1978 Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1979
1980 Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1981 the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}. Likewise, the option
1982 @option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1983
1984 @item -fsigned-bitfields
1985 @itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1986 @itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1987 @itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1988 @opindex fsigned-bitfields
1989 @opindex funsigned-bitfields
1990 @opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1991 @opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1992 These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1993 declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}. By
1994 default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1995 basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1996 @end table
1997
1998 @node C++ Dialect Options
1999 @section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
2000
2001 @cindex compiler options, C++
2002 @cindex C++ options, command-line
2003 @cindex options, C++
2004 This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
2005 for C++ programs. You can also use most of the GNU compiler options
2006 regardless of what language your program is in. For example, you
2007 might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
2008
2009 @smallexample
2010 g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
2011 @end smallexample
2012
2013 @noindent
2014 In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
2015 only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
2016 language supported by GCC@.
2017
2018 Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
2019
2020 @table @gcctabopt
2021
2022 @item -fabi-version=@var{n}
2023 @opindex fabi-version
2024 Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI@. The default is version 2.
2025
2026 Version 0 refers to the version conforming most closely to
2027 the C++ ABI specification. Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0
2028 will change in different versions of G++ as ABI bugs are fixed.
2029
2030 Version 1 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.
2031
2032 Version 2 is the version of the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.
2033
2034 Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a
2035 template argument.
2036
2037 Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard
2038 mangling for vector types.
2039
2040 Version 5, which first appeared in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling of
2041 attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of a
2042 plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of
2043 another parameter.
2044
2045 Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion
2046 behavior of C++11 scoped enums and the mangling of template argument
2047 packs, const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class scope function
2048 used as a template argument.
2049
2050 See also @option{-Wabi}.
2051
2052 @item -fno-access-control
2053 @opindex fno-access-control
2054 Turn off all access checking. This switch is mainly useful for working
2055 around bugs in the access control code.
2056
2057 @item -fcheck-new
2058 @opindex fcheck-new
2059 Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
2060 before attempting to modify the storage allocated. This check is
2061 normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
2062 @code{operator new} only returns @code{0} if it is declared
2063 @samp{throw()}, in which case the compiler always checks the
2064 return value even without this option. In all other cases, when
2065 @code{operator new} has a non-empty exception specification, memory
2066 exhaustion is signalled by throwing @code{std::bad_alloc}. See also
2067 @samp{new (nothrow)}.
2068
2069 @item -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}
2070 @opindex fconstexpr-depth
2071 Set the maximum nested evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr functions
2072 to @var{n}. A limit is needed to detect endless recursion during
2073 constant expression evaluation. The minimum specified by the standard
2074 is 512.
2075
2076 @item -fdeduce-init-list
2077 @opindex fdeduce-init-list
2078 Enable deduction of a template type parameter as
2079 @code{std::initializer_list} from a brace-enclosed initializer list, i.e.@:
2080
2081 @smallexample
2082 template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
2083 @{
2084 return realfn (t);
2085 @}
2086
2087 void f()
2088 @{
2089 forward(@{1,2@}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
2090 @}
2091 @end smallexample
2092
2093 This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the
2094 originally proposed semantics for the C++11 standard, but was not part
2095 of the final standard, so it is disabled by default. This option is
2096 deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of G++.
2097
2098 @item -ffriend-injection
2099 @opindex ffriend-injection
2100 Inject friend functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are
2101 visible outside the scope of the class in which they are declared.
2102 Friend functions were documented to work this way in the old Annotated
2103 C++ Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked
2104 that way. However, in ISO C++ a friend function that is not declared
2105 in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument dependent
2106 lookup. This option causes friends to be injected as they were in
2107 earlier releases.
2108
2109 This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future
2110 release of G++.
2111
2112 @item -fno-elide-constructors
2113 @opindex fno-elide-constructors
2114 The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
2115 that is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
2116 Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
2117 call the copy constructor in all cases.
2118
2119 @item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
2120 @opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
2121 Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications
2122 at run time. This option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful
2123 for reducing code size in production builds, much like defining
2124 @samp{NDEBUG}. This does not give user code permission to throw
2125 exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the compiler
2126 still optimizes based on the specifications, so throwing an
2127 unexpected exception results in undefined behavior at run time.
2128
2129 @item -fextern-tls-init
2130 @itemx -fno-extern-tls-init
2131 @opindex fextern-tls-init
2132 @opindex fno-extern-tls-init
2133 The C++11 and OpenMP standards allow @samp{thread_local} and
2134 @samp{threadprivate} variables to have dynamic (runtime)
2135 initialization. To support this, any use of such a variable goes
2136 through a wrapper function that performs any necessary initialization.
2137 When the use and definition of the variable are in the same
2138 translation unit, this overhead can be optimized away, but when the
2139 use is in a different translation unit there is significant overhead
2140 even if the variable doesn't actually need dynamic initialization. If
2141 the programmer can be sure that no use of the variable in a
2142 non-defining TU needs to trigger dynamic initialization (either
2143 because the variable is statically initialized, or a use of the
2144 variable in the defining TU will be executed before any uses in
2145 another TU), they can avoid this overhead with the
2146 @option{-fno-extern-tls-init} option.
2147
2148 On targets that support symbol aliases, the default is
2149 @option{-fextern-tls-init}. On targets that do not support symbol
2150 aliases, the default is @option{-fno-extern-tls-init}.
2151
2152 @item -ffor-scope
2153 @itemx -fno-for-scope
2154 @opindex ffor-scope
2155 @opindex fno-for-scope
2156 If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2157 a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
2158 as specified by the C++ standard.
2159 If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2160 a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
2161 as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
2162 implementations of C++.
2163
2164 If neither flag is given, the default is to follow the standard,
2165 but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
2166 otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
2167
2168 @item -fno-gnu-keywords
2169 @opindex fno-gnu-keywords
2170 Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
2171 word as an identifier. You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
2172 @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
2173
2174 @item -fno-implicit-templates
2175 @opindex fno-implicit-templates
2176 Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated
2177 implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
2178 @xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
2179
2180 @item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
2181 @opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
2182 Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
2183 The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
2184 without optimization need the same set of explicit instantiations.
2185
2186 @item -fno-implement-inlines
2187 @opindex fno-implement-inlines
2188 To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
2189 controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}. This causes linker
2190 errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
2191
2192 @item -fms-extensions
2193 @opindex fms-extensions
2194 Disable Wpedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
2195 int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
2196
2197 @item -fno-nonansi-builtins
2198 @opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
2199 Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
2200 ANSI/ISO C@. These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
2201 @code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
2202
2203 @item -fnothrow-opt
2204 @opindex fnothrow-opt
2205 Treat a @code{throw()} exception specification as if it were a
2206 @code{noexcept} specification to reduce or eliminate the text size
2207 overhead relative to a function with no exception specification. If
2208 the function has local variables of types with non-trivial
2209 destructors, the exception specification actually makes the
2210 function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be
2211 optimized away. The semantic effect is that an exception thrown out of
2212 a function with such an exception specification results in a call
2213 to @code{terminate} rather than @code{unexpected}.
2214
2215 @item -fno-operator-names
2216 @opindex fno-operator-names
2217 Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
2218 @code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
2219 synonyms as keywords.
2220
2221 @item -fno-optional-diags
2222 @opindex fno-optional-diags
2223 Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
2224 issue. Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
2225 a name having multiple meanings within a class.
2226
2227 @item -fpermissive
2228 @opindex fpermissive
2229 Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
2230 warnings. Thus, using @option{-fpermissive} allows some
2231 nonconforming code to compile.
2232
2233 @item -fno-pretty-templates
2234 @opindex fno-pretty-templates
2235 When an error message refers to a specialization of a function
2236 template, the compiler normally prints the signature of the
2237 template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or
2238 typenames in the signature (e.g. @code{void f(T) [with T = int]}
2239 rather than @code{void f(int)}) so that it's clear which template is
2240 involved. When an error message refers to a specialization of a class
2241 template, the compiler omits any template arguments that match
2242 the default template arguments for that template. If either of these
2243 behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather than
2244 easier, you can use @option{-fno-pretty-templates} to disable them.
2245
2246 @item -frepo
2247 @opindex frepo
2248 Enable automatic template instantiation at link time. This option also
2249 implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}. @xref{Template
2250 Instantiation}, for more information.
2251
2252 @item -fno-rtti
2253 @opindex fno-rtti
2254 Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
2255 functions for use by the C++ run-time type identification features
2256 (@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}). If you don't use those parts
2257 of the language, you can save some space by using this flag. Note that
2258 exception handling uses the same information, but G++ generates it as
2259 needed. The @samp{dynamic_cast} operator can still be used for casts that
2260 do not require run-time type information, i.e.@: casts to @code{void *} or to
2261 unambiguous base classes.
2262
2263 @item -fstats
2264 @opindex fstats
2265 Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
2266 This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
2267
2268 @item -fstrict-enums
2269 @opindex fstrict-enums
2270 Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of
2271 enumerated type can only be one of the values of the enumeration (as
2272 defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
2273 represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the
2274 enumerators). This assumption may not be valid if the program uses a
2275 cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated type.
2276
2277 @item -ftemplate-backtrace-limit=@var{n}
2278 @opindex ftemplate-backtrace-limit
2279 Set the maximum number of template instantiation notes for a single
2280 warning or error to @var{n}. The default value is 10.
2281
2282 @item -ftemplate-depth=@var{n}
2283 @opindex ftemplate-depth
2284 Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
2285 A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
2286 endless recursions during template class instantiation. ANSI/ISO C++
2287 conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17
2288 (changed to 1024 in C++11). The default value is 900, as the compiler
2289 can run out of stack space before hitting 1024 in some situations.
2290
2291 @item -fno-threadsafe-statics
2292 @opindex fno-threadsafe-statics
2293 Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
2294 ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics. You can use this
2295 option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need to be
2296 thread-safe.
2297
2298 @item -fuse-cxa-atexit
2299 @opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
2300 Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
2301 @code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
2302 This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
2303 destructors, but only works if your C library supports
2304 @code{__cxa_atexit}.
2305
2306 @item -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2307 @opindex fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2308 Don't use the @code{__cxa_get_exception_ptr} runtime routine. This
2309 causes @code{std::uncaught_exception} to be incorrect, but is necessary
2310 if the runtime routine is not available.
2311
2312 @item -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2313 @opindex fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2314 This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
2315 pointers to inline functions or methods where the addresses of the two functions
2316 are taken in different shared objects.
2317
2318 The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with
2319 @code{__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))} so that they do not
2320 appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT indirection
2321 when used within the DSO@. Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect
2322 on load and link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the
2323 dynamic export table when the library makes heavy use of templates.
2324
2325 The behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
2326 methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static variables
2327 local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce that
2328 the function is defined in only one shared object.
2329
2330 You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the
2331 effect of the switch for that method. For example, if you do want to
2332 compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might mark it as
2333 having default visibility. Marking the enclosing class with explicit
2334 visibility has no effect.
2335
2336 Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option
2337 as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library boundary.
2338 @xref{Template Instantiation}.
2339
2340 @item -fvisibility-ms-compat
2341 @opindex fvisibility-ms-compat
2342 This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++
2343 linkage model compatible with that of Microsoft Visual Studio.
2344
2345 The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:
2346
2347 @enumerate
2348 @item
2349 It sets the default visibility to @code{hidden}, like
2350 @option{-fvisibility=hidden}.
2351
2352 @item
2353 Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.
2354
2355 @item
2356 The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit
2357 visibility specifications that are defined in more than one
2358 shared object: those declarations are permitted if they are
2359 permitted when this option is not used.
2360 @end enumerate
2361
2362 In new code it is better to use @option{-fvisibility=hidden} and
2363 export those classes that are intended to be externally visible.
2364 Unfortunately it is possible for code to rely, perhaps accidentally,
2365 on the Visual Studio behavior.
2366
2367 Among the consequences of these changes are that static data members
2368 of the same type with the same name but defined in different shared
2369 objects are different, so changing one does not change the other;
2370 and that pointers to function members defined in different shared
2371 objects may not compare equal. When this flag is given, it is a
2372 violation of the ODR to define types with the same name differently.
2373
2374 @item -fvtable-verify=@var{std|preinit|none}
2375 @opindex fvtable-verify
2376 Turn on (or off, if using @option{-fvtable-verify=none}) the security
2377 feature that verifies at runtime, for every virtual call that is made, that
2378 the vtable pointer through which the call is made is valid for the type of
2379 the object, and has not been corrupted or overwritten. If an invalid vtable
2380 pointer is detected (at runtime), an error is reported and execution of the
2381 program is immediately halted.
2382
2383 This option causes runtime data structures to be built, at program start up,
2384 for verifying the vtable pointers. The options @code{std} and @code{preinit}
2385 control the timing of when these data structures are built. In both cases the
2386 data structures are built before execution reaches 'main'. The
2387 @option{-fvtable-verify=std} causes these data structure to be built after the
2388 shared libraries have been loaded and initialized.
2389 @option{-fvtable-verify=preinit} causes them to be built before the shared
2390 libraries have been loaded and initialized.
2391
2392 If this option appears multiple times in the compiler line, with different
2393 values specified, 'none' will take highest priority over both 'std' and
2394 'preinit'; 'preinit' will take priority over 'std'.
2395
2396 @item -fvtv-debug
2397 @opindex (fvtv-debug)
2398 Causes debug versions of the runtime functions for the vtable verification
2399 feature to be called. This assumes the @option{-fvtable-verify=std} or
2400 @option{-fvtable-verify=preinit} has been used. This flag will also cause the
2401 compiler to keep track of which vtable pointers it found for each class, and
2402 record that information in the file ``vtv_set_ptr_data.log'', in the dump
2403 file directory on the user's machine.
2404
2405 Note: This feature APPENDS data to the log file. If you want a fresh log
2406 file, be sure to delete any existing one.
2407
2408 @item -fvtv-counts
2409 @opindex fvtv-counts
2410 This is a debugging flag. When used in conjunction with
2411 @option{-fvtable-verify=std} or @option{-fvtable-verify=preinit}, this
2412 causes the compiler to keep track of the total number of virtual calls
2413 it encountered and the number of verifications it inserted. It also
2414 counts the number of calls to certain runtime library functions
2415 that it inserts. This information, for each compilation unit, is written
2416 to a file named ``vtv_count_data.log'', in the dump_file directory on
2417 the user's machine. It also counts the size of the vtable pointer sets
2418 for each class, and writes this information to ``vtv_class_set_sizes.log''
2419 in the same directory.
2420
2421 Note: This feature APPENDS data to the log files. To get a fresh log
2422 files, be sure to delete any existing ones.
2423
2424 @item -fno-weak
2425 @opindex fno-weak
2426 Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
2427 By default, G++ uses weak symbols if they are available. This
2428 option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
2429 it results in inferior code and has no benefits. This option may
2430 be removed in a future release of G++.
2431
2432 @item -nostdinc++
2433 @opindex nostdinc++
2434 Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
2435 C++, but do still search the other standard directories. (This option
2436 is used when building the C++ library.)
2437 @end table
2438
2439 In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
2440 have meanings only for C++ programs:
2441
2442 @table @gcctabopt
2443 @item -Wabi @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2444 @opindex Wabi
2445 @opindex Wno-abi
2446 Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
2447 vendor-neutral C++ ABI@. Although an effort has been made to warn about
2448 all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
2449 even though G++ is generating incompatible code. There may also be
2450 cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
2451 is compatible.
2452
2453 You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
2454 concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
2455 compatible with code generated by other compilers.
2456
2457 The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=2} (the default) include:
2458
2459 @itemize @bullet
2460
2461 @item
2462 A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is
2463 mangled incorrectly:
2464 @smallexample
2465 extern int N;
2466 template <int &> struct S @{@};
2467 void n (S<N>) @{2@}
2468 @end smallexample
2469
2470 This is fixed in @option{-fabi-version=3}.
2471
2472 @item
2473 SIMD vector types declared using @code{__attribute ((vector_size))} are
2474 mangled in a non-standard way that does not allow for overloading of
2475 functions taking vectors of different sizes.
2476
2477 The mangling is changed in @option{-fabi-version=4}.
2478 @end itemize
2479
2480 The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=1} include:
2481
2482 @itemize @bullet
2483
2484 @item
2485 Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields. G++ may attempt to
2486 pack data into the same byte as a base class. For example:
2487
2488 @smallexample
2489 struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
2490 struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
2491 @end smallexample
2492
2493 @noindent
2494 In this case, G++ places @code{B::f2} into the same byte
2495 as @code{A::f1}; other compilers do not. You can avoid this problem
2496 by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
2497 byte size on your platform; that causes G++ and other compilers to
2498 lay out @code{B} identically.
2499
2500 @item
2501 Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases. G++ does not use
2502 tail padding when laying out virtual bases. For example:
2503
2504 @smallexample
2505 struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
2506 struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
2507 struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
2508 @end smallexample
2509
2510 @noindent
2511 In this case, G++ does not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
2512 @code{A}; other compilers do. You can avoid this problem by
2513 explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
2514 alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that causes G++ and other
2515 compilers to lay out @code{C} identically.
2516
2517 @item
2518 Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
2519 of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union. For
2520 example:
2521
2522 @smallexample
2523 union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
2524 @end smallexample
2525
2526 @noindent
2527 Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ makes the
2528 union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
2529
2530 @item
2531 Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets. For example:
2532
2533 @smallexample
2534 struct A @{@};
2535
2536 struct B @{
2537 A a;
2538 virtual void f ();
2539 @};
2540
2541 struct C : public B, public A @{@};
2542 @end smallexample
2543
2544 @noindent
2545 G++ places the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
2546 it should be placed at offset zero. G++ mistakenly believes that the
2547 @code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
2548
2549 @item
2550 Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
2551 template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 template <typename Q>
2555 void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
2556
2557 template <template <typename> class Q>
2558 void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
2559 @end smallexample
2560
2561 @noindent
2562 Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
2563
2564 @end itemize
2565
2566 It also warns about psABI-related changes. The known psABI changes at this
2567 point include:
2568
2569 @itemize @bullet
2570
2571 @item
2572 For SysV/x86-64, unions with @code{long double} members are
2573 passed in memory as specified in psABI. For example:
2574
2575 @smallexample
2576 union U @{
2577 long double ld;
2578 int i;
2579 @};
2580 @end smallexample
2581
2582 @noindent
2583 @code{union U} is always passed in memory.
2584
2585 @end itemize
2586
2587 @item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2588 @opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
2589 @opindex Wno-ctor-dtor-privacy
2590 Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
2591 destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends nor
2592 public static member functions. Also warn if there are no non-private
2593 methods, and there's at least one private member function that isn't
2594 a constructor or destructor.
2595
2596 @item -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2597 @opindex Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor
2598 @opindex Wno-delete-non-virtual-dtor
2599 Warn when @samp{delete} is used to destroy an instance of a class that
2600 has virtual functions and non-virtual destructor. It is unsafe to delete
2601 an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a base class if the
2602 base class does not have a virtual destructor. This warning is enabled
2603 by @option{-Wall}.
2604
2605 @item -Wliteral-suffix @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2606 @opindex Wliteral-suffix
2607 @opindex Wno-literal-suffix
2608 Warn when a string or character literal is followed by a ud-suffix which does
2609 not begin with an underscore. As a conforming extension, GCC treats such
2610 suffixes as separate preprocessing tokens in order to maintain backwards
2611 compatibility with code that uses formatting macros from @code{<inttypes.h>}.
2612 For example:
2613
2614 @smallexample
2615 #define __STDC_FORMAT_MACROS
2616 #include <inttypes.h>
2617 #include <stdio.h>
2618
2619 int main() @{
2620 int64_t i64 = 123;
2621 printf("My int64: %"PRId64"\n", i64);
2622 @}
2623 @end smallexample
2624
2625 In this case, @code{PRId64} is treated as a separate preprocessing token.
2626
2627 This warning is enabled by default.
2628
2629 @item -Wnarrowing @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2630 @opindex Wnarrowing
2631 @opindex Wno-narrowing
2632 Warn when a narrowing conversion prohibited by C++11 occurs within
2633 @samp{@{ @}}, e.g.
2634
2635 @smallexample
2636 int i = @{ 2.2 @}; // error: narrowing from double to int
2637 @end smallexample
2638
2639 This flag is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wc++11-compat}.
2640
2641 With @option{-std=c++11}, @option{-Wno-narrowing} suppresses the diagnostic
2642 required by the standard. Note that this does not affect the meaning
2643 of well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered
2644 ill-formed in SFINAE context.
2645
2646 @item -Wnoexcept @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2647 @opindex Wnoexcept
2648 @opindex Wno-noexcept
2649 Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call
2650 to a function that does not have a non-throwing exception
2651 specification (i.e. @samp{throw()} or @samp{noexcept}) but is known by
2652 the compiler to never throw an exception.
2653
2654 @item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2655 @opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
2656 @opindex Wno-non-virtual-dtor
2657 Warn when a class has virtual functions and an accessible non-virtual
2658 destructor, in which case it is possible but unsafe to delete
2659 an instance of a derived class through a pointer to the base class.
2660 This warning is also enabled if @option{-Weffc++} is specified.
2661
2662 @item -Wreorder @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2663 @opindex Wreorder
2664 @opindex Wno-reorder
2665 @cindex reordering, warning
2666 @cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
2667 Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
2668 match the order in which they must be executed. For instance:
2669
2670 @smallexample
2671 struct A @{
2672 int i;
2673 int j;
2674 A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
2675 @};
2676 @end smallexample
2677
2678 @noindent
2679 The compiler rearranges the member initializers for @samp{i}
2680 and @samp{j} to match the declaration order of the members, emitting
2681 a warning to that effect. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2682
2683 @item -fext-numeric-literals @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2684 @opindex fext-numeric-literals
2685 @opindex fno-ext-numeric-literals
2686 Accept imaginary, fixed-point, or machine-defined
2687 literal number suffixes as GNU extensions.
2688 When this option is turned off these suffixes are treated
2689 as C++11 user-defined literal numeric suffixes.
2690 This is on by default for all pre-C++11 dialects and all GNU dialects:
2691 @option{-std=c++98}, @option{-std=gnu++98}, @option{-std=gnu++11},
2692 @option{-std=gnu++1y}.
2693 This option is off by default
2694 for ISO C++11 onwards (@option{-std=c++11}, ...).
2695 @end table
2696
2697 The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
2698
2699 @table @gcctabopt
2700 @item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2701 @opindex Weffc++
2702 @opindex Wno-effc++
2703 Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
2704 @cite{Effective C++, Second Edition} book:
2705
2706 @itemize @bullet
2707 @item
2708 Item 11: Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
2709 with dynamically-allocated memory.
2710
2711 @item
2712 Item 12: Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
2713
2714 @item
2715 Item 14: Make destructors virtual in base classes.
2716
2717 @item
2718 Item 15: Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
2719
2720 @item
2721 Item 23: Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
2722
2723 @end itemize
2724
2725 Also warn about violations of the following style guidelines from
2726 Scott Meyers' @cite{More Effective C++} book:
2727
2728 @itemize @bullet
2729 @item
2730 Item 6: Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
2731 decrement operators.
2732
2733 @item
2734 Item 7: Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
2735
2736 @end itemize
2737
2738 When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
2739 headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use @samp{grep -v}
2740 to filter out those warnings.
2741
2742 @item -Wstrict-null-sentinel @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2743 @opindex Wstrict-null-sentinel
2744 @opindex Wno-strict-null-sentinel
2745 Warn about the use of an uncasted @code{NULL} as sentinel. When
2746 compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as @code{NULL} is defined
2747 to @code{__null}. Although it is a null pointer constant rather than a
2748 null pointer, it is guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.
2749 But this use is not portable across different compilers.
2750
2751 @item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2752 @opindex Wno-non-template-friend
2753 @opindex Wnon-template-friend
2754 Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
2755 within a template. Since the advent of explicit template specification
2756 support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
2757 @samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
2758 friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function. (Section
2759 14.5.3). Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
2760 could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
2761 function. Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
2762 behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
2763 check existing code for potential trouble spots and is on by default.
2764 This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
2765 @option{-Wno-non-template-friend}, which keeps the conformant compiler code
2766 but disables the helpful warning.
2767
2768 @item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2769 @opindex Wold-style-cast
2770 @opindex Wno-old-style-cast
2771 Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
2772 a C++ program. The new-style casts (@samp{dynamic_cast},
2773 @samp{static_cast}, @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are
2774 less vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
2775
2776 @item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2777 @opindex Woverloaded-virtual
2778 @opindex Wno-overloaded-virtual
2779 @cindex overloaded virtual function, warning
2780 @cindex warning for overloaded virtual function
2781 Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
2782 base class. For example, in:
2783
2784 @smallexample
2785 struct A @{
2786 virtual void f();
2787 @};
2788
2789 struct B: public A @{
2790 void f(int);
2791 @};
2792 @end smallexample
2793
2794 the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
2795 like:
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 B* b;
2799 b->f();
2800 @end smallexample
2801
2802 @noindent
2803 fails to compile.
2804
2805 @item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2806 @opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
2807 @opindex Wpmf-conversions
2808 Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
2809 to a plain pointer.
2810
2811 @item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2812 @opindex Wsign-promo
2813 @opindex Wno-sign-promo
2814 Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
2815 enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned type of
2816 the same size. Previous versions of G++ tried to preserve
2817 unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
2818 @end table
2819
2820 @node Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options
2821 @section Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
2822
2823 @cindex compiler options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2824 @cindex Objective-C and Objective-C++ options, command-line
2825 @cindex options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2826 (NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
2827 languages themselves. @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
2828 Supported by GCC}, for references.)
2829
2830 This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
2831 for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs. You can also use most of
2832 the language-independent GNU compiler options.
2833 For example, you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
2834
2835 @smallexample
2836 gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
2837 @end smallexample
2838
2839 @noindent
2840 In this example, @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
2841 Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with
2842 any language supported by GCC@.
2843
2844 Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language, Objective-C
2845 compilations may also use options specific to the C front-end (e.g.,
2846 @option{-Wtraditional}). Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
2847 C++-specific options (e.g., @option{-Wabi}).
2848
2849 Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
2850 and Objective-C++ programs:
2851
2852 @table @gcctabopt
2853 @item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
2854 @opindex fconstant-string-class
2855 Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
2856 literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}. The default
2857 class name is @code{NXConstantString} if the GNU runtime is being used, and
2858 @code{NSConstantString} if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below). The
2859 @option{-fconstant-cfstrings} option, if also present, overrides the
2860 @option{-fconstant-string-class} setting and cause @code{@@"@dots{}"} literals
2861 to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2862
2863 @item -fgnu-runtime
2864 @opindex fgnu-runtime
2865 Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2866 runtime. This is the default for most types of systems.
2867
2868 @item -fnext-runtime
2869 @opindex fnext-runtime
2870 Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime. This is the default
2871 for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@. The macro
2872 @code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
2873 used.
2874
2875 @item -fno-nil-receivers
2876 @opindex fno-nil-receivers
2877 Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches (@code{[receiver
2878 message:arg]}) in this translation unit ensure that the receiver is
2879 not @code{nil}. This allows for more efficient entry points in the
2880 runtime to be used. This option is only available in conjunction with
2881 the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.
2882
2883 @item -fobjc-abi-version=@var{n}
2884 @opindex fobjc-abi-version
2885 Use version @var{n} of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.
2886 This option is currently supported only for the NeXT runtime. In that
2887 case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI without support for
2888 properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions. Version 1 is the
2889 traditional (32-bit) ABI with support for properties and other
2890 Objective-C 2.0 additions. Version 2 is the modern (64-bit) ABI. If
2891 nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target
2892 machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit target machines.
2893
2894 @item -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2895 @opindex fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2896 For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a
2897 C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor. If so, synthesize a
2898 special @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} instance method which runs
2899 non-trivial default constructors on any such instance variables, in order,
2900 and then return @code{self}. Similarly, check if any instance variable
2901 is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and if so, synthesize a
2902 special @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} method which runs
2903 all such default destructors, in reverse order.
2904
2905 The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct}
2906 methods thusly generated only operate on instance variables
2907 declared in the current Objective-C class, and not those inherited
2908 from superclasses. It is the responsibility of the Objective-C
2909 runtime to invoke all such methods in an object's inheritance
2910 hierarchy. The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} methods are invoked
2911 by the runtime immediately after a new object instance is allocated;
2912 the @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods are invoked immediately
2913 before the runtime deallocates an object instance.
2914
2915 As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has
2916 support for invoking the @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and
2917 @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods.
2918
2919 @item -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2920 @opindex fobjc-direct-dispatch
2921 Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher. On Darwin this is
2922 accomplished via the comm page.
2923
2924 @item -fobjc-exceptions
2925 @opindex fobjc-exceptions
2926 Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in
2927 Objective-C, similar to what is offered by C++ and Java. This option
2928 is required to use the Objective-C keywords @code{@@try},
2929 @code{@@throw}, @code{@@catch}, @code{@@finally} and
2930 @code{@@synchronized}. This option is available with both the GNU
2931 runtime and the NeXT runtime (but not available in conjunction with
2932 the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).
2933
2934 @item -fobjc-gc
2935 @opindex fobjc-gc
2936 Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++
2937 programs. This option is only available with the NeXT runtime; the
2938 GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation that
2939 does not require special compiler flags.
2940
2941 @item -fobjc-nilcheck
2942 @opindex fobjc-nilcheck
2943 For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil
2944 receiver in method invocations before doing the actual method call.
2945 This is the default and can be disabled using
2946 @option{-fno-objc-nilcheck}. Class methods and super calls are never
2947 checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag is set to.
2948 Currently this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older
2949 version of the NeXT runtime ABI, is used.
2950
2951 @item -fobjc-std=objc1
2952 @opindex fobjc-std
2953 Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language
2954 recognized by GCC 4.0. This only affects the Objective-C additions to
2955 the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++ standards,
2956 which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags. When
2957 this option is used with the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler,
2958 any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by GCC 4.0 is rejected.
2959 This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can
2960 be compiled with older versions of GCC@.
2961
2962 @item -freplace-objc-classes
2963 @opindex freplace-objc-classes
2964 Emit a special marker instructing @command{ld(1)} not to statically link in
2965 the resulting object file, and allow @command{dyld(1)} to load it in at
2966 run time instead. This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-Continue
2967 debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and
2968 dynamically reloaded in the course of program execution, without the need
2969 to restart the program itself. Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality
2970 is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
2971 and later.
2972
2973 @item -fzero-link
2974 @opindex fzero-link
2975 When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls
2976 to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")} (when the name of the class is known at
2977 compile time) with static class references that get initialized at load time,
2978 which improves run-time performance. Specifying the @option{-fzero-link} flag
2979 suppresses this behavior and causes calls to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")}
2980 to be retained. This is useful in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows
2981 for individual class implementations to be modified during program execution.
2982 The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to @code{objc_get_class("@dots{}")}
2983 regardless of command-line options.
2984
2985 @item -gen-decls
2986 @opindex gen-decls
2987 Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
2988 file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
2989
2990 @item -Wassign-intercept @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2991 @opindex Wassign-intercept
2992 @opindex Wno-assign-intercept
2993 Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2994 garbage collector.
2995
2996 @item -Wno-protocol @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2997 @opindex Wno-protocol
2998 @opindex Wprotocol
2999 If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
3000 every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class. The
3001 default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
3002 implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
3003 from the superclass. If you use the @option{-Wno-protocol} option, then
3004 methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
3005 and no warning is issued for them.
3006
3007 @item -Wselector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3008 @opindex Wselector
3009 @opindex Wno-selector
3010 Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
3011 found during compilation. The check is performed on the list of methods
3012 in the final stage of compilation. Additionally, a check is performed
3013 for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
3014 expression, and a corresponding method for that selector has been found
3015 during compilation. Because these checks scan the method table only at
3016 the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
3017 stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
3018 found during compilation, or because the @option{-fsyntax-only} option is
3019 being used.
3020
3021 @item -Wstrict-selector-match @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3022 @opindex Wstrict-selector-match
3023 @opindex Wno-strict-selector-match
3024 Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are
3025 found for a given selector when attempting to send a message using this
3026 selector to a receiver of type @code{id} or @code{Class}. When this flag
3027 is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler omits such warnings
3028 if any differences found are confined to types that share the same size
3029 and alignment.
3030
3031 @item -Wundeclared-selector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3032 @opindex Wundeclared-selector
3033 @opindex Wno-undeclared-selector
3034 Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
3035 undeclared selector is found. A selector is considered undeclared if no
3036 method with that name has been declared before the
3037 @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression, either explicitly in an
3038 @code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly in
3039 an @code{@@implementation} section. This option always performs its
3040 checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found,
3041 while @option{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
3042 compilation. This also enforces the coding style convention
3043 that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
3044
3045 @item -print-objc-runtime-info
3046 @opindex print-objc-runtime-info
3047 Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by
3048 value, if any.
3049
3050 @end table
3051
3052 @node Language Independent Options
3053 @section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
3054 @cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
3055 @cindex diagnostic messages
3056 @cindex message formatting
3057
3058 Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
3059 the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}). You can use the
3060 options described below
3061 to control the formatting algorithm for diagnostic messages,
3062 e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
3063 information should be reported. Note that some language front ends may not
3064 honor these options.
3065
3066 @table @gcctabopt
3067 @item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
3068 @opindex fmessage-length
3069 Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
3070 characters. The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
3071 the front ends supported by GCC@. If @var{n} is zero, then no
3072 line-wrapping is done; each error message appears on a single
3073 line.
3074
3075 @item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
3076 @opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
3077 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic messages
3078 reporter to emit source location information @emph{once}; that is, in
3079 case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
3080 be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
3081 over and over, in subsequent continuation lines. This is the default
3082 behavior.
3083
3084 @item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
3085 Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode. Instructs the diagnostic
3086 messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
3087 prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
3088 a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
3089
3090 @item -fdiagnostics-color[=@var{WHEN}]
3091 @itemx -fno-diagnostics-color
3092 @opindex fdiagnostics-color
3093 @cindex highlight, color, colour
3094 @vindex GCC_COLORS @r{environment variable}
3095 Use color in diagnostics. @var{WHEN} is @samp{never}, @samp{always},
3096 or @samp{auto}. The default is @samp{never} if @env{GCC_COLORS} environment
3097 variable isn't present in the environment, and @samp{auto} otherwise.
3098 @samp{auto} means to use color only when the standard error is a terminal.
3099 The forms @option{-fdiagnostics-color} and @option{-fno-diagnostics-color} are
3100 aliases for @option{-fdiagnostics-color=always} and
3101 @option{-fdiagnostics-color=never}, respectively.
3102
3103 The colors are defined by the environment variable @env{GCC_COLORS}.
3104 Its value is a colon-separated list of capabilities and Select Graphic
3105 Rendition (SGR) substrings. SGR commands are interpreted by the
3106 terminal or terminal emulator. (See the section in the documentation
3107 of your text terminal for permitted values and their meanings as
3108 character attributes.) These substring values are integers in decimal
3109 representation and can be concatenated with semicolons.
3110 Common values to concatenate include
3111 @samp{1} for bold,
3112 @samp{4} for underline,
3113 @samp{5} for blink,
3114 @samp{7} for inverse,
3115 @samp{39} for default foreground color,
3116 @samp{30} to @samp{37} for foreground colors,
3117 @samp{90} to @samp{97} for 16-color mode foreground colors,
3118 @samp{38;5;0} to @samp{38;5;255}
3119 for 88-color and 256-color modes foreground colors,
3120 @samp{49} for default background color,
3121 @samp{40} to @samp{47} for background colors,
3122 @samp{100} to @samp{107} for 16-color mode background colors,
3123 and @samp{48;5;0} to @samp{48;5;255}
3124 for 88-color and 256-color modes background colors.
3125
3126 The default @env{GCC_COLORS} is
3127 @samp{error=01;31:warning=01;35:note=01;36:caret=01;32:locus=01:quote=01}
3128 where @samp{01;31} is bold red, @samp{01;35} is bold magenta,
3129 @samp{01;36} is bold cyan, @samp{01;32} is bold green and
3130 @samp{01} is bold. Setting @env{GCC_COLORS} to the empty
3131 string disables colors.
3132 Supported capabilities are as follows.
3133
3134 @table @code
3135 @item error=
3136 @vindex error GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3137 SGR substring for error: markers.
3138
3139 @item warning=
3140 @vindex warning GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3141 SGR substring for warning: markers.
3142
3143 @item note=
3144 @vindex note GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3145 SGR substring for note: markers.
3146
3147 @item caret=
3148 @vindex caret GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3149 SGR substring for caret line.
3150
3151 @item locus=
3152 @vindex locus GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3153 SGR substring for location information, @samp{file:line} or
3154 @samp{file:line:column} etc.
3155
3156 @item quote=
3157 @vindex quote GCC_COLORS @r{capability}
3158 SGR substring for information printed within quotes.
3159 @end table
3160
3161 @item -fno-diagnostics-show-option
3162 @opindex fno-diagnostics-show-option
3163 @opindex fdiagnostics-show-option
3164 By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the
3165 command-line option that directly controls the diagnostic (if such an
3166 option is known to the diagnostic machinery). Specifying the
3167 @option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag suppresses that behavior.
3168
3169 @item -fno-diagnostics-show-caret
3170 @opindex fno-diagnostics-show-caret
3171 @opindex fdiagnostics-show-caret
3172 By default, each diagnostic emitted includes the original source line
3173 and a caret '^' indicating the column. This option suppresses this
3174 information.
3175
3176 @end table
3177
3178 @node Warning Options
3179 @section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
3180 @cindex options to control warnings
3181 @cindex warning messages
3182 @cindex messages, warning
3183 @cindex suppressing warnings
3184
3185 Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that
3186 are not inherently erroneous but that are risky or suggest there
3187 may have been an error.
3188
3189 The following language-independent options do not enable specific
3190 warnings but control the kinds of diagnostics produced by GCC@.
3191
3192 @table @gcctabopt
3193 @cindex syntax checking
3194 @item -fsyntax-only
3195 @opindex fsyntax-only
3196 Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
3197
3198 @item -fmax-errors=@var{n}
3199 @opindex fmax-errors
3200 Limits the maximum number of error messages to @var{n}, at which point
3201 GCC bails out rather than attempting to continue processing the source
3202 code. If @var{n} is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number
3203 of error messages produced. If @option{-Wfatal-errors} is also
3204 specified, then @option{-Wfatal-errors} takes precedence over this
3205 option.
3206
3207 @item -w
3208 @opindex w
3209 Inhibit all warning messages.
3210
3211 @item -Werror
3212 @opindex Werror
3213 @opindex Wno-error
3214 Make all warnings into errors.
3215
3216 @item -Werror=
3217 @opindex Werror=
3218 @opindex Wno-error=
3219 Make the specified warning into an error. The specifier for a warning
3220 is appended; for example @option{-Werror=switch} turns the warnings
3221 controlled by @option{-Wswitch} into errors. This switch takes a
3222 negative form, to be used to negate @option{-Werror} for specific
3223 warnings; for example @option{-Wno-error=switch} makes
3224 @option{-Wswitch} warnings not be errors, even when @option{-Werror}
3225 is in effect.
3226
3227 The warning message for each controllable warning includes the
3228 option that controls the warning. That option can then be used with
3229 @option{-Werror=} and @option{-Wno-error=} as described above.
3230 (Printing of the option in the warning message can be disabled using the
3231 @option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag.)
3232
3233 Note that specifying @option{-Werror=}@var{foo} automatically implies
3234 @option{-W}@var{foo}. However, @option{-Wno-error=}@var{foo} does not
3235 imply anything.
3236
3237 @item -Wfatal-errors
3238 @opindex Wfatal-errors
3239 @opindex Wno-fatal-errors
3240 This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error
3241 occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing further error
3242 messages.
3243
3244 @end table
3245
3246 You can request many specific warnings with options beginning with
3247 @samp{-W}, for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on
3248 implicit declarations. Each of these specific warning options also
3249 has a negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings; for
3250 example, @option{-Wno-implicit}. This manual lists only one of the
3251 two forms, whichever is not the default. For further
3252 language-specific options also refer to @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
3253 @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
3254
3255 When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g.,
3256 @option{-Wunknown-warning}), GCC emits a diagnostic stating
3257 that the option is not recognized. However, if the @option{-Wno-} form
3258 is used, the behavior is slightly different: no diagnostic is
3259 produced for @option{-Wno-unknown-warning} unless other diagnostics
3260 are being produced. This allows the use of new @option{-Wno-} options
3261 with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the compiler
3262 warns that an unrecognized option is present.
3263
3264 @table @gcctabopt
3265 @item -Wpedantic
3266 @itemx -pedantic
3267 @opindex pedantic
3268 @opindex Wpedantic
3269 Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
3270 reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
3271 programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++. For ISO C, follows the
3272 version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
3273
3274 Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
3275 this option (though a rare few require @option{-ansi} or a
3276 @option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@. However,
3277 without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
3278 features are supported as well. With this option, they are rejected.
3279
3280 @option{-Wpedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
3281 alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}. Pedantic
3282 warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
3283 @code{__extension__}. However, only system header files should use
3284 these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
3285 @xref{Alternate Keywords}.
3286
3287 Some users try to use @option{-Wpedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
3288 C conformance. They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
3289 it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
3290 ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
3291 diagnostics have been added.
3292
3293 A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
3294 some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
3295 be quite different from @option{-Wpedantic}. We don't have plans to
3296 support such a feature in the near future.
3297
3298 Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
3299 extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
3300 corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
3301 extended dialect is based. Warnings from @option{-Wpedantic} are given
3302 where they are required by the base standard. (It does not make sense
3303 for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
3304 C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
3305 features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
3306 nothing to warn about.)
3307
3308 @item -pedantic-errors
3309 @opindex pedantic-errors
3310 Like @option{-Wpedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
3311 warnings.
3312
3313 @item -Wall
3314 @opindex Wall
3315 @opindex Wno-all
3316 This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users
3317 consider questionable, and that are easy to avoid (or modify to
3318 prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros. This also
3319 enables some language-specific warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect
3320 Options} and @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
3321
3322 @option{-Wall} turns on the following warning flags:
3323
3324 @gccoptlist{-Waddress @gol
3325 -Warray-bounds @r{(only with} @option{-O2}@r{)} @gol
3326 -Wc++11-compat @gol
3327 -Wchar-subscripts @gol
3328 -Wenum-compare @r{(in C/ObjC; this is on by default in C++)} @gol
3329 -Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3330 -Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3331 -Wcomment @gol
3332 -Wformat @gol
3333 -Wmain @r{(only for C/ObjC and unless} @option{-ffreestanding}@r{)} @gol
3334 -Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
3335 -Wmissing-braces @r{(only for C/ObjC)} @gol
3336 -Wnonnull @gol
3337 -Wopenmp-simd @gol
3338 -Wparentheses @gol
3339 -Wpointer-sign @gol
3340 -Wreorder @gol
3341 -Wreturn-type @gol
3342 -Wsequence-point @gol
3343 -Wsign-compare @r{(only in C++)} @gol
3344 -Wstrict-aliasing @gol
3345 -Wstrict-overflow=1 @gol
3346 -Wswitch @gol
3347 -Wtrigraphs @gol
3348 -Wuninitialized @gol
3349 -Wunknown-pragmas @gol
3350 -Wunused-function @gol
3351 -Wunused-label @gol
3352 -Wunused-value @gol
3353 -Wunused-variable @gol
3354 -Wvolatile-register-var @gol
3355 }
3356
3357 Note that some warning flags are not implied by @option{-Wall}. Some of
3358 them warn about constructions that users generally do not consider
3359 questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
3360 others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in
3361 some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
3362 the warning. Some of them are enabled by @option{-Wextra} but many of
3363 them must be enabled individually.
3364
3365 @item -Wextra
3366 @opindex W
3367 @opindex Wextra
3368 @opindex Wno-extra
3369 This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by
3370 @option{-Wall}. (This option used to be called @option{-W}. The older
3371 name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)
3372
3373 @gccoptlist{-Wclobbered @gol
3374 -Wempty-body @gol
3375 -Wignored-qualifiers @gol
3376 -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
3377 -Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C only)} @gol
3378 -Wold-style-declaration @r{(C only)} @gol
3379 -Woverride-init @gol
3380 -Wsign-compare @gol
3381 -Wtype-limits @gol
3382 -Wuninitialized @gol
3383 -Wunused-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)} @gol
3384 -Wunused-but-set-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)} @gol
3385 }
3386
3387 The option @option{-Wextra} also prints warning messages for the
3388 following cases:
3389
3390 @itemize @bullet
3391
3392 @item
3393 A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
3394 @samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
3395
3396 @item
3397 (C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a
3398 conditional expression.
3399
3400 @item
3401 (C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.
3402
3403 @item
3404 (C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared @samp{register}.
3405
3406 @item
3407 (C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been declared
3408 @samp{register}.
3409
3410 @item
3411 (C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class's copy
3412 constructor.
3413
3414 @end itemize
3415
3416 @item -Wchar-subscripts
3417 @opindex Wchar-subscripts
3418 @opindex Wno-char-subscripts
3419 Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}. This is a common cause
3420 of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
3421 machines.
3422 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3423
3424 @item -Wcomment
3425 @opindex Wcomment
3426 @opindex Wno-comment
3427 Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
3428 comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
3429 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3430
3431 @item -Wno-coverage-mismatch
3432 @opindex Wno-coverage-mismatch
3433 Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the
3434 @option{-fprofile-use} option.
3435 If a source file is changed between compiling with @option{-fprofile-gen} and
3436 with @option{-fprofile-use}, the files with the profile feedback can fail
3437 to match the source file and GCC cannot use the profile feedback
3438 information. By default, this warning is enabled and is treated as an
3439 error. @option{-Wno-coverage-mismatch} can be used to disable the
3440 warning or @option{-Wno-error=coverage-mismatch} can be used to
3441 disable the error. Disabling the error for this warning can result in
3442 poorly optimized code and is useful only in the
3443 case of very minor changes such as bug fixes to an existing code-base.
3444 Completely disabling the warning is not recommended.
3445
3446 @item -Wno-cpp
3447 @r{(C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)}
3448
3449 Suppress warning messages emitted by @code{#warning} directives.
3450
3451 @item -Wdouble-promotion @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3452 @opindex Wdouble-promotion
3453 @opindex Wno-double-promotion
3454 Give a warning when a value of type @code{float} is implicitly
3455 promoted to @code{double}. CPUs with a 32-bit ``single-precision''
3456 floating-point unit implement @code{float} in hardware, but emulate
3457 @code{double} in software. On such a machine, doing computations
3458 using @code{double} values is much more expensive because of the
3459 overhead required for software emulation.
3460
3461 It is easy to accidentally do computations with @code{double} because
3462 floating-point literals are implicitly of type @code{double}. For
3463 example, in:
3464 @smallexample
3465 @group
3466 float area(float radius)
3467 @{
3468 return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
3469 @}
3470 @end group
3471 @end smallexample
3472 the compiler performs the entire computation with @code{double}
3473 because the floating-point literal is a @code{double}.
3474
3475 @item -Wformat
3476 @itemx -Wformat=@var{n}
3477 @opindex Wformat
3478 @opindex Wno-format
3479 @opindex ffreestanding
3480 @opindex fno-builtin
3481 @opindex Wformat=
3482 Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
3483 the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
3484 specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
3485 sense. This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
3486 attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
3487 @code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
3488 not in the C standard) families (or other target-specific families).
3489 Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
3490 specified depends on the standard version selected, and such checks of
3491 functions without the attribute specified are disabled by
3492 @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-fno-builtin}.
3493
3494 The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
3495 libc version 2.2. These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
3496 as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
3497 extensions. Other library implementations may not support all these
3498 features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
3499 particular library's limitations. However, if @option{-Wpedantic} is used
3500 with @option{-Wformat}, warnings are given about format features not
3501 in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
3502 since those are not in any version of the C standard). @xref{C Dialect
3503 Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
3504
3505 @table @gcctabopt
3506 @item -Wformat=1
3507 @itemx -Wformat
3508 @opindex Wformat
3509 @opindex Wformat=1
3510 Option @option{-Wformat} is equivalent to @option{-Wformat=1}, and
3511 @option{-Wno-format} is equivalent to @option{-Wformat=0}. Since
3512 @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for several
3513 functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}. Some
3514 aspects of this level of format checking can be disabled by the
3515 options: @option{-Wno-format-contains-nul},
3516 @option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, and @option{-Wno-format-zero-length}.
3517 @option{-Wformat} is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3518
3519 @item -Wno-format-contains-nul
3520 @opindex Wno-format-contains-nul
3521 @opindex Wformat-contains-nul
3522 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about format strings that
3523 contain NUL bytes.
3524
3525 @item -Wno-format-extra-args
3526 @opindex Wno-format-extra-args
3527 @opindex Wformat-extra-args
3528 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
3529 @code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function. The C standard specifies
3530 that such arguments are ignored.
3531
3532 Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
3533 specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
3534 warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
3535 type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments. However,
3536 in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option suppresses the
3537 warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
3538 Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
3539
3540 @item -Wno-format-zero-length
3541 @opindex Wno-format-zero-length
3542 @opindex Wformat-zero-length
3543 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
3544 The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
3545
3546
3547 @item -Wformat=2
3548 @opindex Wformat=2
3549 Enable @option{-Wformat} plus additional format checks. Currently
3550 equivalent to @option{-Wformat -Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security
3551 -Wformat-y2k}.
3552
3553 @item -Wformat-nonliteral
3554 @opindex Wformat-nonliteral
3555 @opindex Wno-format-nonliteral
3556 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
3557 string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
3558 takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
3559
3560 @item -Wformat-security
3561 @opindex Wformat-security
3562 @opindex Wno-format-security
3563 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
3564 functions that represent possible security problems. At present, this
3565 warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
3566 format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
3567 as in @code{printf (foo);}. This may be a security hole if the format
3568 string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}. (This is
3569 currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
3570 in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
3571 included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
3572
3573 @item -Wformat-y2k
3574 @opindex Wformat-y2k
3575 @opindex Wno-format-y2k
3576 If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about @code{strftime}
3577 formats that may yield only a two-digit year.
3578 @end table
3579
3580 @item -Wnonnull
3581 @opindex Wnonnull
3582 @opindex Wno-nonnull
3583 Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
3584 requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
3585
3586 @option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}. It
3587 can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
3588
3589 @item -Winit-self @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3590 @opindex Winit-self
3591 @opindex Wno-init-self
3592 Warn about uninitialized variables that are initialized with themselves.
3593 Note this option can only be used with the @option{-Wuninitialized} option.
3594
3595 For example, GCC warns about @code{i} being uninitialized in the
3596 following snippet only when @option{-Winit-self} has been specified:
3597 @smallexample
3598 @group
3599 int f()
3600 @{
3601 int i = i;
3602 return i;
3603 @}
3604 @end group
3605 @end smallexample
3606
3607 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} in C++.
3608
3609 @item -Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3610 @opindex Wimplicit-int
3611 @opindex Wno-implicit-int
3612 Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
3613 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3614
3615 @item -Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3616 @opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
3617 @opindex Wno-implicit-function-declaration
3618 Give a warning whenever a function is used before being declared. In
3619 C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this warning is
3620 enabled by default and it is made into an error by
3621 @option{-pedantic-errors}. This warning is also enabled by
3622 @option{-Wall}.
3623
3624 @item -Wimplicit @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3625 @opindex Wimplicit
3626 @opindex Wno-implicit
3627 Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
3628 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3629
3630 @item -Wignored-qualifiers @r{(C and C++ only)}
3631 @opindex Wignored-qualifiers
3632 @opindex Wno-ignored-qualifiers
3633 Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier
3634 such as @code{const}. For ISO C such a type qualifier has no effect,
3635 since the value returned by a function is not an lvalue.
3636 For C++, the warning is only emitted for scalar types or @code{void}.
3637 ISO C prohibits qualified @code{void} return types on function
3638 definitions, so such return types always receive a warning
3639 even without this option.
3640
3641 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
3642
3643 @item -Wmain
3644 @opindex Wmain
3645 @opindex Wno-main
3646 Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious. @samp{main} should be
3647 a function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
3648 arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types. This warning
3649 is enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either @option{-Wall}
3650 or @option{-Wpedantic}.
3651
3652 @item -Wmissing-braces
3653 @opindex Wmissing-braces
3654 @opindex Wno-missing-braces
3655 Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed. In
3656 the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
3657 bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed. This warning is
3658 enabled by @option{-Wall} in C.
3659
3660 @smallexample
3661 int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
3662 int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
3663 @end smallexample
3664
3665 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3666
3667 @item -Wmissing-include-dirs @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3668 @opindex Wmissing-include-dirs
3669 @opindex Wno-missing-include-dirs
3670 Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
3671
3672 @item -Wparentheses
3673 @opindex Wparentheses
3674 @opindex Wno-parentheses
3675 Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
3676 as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
3677 is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
3678 often get confused about.
3679
3680 Also warn if a comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is
3681 equivalent to @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different
3682 interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
3683
3684 Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
3685 @code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs. Here is an example of
3686 such a case:
3687
3688 @smallexample
3689 @group
3690 @{
3691 if (a)
3692 if (b)
3693 foo ();
3694 else
3695 bar ();
3696 @}
3697 @end group
3698 @end smallexample
3699
3700 In C/C++, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible
3701 @code{if} statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}. This is
3702 often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above
3703 example by indentation the programmer chose. When there is the
3704 potential for this confusion, GCC issues a warning when this flag
3705 is specified. To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around
3706 the innermost @code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else}
3707 can belong to the enclosing @code{if}. The resulting code
3708 looks like this:
3709
3710 @smallexample
3711 @group
3712 @{
3713 if (a)
3714 @{
3715 if (b)
3716 foo ();
3717 else
3718 bar ();
3719 @}
3720 @}
3721 @end group
3722 @end smallexample
3723
3724 Also warn for dangerous uses of the GNU extension to
3725 @code{?:} with omitted middle operand. When the condition
3726 in the @code{?}: operator is a boolean expression, the omitted value is
3727 always 1. Often programmers expect it to be a value computed
3728 inside the conditional expression instead.
3729
3730 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3731
3732 @item -Wsequence-point
3733 @opindex Wsequence-point
3734 @opindex Wno-sequence-point
3735 Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
3736 of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
3737
3738 The C and C++ standards define the order in which expressions in a C/C++
3739 program are evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent
3740 a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those
3741 executed before the sequence point, and those executed after it. These
3742 occur after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part
3743 of a larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
3744 @code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
3745 function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
3746 expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
3747 Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
3748 evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified. All
3749 these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
3750 since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
3751 with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
3752 are called is not specified. However, the standards committee have
3753 ruled that function calls do not overlap.
3754
3755 It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
3756 values of objects take effect. Programs whose behavior depends on this
3757 have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that ``Between
3758 the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored
3759 value modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression.
3760 Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to determine the value
3761 to be stored.''. If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
3762 particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
3763
3764 Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
3765 = b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}. Some more complicated cases are not
3766 diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
3767 result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
3768 this sort of problem in programs.
3769
3770 The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
3771 over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
3772 Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
3773 definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
3774 @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/readings.html}.
3775
3776 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} for C and C++.
3777
3778 @item -Wno-return-local-addr
3779 @opindex Wno-return-local-addr
3780 @opindex Wreturn-local-addr
3781 Do not warn about returning a pointer (or in C++, a reference) to a
3782 variable that goes out of scope after the function returns.
3783
3784 @item -Wreturn-type
3785 @opindex Wreturn-type
3786 @opindex Wno-return-type
3787 Warn whenever a function is defined with a return type that defaults
3788 to @code{int}. Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
3789 return value in a function whose return type is not @code{void}
3790 (falling off the end of the function body is considered returning
3791 without a value), and about a @code{return} statement with an
3792 expression in a function whose return type is @code{void}.
3793
3794 For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
3795 message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified. The only
3796 exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
3797
3798 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3799
3800 @item -Wswitch
3801 @opindex Wswitch
3802 @opindex Wno-switch
3803 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3804 and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3805 enumeration. (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
3806 warning.) @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3807 provoke warnings when this option is used (even if there is a
3808 @code{default} label).
3809 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3810
3811 @item -Wswitch-default
3812 @opindex Wswitch-default
3813 @opindex Wno-switch-default
3814 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
3815 case.
3816
3817 @item -Wswitch-enum
3818 @opindex Wswitch-enum
3819 @opindex Wno-switch-enum
3820 Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3821 and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3822 enumeration. @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3823 provoke warnings when this option is used. The only difference
3824 between @option{-Wswitch} and this option is that this option gives a
3825 warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a
3826 @code{default} label.
3827
3828 @item -Wsync-nand @r{(C and C++ only)}
3829 @opindex Wsync-nand
3830 @opindex Wno-sync-nand
3831 Warn when @code{__sync_fetch_and_nand} and @code{__sync_nand_and_fetch}
3832 built-in functions are used. These functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.
3833
3834 @item -Wtrigraphs
3835 @opindex Wtrigraphs
3836 @opindex Wno-trigraphs
3837 Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
3838 the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
3839 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3840
3841 @item -Wunused-but-set-parameter
3842 @opindex Wunused-but-set-parameter
3843 @opindex Wno-unused-but-set-parameter
3844 Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3845 (aside from its declaration).
3846
3847 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3848 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3849
3850 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused} together with
3851 @option{-Wextra}.
3852
3853 @item -Wunused-but-set-variable
3854 @opindex Wunused-but-set-variable
3855 @opindex Wno-unused-but-set-variable
3856 Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3857 (aside from its declaration).
3858 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3859
3860 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3861 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3862
3863 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused}, which is enabled
3864 by @option{-Wall}.
3865
3866 @item -Wunused-function
3867 @opindex Wunused-function
3868 @opindex Wno-unused-function
3869 Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
3870 non-inline static function is unused.
3871 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3872
3873 @item -Wunused-label
3874 @opindex Wunused-label
3875 @opindex Wno-unused-label
3876 Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
3877 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3878
3879 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3880 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3881
3882 @item -Wunused-local-typedefs @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
3883 @opindex Wunused-local-typedefs
3884 Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.
3885 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3886
3887 @item -Wunused-parameter
3888 @opindex Wunused-parameter
3889 @opindex Wno-unused-parameter
3890 Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
3891
3892 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3893 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3894
3895 @item -Wno-unused-result
3896 @opindex Wunused-result
3897 @opindex Wno-unused-result
3898 Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute
3899 @code{warn_unused_result} (@pxref{Function Attributes}) does not use
3900 its return value. The default is @option{-Wunused-result}.
3901
3902 @item -Wunused-variable
3903 @opindex Wunused-variable
3904 @opindex Wno-unused-variable
3905 Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
3906 aside from its declaration.
3907 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3908
3909 To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3910 (@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3911
3912 @item -Wunused-value
3913 @opindex Wunused-value
3914 @opindex Wno-unused-value
3915 Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not
3916 used. To suppress this warning cast the unused expression to
3917 @samp{void}. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand
3918 side of a comma expression that contains no side effects. For example,
3919 an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} causes a warning, while
3920 @samp{x[(void)i,j]} does not.
3921
3922 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3923
3924 @item -Wunused
3925 @opindex Wunused
3926 @opindex Wno-unused
3927 All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
3928
3929 In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
3930 either specify @option{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @option{-Wall} implies
3931 @option{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
3932
3933 @item -Wuninitialized
3934 @opindex Wuninitialized
3935 @opindex Wno-uninitialized
3936 Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized
3937 or if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call. In C++,
3938 warn if a non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member
3939 appears in a class without constructors.
3940
3941 If you want to warn about code that uses the uninitialized value of the
3942 variable in its own initializer, use the @option{-Winit-self} option.
3943
3944 These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
3945 elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
3946 variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole. They do
3947 not occur for variables or elements declared @code{volatile}. Because
3948 these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or elements
3949 for which there are warnings depends on the precise optimization
3950 options and version of GCC used.
3951
3952 Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
3953 to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
3954 computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
3955 are printed.
3956
3957 @item -Wmaybe-uninitialized
3958 @opindex Wmaybe-uninitialized
3959 @opindex Wno-maybe-uninitialized
3960 For an automatic variable, if there exists a path from the function
3961 entry to a use of the variable that is initialized, but there exist
3962 some other paths for which the variable is not initialized, the compiler
3963 emits a warning if it cannot prove the uninitialized paths are not
3964 executed at run time. These warnings are made optional because GCC is
3965 not smart enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
3966 in spite of appearing to have an error. Here is one example of how
3967 this can happen:
3968
3969 @smallexample
3970 @group
3971 @{
3972 int x;
3973 switch (y)
3974 @{
3975 case 1: x = 1;
3976 break;
3977 case 2: x = 4;
3978 break;
3979 case 3: x = 5;
3980 @}
3981 foo (x);
3982 @}
3983 @end group
3984 @end smallexample
3985
3986 @noindent
3987 If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
3988 always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. To suppress the
3989 warning, you need to provide a default case with assert(0) or
3990 similar code.
3991
3992 @cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
3993 This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
3994 changed by a call to @code{longjmp}. These warnings as well are possible
3995 only in optimizing compilation.
3996
3997 The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}. It cannot know
3998 where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
3999 call it at any point in the code. As a result, you may get a warning
4000 even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
4001 in fact be called at the place that would cause a problem.
4002
4003 Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
4004 you use that never return as @code{noreturn}. @xref{Function
4005 Attributes}.
4006
4007 This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wextra}.
4008
4009 @item -Wunknown-pragmas
4010 @opindex Wunknown-pragmas
4011 @opindex Wno-unknown-pragmas
4012 @cindex warning for unknown pragmas
4013 @cindex unknown pragmas, warning
4014 @cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
4015 Warn when a @code{#pragma} directive is encountered that is not understood by
4016 GCC@. If this command-line option is used, warnings are even issued
4017 for unknown pragmas in system header files. This is not the case if
4018 the warnings are only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command-line option.
4019
4020 @item -Wno-pragmas
4021 @opindex Wno-pragmas
4022 @opindex Wpragmas
4023 Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
4024 invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas. See also
4025 @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
4026
4027 @item -Wstrict-aliasing
4028 @opindex Wstrict-aliasing
4029 @opindex Wno-strict-aliasing
4030 This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
4031 It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
4032 compiler is using for optimization. The warning does not catch all
4033 cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls. It is
4034 included in @option{-Wall}.
4035 It is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=3}
4036
4037 @item -Wstrict-aliasing=n
4038 @opindex Wstrict-aliasing=n
4039 This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
4040 It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
4041 compiler is using for optimization.
4042 Higher levels correspond to higher accuracy (fewer false positives).
4043 Higher levels also correspond to more effort, similar to the way @option{-O}
4044 works.
4045 @option{-Wstrict-aliasing} is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=3}.
4046
4047 Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.
4048 Possibly useful when higher levels
4049 do not warn but @option{-fstrict-aliasing} still breaks the code, as it has very few
4050 false negatives. However, it has many false positives.
4051 Warns for all pointer conversions between possibly incompatible types,
4052 even if never dereferenced. Runs in the front end only.
4053
4054 Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise.
4055 May still have many false positives (not as many as level 1 though),
4056 and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).
4057 Unlike level 1, it only warns when an address is taken. Warns about
4058 incomplete types. Runs in the front end only.
4059
4060 Level 3 (default for @option{-Wstrict-aliasing}):
4061 Should have very few false positives and few false
4062 negatives. Slightly slower than levels 1 or 2 when optimization is enabled.
4063 Takes care of the common pun+dereference pattern in the front end:
4064 @code{*(int*)&some_float}.
4065 If optimization is enabled, it also runs in the back end, where it deals
4066 with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to information.
4067 Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.
4068 Does not warn about incomplete types.
4069
4070 @item -Wstrict-overflow
4071 @itemx -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n}
4072 @opindex Wstrict-overflow
4073 @opindex Wno-strict-overflow
4074 This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is active.
4075 It warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
4076 assumption that signed overflow does not occur. Note that it does not
4077 warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only warns
4078 about cases where the compiler implements some optimization. Thus
4079 this warning depends on the optimization level.
4080
4081 An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
4082 perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such that
4083 overflow never does, in fact, occur. Therefore this warning can
4084 easily give a false positive: a warning about code that is not
4085 actually a problem. To help focus on important issues, several
4086 warning levels are defined. No warnings are issued for the use of
4087 undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop
4088 requires, in particular when determining whether a loop will be
4089 executed at all.
4090
4091 @table @gcctabopt
4092 @item -Wstrict-overflow=1
4093 Warn about cases that are both questionable and easy to avoid. For
4094 example, with @option{-fstrict-overflow}, the compiler simplifies
4095 @code{x + 1 > x} to @code{1}. This level of
4096 @option{-Wstrict-overflow} is enabled by @option{-Wall}; higher levels
4097 are not, and must be explicitly requested.
4098
4099 @item -Wstrict-overflow=2
4100 Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a
4101 constant. For example: @code{abs (x) >= 0}. This can only be
4102 simplified when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is in effect, because
4103 @code{abs (INT_MIN)} overflows to @code{INT_MIN}, which is less than
4104 zero. @option{-Wstrict-overflow} (with no level) is the same as
4105 @option{-Wstrict-overflow=2}.
4106
4107 @item -Wstrict-overflow=3
4108 Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified. For
4109 example: @code{x + 1 > 1} is simplified to @code{x > 0}.
4110
4111 @item -Wstrict-overflow=4
4112 Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.
4113 For example: @code{(x * 10) / 5} is simplified to @code{x * 2}.
4114
4115 @item -Wstrict-overflow=5
4116 Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude of a
4117 constant involved in a comparison. For example: @code{x + 2 > y} is
4118 simplified to @code{x + 1 >= y}. This is reported only at the
4119 highest warning level because this simplification applies to many
4120 comparisons, so this warning level gives a very large number of
4121 false positives.
4122 @end table
4123
4124 @item -Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{|}format@r{]}
4125 @opindex Wsuggest-attribute=
4126 @opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=
4127 Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The
4128 attributes currently supported are listed below.
4129
4130 @table @gcctabopt
4131 @item -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
4132 @itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=const
4133 @itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
4134 @opindex Wsuggest-attribute=pure
4135 @opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=pure
4136 @opindex Wsuggest-attribute=const
4137 @opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=const
4138 @opindex Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
4139 @opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=noreturn
4140
4141 Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes
4142 @code{pure}, @code{const} or @code{noreturn}. The compiler only warns for
4143 functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of @code{pure} and
4144 @code{const}) if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function
4145 returns normally if it doesn't contain an infinite loop or return abnormally
4146 by throwing, calling @code{abort()} or trapping. This analysis requires option
4147 @option{-fipa-pure-const}, which is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
4148 higher. Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.
4149
4150 @item -Wsuggest-attribute=format
4151 @itemx -Wmissing-format-attribute
4152 @opindex Wsuggest-attribute=format
4153 @opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
4154 @opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=format
4155 @opindex Wno-missing-format-attribute
4156 @opindex Wformat
4157 @opindex Wno-format
4158
4159 Warn about function pointers that might be candidates for @code{format}
4160 attributes. Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.
4161 GCC guesses that function pointers with @code{format} attributes that
4162 are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return
4163 statements should have a corresponding @code{format} attribute in the
4164 resulting type. I.e.@: the left-hand side of the assignment or
4165 initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type
4166 of the containing function respectively should also have a @code{format}
4167 attribute to avoid the warning.
4168
4169 GCC also warns about function definitions that might be
4170 candidates for @code{format} attributes. Again, these are only
4171 possible candidates. GCC guesses that @code{format} attributes
4172 might be appropriate for any function that calls a function like
4173 @code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
4174 case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
4175 appropriate may not be detected.
4176 @end table
4177
4178 @item -Warray-bounds
4179 @opindex Wno-array-bounds
4180 @opindex Warray-bounds
4181 This option is only active when @option{-ftree-vrp} is active
4182 (default for @option{-O2} and above). It warns about subscripts to arrays
4183 that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4184
4185 @item -Wno-div-by-zero
4186 @opindex Wno-div-by-zero
4187 @opindex Wdiv-by-zero
4188 Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero. Floating-point
4189 division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
4190 obtaining infinities and NaNs.
4191
4192 @item -Wsystem-headers
4193 @opindex Wsystem-headers
4194 @opindex Wno-system-headers
4195 @cindex warnings from system headers
4196 @cindex system headers, warnings from
4197 Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
4198 Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
4199 that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
4200 compiler output harder to read. Using this command-line option tells
4201 GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
4202 code. However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
4203 option does @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
4204 headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
4205
4206 @item -Wtrampolines
4207 @opindex Wtrampolines
4208 @opindex Wno-trampolines
4209 Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.
4210
4211 A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
4212 time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
4213 is used to call the nested function indirectly. For some targets, it
4214 is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment. But,
4215 for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
4216 to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.
4217
4218 @item -Wfloat-equal
4219 @opindex Wfloat-equal
4220 @opindex Wno-float-equal
4221 Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.
4222
4223 The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
4224 programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
4225 infinitely precise real numbers. If you are doing this, then you need
4226 to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
4227 likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
4228 when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
4229 different problem). In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
4230 should check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
4231 this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
4232 probably mistaken.
4233
4234 @item -Wtraditional @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4235 @opindex Wtraditional
4236 @opindex Wno-traditional
4237 Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
4238 ISO C@. Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
4239 equivalent, and/or problematic constructs that should be avoided.
4240
4241 @itemize @bullet
4242 @item
4243 Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
4244 In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
4245 but in ISO C it does not.
4246
4247 @item
4248 In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
4249 Traditional preprocessors only considered a line to be a directive
4250 if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line. Therefore
4251 @option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
4252 understands but ignores because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
4253 first character on the line. It also suggests you hide directives like
4254 @samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them. Some
4255 traditional implementations do not recognize @samp{#elif}, so this option
4256 suggests avoiding it altogether.
4257
4258 @item
4259 A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
4260
4261 @item
4262 The unary plus operator.
4263
4264 @item
4265 The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating-point
4266 constant suffixes. (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
4267 constants.) Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
4268 headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
4269 Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
4270 warnings, however GCC's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
4271 avoid warning in these cases.
4272
4273 @item
4274 A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
4275 the block.
4276
4277 @item
4278 A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
4279
4280 @item
4281 A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
4282 This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
4283
4284 @item
4285 The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
4286 signedness from its traditional type. This warning is only issued if
4287 the base of the constant is ten. I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
4288 typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
4289
4290 @item
4291 Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
4292
4293 @item
4294 Initialization of automatic aggregates.
4295
4296 @item
4297 Identifier conflicts with labels. Traditional C lacks a separate
4298 namespace for labels.
4299
4300 @item
4301 Initialization of unions. If the initializer is zero, the warning is
4302 omitted. This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
4303 user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
4304 initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
4305 traditional C case.
4306
4307 @item
4308 Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values and vice
4309 versa. The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
4310 C causes serious problems. This is a subset of the possible
4311 conversion warnings; for the full set use @option{-Wtraditional-conversion}.
4312
4313 @item
4314 Use of ISO C style function definitions. This warning intentionally is
4315 @emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
4316 because these ISO C features appear in your code when using
4317 libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
4318 @code{VPARAMS}. This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
4319 because that feature is already a GCC extension and thus not relevant to
4320 traditional C compatibility.
4321 @end itemize
4322
4323 @item -Wtraditional-conversion @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4324 @opindex Wtraditional-conversion
4325 @opindex Wno-traditional-conversion
4326 Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
4327 would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype. This
4328 includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
4329 conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed-point argument
4330 except when the same as the default promotion.
4331
4332 @item -Wdeclaration-after-statement @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4333 @opindex Wdeclaration-after-statement
4334 @opindex Wno-declaration-after-statement
4335 Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block. This
4336 construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is by default
4337 allowed in GCC@. It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not supported by
4338 GCC versions before GCC 3.0. @xref{Mixed Declarations}.
4339
4340 @item -Wundef
4341 @opindex Wundef
4342 @opindex Wno-undef
4343 Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
4344
4345 @item -Wno-endif-labels
4346 @opindex Wno-endif-labels
4347 @opindex Wendif-labels
4348 Do not warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
4349
4350 @item -Wshadow
4351 @opindex Wshadow
4352 @opindex Wno-shadow
4353 Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows another variable,
4354 parameter, type, or class member (in C++), or whenever a built-in function
4355 is shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler warns if a local variable
4356 shadows an explicit typedef, but not if it shadows a struct/class/enum.
4357
4358 @item -Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4359 @opindex Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4360 @opindex Wlarger-than-@var{len}
4361 Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
4362
4363 @item -Wframe-larger-than=@var{len}
4364 @opindex Wframe-larger-than
4365 Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than @var{len} bytes.
4366 The computation done to determine the stack frame size is approximate
4367 and not conservative.
4368 The actual requirements may be somewhat greater than @var{len}
4369 even if you do not get a warning. In addition, any space allocated
4370 via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related constructs
4371 is not included by the compiler when determining
4372 whether or not to issue a warning.
4373
4374 @item -Wno-free-nonheap-object
4375 @opindex Wno-free-nonheap-object
4376 @opindex Wfree-nonheap-object
4377 Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not allocated
4378 on the heap.
4379
4380 @item -Wstack-usage=@var{len}
4381 @opindex Wstack-usage
4382 Warn if the stack usage of a function might be larger than @var{len} bytes.
4383 The computation done to determine the stack usage is conservative.
4384 Any space allocated via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related
4385 constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or not to
4386 issue a warning.
4387
4388 The message is in keeping with the output of @option{-fstack-usage}.
4389
4390 @itemize
4391 @item
4392 If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified amount, it's:
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes
4396 @end smallexample
4397 @item
4398 If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:
4399
4400 @smallexample
4401 warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes
4402 @end smallexample
4403 @item
4404 If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:
4405
4406 @smallexample
4407 warning: stack usage might be unbounded
4408 @end smallexample
4409 @end itemize
4410
4411 @item -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4412 @opindex Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4413 @opindex Wno-unsafe-loop-optimizations
4414 Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler cannot
4415 assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices. With
4416 @option{-funsafe-loop-optimizations} warn if the compiler makes
4417 such assumptions.
4418
4419 @item -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @r{(MinGW targets only)}
4420 @opindex Wno-pedantic-ms-format
4421 @opindex Wpedantic-ms-format
4422 When used in combination with @option{-Wformat}
4423 and @option{-pedantic} without GNU extensions, this option
4424 disables the warnings about non-ISO @code{printf} / @code{scanf} format
4425 width specifiers @code{I32}, @code{I64}, and @code{I} used on Windows targets,
4426 which depend on the MS runtime.
4427
4428 @item -Wpointer-arith
4429 @opindex Wpointer-arith
4430 @opindex Wno-pointer-arith
4431 Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
4432 of @code{void}. GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
4433 convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
4434 to functions. In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves
4435 @code{NULL}. This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wpedantic}.
4436
4437 @item -Wtype-limits
4438 @opindex Wtype-limits
4439 @opindex Wno-type-limits
4440 Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited
4441 range of the data type, but do not warn for constant expressions. For
4442 example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared against zero with
4443 @samp{<} or @samp{>=}. This warning is also enabled by
4444 @option{-Wextra}.
4445
4446 @item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4447 @opindex Wbad-function-cast
4448 @opindex Wno-bad-function-cast
4449 Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
4450 For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
4451
4452 @item -Wc++-compat @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4453 Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of
4454 ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.@: request for implicit conversion from
4455 @code{void *} to a pointer to non-@code{void} type.
4456
4457 @item -Wc++11-compat @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4458 Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++ 1998
4459 and ISO C++ 2011, e.g., identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are keywords
4460 in ISO C++ 2011. This warning turns on @option{-Wnarrowing} and is
4461 enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4462
4463 @item -Wcast-qual
4464 @opindex Wcast-qual
4465 @opindex Wno-cast-qual
4466 Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
4467 the target type. For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
4468 to an ordinary @code{char *}.
4469
4470 Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an
4471 unsafe way. For example, casting @code{char **} to @code{const char **}
4472 is unsafe, as in this example:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 /* p is char ** value. */
4476 const char **q = (const char **) p;
4477 /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK. */
4478 *q = "string";
4479 /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory. */
4480 **p = 'b';
4481 @end smallexample
4482
4483 @item -Wcast-align
4484 @opindex Wcast-align
4485 @opindex Wno-cast-align
4486 Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
4487 target is increased. For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
4488 an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
4489 two- or four-byte boundaries.
4490
4491 @item -Wwrite-strings
4492 @opindex Wwrite-strings
4493 @opindex Wno-write-strings
4494 When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
4495 char[@var{length}]} so that copying the address of one into a
4496 non-@code{const} @code{char *} pointer produces a warning. These
4497 warnings help you find at compile time code that can try to write
4498 into a string constant, but only if you have been very careful about
4499 using @code{const} in declarations and prototypes. Otherwise, it is
4500 just a nuisance. This is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request
4501 these warnings.
4502
4503 When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from string
4504 literals to @code{char *}. This warning is enabled by default for C++
4505 programs.
4506
4507 @item -Wclobbered
4508 @opindex Wclobbered
4509 @opindex Wno-clobbered
4510 Warn for variables that might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or
4511 @samp{vfork}. This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4512
4513 @item -Wconditionally-supported @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4514 @opindex Wconditionally-supported
4515 @opindex Wno-conditionally-supported
4516 Warn for conditionally-supported (C++11 [intro.defs]) constructs.
4517
4518 @item -Wconversion
4519 @opindex Wconversion
4520 @opindex Wno-conversion
4521 Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This includes
4522 conversions between real and integer, like @code{abs (x)} when
4523 @code{x} is @code{double}; conversions between signed and unsigned,
4524 like @code{unsigned ui = -1}; and conversions to smaller types, like
4525 @code{sqrtf (M_PI)}. Do not warn for explicit casts like @code{abs
4526 ((int) x)} and @code{ui = (unsigned) -1}, or if the value is not
4527 changed by the conversion like in @code{abs (2.0)}. Warnings about
4528 conversions between signed and unsigned integers can be disabled by
4529 using @option{-Wno-sign-conversion}.
4530
4531 For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined
4532 conversions; and conversions that never use a type conversion
4533 operator: conversions to @code{void}, the same type, a base class or a
4534 reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and
4535 unsigned integers are disabled by default in C++ unless
4536 @option{-Wsign-conversion} is explicitly enabled.
4537
4538 @item -Wno-conversion-null @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4539 @opindex Wconversion-null
4540 @opindex Wno-conversion-null
4541 Do not warn for conversions between @code{NULL} and non-pointer
4542 types. @option{-Wconversion-null} is enabled by default.
4543
4544 @item -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4545 @opindex Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant
4546 @opindex Wno-zero-as-null-pointer-constant
4547 Warn when a literal '0' is used as null pointer constant. This can
4548 be useful to facilitate the conversion to @code{nullptr} in C++11.
4549
4550 @item -Wdate-time
4551 @opindex Wdate-time
4552 @opindex Wno-date-time
4553 Warn when macros @code{__TIME__}, @code{__DATE__} or @code{__TIMESTAMP__}
4554 are encountered as they might prevent bit-wise-identical reproducible
4555 compilations.
4556
4557 @item -Wdelete-incomplete @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4558 @opindex Wdelete-incomplete
4559 @opindex Wno-delete-incomplete
4560 Warn when deleting a pointer to incomplete type, which may cause
4561 undefined behavior at runtime. This warning is enabled by default.
4562
4563 @item -Wuseless-cast @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4564 @opindex Wuseless-cast
4565 @opindex Wno-useless-cast
4566 Warn when an expression is casted to its own type.
4567
4568 @item -Wempty-body
4569 @opindex Wempty-body
4570 @opindex Wno-empty-body
4571 Warn if an empty body occurs in an @samp{if}, @samp{else} or @samp{do
4572 while} statement. This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4573
4574 @item -Wenum-compare
4575 @opindex Wenum-compare
4576 @opindex Wno-enum-compare
4577 Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated types.
4578 In C++ enumeral mismatches in conditional expressions are also
4579 diagnosed and the warning is enabled by default. In C this warning is
4580 enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4581
4582 @item -Wjump-misses-init @r{(C, Objective-C only)}
4583 @opindex Wjump-misses-init
4584 @opindex Wno-jump-misses-init
4585 Warn if a @code{goto} statement or a @code{switch} statement jumps
4586 forward across the initialization of a variable, or jumps backward to a
4587 label after the variable has been initialized. This only warns about
4588 variables that are initialized when they are declared. This warning is
4589 only supported for C and Objective-C; in C++ this sort of branch is an
4590 error in any case.
4591
4592 @option{-Wjump-misses-init} is included in @option{-Wc++-compat}. It
4593 can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-jump-misses-init} option.
4594
4595 @item -Wsign-compare
4596 @opindex Wsign-compare
4597 @opindex Wno-sign-compare
4598 @cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
4599 @cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
4600 @cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
4601 Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
4602 an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
4603 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
4604 of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @option{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
4605
4606 @item -Wsign-conversion
4607 @opindex Wsign-conversion
4608 @opindex Wno-sign-conversion
4609 Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer
4610 value, like assigning a signed integer expression to an unsigned
4611 integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
4612 option is enabled also by @option{-Wconversion}.
4613
4614 @item -Wfloat-conversion
4615 @opindex Wfloat-conversion
4616 @opindex Wno-float-conversion
4617 Warn for implicit conversions that reduce the precision of a real value.
4618 This includes conversions from real to integer, and from higher precision
4619 real to lower precision real values. This option is also enabled by
4620 @option{-Wconversion}.
4621
4622 @item -Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess
4623 @opindex Wsizeof-pointer-memaccess
4624 @opindex Wno-sizeof-pointer-memaccess
4625 Warn for suspicious length parameters to certain string and memory built-in
4626 functions if the argument uses @code{sizeof}. This warning warns e.g.@:
4627 about @code{memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (ptr));} if @code{ptr} is not an array,
4628 but a pointer, and suggests a possible fix, or about
4629 @code{memcpy (&foo, ptr, sizeof (&foo));}. This warning is enabled by
4630 @option{-Wall}.
4631
4632 @item -Waddress
4633 @opindex Waddress
4634 @opindex Wno-address
4635 Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
4636 the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
4637 @code{void func(void); if (func)}, and comparisons against the memory
4638 address of a string literal, such as @code{if (x == "abc")}. Such
4639 uses typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
4640 always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
4641 indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
4642 call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
4643 behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that the
4644 programmer intended to use @code{strcmp}. This warning is enabled by
4645 @option{-Wall}.
4646
4647 @item -Wlogical-op
4648 @opindex Wlogical-op
4649 @opindex Wno-logical-op
4650 Warn about suspicious uses of logical operators in expressions.
4651 This includes using logical operators in contexts where a
4652 bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.
4653
4654 @item -Waggregate-return
4655 @opindex Waggregate-return
4656 @opindex Wno-aggregate-return
4657 Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
4658 called. (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
4659 a warning.)
4660
4661 @item -Wno-aggressive-loop-optimizations
4662 @opindex Wno-aggressive-loop-optimizations
4663 @opindex Waggressive-loop-optimizations
4664 Warn if in a loop with constant number of iterations the compiler detects
4665 undefined behavior in some statement during one or more of the iterations.
4666
4667 @item -Wno-attributes
4668 @opindex Wno-attributes
4669 @opindex Wattributes
4670 Do not warn if an unexpected @code{__attribute__} is used, such as
4671 unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
4672 etc. This does not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
4673 attributes.
4674
4675 @item -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4676 @opindex Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4677 @opindex Wbuiltin-macro-redefined
4678 Do not warn if certain built-in macros are redefined. This suppresses
4679 warnings for redefinition of @code{__TIMESTAMP__}, @code{__TIME__},
4680 @code{__DATE__}, @code{__FILE__}, and @code{__BASE_FILE__}.
4681
4682 @item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4683 @opindex Wstrict-prototypes
4684 @opindex Wno-strict-prototypes
4685 Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
4686 argument types. (An old-style function definition is permitted without
4687 a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the argument
4688 types.)
4689
4690 @item -Wold-style-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4691 @opindex Wold-style-declaration
4692 @opindex Wno-old-style-declaration
4693 Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a
4694 declaration. For example, warn if storage-class specifiers like
4695 @code{static} are not the first things in a declaration. This warning
4696 is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4697
4698 @item -Wold-style-definition @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4699 @opindex Wold-style-definition
4700 @opindex Wno-old-style-definition
4701 Warn if an old-style function definition is used. A warning is given
4702 even if there is a previous prototype.
4703
4704 @item -Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4705 @opindex Wmissing-parameter-type
4706 @opindex Wno-missing-parameter-type
4707 A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
4708 functions:
4709
4710 @smallexample
4711 void foo(bar) @{ @}
4712 @end smallexample
4713
4714 This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4715
4716 @item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4717 @opindex Wmissing-prototypes
4718 @opindex Wno-missing-prototypes
4719 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
4720 declaration. This warning is issued even if the definition itself
4721 provides a prototype. Use this option to detect global functions
4722 that do not have a matching prototype declaration in a header file.
4723 This option is not valid for C++ because all function declarations
4724 provide prototypes and a non-matching declaration will declare an
4725 overload rather than conflict with an earlier declaration.
4726 Use @option{-Wmissing-declarations} to detect missing declarations in C++.
4727
4728 @item -Wmissing-declarations
4729 @opindex Wmissing-declarations
4730 @opindex Wno-missing-declarations
4731 Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
4732 Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
4733 Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
4734 header files. In C, no warnings are issued for functions with previous
4735 non-prototype declarations; use @option{-Wmissing-prototype} to detect
4736 missing prototypes. In C++, no warnings are issued for function templates,
4737 or for inline functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.
4738
4739 @item -Wmissing-field-initializers
4740 @opindex Wmissing-field-initializers
4741 @opindex Wno-missing-field-initializers
4742 @opindex W
4743 @opindex Wextra
4744 @opindex Wno-extra
4745 Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing. For
4746 example, the following code causes such a warning, because
4747 @code{x.h} is implicitly zero:
4748
4749 @smallexample
4750 struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4751 struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
4752 @end smallexample
4753
4754 This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the following
4755 modification does not trigger a warning:
4756
4757 @smallexample
4758 struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4759 struct s x = @{ .f = 3, .g = 4 @};
4760 @end smallexample
4761
4762 This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}. To get other @option{-Wextra}
4763 warnings without this one, use @option{-Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers}.
4764
4765 @item -Wno-multichar
4766 @opindex Wno-multichar
4767 @opindex Wmultichar
4768 Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
4769 Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
4770 implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
4771
4772 @item -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
4773 @opindex Wnormalized=
4774 @cindex NFC
4775 @cindex NFKC
4776 @cindex character set, input normalization
4777 In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
4778 different sequences of characters. However, sometimes when characters
4779 outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
4780 different character sequences that look the same. To avoid confusion,
4781 the ISO 10646 standard sets out some @dfn{normalization rules} which
4782 when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are turned into
4783 the same sequence. GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers that
4784 have not been normalized; this option controls that warning.
4785
4786 There are four levels of warning supported by GCC@. The default is
4787 @option{-Wnormalized=nfc}, which warns about any identifier that is
4788 not in the ISO 10646 ``C'' normalized form, @dfn{NFC}. NFC is the
4789 recommended form for most uses.
4790
4791 Unfortunately, there are some characters allowed in identifiers by
4792 ISO C and ISO C++ that, when turned into NFC, are not allowed in
4793 identifiers. That is, there's no way to use these symbols in portable
4794 ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC@.
4795 @option{-Wnormalized=id} suppresses the warning for these characters.
4796 It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
4797 this, which is why this option is not the default.
4798
4799 You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
4800 @option{-Wnormalized=none}. You should only do this if you
4801 are using some other normalization scheme (like ``D''), because
4802 otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.
4803
4804 Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look identical
4805 in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once formatting has
4806 been applied. For instance @code{\u207F}, ``SUPERSCRIPT LATIN SMALL
4807 LETTER N'', displays just like a regular @code{n} that has been
4808 placed in a superscript. ISO 10646 defines the @dfn{NFKC}
4809 normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
4810 well, and GCC warns if your code is not in NFKC if you use
4811 @option{-Wnormalized=nfkc}. This warning is comparable to warning
4812 about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
4813 confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
4814 useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment
4815 cannot be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
4816
4817 @item -Wno-deprecated
4818 @opindex Wno-deprecated
4819 @opindex Wdeprecated
4820 Do not warn about usage of deprecated features. @xref{Deprecated Features}.
4821
4822 @item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
4823 @opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
4824 @opindex Wdeprecated-declarations
4825 Do not warn about uses of functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}),
4826 variables (@pxref{Variable Attributes}), and types (@pxref{Type
4827 Attributes}) marked as deprecated by using the @code{deprecated}
4828 attribute.
4829
4830 @item -Wno-overflow
4831 @opindex Wno-overflow
4832 @opindex Woverflow
4833 Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
4834
4835 @item -Wopenmp-simd
4836 @opindex Wopenm-simd
4837 Warn if the vectorizer cost model overrides the OpenMP or the Cilk Plus
4838 simd directive set by user. The @option{-fsimd-cost-model=unlimited} can
4839 be used to relax the cost model.
4840
4841 @item -Woverride-init @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4842 @opindex Woverride-init
4843 @opindex Wno-override-init
4844 @opindex W
4845 @opindex Wextra
4846 @opindex Wno-extra
4847 Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when
4848 using designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
4849 Initializers}).
4850
4851 This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}. To get other
4852 @option{-Wextra} warnings without this one, use @option{-Wextra
4853 -Wno-override-init}.
4854
4855 @item -Wpacked
4856 @opindex Wpacked
4857 @opindex Wno-packed
4858 Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
4859 attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
4860 Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit. For
4861 instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
4862 is misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
4863 have the packed attribute:
4864
4865 @smallexample
4866 @group
4867 struct foo @{
4868 int x;
4869 char a, b, c, d;
4870 @} __attribute__((packed));
4871 struct bar @{
4872 char z;
4873 struct foo f;
4874 @};
4875 @end group
4876 @end smallexample
4877
4878 @item -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4879 @opindex Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4880 @opindex Wno-packed-bitfield-compat
4881 The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the @code{packed} attribute
4882 on bit-fields of type @code{char}. This has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but
4883 the change can lead to differences in the structure layout. GCC
4884 informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.
4885 For example there is no longer a 4-bit padding between field @code{a}
4886 and @code{b} in this structure:
4887
4888 @smallexample
4889 struct foo
4890 @{
4891 char a:4;
4892 char b:8;
4893 @} __attribute__ ((packed));
4894 @end smallexample
4895
4896 This warning is enabled by default. Use
4897 @option{-Wno-packed-bitfield-compat} to disable this warning.
4898
4899 @item -Wpadded
4900 @opindex Wpadded
4901 @opindex Wno-padded
4902 Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
4903 of the structure or to align the whole structure. Sometimes when this
4904 happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
4905 reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
4906
4907 @item -Wredundant-decls
4908 @opindex Wredundant-decls
4909 @opindex Wno-redundant-decls
4910 Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
4911 cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
4912
4913 @item -Wnested-externs @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4914 @opindex Wnested-externs
4915 @opindex Wno-nested-externs
4916 Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
4917
4918 @item -Wno-inherited-variadic-ctor
4919 @opindex Winherited-variadic-ctor
4920 @opindex Wno-inherited-variadic-ctor
4921 Suppress warnings about use of C++11 inheriting constructors when the
4922 base class inherited from has a C variadic constructor; the warning is
4923 on by default because the ellipsis is not inherited.
4924
4925 @item -Winline
4926 @opindex Winline
4927 @opindex Wno-inline
4928 Warn if a function that is declared as inline cannot be inlined.
4929 Even with this option, the compiler does not warn about failures to
4930 inline functions declared in system headers.
4931
4932 The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not
4933 to inline a function. For example, the compiler takes into account
4934 the size of the function being inlined and the amount of inlining
4935 that has already been done in the current function. Therefore,
4936 seemingly insignificant changes in the source program can cause the
4937 warnings produced by @option{-Winline} to appear or disappear.
4938
4939 @item -Wno-invalid-offsetof @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4940 @opindex Wno-invalid-offsetof
4941 @opindex Winvalid-offsetof
4942 Suppress warnings from applying the @samp{offsetof} macro to a non-POD
4943 type. According to the 1998 ISO C++ standard, applying @samp{offsetof}
4944 to a non-POD type is undefined. In existing C++ implementations,
4945 however, @samp{offsetof} typically gives meaningful results even when
4946 applied to certain kinds of non-POD types (such as a simple
4947 @samp{struct} that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a
4948 constructor). This flag is for users who are aware that they are
4949 writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore the
4950 warning about it.
4951
4952 The restrictions on @samp{offsetof} may be relaxed in a future version
4953 of the C++ standard.
4954
4955 @item -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4956 @opindex Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4957 @opindex Wint-to-pointer-cast
4958 Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
4959 different size. In C++, casting to a pointer type of smaller size is
4960 an error. @option{Wint-to-pointer-cast} is enabled by default.
4961
4962
4963 @item -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4964 @opindex Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
4965 @opindex Wpointer-to-int-cast
4966 Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
4967 different size.
4968
4969 @item -Winvalid-pch
4970 @opindex Winvalid-pch
4971 @opindex Wno-invalid-pch
4972 Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
4973 the search path but can't be used.
4974
4975 @item -Wlong-long
4976 @opindex Wlong-long
4977 @opindex Wno-long-long
4978 Warn if @samp{long long} type is used. This is enabled by either
4979 @option{-Wpedantic} or @option{-Wtraditional} in ISO C90 and C++98
4980 modes. To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}.
4981
4982 @item -Wvariadic-macros
4983 @opindex Wvariadic-macros
4984 @opindex Wno-variadic-macros
4985 Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU
4986 alternate syntax when in pedantic ISO C99 mode. This is default.
4987 To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-variadic-macros}.
4988
4989 @item -Wvarargs
4990 @opindex Wvarargs
4991 @opindex Wno-varargs
4992 Warn upon questionable usage of the macros used to handle variable
4993 arguments like @samp{va_start}. This is default. To inhibit the
4994 warning messages, use @option{-Wno-varargs}.
4995
4996 @item -Wvector-operation-performance
4997 @opindex Wvector-operation-performance
4998 @opindex Wno-vector-operation-performance
4999 Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities of the
5000 architecture. Mainly useful for the performance tuning.
5001 Vector operation can be implemented @code{piecewise}, which means that the
5002 scalar operation is performed on every vector element;
5003 @code{in parallel}, which means that the vector operation is implemented
5004 using scalars of wider type, which normally is more performance efficient;
5005 and @code{as a single scalar}, which means that vector fits into a
5006 scalar type.
5007
5008 @item -Wno-virtual-move-assign
5009 @opindex Wvirtual-move-assign
5010 @opindex Wno-virtual-move-assign
5011 Suppress warnings about inheriting from a virtual base with a
5012 non-trivial C++11 move assignment operator. This is dangerous because
5013 if the virtual base is reachable along more than one path, it will be
5014 moved multiple times, which can mean both objects end up in the
5015 moved-from state. If the move assignment operator is written to avoid
5016 moving from a moved-from object, this warning can be disabled.
5017
5018 @item -Wvla
5019 @opindex Wvla
5020 @opindex Wno-vla
5021 Warn if variable length array is used in the code.
5022 @option{-Wno-vla} prevents the @option{-Wpedantic} warning of
5023 the variable length array.
5024
5025 @item -Wvolatile-register-var
5026 @opindex Wvolatile-register-var
5027 @opindex Wno-volatile-register-var
5028 Warn if a register variable is declared volatile. The volatile
5029 modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate reads
5030 and/or writes to register variables. This warning is enabled by
5031 @option{-Wall}.
5032
5033 @item -Wdisabled-optimization
5034 @opindex Wdisabled-optimization
5035 @opindex Wno-disabled-optimization
5036 Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled. This warning does
5037 not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
5038 merely indicates that GCC's optimizers are unable to handle the code
5039 effectively. Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
5040 complex; GCC refuses to optimize programs when the optimization
5041 itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
5042
5043 @item -Wpointer-sign @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
5044 @opindex Wpointer-sign
5045 @opindex Wno-pointer-sign
5046 Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different signedness.
5047 This option is only supported for C and Objective-C@. It is implied by
5048 @option{-Wall} and by @option{-Wpedantic}, which can be disabled with
5049 @option{-Wno-pointer-sign}.
5050
5051 @item -Wstack-protector
5052 @opindex Wstack-protector
5053 @opindex Wno-stack-protector
5054 This option is only active when @option{-fstack-protector} is active. It
5055 warns about functions that are not protected against stack smashing.
5056
5057 @item -Woverlength-strings
5058 @opindex Woverlength-strings
5059 @opindex Wno-overlength-strings
5060 Warn about string constants that are longer than the ``minimum
5061 maximum'' length specified in the C standard. Modern compilers
5062 generally allow string constants that are much longer than the
5063 standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
5064 using longer strings.
5065
5066 The limit applies @emph{after} string constant concatenation, and does
5067 not count the trailing NUL@. In C90, the limit was 509 characters; in
5068 C99, it was raised to 4095. C++98 does not specify a normative
5069 minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++@.
5070
5071 This option is implied by @option{-Wpedantic}, and can be disabled with
5072 @option{-Wno-overlength-strings}.
5073
5074 @item -Wunsuffixed-float-constants @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
5075 @opindex Wunsuffixed-float-constants
5076
5077 Issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have
5078 a suffix. When used together with @option{-Wsystem-headers} it
5079 warns about such constants in system header files. This can be useful
5080 when preparing code to use with the @code{FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64} pragma
5081 from the decimal floating-point extension to C99.
5082 @end table
5083
5084 @node Debugging Options
5085 @section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
5086 @cindex options, debugging
5087 @cindex debugging information options
5088
5089 GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
5090 either your program or GCC:
5091
5092 @table @gcctabopt
5093 @item -g
5094 @opindex g
5095 Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
5096 (stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF 2)@. GDB can work with this debugging
5097 information.
5098
5099 On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
5100 debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
5101 makes debugging work better in GDB but probably makes other debuggers
5102 crash or
5103 refuse to read the program. If you want to control for certain whether
5104 to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
5105 @option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms} (see below).
5106
5107 GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
5108 @option{-O}. The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
5109 produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
5110 at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
5111 some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
5112 results or their values are already at hand; some statements may
5113 execute in different places because they have been moved out of loops.
5114
5115 Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output. This makes
5116 it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
5117
5118 The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
5119 capability for more than one debugging format.
5120
5121 @item -gsplit-dwarf
5122 @opindex gsplit-dwarf
5123 Separate as much dwarf debugging information as possible into a
5124 separate output file with the extension .dwo. This option allows
5125 the build system to avoid linking files with debug information. To
5126 be useful, this option requires a debugger capable of reading .dwo
5127 files.
5128
5129 @item -ggdb
5130 @opindex ggdb
5131 Produce debugging information for use by GDB@. This means to use the
5132 most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
5133 if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
5134 possible.
5135
5136 @item -gpubnames
5137 @opindex gpubnames
5138 Generate dwarf .debug_pubnames and .debug_pubtypes sections.
5139
5140 @item -ggnu-pubnames
5141 @opindex ggnu-pubnames
5142 Generate .debug_pubnames and .debug_pubtypes sections in a format
5143 suitable for conversion into a GDB@ index. This option is only useful
5144 with a linker that can produce GDB@ index version 7.
5145
5146 @item -gstabs
5147 @opindex gstabs
5148 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
5149 without GDB extensions. This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
5150 systems. On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
5151 produces stabs debugging output that is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
5152 On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
5153
5154 @item -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
5155 @opindex feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
5156 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
5157 for only symbols that are actually used.
5158
5159 @item -femit-class-debug-always
5160 Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one
5161 object file, emit it in all object files using the class. This option
5162 should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle the way GCC
5163 normally emits debugging information for classes because using this
5164 option increases the size of debugging information by as much as a
5165 factor of two.
5166
5167 @item -fdebug-types-section
5168 @opindex fdebug-types-section
5169 @opindex fno-debug-types-section
5170 When using DWARF Version 4 or higher, type DIEs can be put into
5171 their own @code{.debug_types} section instead of making them part of the
5172 @code{.debug_info} section. It is more efficient to put them in a separate
5173 comdat sections since the linker can then remove duplicates.
5174 But not all DWARF consumers support @code{.debug_types} sections yet
5175 and on some objects @code{.debug_types} produces larger instead of smaller
5176 debugging information.
5177
5178 @item -gstabs+
5179 @opindex gstabs+
5180 Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
5181 using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@. The
5182 use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
5183 refuse to read the program.
5184
5185 @item -gcoff
5186 @opindex gcoff
5187 Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
5188 This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
5189 System V Release 4.
5190
5191 @item -gxcoff
5192 @opindex gxcoff
5193 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
5194 This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
5195
5196 @item -gxcoff+
5197 @opindex gxcoff+
5198 Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
5199 using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@. The
5200 use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
5201 refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
5202 assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
5203
5204 @item -gdwarf-@var{version}
5205 @opindex gdwarf-@var{version}
5206 Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is supported).
5207 The value of @var{version} may be either 2, 3 or 4; the default version
5208 for most targets is 4.
5209
5210 Note that with DWARF Version 2, some ports require and always
5211 use some non-conflicting DWARF 3 extensions in the unwind tables.
5212
5213 Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}
5214 for maximum benefit.
5215
5216 @item -grecord-gcc-switches
5217 @opindex grecord-gcc-switches
5218 This switch causes the command-line options used to invoke the
5219 compiler that may affect code generation to be appended to the
5220 DW_AT_producer attribute in DWARF debugging information. The options
5221 are concatenated with spaces separating them from each other and from
5222 the compiler version. See also @option{-frecord-gcc-switches} for another
5223 way of storing compiler options into the object file. This is the default.
5224
5225 @item -gno-record-gcc-switches
5226 @opindex gno-record-gcc-switches
5227 Disallow appending command-line options to the DW_AT_producer attribute
5228 in DWARF debugging information.
5229
5230 @item -gstrict-dwarf
5231 @opindex gstrict-dwarf
5232 Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected
5233 with @option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}. On most targets using non-conflicting
5234 DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.
5235
5236 @item -gno-strict-dwarf
5237 @opindex gno-strict-dwarf
5238 Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with
5239 @option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.
5240
5241 @item -gvms
5242 @opindex gvms
5243 Produce debugging information in Alpha/VMS debug format (if that is
5244 supported). This is the format used by DEBUG on Alpha/VMS systems.
5245
5246 @item -g@var{level}
5247 @itemx -ggdb@var{level}
5248 @itemx -gstabs@var{level}
5249 @itemx -gcoff@var{level}
5250 @itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
5251 @itemx -gvms@var{level}
5252 Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
5253 much information. The default level is 2.
5254
5255 Level 0 produces no debug information at all. Thus, @option{-g0} negates
5256 @option{-g}.
5257
5258 Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
5259 parts of the program that you don't plan to debug. This includes
5260 descriptions of functions and external variables, and line number
5261 tables, but no information about local variables.
5262
5263 Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
5264 present in the program. Some debuggers support macro expansion when
5265 you use @option{-g3}.
5266
5267 @option{-gdwarf-2} does not accept a concatenated debug level, because
5268 GCC used to support an option @option{-gdwarf} that meant to generate
5269 debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very
5270 different from version 2), and it would have been too confusing. That
5271 debug format is long obsolete, but the option cannot be changed now.
5272 Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}} option to change the
5273 debug level for DWARF.
5274
5275 @item -gtoggle
5276 @opindex gtoggle
5277 Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option
5278 generates it, or turn it on at level 2 otherwise. The position of this
5279 argument in the command line does not matter; it takes effect after all
5280 other options are processed, and it does so only once, no matter how
5281 many times it is given. This is mainly intended to be used with
5282 @option{-fcompare-debug}.
5283
5284 @item -fsanitize=address
5285 @opindex fsanitize=address
5286 Enable AddressSanitizer, a fast memory error detector.
5287 Memory access instructions will be instrumented to detect
5288 out-of-bounds and use-after-free bugs.
5289 See @uref{http://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/} for
5290 more details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using the
5291 @env{ASAN_OPTIONS} environment variable; see
5292 @url{https://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/wiki/Flags#Run-time_flags} for
5293 a list of supported options.
5294
5295 @item -fsanitize=thread
5296 @opindex fsanitize=thread
5297 Enable ThreadSanitizer, a fast data race detector.
5298 Memory access instructions will be instrumented to detect
5299 data race bugs. See @uref{http://code.google.com/p/thread-sanitizer/} for more
5300 details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using the @env{TSAN_OPTIONS}
5301 environment variable; see
5302 @url{https://code.google.com/p/thread-sanitizer/wiki/Flags} for a list of
5303 supported options.
5304
5305 @item -fsanitize=leak
5306 @opindex fsanitize=leak
5307 Enable LeakSanitizer, a memory leak detector.
5308 This option only matters for linking of executables and if neither
5309 @option{-fsanitize=address} nor @option{-fsanitize=thread} is used. In that
5310 case it will link the executable against a library that overrides @code{malloc}
5311 and other allocator functions. See
5312 @uref{https://code.google.com/p/address-sanitizer/wiki/LeakSanitizer} for more
5313 details. The run-time behavior can be influenced using the
5314 @env{LSAN_OPTIONS} environment variable.
5315
5316 @item -fsanitize=undefined
5317 @opindex fsanitize=undefined
5318 Enable UndefinedBehaviorSanitizer, a fast undefined behavior detector.
5319 Various computations will be instrumented to detect undefined behavior
5320 at runtime. Current suboptions are:
5321
5322 @table @gcctabopt
5323
5324 @item -fsanitize=shift
5325 @opindex fsanitize=shift
5326
5327 This option enables checking that the result of a shift operation is
5328 not undefined. Note that what exactly is considered undefined differs
5329 slightly between C and C++, as well as between ISO C90 and C99, etc.
5330
5331 @item -fsanitize=integer-divide-by-zero
5332 @opindex fsanitize=integer-divide-by-zero
5333
5334 Detect integer division by zero as well as @code{INT_MIN / -1} division.
5335
5336 @item -fsanitize=unreachable
5337 @opindex fsanitize=unreachable
5338
5339 With this option, the compiler will turn the @code{__builtin_unreachable}
5340 call into a diagnostics message call instead. When reaching the
5341 @code{__builtin_unreachable} call, the behavior is undefined.
5342
5343 @item -fsanitize=vla-bound
5344 @opindex fsanitize=vla-bound
5345
5346 This option instructs the compiler to check that the size of a variable
5347 length array is positive. This option does not have any effect in
5348 @option{-std=c++1y} mode, as the standard requires the exception be thrown
5349 instead.
5350
5351 @item -fsanitize=null
5352 @opindex fsanitize=null
5353
5354 This option enables pointer checking. Particularly, the application
5355 built with this option turned on will issue an error message when it
5356 tries to dereference a NULL pointer, or if a reference (possibly an
5357 rvalue reference) is bound to a NULL pointer.
5358
5359 @item -fsanitize=return
5360 @opindex fsanitize=return
5361
5362 This option enables return statement checking. Programs
5363 built with this option turned on will issue an error message
5364 when the end of a non-void function is reached without actually
5365 returning a value. This option works in C++ only.
5366
5367 @item -fsanitize=signed-integer-overflow
5368 @opindex fsanitize=signed-integer-overflow
5369
5370 This option enables signed integer overflow checking. We check that
5371 the result of @code{+}, @code{*}, and both unary and binary @code{-}
5372 does not overflow in the signed arithmetics. Note, integer promotion
5373 rules must be taken into account. That is, the following is not an
5374 overflow:
5375 @smallexample
5376 signed char a = SCHAR_MAX;
5377 a++;
5378 @end smallexample
5379
5380 @end table
5381
5382 While @option{-ftrapv} causes traps for signed overflows to be emitted,
5383 @option{-fsanitize=undefined} gives a diagnostic message.
5384 This currently works only for the C family of languages.
5385
5386 @item -fdump-final-insns@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
5387 @opindex fdump-final-insns
5388 Dump the final internal representation (RTL) to @var{file}. If the
5389 optional argument is omitted (or if @var{file} is @code{.}), the name
5390 of the dump file is determined by appending @code{.gkd} to the
5391 compilation output file name.
5392
5393 @item -fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}
5394 @opindex fcompare-debug
5395 @opindex fno-compare-debug
5396 If no error occurs during compilation, run the compiler a second time,
5397 adding @var{opts} and @option{-fcompare-debug-second} to the arguments
5398 passed to the second compilation. Dump the final internal
5399 representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.
5400
5401 If the equal sign is omitted, the default @option{-gtoggle} is used.
5402
5403 The environment variable @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG}, if defined, non-empty
5404 and nonzero, implicitly enables @option{-fcompare-debug}. If
5405 @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is defined to a string starting with a dash,
5406 then it is used for @var{opts}, otherwise the default @option{-gtoggle}
5407 is used.
5408
5409 @option{-fcompare-debug=}, with the equal sign but without @var{opts},
5410 is equivalent to @option{-fno-compare-debug}, which disables the dumping
5411 of the final representation and the second compilation, preventing even
5412 @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} from taking effect.
5413
5414 To verify full coverage during @option{-fcompare-debug} testing, set
5415 @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to say @samp{-fcompare-debug-not-overridden},
5416 which GCC rejects as an invalid option in any actual compilation
5417 (rather than preprocessing, assembly or linking). To get just a
5418 warning, setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to @samp{-w%n-fcompare-debug
5419 not overridden} will do.
5420
5421 @item -fcompare-debug-second
5422 @opindex fcompare-debug-second
5423 This option is implicitly passed to the compiler for the second
5424 compilation requested by @option{-fcompare-debug}, along with options to
5425 silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
5426 side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output. Dump
5427 files and preserved temporary files are renamed so as to contain the
5428 @code{.gk} additional extension during the second compilation, to avoid
5429 overwriting those generated by the first.
5430
5431 When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the
5432 @emph{first} compilation to be skipped, which makes it useful for little
5433 other than debugging the compiler proper.
5434
5435 @item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
5436 @opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
5437 Compress DWARF 2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
5438 information about each symbol. This option only makes sense when
5439 generating DWARF 2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
5440
5441 @item -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
5442 @opindex femit-struct-debug-baseonly
5443 Emit debug information for struct-like types
5444 only when the base name of the compilation source file
5445 matches the base name of file in which the struct is defined.
5446
5447 This option substantially reduces the size of debugging information,
5448 but at significant potential loss in type information to the debugger.
5449 See @option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} for a less aggressive option.
5450 See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
5451
5452 This option works only with DWARF 2.
5453
5454 @item -femit-struct-debug-reduced
5455 @opindex femit-struct-debug-reduced
5456 Emit debug information for struct-like types
5457 only when the base name of the compilation source file
5458 matches the base name of file in which the type is defined,
5459 unless the struct is a template or defined in a system header.
5460
5461 This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information,
5462 with some potential loss in type information to the debugger.
5463 See @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly} for a more aggressive option.
5464 See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
5465
5466 This option works only with DWARF 2.
5467
5468 @item -femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]}
5469 Specify the struct-like types
5470 for which the compiler generates debug information.
5471 The intent is to reduce duplicate struct debug information
5472 between different object files within the same program.
5473
5474 This option is a detailed version of
5475 @option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} and @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly},
5476 which serves for most needs.
5477
5478 A specification has the syntax@*
5479 [@samp{dir:}|@samp{ind:}][@samp{ord:}|@samp{gen:}](@samp{any}|@samp{sys}|@samp{base}|@samp{none})
5480
5481 The optional first word limits the specification to
5482 structs that are used directly (@samp{dir:}) or used indirectly (@samp{ind:}).
5483 A struct type is used directly when it is the type of a variable, member.
5484 Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.
5485 That is, when use of an incomplete struct is valid, the use is indirect.
5486 An example is
5487 @samp{struct one direct; struct two * indirect;}.
5488
5489 The optional second word limits the specification to
5490 ordinary structs (@samp{ord:}) or generic structs (@samp{gen:}).
5491 Generic structs are a bit complicated to explain.
5492 For C++, these are non-explicit specializations of template classes,
5493 or non-template classes within the above.
5494 Other programming languages have generics,
5495 but @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} does not yet implement them.
5496
5497 The third word specifies the source files for those
5498 structs for which the compiler should emit debug information.
5499 The values @samp{none} and @samp{any} have the normal meaning.
5500 The value @samp{base} means that
5501 the base of name of the file in which the type declaration appears
5502 must match the base of the name of the main compilation file.
5503 In practice, this means that when compiling @file{foo.c}, debug information
5504 is generated for types declared in that file and @file{foo.h},
5505 but not other header files.
5506 The value @samp{sys} means those types satisfying @samp{base}
5507 or declared in system or compiler headers.
5508
5509 You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.
5510
5511 The default is @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed=all}.
5512
5513 This option works only with DWARF 2.
5514
5515 @item -fno-merge-debug-strings
5516 @opindex fmerge-debug-strings
5517 @opindex fno-merge-debug-strings
5518 Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging
5519 information that are identical in different object files. Merging is
5520 not supported by all assemblers or linkers. Merging decreases the size
5521 of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing
5522 link processing time. Merging is enabled by default.
5523
5524 @item -fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new}
5525 @opindex fdebug-prefix-map
5526 When compiling files in directory @file{@var{old}}, record debugging
5527 information describing them as in @file{@var{new}} instead.
5528
5529 @item -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5530 @opindex fdwarf2-cfi-asm
5531 @opindex fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5532 Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated @code{.eh_frame} section
5533 instead of using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives.
5534
5535 @cindex @command{prof}
5536 @item -p
5537 @opindex p
5538 Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5539 analysis program @command{prof}. You must use this option when compiling
5540 the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5541 linking.
5542
5543 @cindex @command{gprof}
5544 @item -pg
5545 @opindex pg
5546 Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5547 analysis program @command{gprof}. You must use this option when compiling
5548 the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5549 linking.
5550
5551 @item -Q
5552 @opindex Q
5553 Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
5554 print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
5555
5556 @item -ftime-report
5557 @opindex ftime-report
5558 Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
5559 pass when it finishes.
5560
5561 @item -fmem-report
5562 @opindex fmem-report
5563 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5564 allocation when it finishes.
5565
5566 @item -fmem-report-wpa
5567 @opindex fmem-report-wpa
5568 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5569 allocation for the WPA phase only.
5570
5571 @item -fpre-ipa-mem-report
5572 @opindex fpre-ipa-mem-report
5573 @item -fpost-ipa-mem-report
5574 @opindex fpost-ipa-mem-report
5575 Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5576 allocation before or after interprocedural optimization.
5577
5578 @item -fprofile-report
5579 @opindex fprofile-report
5580 Makes the compiler print some statistics about consistency of the
5581 (estimated) profile and effect of individual passes.
5582
5583 @item -fstack-usage
5584 @opindex fstack-usage
5585 Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program, on a
5586 per-function basis. The filename for the dump is made by appending
5587 @file{.su} to the @var{auxname}. @var{auxname} is generated from the name of
5588 the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable,
5589 otherwise it is the basename of the source file. An entry is made up
5590 of three fields:
5591
5592 @itemize
5593 @item
5594 The name of the function.
5595 @item
5596 A number of bytes.
5597 @item
5598 One or more qualifiers: @code{static}, @code{dynamic}, @code{bounded}.
5599 @end itemize
5600
5601 The qualifier @code{static} means that the function manipulates the stack
5602 statically: a fixed number of bytes are allocated for the frame on function
5603 entry and released on function exit; no stack adjustments are otherwise made
5604 in the function. The second field is this fixed number of bytes.
5605
5606 The qualifier @code{dynamic} means that the function manipulates the stack
5607 dynamically: in addition to the static allocation described above, stack
5608 adjustments are made in the body of the function, for example to push/pop
5609 arguments around function calls. If the qualifier @code{bounded} is also
5610 present, the amount of these adjustments is bounded at compile time and
5611 the second field is an upper bound of the total amount of stack used by
5612 the function. If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
5613 not bounded at compile time and the second field only represents the
5614 bounded part.
5615
5616 @item -fprofile-arcs
5617 @opindex fprofile-arcs
5618 Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented. During
5619 execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
5620 executed and how many times it is taken or returns. When the compiled
5621 program exits it saves this data to a file called
5622 @file{@var{auxname}.gcda} for each source file. The data may be used for
5623 profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
5624 test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}). Each object file's
5625 @var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5626 explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
5627 the basename of the source file. In both cases any suffix is removed
5628 (e.g.@: @file{foo.gcda} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
5629 @file{dir/foo.gcda} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
5630 @xref{Cross-profiling}.
5631
5632 @cindex @command{gcov}
5633 @item --coverage
5634 @opindex coverage
5635
5636 This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage
5637 analysis. The option is a synonym for @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5638 @option{-ftest-coverage} (when compiling) and @option{-lgcov} (when
5639 linking). See the documentation for those options for more details.
5640
5641 @itemize
5642
5643 @item
5644 Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
5645 and code generation options. For test coverage analysis, use the
5646 additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option. You do not need to profile
5647 every source file in a program.
5648
5649 @item
5650 Link your object files with @option{-lgcov} or @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5651 (the latter implies the former).
5652
5653 @item
5654 Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
5655 information. This may be repeated any number of times. You can run
5656 concurrent instances of your program, and provided that the file system
5657 supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated. Also
5658 @code{fork} calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting
5659 will not happen).
5660
5661 @item
5662 For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
5663 the same optimization and code generation options plus
5664 @option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
5665 Control Optimization}).
5666
5667 @item
5668 For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
5669 information from the @file{.gcno} and @file{.gcda} files. Refer to the
5670 @command{gcov} documentation for further information.
5671
5672 @end itemize
5673
5674 With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
5675 creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
5676 Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
5677 compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
5678 executed. When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
5679 instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
5680 block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
5681
5682 @need 2000
5683 @item -ftest-coverage
5684 @opindex ftest-coverage
5685 Produce a notes file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
5686 (@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
5687 show program coverage. Each source file's note file is called
5688 @file{@var{auxname}.gcno}. Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
5689 above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
5690 generate test coverage data. Coverage data matches the source files
5691 more closely if you do not optimize.
5692
5693 @item -fdbg-cnt-list
5694 @opindex fdbg-cnt-list
5695 Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.
5696
5697
5698 @item -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list}
5699 @opindex fdbg-cnt
5700 Set the internal debug counter upper bound. @var{counter-value-list}
5701 is a comma-separated list of @var{name}:@var{value} pairs
5702 which sets the upper bound of each debug counter @var{name} to @var{value}.
5703 All debug counters have the initial upper bound of @code{UINT_MAX};
5704 thus @code{dbg_cnt()} returns true always unless the upper bound
5705 is set by this option.
5706 For example, with @option{-fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0},
5707 @code{dbg_cnt(dce)} returns true only for first 10 invocations.
5708
5709 @item -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}
5710 @itemx -fdisable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5711 @opindex fdisable-
5712 @opindex fenable-
5713
5714 This is a set of options that are used to explicitly disable/enable
5715 optimization passes. These options are intended for use for debugging GCC.
5716 Compiler users should use regular options for enabling/disabling
5717 passes instead.
5718
5719 @table @gcctabopt
5720
5721 @item -fdisable-ipa-@var{pass}
5722 Disable IPA pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name. If the same pass is
5723 statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5724 appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5725
5726 @item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}
5727 @itemx -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5728 Disable RTL pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name. If the same pass is
5729 statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5730 appended with a sequential number starting from 1. @var{range-list} is a
5731 comma-separated list of function ranges or assembler names. Each range is a number
5732 pair separated by a colon. The range is inclusive in both ends. If the range
5733 is trivial, the number pair can be simplified as a single number. If the
5734 function's call graph node's @var{uid} falls within one of the specified ranges,
5735 the @var{pass} is disabled for that function. The @var{uid} is shown in the
5736 function header of a dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using
5737 option @option{-fdump-passes}.
5738
5739 @item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}
5740 @itemx -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5741 Disable tree pass @var{pass}. See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description of
5742 option arguments.
5743
5744 @item -fenable-ipa-@var{pass}
5745 Enable IPA pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name. If the same pass is
5746 statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5747 appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5748
5749 @item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}
5750 @itemx -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5751 Enable RTL pass @var{pass}. See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for option argument
5752 description and examples.
5753
5754 @item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}
5755 @itemx -fenable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5756 Enable tree pass @var{pass}. See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description
5757 of option arguments.
5758
5759 @end table
5760
5761 Here are some examples showing uses of these options.
5762
5763 @smallexample
5764
5765 # disable ccp1 for all functions
5766 -fdisable-tree-ccp1
5767 # disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
5768 -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
5769 # disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
5770 # [300,400], and [400,1000]
5771 # disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
5772 -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
5773 # disable early inlining
5774 -fdisable-tree-einline
5775 # disable ipa inlining
5776 -fdisable-ipa-inline
5777 # enable tree full unroll
5778 -fenable-tree-unroll
5779
5780 @end smallexample
5781
5782 @item -d@var{letters}
5783 @itemx -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
5784 @itemx -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{filename}
5785 @opindex d
5786 @opindex fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
5787 Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
5788 @var{letters}. This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
5789 compiler. The file names for most of the dumps are made by appending
5790 a pass number and a word to the @var{dumpname}, and the files are
5791 created in the directory of the output file. In case of
5792 @option{=@var{filename}} option, the dump is output on the given file
5793 instead of the pass numbered dump files. Note that the pass number is
5794 computed statically as passes get registered into the pass manager.
5795 Thus the numbering is not related to the dynamic order of execution of
5796 passes. In particular, a pass installed by a plugin could have a
5797 number over 200 even if it executed quite early. @var{dumpname} is
5798 generated from the name of the output file, if explicitly specified
5799 and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the basename of the
5800 source file. These switches may have different effects when
5801 @option{-E} is used for preprocessing.
5802
5803 Debug dumps can be enabled with a @option{-fdump-rtl} switch or some
5804 @option{-d} option @var{letters}. Here are the possible
5805 letters for use in @var{pass} and @var{letters}, and their meanings:
5806
5807 @table @gcctabopt
5808
5809 @item -fdump-rtl-alignments
5810 @opindex fdump-rtl-alignments
5811 Dump after branch alignments have been computed.
5812
5813 @item -fdump-rtl-asmcons
5814 @opindex fdump-rtl-asmcons
5815 Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.
5816
5817 @item -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5818 @opindex fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5819 Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery. This pass is only run on
5820 architectures that have auto inc or auto dec instructions.
5821
5822 @item -fdump-rtl-barriers
5823 @opindex fdump-rtl-barriers
5824 Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.
5825
5826 @item -fdump-rtl-bbpart
5827 @opindex fdump-rtl-bbpart
5828 Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.
5829
5830 @item -fdump-rtl-bbro
5831 @opindex fdump-rtl-bbro
5832 Dump after block reordering.
5833
5834 @item -fdump-rtl-btl1
5835 @itemx -fdump-rtl-btl2
5836 @opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5837 @opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5838 @option{-fdump-rtl-btl1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-btl2} enable dumping
5839 after the two branch
5840 target load optimization passes.
5841
5842 @item -fdump-rtl-bypass
5843 @opindex fdump-rtl-bypass
5844 Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.
5845
5846 @item -fdump-rtl-combine
5847 @opindex fdump-rtl-combine
5848 Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.
5849
5850 @item -fdump-rtl-compgotos
5851 @opindex fdump-rtl-compgotos
5852 Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.
5853
5854 @item -fdump-rtl-ce1
5855 @itemx -fdump-rtl-ce2
5856 @itemx -fdump-rtl-ce3
5857 @opindex fdump-rtl-ce1
5858 @opindex fdump-rtl-ce2
5859 @opindex fdump-rtl-ce3
5860 @option{-fdump-rtl-ce1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-ce2}, and
5861 @option{-fdump-rtl-ce3} enable dumping after the three
5862 if conversion passes.
5863
5864 @item -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5865 @opindex fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5866 Dump after hard register copy propagation.
5867
5868 @item -fdump-rtl-csa
5869 @opindex fdump-rtl-csa
5870 Dump after combining stack adjustments.
5871
5872 @item -fdump-rtl-cse1
5873 @itemx -fdump-rtl-cse2
5874 @opindex fdump-rtl-cse1
5875 @opindex fdump-rtl-cse2
5876 @option{-fdump-rtl-cse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-cse2} enable dumping after
5877 the two common subexpression elimination passes.
5878
5879 @item -fdump-rtl-dce
5880 @opindex fdump-rtl-dce
5881 Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.
5882
5883 @item -fdump-rtl-dbr
5884 @opindex fdump-rtl-dbr
5885 Dump after delayed branch scheduling.
5886
5887 @item -fdump-rtl-dce1
5888 @itemx -fdump-rtl-dce2
5889 @opindex fdump-rtl-dce1
5890 @opindex fdump-rtl-dce2
5891 @option{-fdump-rtl-dce1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-dce2} enable dumping after
5892 the two dead store elimination passes.
5893
5894 @item -fdump-rtl-eh
5895 @opindex fdump-rtl-eh
5896 Dump after finalization of EH handling code.
5897
5898 @item -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5899 @opindex fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5900 Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.
5901
5902 @item -fdump-rtl-expand
5903 @opindex fdump-rtl-expand
5904 Dump after RTL generation.
5905
5906 @item -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5907 @itemx -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5908 @opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5909 @opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5910 @option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop2} enable
5911 dumping after the two forward propagation passes.
5912
5913 @item -fdump-rtl-gcse1
5914 @itemx -fdump-rtl-gcse2
5915 @opindex fdump-rtl-gcse1
5916 @opindex fdump-rtl-gcse2
5917 @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse2} enable dumping
5918 after global common subexpression elimination.
5919
5920 @item -fdump-rtl-init-regs
5921 @opindex fdump-rtl-init-regs
5922 Dump after the initialization of the registers.
5923
5924 @item -fdump-rtl-initvals
5925 @opindex fdump-rtl-initvals
5926 Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.
5927
5928 @item -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5929 @opindex fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5930 Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.
5931
5932 @item -fdump-rtl-ira
5933 @opindex fdump-rtl-ira
5934 Dump after iterated register allocation.
5935
5936 @item -fdump-rtl-jump
5937 @opindex fdump-rtl-jump
5938 Dump after the second jump optimization.
5939
5940 @item -fdump-rtl-loop2
5941 @opindex fdump-rtl-loop2
5942 @option{-fdump-rtl-loop2} enables dumping after the rtl
5943 loop optimization passes.
5944
5945 @item -fdump-rtl-mach
5946 @opindex fdump-rtl-mach
5947 Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that
5948 pass exists.
5949
5950 @item -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5951 @opindex fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5952 Dump after removing redundant mode switches.
5953
5954 @item -fdump-rtl-rnreg
5955 @opindex fdump-rtl-rnreg
5956 Dump after register renumbering.
5957
5958 @item -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5959 @opindex fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5960 Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.
5961
5962 @item -fdump-rtl-peephole2
5963 @opindex fdump-rtl-peephole2
5964 Dump after the peephole pass.
5965
5966 @item -fdump-rtl-postreload
5967 @opindex fdump-rtl-postreload
5968 Dump after post-reload optimizations.
5969
5970 @item -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5971 @opindex fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5972 Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.
5973
5974 @item -fdump-rtl-sched1
5975 @itemx -fdump-rtl-sched2
5976 @opindex fdump-rtl-sched1
5977 @opindex fdump-rtl-sched2
5978 @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} enable dumping
5979 after the basic block scheduling passes.
5980
5981 @item -fdump-rtl-ree
5982 @opindex fdump-rtl-ree
5983 Dump after sign/zero extension elimination.
5984
5985 @item -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5986 @opindex fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5987 Dump after common sequence discovery.
5988
5989 @item -fdump-rtl-shorten
5990 @opindex fdump-rtl-shorten
5991 Dump after shortening branches.
5992
5993 @item -fdump-rtl-sibling
5994 @opindex fdump-rtl-sibling
5995 Dump after sibling call optimizations.
5996
5997 @item -fdump-rtl-split1
5998 @itemx -fdump-rtl-split2
5999 @itemx -fdump-rtl-split3
6000 @itemx -fdump-rtl-split4
6001 @itemx -fdump-rtl-split5
6002 @opindex fdump-rtl-split1
6003 @opindex fdump-rtl-split2
6004 @opindex fdump-rtl-split3
6005 @opindex fdump-rtl-split4
6006 @opindex fdump-rtl-split5
6007 @option{-fdump-rtl-split1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split2},
6008 @option{-fdump-rtl-split3}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split4} and
6009 @option{-fdump-rtl-split5} enable dumping after five rounds of
6010 instruction splitting.
6011
6012 @item -fdump-rtl-sms
6013 @opindex fdump-rtl-sms
6014 Dump after modulo scheduling. This pass is only run on some
6015 architectures.
6016
6017 @item -fdump-rtl-stack
6018 @opindex fdump-rtl-stack
6019 Dump after conversion from GCC's ``flat register file'' registers to the
6020 x87's stack-like registers. This pass is only run on x86 variants.
6021
6022 @item -fdump-rtl-subreg1
6023 @itemx -fdump-rtl-subreg2
6024 @opindex fdump-rtl-subreg1
6025 @opindex fdump-rtl-subreg2
6026 @option{-fdump-rtl-subreg1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-subreg2} enable dumping after
6027 the two subreg expansion passes.
6028
6029 @item -fdump-rtl-unshare
6030 @opindex fdump-rtl-unshare
6031 Dump after all rtl has been unshared.
6032
6033 @item -fdump-rtl-vartrack
6034 @opindex fdump-rtl-vartrack
6035 Dump after variable tracking.
6036
6037 @item -fdump-rtl-vregs
6038 @opindex fdump-rtl-vregs
6039 Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.
6040
6041 @item -fdump-rtl-web
6042 @opindex fdump-rtl-web
6043 Dump after live range splitting.
6044
6045 @item -fdump-rtl-regclass
6046 @itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
6047 @itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
6048 @itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinit
6049 @itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinish
6050 @opindex fdump-rtl-regclass
6051 @opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
6052 @opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
6053 @opindex fdump-rtl-dfinit
6054 @opindex fdump-rtl-dfinish
6055 These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.
6056
6057 @item -da
6058 @itemx -fdump-rtl-all
6059 @opindex da
6060 @opindex fdump-rtl-all
6061 Produce all the dumps listed above.
6062
6063 @item -dA
6064 @opindex dA
6065 Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
6066
6067 @item -dD
6068 @opindex dD
6069 Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
6070 normal output.
6071
6072 @item -dH
6073 @opindex dH
6074 Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
6075
6076 @item -dp
6077 @opindex dp
6078 Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
6079 pattern and alternative is used. The length of each instruction is
6080 also printed.
6081
6082 @item -dP
6083 @opindex dP
6084 Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
6085 Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
6086
6087 @item -dx
6088 @opindex dx
6089 Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it. Usually used
6090 with @option{-fdump-rtl-expand}.
6091 @end table
6092
6093 @item -fdump-noaddr
6094 @opindex fdump-noaddr
6095 When doing debugging dumps, suppress address output. This makes it more
6096 feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with
6097 different compiler binaries and/or different
6098 text / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
6099
6100 @item -fdump-unnumbered
6101 @opindex fdump-unnumbered
6102 When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address output.
6103 This makes it more feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler
6104 invocations with different options, in particular with and without
6105 @option{-g}.
6106
6107 @item -fdump-unnumbered-links
6108 @opindex fdump-unnumbered-links
6109 When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress
6110 instruction numbers for the links to the previous and next instructions
6111 in a sequence.
6112
6113 @item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C++ only)}
6114 @itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
6115 @opindex fdump-translation-unit
6116 Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
6117 unit to a file. The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
6118 source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as the
6119 output file. If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
6120 controls the details of the dump as described for the
6121 @option{-fdump-tree} options.
6122
6123 @item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
6124 @itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
6125 @opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
6126 Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
6127 table layout to a file. The file name is made by appending
6128 @file{.class} to the source file name, and the file is created in the
6129 same directory as the output file. If the @samp{-@var{options}} form
6130 is used, @var{options} controls the details of the dump as described
6131 for the @option{-fdump-tree} options.
6132
6133 @item -fdump-ipa-@var{switch}
6134 @opindex fdump-ipa
6135 Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
6136 language tree to a file. The file name is generated by appending a
6137 switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is created
6138 in the same directory as the output file. The following dumps are
6139 possible:
6140
6141 @table @samp
6142 @item all
6143 Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.
6144
6145 @item cgraph
6146 Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal,
6147 and inlining decisions.
6148
6149 @item inline
6150 Dump after function inlining.
6151
6152 @end table
6153
6154 @item -fdump-passes
6155 @opindex fdump-passes
6156 Dump the list of optimization passes that are turned on and off by
6157 the current command-line options.
6158
6159 @item -fdump-statistics-@var{option}
6160 @opindex fdump-statistics
6161 Enable and control dumping of pass statistics in a separate file. The
6162 file name is generated by appending a suffix ending in
6163 @samp{.statistics} to the source file name, and the file is created in
6164 the same directory as the output file. If the @samp{-@var{option}}
6165 form is used, @samp{-stats} causes counters to be summed over the
6166 whole compilation unit while @samp{-details} dumps every event as
6167 the passes generate them. The default with no option is to sum
6168 counters for each function compiled.
6169
6170 @item -fdump-tree-@var{switch}
6171 @itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}
6172 @itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}=@var{filename}
6173 @opindex fdump-tree
6174 Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
6175 language tree to a file. The file name is generated by appending a
6176 switch-specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
6177 created in the same directory as the output file. In case of
6178 @option{=@var{filename}} option, the dump is output on the given file
6179 instead of the auto named dump files. If the @samp{-@var{options}}
6180 form is used, @var{options} is a list of @samp{-} separated options
6181 which control the details of the dump. Not all options are applicable
6182 to all dumps; those that are not meaningful are ignored. The
6183 following options are available
6184
6185 @table @samp
6186 @item address
6187 Print the address of each node. Usually this is not meaningful as it
6188 changes according to the environment and source file. Its primary use
6189 is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
6190 @item asmname
6191 If @code{DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME} has been set for a given decl, use that
6192 in the dump instead of @code{DECL_NAME}. Its primary use is ease of
6193 use working backward from mangled names in the assembly file.
6194 @item slim
6195 When dumping front-end intermediate representations, inhibit dumping
6196 of members of a scope or body of a function merely because that scope
6197 has been reached. Only dump such items when they are directly reachable
6198 by some other path.
6199
6200 When dumping pretty-printed trees, this option inhibits dumping the
6201 bodies of control structures.
6202
6203 When dumping RTL, print the RTL in slim (condensed) form instead of
6204 the default LISP-like representation.
6205 @item raw
6206 Print a raw representation of the tree. By default, trees are
6207 pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
6208 @item details
6209 Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option). Also
6210 include information from the optimization passes.
6211 @item stats
6212 Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump
6213 option).
6214 @item blocks
6215 Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
6216 @item graph
6217 For each of the other indicated dump files (@option{-fdump-rtl-@var{pass}}),
6218 dump a representation of the control flow graph suitable for viewing with
6219 GraphViz to @file{@var{file}.@var{passid}.@var{pass}.dot}. Each function in
6220 the file is pretty-printed as a subgraph, so that GraphViz can render them
6221 all in a single plot.
6222
6223 This option currently only works for RTL dumps, and the RTL is always
6224 dumped in slim form.
6225 @item vops
6226 Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
6227 @item lineno
6228 Enable showing line numbers for statements.
6229 @item uid
6230 Enable showing the unique ID (@code{DECL_UID}) for each variable.
6231 @item verbose
6232 Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.
6233 @item eh
6234 Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.
6235 @item scev
6236 Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.
6237 @item optimized
6238 Enable showing optimization information (only available in certain
6239 passes).
6240 @item missed
6241 Enable showing missed optimization information (only available in certain
6242 passes).
6243 @item notes
6244 Enable other detailed optimization information (only available in
6245 certain passes).
6246 @item =@var{filename}
6247 Instead of an auto named dump file, output into the given file
6248 name. The file names @file{stdout} and @file{stderr} are treated
6249 specially and are considered already open standard streams. For
6250 example,
6251
6252 @smallexample
6253 gcc -O2 -ftree-vectorize -fdump-tree-vect-blocks=foo.dump
6254 -fdump-tree-pre=stderr file.c
6255 @end smallexample
6256
6257 outputs vectorizer dump into @file{foo.dump}, while the PRE dump is
6258 output on to @file{stderr}. If two conflicting dump filenames are
6259 given for the same pass, then the latter option overrides the earlier
6260 one.
6261
6262 @item all
6263 Turn on all options, except @option{raw}, @option{slim}, @option{verbose}
6264 and @option{lineno}.
6265
6266 @item optall
6267 Turn on all optimization options, i.e., @option{optimized},
6268 @option{missed}, and @option{note}.
6269 @end table
6270
6271 The following tree dumps are possible:
6272 @table @samp
6273
6274 @item original
6275 @opindex fdump-tree-original
6276 Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
6277
6278 @item optimized
6279 @opindex fdump-tree-optimized
6280 Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
6281
6282 @item gimple
6283 @opindex fdump-tree-gimple
6284 Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file. The
6285 file name is made by appending @file{.gimple} to the source file name.
6286
6287 @item cfg
6288 @opindex fdump-tree-cfg
6289 Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file. The file name is
6290 made by appending @file{.cfg} to the source file name.
6291
6292 @item ch
6293 @opindex fdump-tree-ch
6294 Dump each function after copying loop headers. The file name is made by
6295 appending @file{.ch} to the source file name.
6296
6297 @item ssa
6298 @opindex fdump-tree-ssa
6299 Dump SSA related information to a file. The file name is made by appending
6300 @file{.ssa} to the source file name.
6301
6302 @item alias
6303 @opindex fdump-tree-alias
6304 Dump aliasing information for each function. The file name is made by
6305 appending @file{.alias} to the source file name.
6306
6307 @item ccp
6308 @opindex fdump-tree-ccp
6309 Dump each function after CCP@. The file name is made by appending
6310 @file{.ccp} to the source file name.
6311
6312 @item storeccp
6313 @opindex fdump-tree-storeccp
6314 Dump each function after STORE-CCP@. The file name is made by appending
6315 @file{.storeccp} to the source file name.
6316
6317 @item pre
6318 @opindex fdump-tree-pre
6319 Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination. The file name is made
6320 by appending @file{.pre} to the source file name.
6321
6322 @item fre
6323 @opindex fdump-tree-fre
6324 Dump trees after full redundancy elimination. The file name is made
6325 by appending @file{.fre} to the source file name.
6326
6327 @item copyprop
6328 @opindex fdump-tree-copyprop
6329 Dump trees after copy propagation. The file name is made
6330 by appending @file{.copyprop} to the source file name.
6331
6332 @item store_copyprop
6333 @opindex fdump-tree-store_copyprop
6334 Dump trees after store copy-propagation. The file name is made
6335 by appending @file{.store_copyprop} to the source file name.
6336
6337 @item dce
6338 @opindex fdump-tree-dce
6339 Dump each function after dead code elimination. The file name is made by
6340 appending @file{.dce} to the source file name.
6341
6342 @item sra
6343 @opindex fdump-tree-sra
6344 Dump each function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates. The
6345 file name is made by appending @file{.sra} to the source file name.
6346
6347 @item sink
6348 @opindex fdump-tree-sink
6349 Dump each function after performing code sinking. The file name is made
6350 by appending @file{.sink} to the source file name.
6351
6352 @item dom
6353 @opindex fdump-tree-dom
6354 Dump each function after applying dominator tree optimizations. The file
6355 name is made by appending @file{.dom} to the source file name.
6356
6357 @item dse
6358 @opindex fdump-tree-dse
6359 Dump each function after applying dead store elimination. The file
6360 name is made by appending @file{.dse} to the source file name.
6361
6362 @item phiopt
6363 @opindex fdump-tree-phiopt
6364 Dump each function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code. The file
6365 name is made by appending @file{.phiopt} to the source file name.
6366
6367 @item forwprop
6368 @opindex fdump-tree-forwprop
6369 Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables. The file
6370 name is made by appending @file{.forwprop} to the source file name.
6371
6372 @item copyrename
6373 @opindex fdump-tree-copyrename
6374 Dump each function after applying the copy rename optimization. The file
6375 name is made by appending @file{.copyrename} to the source file name.
6376
6377 @item nrv
6378 @opindex fdump-tree-nrv
6379 Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on
6380 generic trees. The file name is made by appending @file{.nrv} to the source
6381 file name.
6382
6383 @item vect
6384 @opindex fdump-tree-vect
6385 Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops. The file name is
6386 made by appending @file{.vect} to the source file name.
6387
6388 @item slp
6389 @opindex fdump-tree-slp
6390 Dump each function after applying vectorization of basic blocks. The file name
6391 is made by appending @file{.slp} to the source file name.
6392
6393 @item vrp
6394 @opindex fdump-tree-vrp
6395 Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP). The file name
6396 is made by appending @file{.vrp} to the source file name.
6397
6398 @item all
6399 @opindex fdump-tree-all
6400 Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.
6401 @end table
6402
6403 @item -fopt-info
6404 @itemx -fopt-info-@var{options}
6405 @itemx -fopt-info-@var{options}=@var{filename}
6406 @opindex fopt-info
6407 Controls optimization dumps from various optimization passes. If the
6408 @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options} is a list of
6409 @samp{-} separated options to select the dump details and
6410 optimizations. If @var{options} is not specified, it defaults to
6411 @option{optimized} for details and @option{optall} for optimization
6412 groups. If the @var{filename} is not specified, it defaults to
6413 @file{stderr}. Note that the output @var{filename} will be overwritten
6414 in case of multiple translation units. If a combined output from
6415 multiple translation units is desired, @file{stderr} should be used
6416 instead.
6417
6418 The options can be divided into two groups, 1) options describing the
6419 verbosity of the dump, and 2) options describing which optimizations
6420 should be included. The options from both the groups can be freely
6421 mixed as they are non-overlapping. However, in case of any conflicts,
6422 the latter options override the earlier options on the command
6423 line. Though multiple -fopt-info options are accepted, only one of
6424 them can have @option{=filename}. If other filenames are provided then
6425 all but the first one are ignored.
6426
6427 The dump verbosity has the following options
6428
6429 @table @samp
6430 @item optimized
6431 Print information when an optimization is successfully applied. It is
6432 up to a pass to decide which information is relevant. For example, the
6433 vectorizer passes print the source location of loops which got
6434 successfully vectorized.
6435 @item missed
6436 Print information about missed optimizations. Individual passes
6437 control which information to include in the output. For example,
6438
6439 @smallexample
6440 gcc -O2 -ftree-vectorize -fopt-info-vec-missed
6441 @end smallexample
6442
6443 will print information about missed optimization opportunities from
6444 vectorization passes on stderr.
6445 @item note
6446 Print verbose information about optimizations, such as certain
6447 transformations, more detailed messages about decisions etc.
6448 @item all
6449 Print detailed optimization information. This includes
6450 @var{optimized}, @var{missed}, and @var{note}.
6451 @end table
6452
6453 The second set of options describes a group of optimizations and may
6454 include one or more of the following.
6455
6456 @table @samp
6457 @item ipa
6458 Enable dumps from all interprocedural optimizations.
6459 @item loop
6460 Enable dumps from all loop optimizations.
6461 @item inline
6462 Enable dumps from all inlining optimizations.
6463 @item vec
6464 Enable dumps from all vectorization optimizations.
6465 @item optall
6466 Enable dumps from all optimizations. This is a superset of
6467 the optimization groups listed above.
6468 @end table
6469
6470 For example,
6471 @smallexample
6472 gcc -O3 -fopt-info-missed=missed.all
6473 @end smallexample
6474
6475 outputs missed optimization report from all the passes into
6476 @file{missed.all}.
6477
6478 As another example,
6479 @smallexample
6480 gcc -O3 -fopt-info-inline-optimized-missed=inline.txt
6481 @end smallexample
6482
6483 will output information about missed optimizations as well as
6484 optimized locations from all the inlining passes into
6485 @file{inline.txt}.
6486
6487 If the @var{filename} is provided, then the dumps from all the
6488 applicable optimizations are concatenated into the @file{filename}.
6489 Otherwise the dump is output onto @file{stderr}. If @var{options} is
6490 omitted, it defaults to @option{all-optall}, which means dump all
6491 available optimization info from all the passes. In the following
6492 example, all optimization info is output on to @file{stderr}.
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 gcc -O3 -fopt-info
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 Note that @option{-fopt-info-vec-missed} behaves the same as
6499 @option{-fopt-info-missed-vec}.
6500
6501 As another example, consider
6502
6503 @smallexample
6504 gcc -fopt-info-vec-missed=vec.miss -fopt-info-loop-optimized=loop.opt
6505 @end smallexample
6506
6507 Here the two output filenames @file{vec.miss} and @file{loop.opt} are
6508 in conflict since only one output file is allowed. In this case, only
6509 the first option takes effect and the subsequent options are
6510 ignored. Thus only the @file{vec.miss} is produced which contains
6511 dumps from the vectorizer about missed opportunities.
6512
6513 @item -frandom-seed=@var{string}
6514 @opindex frandom-seed
6515 This option provides a seed that GCC uses in place of
6516 random numbers in generating certain symbol names
6517 that have to be different in every compiled file. It is also used to
6518 place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that
6519 produce them. You can use the @option{-frandom-seed} option to produce
6520 reproducibly identical object files.
6521
6522 The @var{string} should be different for every file you compile.
6523
6524 @item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
6525 @opindex fsched-verbose
6526 On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
6527 amount of debugging output the scheduler prints. This information is
6528 written to standard error, unless @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} or
6529 @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} is specified, in which case it is output
6530 to the usual dump listing file, @file{.sched1} or @file{.sched2}
6531 respectively. However for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is
6532 always printed to standard error.
6533
6534 For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
6535 same information as @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2}.
6536 For @var{n} greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities,
6537 detailed ready list information and unit/insn info. For @var{n} greater
6538 than two, it includes RTL at abort point, control-flow and regions info.
6539 And for @var{n} over four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes
6540 dependence info.
6541
6542 @item -save-temps
6543 @itemx -save-temps=cwd
6544 @opindex save-temps
6545 Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
6546 in the current directory and name them based on the source file. Thus,
6547 compiling @file{foo.c} with @option{-c -save-temps} produces files
6548 @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}. This creates a
6549 preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
6550 normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
6551
6552 When used in combination with the @option{-x} command-line option,
6553 @option{-save-temps} is sensible enough to avoid over writing an
6554 input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.
6555 The corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
6556 source file before using @option{-save-temps}.
6557
6558 If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source
6559 files that share a common base name in different subdirectories or the
6560 same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it is
6561 likely that the different parallel compilers will interfere with each
6562 other, and overwrite the temporary files. For instance:
6563
6564 @smallexample
6565 gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
6566 gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&
6567 @end smallexample
6568
6569 may result in @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.o} being written to
6570 simultaneously by both compilers.
6571
6572 @item -save-temps=obj
6573 @opindex save-temps=obj
6574 Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently. If the
6575 @option{-o} option is used, the temporary files are based on the
6576 object file. If the @option{-o} option is not used, the
6577 @option{-save-temps=obj} switch behaves like @option{-save-temps}.
6578
6579 For example:
6580
6581 @smallexample
6582 gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
6583 gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
6584 gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar
6585 @end smallexample
6586
6587 @noindent
6588 creates @file{foo.i}, @file{foo.s}, @file{dir/xbar.i},
6589 @file{dir/xbar.s}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.i}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.s}, and
6590 @file{dir2/yfoobar.o}.
6591
6592 @item -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
6593 @opindex time
6594 Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
6595 sequence. For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
6596 (plus the linker if linking is done).
6597
6598 Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:
6599
6600 @smallexample
6601 # cc1 0.12 0.01
6602 # as 0.00 0.01
6603 @end smallexample
6604
6605 The first number on each line is the ``user time'', that is time spent
6606 executing the program itself. The second number is ``system time'',
6607 time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
6608 Both numbers are in seconds.
6609
6610 With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the
6611 named file, and it looks like this:
6612
6613 @smallexample
6614 0.12 0.01 cc1 @var{options}
6615 0.00 0.01 as @var{options}
6616 @end smallexample
6617
6618 The ``user time'' and the ``system time'' are moved before the program
6619 name, and the options passed to the program are displayed, so that one
6620 can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which options.
6621
6622 @item -fvar-tracking
6623 @opindex fvar-tracking
6624 Run variable tracking pass. It computes where variables are stored at each
6625 position in code. Better debugging information is then generated
6626 (if the debugging information format supports this information).
6627
6628 It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (@option{-Os},
6629 @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}), debugging information (@option{-g}) and
6630 the debug info format supports it.
6631
6632 @item -fvar-tracking-assignments
6633 @opindex fvar-tracking-assignments
6634 @opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments
6635 Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and
6636 attempt to carry the annotations over throughout the compilation all the
6637 way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information while
6638 optimizing. Use of @option{-gdwarf-4} is recommended along with it.
6639
6640 It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case
6641 annotations are created and maintained, but discarded at the end.
6642
6643 @item -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6644 @opindex fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6645 @opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments-toggle
6646 Toggle @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, in the same way that
6647 @option{-gtoggle} toggles @option{-g}.
6648
6649 @item -print-file-name=@var{library}
6650 @opindex print-file-name
6651 Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
6652 would be used when linking---and don't do anything else. With this
6653 option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
6654 file name.
6655
6656 @item -print-multi-directory
6657 @opindex print-multi-directory
6658 Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
6659 other switches present in the command line. This directory is supposed
6660 to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
6661
6662 @item -print-multi-lib
6663 @opindex print-multi-lib
6664 Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
6665 that enable them. The directory name is separated from the switches by
6666 @samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
6667 @samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches. This is supposed to
6668 ease shell processing.
6669
6670 @item -print-multi-os-directory
6671 @opindex print-multi-os-directory
6672 Print the path to OS libraries for the selected
6673 multilib, relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory. If OS libraries are
6674 present in the @file{lib} subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is
6675 usually just @file{.}, if OS libraries are present in @file{lib@var{suffix}}
6676 sibling directories this prints e.g.@: @file{../lib64}, @file{../lib} or
6677 @file{../lib32}, or if OS libraries are present in @file{lib/@var{subdir}}
6678 subdirectories it prints e.g.@: @file{amd64}, @file{sparcv9} or @file{ev6}.
6679
6680 @item -print-multiarch
6681 @opindex print-multiarch
6682 Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch,
6683 relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.
6684
6685 @item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
6686 @opindex print-prog-name
6687 Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
6688
6689 @item -print-libgcc-file-name
6690 @opindex print-libgcc-file-name
6691 Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
6692
6693 This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6694 but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}. You can do:
6695
6696 @smallexample
6697 gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
6698 @end smallexample
6699
6700 @item -print-search-dirs
6701 @opindex print-search-dirs
6702 Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
6703 program and library directories @command{gcc} searches---and don't do anything else.
6704
6705 This is useful when @command{gcc} prints the error message
6706 @samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
6707 To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
6708 components where @command{gcc} expects to find them, or you can set the environment
6709 variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
6710 Don't forget the trailing @samp{/}.
6711 @xref{Environment Variables}.
6712
6713 @item -print-sysroot
6714 @opindex print-sysroot
6715 Print the target sysroot directory that is used during
6716 compilation. This is the target sysroot specified either at configure
6717 time or using the @option{--sysroot} option, possibly with an extra
6718 suffix that depends on compilation options. If no target sysroot is
6719 specified, the option prints nothing.
6720
6721 @item -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6722 @opindex print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6723 Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for
6724 headers, or give an error if the compiler is not configured with such
6725 a suffix---and don't do anything else.
6726
6727 @item -dumpmachine
6728 @opindex dumpmachine
6729 Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
6730 @samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
6731
6732 @item -dumpversion
6733 @opindex dumpversion
6734 Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
6735 anything else.
6736
6737 @item -dumpspecs
6738 @opindex dumpspecs
6739 Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else. (This
6740 is used when GCC itself is being built.) @xref{Spec Files}.
6741
6742 @item -fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types
6743 @opindex feliminate-unused-debug-types
6744 @opindex fno-eliminate-unused-debug-types
6745 Normally, when producing DWARF 2 output, GCC avoids producing debug symbol
6746 output for types that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.
6747 Sometimes it is useful to have GCC emit debugging
6748 information for all types declared in a compilation
6749 unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used
6750 in that compilation unit, for example
6751 if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is
6752 not actually used in your program (but is declared). More often,
6753 however, this results in a significant amount of wasted space.
6754 @end table
6755
6756 @node Optimize Options
6757 @section Options That Control Optimization
6758 @cindex optimize options
6759 @cindex options, optimization
6760
6761 These options control various sorts of optimizations.
6762
6763 Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
6764 cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
6765 results. Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
6766 breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
6767 variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
6768 function and get exactly the results you expect from the source
6769 code.
6770
6771 Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
6772 the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
6773 and possibly the ability to debug the program.
6774
6775 The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of the
6776 program. Compiling multiple files at once to a single output file mode allows
6777 the compiler to use information gained from all of the files when compiling
6778 each of them.
6779
6780 Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag. Only
6781 optimizations that have a flag are listed in this section.
6782
6783 Most optimizations are only enabled if an @option{-O} level is set on
6784 the command line. Otherwise they are disabled, even if individual
6785 optimization flags are specified.
6786
6787 Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different
6788 set of optimizations may be enabled at each @option{-O} level than
6789 those listed here. You can invoke GCC with @option{-Q --help=optimizers}
6790 to find out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.
6791 @xref{Overall Options}, for examples.
6792
6793 @table @gcctabopt
6794 @item -O
6795 @itemx -O1
6796 @opindex O
6797 @opindex O1
6798 Optimize. Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
6799 more memory for a large function.
6800
6801 With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
6802 time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
6803 compilation time.
6804
6805 @option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
6806 @gccoptlist{
6807 -fauto-inc-dec @gol
6808 -fcompare-elim @gol
6809 -fcprop-registers @gol
6810 -fdce @gol
6811 -fdefer-pop @gol
6812 -fdelayed-branch @gol
6813 -fdse @gol
6814 -fguess-branch-probability @gol
6815 -fif-conversion2 @gol
6816 -fif-conversion @gol
6817 -fipa-pure-const @gol
6818 -fipa-profile @gol
6819 -fipa-reference @gol
6820 -fmerge-constants
6821 -fsplit-wide-types @gol
6822 -ftree-bit-ccp @gol
6823 -ftree-builtin-call-dce @gol
6824 -ftree-ccp @gol
6825 -ftree-ch @gol
6826 -ftree-copyrename @gol
6827 -ftree-dce @gol
6828 -ftree-dominator-opts @gol
6829 -ftree-dse @gol
6830 -ftree-forwprop @gol
6831 -ftree-fre @gol
6832 -ftree-phiprop @gol
6833 -ftree-slsr @gol
6834 -ftree-sra @gol
6835 -ftree-pta @gol
6836 -ftree-ter @gol
6837 -funit-at-a-time}
6838
6839 @option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
6840 where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
6841
6842 @item -O2
6843 @opindex O2
6844 Optimize even more. GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
6845 that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff.
6846 As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
6847 and the performance of the generated code.
6848
6849 @option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}. It
6850 also turns on the following optimization flags:
6851 @gccoptlist{-fthread-jumps @gol
6852 -falign-functions -falign-jumps @gol
6853 -falign-loops -falign-labels @gol
6854 -fcaller-saves @gol
6855 -fcrossjumping @gol
6856 -fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks @gol
6857 -fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
6858 -fdevirtualize -fdevirtualize-speculatively @gol
6859 -fexpensive-optimizations @gol
6860 -fgcse -fgcse-lm @gol
6861 -fhoist-adjacent-loads @gol
6862 -finline-small-functions @gol
6863 -findirect-inlining @gol
6864 -fipa-sra @gol
6865 -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference @gol
6866 -foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
6867 -fpartial-inlining @gol
6868 -fpeephole2 @gol
6869 -freorder-blocks -freorder-functions @gol
6870 -frerun-cse-after-loop @gol
6871 -fsched-interblock -fsched-spec @gol
6872 -fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 @gol
6873 -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
6874 -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
6875 -ftree-pre @gol
6876 -ftree-vrp}
6877
6878 Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
6879 invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
6880
6881 @item -O3
6882 @opindex O3
6883 Optimize yet more. @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified
6884 by @option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions},
6885 @option{-funswitch-loops}, @option{-fpredictive-commoning},
6886 @option{-fgcse-after-reload}, @option{-ftree-loop-vectorize},
6887 @option{-ftree-slp-vectorize}, @option{-fvect-cost-model},
6888 @option{-ftree-partial-pre} and @option{-fipa-cp-clone} options.
6889
6890 @item -O0
6891 @opindex O0
6892 Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected
6893 results. This is the default.
6894
6895 @item -Os
6896 @opindex Os
6897 Optimize for size. @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
6898 do not typically increase code size. It also performs further
6899 optimizations designed to reduce code size.
6900
6901 @option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
6902 @gccoptlist{-falign-functions -falign-jumps -falign-loops @gol
6903 -falign-labels -freorder-blocks -freorder-blocks-and-partition @gol
6904 -fprefetch-loop-arrays}
6905
6906 @item -Ofast
6907 @opindex Ofast
6908 Disregard strict standards compliance. @option{-Ofast} enables all
6909 @option{-O3} optimizations. It also enables optimizations that are not
6910 valid for all standard-compliant programs.
6911 It turns on @option{-ffast-math} and the Fortran-specific
6912 @option{-fno-protect-parens} and @option{-fstack-arrays}.
6913
6914 @item -Og
6915 @opindex Og
6916 Optimize debugging experience. @option{-Og} enables optimizations
6917 that do not interfere with debugging. It should be the optimization
6918 level of choice for the standard edit-compile-debug cycle, offering
6919 a reasonable level of optimization while maintaining fast compilation
6920 and a good debugging experience.
6921
6922 If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
6923 the last such option is the one that is effective.
6924 @end table
6925
6926 Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
6927 flags. Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
6928 form of @option{-ffoo} is @option{-fno-foo}. In the table
6929 below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically
6930 use. You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
6931 or adding it.
6932
6933 The following options control specific optimizations. They are either
6934 activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are. You
6935 can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
6936 optimizations to be performed is desired.
6937
6938 @table @gcctabopt
6939 @item -fno-defer-pop
6940 @opindex fno-defer-pop
6941 Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
6942 returns. For machines that must pop arguments after a function call,
6943 the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
6944 function calls and pops them all at once.
6945
6946 Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6947
6948 @item -fforward-propagate
6949 @opindex fforward-propagate
6950 Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL@. The pass tries to combine two
6951 instructions and checks if the result can be simplified. If loop unrolling
6952 is active, two passes are performed and the second is scheduled after
6953 loop unrolling.
6954
6955 This option is enabled by default at optimization levels @option{-O},
6956 @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6957
6958 @item -ffp-contract=@var{style}
6959 @opindex ffp-contract
6960 @option{-ffp-contract=off} disables floating-point expression contraction.
6961 @option{-ffp-contract=fast} enables floating-point expression contraction
6962 such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target has
6963 native support for them.
6964 @option{-ffp-contract=on} enables floating-point expression contraction
6965 if allowed by the language standard. This is currently not implemented
6966 and treated equal to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
6967
6968 The default is @option{-ffp-contract=fast}.
6969
6970 @item -fomit-frame-pointer
6971 @opindex fomit-frame-pointer
6972 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
6973 don't need one. This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
6974 restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
6975 in many functions. @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
6976 some machines.}
6977
6978 On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
6979 the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
6980 and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist. The
6981 machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
6982 whether a target machine supports this flag. @xref{Registers,,Register
6983 Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
6984
6985 Starting with GCC version 4.6, the default setting (when not optimizing for
6986 size) for 32-bit GNU/Linux x86 and 32-bit Darwin x86 targets has been changed to
6987 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}. The default can be reverted to
6988 @option{-fno-omit-frame-pointer} by configuring GCC with the
6989 @option{--enable-frame-pointer} configure option.
6990
6991 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6992
6993 @item -foptimize-sibling-calls
6994 @opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
6995 Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
6996
6997 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6998
6999 @item -fno-inline
7000 @opindex fno-inline
7001 Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with
7002 the @code{always_inline} attribute. This is the default when not
7003 optimizing.
7004
7005 Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them
7006 with the @code{noinline} attribute.
7007
7008 @item -finline-small-functions
7009 @opindex finline-small-functions
7010 Integrate functions into their callers when their body is smaller than expected
7011 function call code (so overall size of program gets smaller). The compiler
7012 heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth integrating
7013 in this way. This inlining applies to all functions, even those not declared
7014 inline.
7015
7016 Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
7017
7018 @item -findirect-inlining
7019 @opindex findirect-inlining
7020 Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to be known at compile
7021 time thanks to previous inlining. This option has any effect only
7022 when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
7023 or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
7024
7025 Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
7026
7027 @item -finline-functions
7028 @opindex finline-functions
7029 Consider all functions for inlining, even if they are not declared inline.
7030 The compiler heuristically decides which functions are worth integrating
7031 in this way.
7032
7033 If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
7034 declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
7035 assembler code in its own right.
7036
7037 Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
7038
7039 @item -finline-functions-called-once
7040 @opindex finline-functions-called-once
7041 Consider all @code{static} functions called once for inlining into their
7042 caller even if they are not marked @code{inline}. If a call to a given
7043 function is integrated, then the function is not output as assembler code
7044 in its own right.
7045
7046 Enabled at levels @option{-O1}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
7047
7048 @item -fearly-inlining
7049 @opindex fearly-inlining
7050 Inline functions marked by @code{always_inline} and functions whose body seems
7051 smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
7052 @option{-fprofile-generate} instrumentation and real inlining pass. Doing so
7053 makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs
7054 having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
7055
7056 Enabled by default.
7057
7058 @item -fipa-sra
7059 @opindex fipa-sra
7060 Perform interprocedural scalar replacement of aggregates, removal of
7061 unused parameters and replacement of parameters passed by reference
7062 by parameters passed by value.
7063
7064 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
7065
7066 @item -finline-limit=@var{n}
7067 @opindex finline-limit
7068 By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined. This flag
7069 allows coarse control of this limit. @var{n} is the size of functions that
7070 can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.
7071
7072 Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may be
7073 specified individually by using @option{--param @var{name}=@var{value}}.
7074 The @option{-finline-limit=@var{n}} option sets some of these parameters
7075 as follows:
7076
7077 @table @gcctabopt
7078 @item max-inline-insns-single
7079 is set to @var{n}/2.
7080 @item max-inline-insns-auto
7081 is set to @var{n}/2.
7082 @end table
7083
7084 See below for a documentation of the individual
7085 parameters controlling inlining and for the defaults of these parameters.
7086
7087 @emph{Note:} there may be no value to @option{-finline-limit} that results
7088 in default behavior.
7089
7090 @emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
7091 abstract measurement of function's size. In no way does it represent a count
7092 of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
7093 release to an another.
7094
7095 @item -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
7096 @opindex -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
7097 This is a more fine-grained version of @option{-fkeep-inline-functions},
7098 which applies only to functions that are declared using the @code{dllexport}
7099 attribute or declspec (@xref{Function Attributes,,Declaring Attributes of
7100 Functions}.)
7101
7102 @item -fkeep-inline-functions
7103 @opindex fkeep-inline-functions
7104 In C, emit @code{static} functions that are declared @code{inline}
7105 into the object file, even if the function has been inlined into all
7106 of its callers. This switch does not affect functions using the
7107 @code{extern inline} extension in GNU C90@. In C++, emit any and all
7108 inline functions into the object file.
7109
7110 @item -fkeep-static-consts
7111 @opindex fkeep-static-consts
7112 Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
7113 on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
7114
7115 GCC enables this option by default. If you want to force the compiler to
7116 check if a variable is referenced, regardless of whether or not
7117 optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
7118
7119 @item -fmerge-constants
7120 @opindex fmerge-constants
7121 Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating-point
7122 constants) across compilation units.
7123
7124 This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
7125 linker support it. Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
7126 behavior.
7127
7128 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7129
7130 @item -fmerge-all-constants
7131 @opindex fmerge-all-constants
7132 Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
7133
7134 This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}. In addition to
7135 @option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g.@: even constant initialized
7136 arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-point
7137 types. Languages like C or C++ require each variable, including multiple
7138 instances of the same variable in recursive calls, to have distinct locations,
7139 so using this option results in non-conforming
7140 behavior.
7141
7142 @item -fmodulo-sched
7143 @opindex fmodulo-sched
7144 Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling
7145 pass. This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders their
7146 instructions by overlapping different iterations.
7147
7148 @item -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
7149 @opindex fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
7150 Perform more aggressive SMS-based modulo scheduling with register moves
7151 allowed. By setting this flag certain anti-dependences edges are
7152 deleted, which triggers the generation of reg-moves based on the
7153 life-range analysis. This option is effective only with
7154 @option{-fmodulo-sched} enabled.
7155
7156 @item -fno-branch-count-reg
7157 @opindex fno-branch-count-reg
7158 Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
7159 but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
7160 register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
7161 This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
7162 instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
7163
7164 The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}.
7165
7166 @item -fno-function-cse
7167 @opindex fno-function-cse
7168 Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
7169 calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
7170
7171 This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
7172 that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
7173 performed when this option is not used.
7174
7175 The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
7176
7177 @item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
7178 @opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
7179 If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
7180 are initialized to zero into BSS@. This can save space in the resulting
7181 code.
7182
7183 This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
7184 rely on variables going to the data section---e.g., so that the
7185 resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
7186 assumptions based on that.
7187
7188 The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
7189
7190 @item -fthread-jumps
7191 @opindex fthread-jumps
7192 Perform optimizations that check to see if a jump branches to a
7193 location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found. If
7194 so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
7195 second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
7196 the condition is known to be true or false.
7197
7198 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7199
7200 @item -fsplit-wide-types
7201 @opindex fsplit-wide-types
7202 When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as @code{long
7203 long} on a 32-bit system, split the registers apart and allocate them
7204 independently. This normally generates better code for those types,
7205 but may make debugging more difficult.
7206
7207 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3},
7208 @option{-Os}.
7209
7210 @item -fcse-follow-jumps
7211 @opindex fcse-follow-jumps
7212 In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions
7213 when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path. For
7214 example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
7215 @code{else} clause, CSE follows the jump when the condition
7216 tested is false.
7217
7218 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7219
7220 @item -fcse-skip-blocks
7221 @opindex fcse-skip-blocks
7222 This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
7223 follow jumps that conditionally skip over blocks. When CSE
7224 encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
7225 @option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
7226 body of the @code{if}.
7227
7228 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7229
7230 @item -frerun-cse-after-loop
7231 @opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
7232 Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations are
7233 performed.
7234
7235 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7236
7237 @item -fgcse
7238 @opindex fgcse
7239 Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
7240 This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
7241
7242 @emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
7243 extension, you may get better run-time performance if you disable
7244 the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
7245 @option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
7246
7247 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7248
7249 @item -fgcse-lm
7250 @opindex fgcse-lm
7251 When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination
7252 attempts to move loads that are only killed by stores into themselves. This
7253 allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
7254 the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
7255
7256 Enabled by default when @option{-fgcse} is enabled.
7257
7258 @item -fgcse-sm
7259 @opindex fgcse-sm
7260 When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, a store motion pass is run after
7261 global common subexpression elimination. This pass attempts to move
7262 stores out of loops. When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm},
7263 loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before
7264 the loop and a store after the loop.
7265
7266 Not enabled at any optimization level.
7267
7268 @item -fgcse-las
7269 @opindex fgcse-las
7270 When @option{-fgcse-las} is enabled, the global common subexpression
7271 elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores to the
7272 same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
7273
7274 Not enabled at any optimization level.
7275
7276 @item -fgcse-after-reload
7277 @opindex fgcse-after-reload
7278 When @option{-fgcse-after-reload} is enabled, a redundant load elimination
7279 pass is performed after reload. The purpose of this pass is to clean up
7280 redundant spilling.
7281
7282 @item -faggressive-loop-optimizations
7283 @opindex faggressive-loop-optimizations
7284 This option tells the loop optimizer to use language constraints to
7285 derive bounds for the number of iterations of a loop. This assumes that
7286 loop code does not invoke undefined behavior by for example causing signed
7287 integer overflows or out-of-bound array accesses. The bounds for the
7288 number of iterations of a loop are used to guide loop unrolling and peeling
7289 and loop exit test optimizations.
7290 This option is enabled by default.
7291
7292 @item -funsafe-loop-optimizations
7293 @opindex funsafe-loop-optimizations
7294 This option tells the loop optimizer to assume that loop indices do not
7295 overflow, and that loops with nontrivial exit condition are not
7296 infinite. This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
7297 the loop optimizer itself cannot prove that these assumptions are valid.
7298 If you use @option{-Wunsafe-loop-optimizations}, the compiler warns you
7299 if it finds this kind of loop.
7300
7301 @item -fcrossjumping
7302 @opindex fcrossjumping
7303 Perform cross-jumping transformation.
7304 This transformation unifies equivalent code and saves code size. The
7305 resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
7306
7307 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7308
7309 @item -fauto-inc-dec
7310 @opindex fauto-inc-dec
7311 Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.
7312 This pass is always skipped on architectures that do not have
7313 instructions to support this. Enabled by default at @option{-O} and
7314 higher on architectures that support this.
7315
7316 @item -fdce
7317 @opindex fdce
7318 Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL@.
7319 Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7320
7321 @item -fdse
7322 @opindex fdse
7323 Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL@.
7324 Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7325
7326 @item -fif-conversion
7327 @opindex fif-conversion
7328 Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents. This
7329 includes use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
7330 some tricks doable by standard arithmetics. The use of conditional execution
7331 on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
7332
7333 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7334
7335 @item -fif-conversion2
7336 @opindex fif-conversion2
7337 Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
7338 branch-less equivalents.
7339
7340 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7341
7342 @item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
7343 @opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
7344 Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers, and that
7345 no code or data element resides there. This enables simple constant
7346 folding optimizations at all optimization levels. In addition, other
7347 optimization passes in GCC use this flag to control global dataflow
7348 analyses that eliminate useless checks for null pointers; these assume
7349 that if a pointer is checked after it has already been dereferenced,
7350 it cannot be null.
7351
7352 Note however that in some environments this assumption is not true.
7353 Use @option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
7354 for programs that depend on that behavior.
7355
7356 Some targets, especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.
7357 Otherwise it is enabled at all levels: @option{-O0}, @option{-O1},
7358 @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}. Passes that use the information
7359 are enabled independently at different optimization levels.
7360
7361 @item -fdevirtualize
7362 @opindex fdevirtualize
7363 Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls. This
7364 is done both within a procedure and interprocedurally as part of
7365 indirect inlining (@code{-findirect-inlining}) and interprocedural constant
7366 propagation (@option{-fipa-cp}).
7367 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7368
7369 @item -fdevirtualize-speculatively
7370 @opindex fdevirtualize-speculatively
7371 Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to speculative direct calls.
7372 Based on the analysis of the type inheritance graph, determine for a given call
7373 the set of likely targets. If the set is small, preferably of size 1, change
7374 the call into an conditional deciding on direct and indirect call. The
7375 speculative calls enable more optimizations, such as inlining. When they seem
7376 useless after further optimization, they are converted back into original form.
7377
7378 @item -fexpensive-optimizations
7379 @opindex fexpensive-optimizations
7380 Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
7381
7382 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7383
7384 @item -free
7385 @opindex free
7386 Attempt to remove redundant extension instructions. This is especially
7387 helpful for the x86-64 architecture, which implicitly zero-extends in 64-bit
7388 registers after writing to their lower 32-bit half.
7389
7390 Enabled for x86 at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7391
7392 @item -flive-range-shrinkage
7393 @opindex flive-range-shrinkage
7394 Attempt to decrease register pressure through register live range
7395 shrinkage. This is helpful for fast processors with small or moderate
7396 size register sets.
7397
7398 @item -fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm}
7399 Use the specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register
7400 allocator. The @var{algorithm} argument can be @samp{priority}, which
7401 specifies Chow's priority coloring, or @samp{CB}, which specifies
7402 Chaitin-Briggs coloring. Chaitin-Briggs coloring is not implemented
7403 for all architectures, but for those targets that do support it, it is
7404 the default because it generates better code.
7405
7406 @item -fira-region=@var{region}
7407 Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator. The
7408 @var{region} argument should be one of the following:
7409
7410 @table @samp
7411
7412 @item all
7413 Use all loops as register allocation regions.
7414 This can give the best results for machines with a small and/or
7415 irregular register set.
7416
7417 @item mixed
7418 Use all loops except for loops with small register pressure
7419 as the regions. This value usually gives
7420 the best results in most cases and for most architectures,
7421 and is enabled by default when compiling with optimization for speed
7422 (@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}).
7423
7424 @item one
7425 Use all functions as a single region.
7426 This typically results in the smallest code size, and is enabled by default for
7427 @option{-Os} or @option{-O0}.
7428
7429 @end table
7430
7431 @item -fira-hoist-pressure
7432 @opindex fira-hoist-pressure
7433 Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in the code hoisting pass for
7434 decisions to hoist expressions. This option usually results in smaller
7435 code, but it can slow the compiler down.
7436
7437 This option is enabled at level @option{-Os} for all targets.
7438
7439 @item -fira-loop-pressure
7440 @opindex fira-loop-pressure
7441 Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to move
7442 loop invariants. This option usually results in generation
7443 of faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>= 32
7444 registers), but it can slow the compiler down.
7445
7446 This option is enabled at level @option{-O3} for some targets.
7447
7448 @item -fno-ira-share-save-slots
7449 @opindex fno-ira-share-save-slots
7450 Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard
7451 registers living through a call. Each hard register gets a
7452 separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
7453 larger.
7454
7455 @item -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
7456 @opindex fno-ira-share-spill-slots
7457 Disable sharing of stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers. Each
7458 pseudo-register that does not get a hard register gets a separate
7459 stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.
7460
7461 @item -fira-verbose=@var{n}
7462 @opindex fira-verbose
7463 Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register allocator.
7464 The default value is 5. If the value @var{n} is greater or equal to 10,
7465 the dump output is sent to stderr using the same format as @var{n} minus 10.
7466
7467 @item -fdelayed-branch
7468 @opindex fdelayed-branch
7469 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
7470 to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
7471 instructions.
7472
7473 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7474
7475 @item -fschedule-insns
7476 @opindex fschedule-insns
7477 If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
7478 eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable. This
7479 helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
7480 by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
7481 or floating-point instruction is required.
7482
7483 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7484
7485 @item -fschedule-insns2
7486 @opindex fschedule-insns2
7487 Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
7488 instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done. This is
7489 especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
7490 registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
7491
7492 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7493
7494 @item -fno-sched-interblock
7495 @opindex fno-sched-interblock
7496 Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks. This is normally
7497 enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
7498 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7499
7500 @item -fno-sched-spec
7501 @opindex fno-sched-spec
7502 Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions. This is normally
7503 enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
7504 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7505
7506 @item -fsched-pressure
7507 @opindex fsched-pressure
7508 Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before register
7509 allocation. This only makes sense when scheduling before register
7510 allocation is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at
7511 @option{-O2} or higher. Usage of this option can improve the
7512 generated code and decrease its size by preventing register pressure
7513 increase above the number of available hard registers and subsequent
7514 spills in register allocation.
7515
7516 @item -fsched-spec-load
7517 @opindex fsched-spec-load
7518 Allow speculative motion of some load instructions. This only makes
7519 sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
7520 @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7521
7522 @item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
7523 @opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
7524 Allow speculative motion of more load instructions. This only makes
7525 sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
7526 @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7527
7528 @item -fsched-stalled-insns
7529 @itemx -fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n}
7530 @opindex fsched-stalled-insns
7531 Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue
7532 of stalled insns into the ready list during the second scheduling pass.
7533 @option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns} means that no insns are moved
7534 prematurely, @option{-fsched-stalled-insns=0} means there is no limit
7535 on how many queued insns can be moved prematurely.
7536 @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} without a value is equivalent to
7537 @option{-fsched-stalled-insns=1}.
7538
7539 @item -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
7540 @itemx -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n}
7541 @opindex fsched-stalled-insns-dep
7542 Define how many insn groups (cycles) are examined for a dependency
7543 on a stalled insn that is a candidate for premature removal from the queue
7544 of stalled insns. This has an effect only during the second scheduling pass,
7545 and only if @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} is used.
7546 @option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep} is equivalent to
7547 @option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0}.
7548 @option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep} without a value is equivalent to
7549 @option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1}.
7550
7551 @item -fsched2-use-superblocks
7552 @opindex fsched2-use-superblocks
7553 When scheduling after register allocation, use superblock scheduling.
7554 This allows motion across basic block boundaries,
7555 resulting in faster schedules. This option is experimental, as not all machine
7556 descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable
7557 results from the algorithm.
7558
7559 This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
7560 @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7561
7562 @item -fsched-group-heuristic
7563 @opindex fsched-group-heuristic
7564 Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic favors
7565 the instruction that belongs to a schedule group. This is enabled
7566 by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
7567 or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7568
7569 @item -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
7570 @opindex fsched-critical-path-heuristic
7571 Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic favors
7572 instructions on the critical path. This is enabled by default when
7573 scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
7574 or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7575
7576 @item -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
7577 @opindex fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
7578 Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler. This
7579 heuristic favors speculative instructions with greater dependency weakness.
7580 This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
7581 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2}
7582 or at @option{-O2} or higher.
7583
7584 @item -fsched-rank-heuristic
7585 @opindex fsched-rank-heuristic
7586 Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic favors
7587 the instruction belonging to a basic block with greater size or frequency.
7588 This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
7589 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
7590 at @option{-O2} or higher.
7591
7592 @item -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
7593 @opindex fsched-last-insn-heuristic
7594 Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic
7595 favors the instruction that is less dependent on the last instruction
7596 scheduled. This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
7597 i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
7598 at @option{-O2} or higher.
7599
7600 @item -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
7601 @opindex fsched-dep-count-heuristic
7602 Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler. This heuristic
7603 favors the instruction that has more instructions depending on it.
7604 This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
7605 with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
7606 at @option{-O2} or higher.
7607
7608 @item -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
7609 @opindex freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
7610 Modulo scheduling is performed before traditional scheduling. If a loop
7611 is modulo scheduled, later scheduling passes may change its schedule.
7612 Use this option to control that behavior.
7613
7614 @item -fselective-scheduling
7615 @opindex fselective-scheduling
7616 Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm. Selective
7617 scheduling runs instead of the first scheduler pass.
7618
7619 @item -fselective-scheduling2
7620 @opindex fselective-scheduling2
7621 Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm. Selective
7622 scheduling runs instead of the second scheduler pass.
7623
7624 @item -fsel-sched-pipelining
7625 @opindex fsel-sched-pipelining
7626 Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.
7627 This option has no effect unless one of @option{-fselective-scheduling} or
7628 @option{-fselective-scheduling2} is turned on.
7629
7630 @item -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
7631 @opindex fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
7632 When pipelining loops during selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.
7633 This option has no effect unless @option{-fsel-sched-pipelining} is turned on.
7634
7635 @item -fshrink-wrap
7636 @opindex fshrink-wrap
7637 Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need it,
7638 rather than at the top of the function. This flag is enabled by default at
7639 @option{-O} and higher.
7640
7641 @item -fcaller-saves
7642 @opindex fcaller-saves
7643 Enable allocation of values to registers that are clobbered by
7644 function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
7645 registers around such calls. Such allocation is done only when it
7646 seems to result in better code.
7647
7648 This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
7649 those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
7650
7651 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7652
7653 @item -fcombine-stack-adjustments
7654 @opindex fcombine-stack-adjustments
7655 Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references
7656 and then tries to find ways to combine them.
7657
7658 Enabled by default at @option{-O1} and higher.
7659
7660 @item -fconserve-stack
7661 @opindex fconserve-stack
7662 Attempt to minimize stack usage. The compiler attempts to use less
7663 stack space, even if that makes the program slower. This option
7664 implies setting the @option{large-stack-frame} parameter to 100
7665 and the @option{large-stack-frame-growth} parameter to 400.
7666
7667 @item -ftree-reassoc
7668 @opindex ftree-reassoc
7669 Perform reassociation on trees. This flag is enabled by default
7670 at @option{-O} and higher.
7671
7672 @item -ftree-pre
7673 @opindex ftree-pre
7674 Perform partial redundancy elimination (PRE) on trees. This flag is
7675 enabled by default at @option{-O2} and @option{-O3}.
7676
7677 @item -ftree-partial-pre
7678 @opindex ftree-partial-pre
7679 Make partial redundancy elimination (PRE) more aggressive. This flag is
7680 enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7681
7682 @item -ftree-forwprop
7683 @opindex ftree-forwprop
7684 Perform forward propagation on trees. This flag is enabled by default
7685 at @option{-O} and higher.
7686
7687 @item -ftree-fre
7688 @opindex ftree-fre
7689 Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees. The difference
7690 between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions
7691 that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.
7692 This analysis is faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
7693 This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7694
7695 @item -ftree-phiprop
7696 @opindex ftree-phiprop
7697 Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees. This
7698 pass is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7699
7700 @item -fhoist-adjacent-loads
7701 @opindex hoist-adjacent-loads
7702 Speculatively hoist loads from both branches of an if-then-else if the
7703 loads are from adjacent locations in the same structure and the target
7704 architecture has a conditional move instruction. This flag is enabled
7705 by default at @option{-O2} and higher.
7706
7707 @item -ftree-copy-prop
7708 @opindex ftree-copy-prop
7709 Perform copy propagation on trees. This pass eliminates unnecessary
7710 copy operations. This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
7711 higher.
7712
7713 @item -fipa-pure-const
7714 @opindex fipa-pure-const
7715 Discover which functions are pure or constant.
7716 Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7717
7718 @item -fipa-reference
7719 @opindex fipa-reference
7720 Discover which static variables do not escape the
7721 compilation unit.
7722 Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7723
7724 @item -fipa-pta
7725 @opindex fipa-pta
7726 Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural modification
7727 and reference analysis. This option can cause excessive memory and
7728 compile-time usage on large compilation units. It is not enabled by
7729 default at any optimization level.
7730
7731 @item -fipa-profile
7732 @opindex fipa-profile
7733 Perform interprocedural profile propagation. The functions called only from
7734 cold functions are marked as cold. Also functions executed once (such as
7735 @code{cold}, @code{noreturn}, static constructors or destructors) are identified. Cold
7736 functions and loop less parts of functions executed once are then optimized for
7737 size.
7738 Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7739
7740 @item -fipa-cp
7741 @opindex fipa-cp
7742 Perform interprocedural constant propagation.
7743 This optimization analyzes the program to determine when values passed
7744 to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.
7745 This optimization can substantially increase performance
7746 if the application has constants passed to functions.
7747 This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O2}, @option{-Os} and @option{-O3}.
7748
7749 @item -fipa-cp-clone
7750 @opindex fipa-cp-clone
7751 Perform function cloning to make interprocedural constant propagation stronger.
7752 When enabled, interprocedural constant propagation performs function cloning
7753 when externally visible function can be called with constant arguments.
7754 Because this optimization can create multiple copies of functions,
7755 it may significantly increase code size
7756 (see @option{--param ipcp-unit-growth=@var{value}}).
7757 This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7758
7759 @item -fisolate-erroneous-paths-dereference
7760 Detect paths which trigger erroneous or undefined behaviour due to
7761 dereferencing a NULL pointer. Isolate those paths from the main control
7762 flow and turn the statement with erroneous or undefined behaviour into a trap.
7763
7764 @item -fisolate-erroneous-paths-attribute
7765 Detect paths which trigger erroneous or undefined behaviour due a NULL value
7766 being used in a way which is forbidden by a @code{returns_nonnull} or @code{nonnull}
7767 attribute. Isolate those paths from the main control flow and turn the
7768 statement with erroneous or undefined behaviour into a trap. This is not
7769 currently enabled, but may be enabled by @code{-O2} in the future.
7770
7771 @item -ftree-sink
7772 @opindex ftree-sink
7773 Perform forward store motion on trees. This flag is
7774 enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7775
7776 @item -ftree-bit-ccp
7777 @opindex ftree-bit-ccp
7778 Perform sparse conditional bit constant propagation on trees and propagate
7779 pointer alignment information.
7780 This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7781 at @option{-O} and higher. It requires that @option{-ftree-ccp} is enabled.
7782
7783 @item -ftree-ccp
7784 @opindex ftree-ccp
7785 Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees. This
7786 pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7787 at @option{-O} and higher.
7788
7789 @item -ftree-switch-conversion
7790 Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to
7791 initializations from a scalar array. This flag is enabled by default
7792 at @option{-O2} and higher.
7793
7794 @item -ftree-tail-merge
7795 Look for identical code sequences. When found, replace one with a jump to the
7796 other. This optimization is known as tail merging or cross jumping. This flag
7797 is enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher. The compilation time
7798 in this pass can
7799 be limited using @option{max-tail-merge-comparisons} parameter and
7800 @option{max-tail-merge-iterations} parameter.
7801
7802 @item -ftree-dce
7803 @opindex ftree-dce
7804 Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees. This flag is enabled by
7805 default at @option{-O} and higher.
7806
7807 @item -ftree-builtin-call-dce
7808 @opindex ftree-builtin-call-dce
7809 Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to built-in functions
7810 that may set @code{errno} but are otherwise side-effect free. This flag is
7811 enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher if @option{-Os} is not also
7812 specified.
7813
7814 @item -ftree-dominator-opts
7815 @opindex ftree-dominator-opts
7816 Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
7817 propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and expression
7818 simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal. This also
7819 performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is
7820 enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7821
7822 @item -ftree-dse
7823 @opindex ftree-dse
7824 Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees. A dead store is a store into
7825 a memory location that is later overwritten by another store without
7826 any intervening loads. In this case the earlier store can be deleted. This
7827 flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7828
7829 @item -ftree-ch
7830 @opindex ftree-ch
7831 Perform loop header copying on trees. This is beneficial since it increases
7832 effectiveness of code motion optimizations. It also saves one jump. This flag
7833 is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher. It is not enabled
7834 for @option{-Os}, since it usually increases code size.
7835
7836 @item -ftree-loop-optimize
7837 @opindex ftree-loop-optimize
7838 Perform loop optimizations on trees. This flag is enabled by default
7839 at @option{-O} and higher.
7840
7841 @item -ftree-loop-linear
7842 @opindex ftree-loop-linear
7843 Perform loop interchange transformations on tree. Same as
7844 @option{-floop-interchange}. To use this code transformation, GCC has
7845 to be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7846 enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7847
7848 @item -floop-interchange
7849 @opindex floop-interchange
7850 Perform loop interchange transformations on loops. Interchanging two
7851 nested loops switches the inner and outer loops. For example, given a
7852 loop like:
7853 @smallexample
7854 DO J = 1, M
7855 DO I = 1, N
7856 A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7857 ENDDO
7858 ENDDO
7859 @end smallexample
7860 loop interchange transforms the loop as if it were written:
7861 @smallexample
7862 DO I = 1, N
7863 DO J = 1, M
7864 A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7865 ENDDO
7866 ENDDO
7867 @end smallexample
7868 which can be beneficial when @code{N} is larger than the caches,
7869 because in Fortran, the elements of an array are stored in memory
7870 contiguously by column, and the original loop iterates over rows,
7871 potentially creating at each access a cache miss. This optimization
7872 applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited to
7873 Fortran. To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7874 with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7875 Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7876
7877 @item -floop-strip-mine
7878 @opindex floop-strip-mine
7879 Perform loop strip mining transformations on loops. Strip mining
7880 splits a loop into two nested loops. The outer loop has strides
7881 equal to the strip size and the inner loop has strides of the
7882 original loop within a strip. The strip length can be changed
7883 using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter. For example,
7884 given a loop like:
7885 @smallexample
7886 DO I = 1, N
7887 A(I) = A(I) + C
7888 ENDDO
7889 @end smallexample
7890 loop strip mining transforms the loop as if it were written:
7891 @smallexample
7892 DO II = 1, N, 51
7893 DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7894 A(I) = A(I) + C
7895 ENDDO
7896 ENDDO
7897 @end smallexample
7898 This optimization applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is
7899 not limited to Fortran. To use this code transformation, GCC has to
7900 be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7901 enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7902
7903 @item -floop-block
7904 @opindex floop-block
7905 Perform loop blocking transformations on loops. Blocking strip mines
7906 each loop in the loop nest such that the memory accesses of the
7907 element loops fit inside caches. The strip length can be changed
7908 using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter. For example, given
7909 a loop like:
7910 @smallexample
7911 DO I = 1, N
7912 DO J = 1, M
7913 A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7914 ENDDO
7915 ENDDO
7916 @end smallexample
7917 loop blocking transforms the loop as if it were written:
7918 @smallexample
7919 DO II = 1, N, 51
7920 DO JJ = 1, M, 51
7921 DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7922 DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
7923 A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7924 ENDDO
7925 ENDDO
7926 ENDDO
7927 ENDDO
7928 @end smallexample
7929 which can be beneficial when @code{M} is larger than the caches,
7930 because the innermost loop iterates over a smaller amount of data
7931 which can be kept in the caches. This optimization applies to all the
7932 languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran. To use this
7933 code transformation, GCC has to be configured with @option{--with-ppl}
7934 and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the Graphite loop transformation
7935 infrastructure.
7936
7937 @item -fgraphite-identity
7938 @opindex fgraphite-identity
7939 Enable the identity transformation for graphite. For every SCoP we generate
7940 the polyhedral representation and transform it back to gimple. Using
7941 @option{-fgraphite-identity} we can check the costs or benefits of the
7942 GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation. Some minimal optimizations
7943 are also performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and
7944 dead code elimination in loops.
7945
7946 @item -floop-nest-optimize
7947 @opindex floop-nest-optimize
7948 Enable the ISL based loop nest optimizer. This is a generic loop nest
7949 optimizer based on the Pluto optimization algorithms. It calculates a loop
7950 structure optimized for data-locality and parallelism. This option
7951 is experimental.
7952
7953 @item -floop-parallelize-all
7954 @opindex floop-parallelize-all
7955 Use the Graphite data dependence analysis to identify loops that can
7956 be parallelized. Parallelize all the loops that can be analyzed to
7957 not contain loop carried dependences without checking that it is
7958 profitable to parallelize the loops.
7959
7960 @item -fcheck-data-deps
7961 @opindex fcheck-data-deps
7962 Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers. This option
7963 is used for debugging the data dependence analyzers.
7964
7965 @item -ftree-loop-if-convert
7966 Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to
7967 branch-less equivalents. The intent is to remove control-flow from
7968 the innermost loops in order to improve the ability of the
7969 vectorization pass to handle these loops. This is enabled by default
7970 if vectorization is enabled.
7971
7972 @item -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
7973 Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.
7974 This transformation can be unsafe for multi-threaded programs as it
7975 transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional memory writes.
7976 For example,
7977 @smallexample
7978 for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7979 if (cond)
7980 A[i] = expr;
7981 @end smallexample
7982 is transformed to
7983 @smallexample
7984 for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7985 A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];
7986 @end smallexample
7987 potentially producing data races.
7988
7989 @item -ftree-loop-distribution
7990 Perform loop distribution. This flag can improve cache performance on
7991 big loop bodies and allow further loop optimizations, like
7992 parallelization or vectorization, to take place. For example, the loop
7993 @smallexample
7994 DO I = 1, N
7995 A(I) = B(I) + C
7996 D(I) = E(I) * F
7997 ENDDO
7998 @end smallexample
7999 is transformed to
8000 @smallexample
8001 DO I = 1, N
8002 A(I) = B(I) + C
8003 ENDDO
8004 DO I = 1, N
8005 D(I) = E(I) * F
8006 ENDDO
8007 @end smallexample
8008
8009 @item -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
8010 Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with
8011 calls to a library. This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
8012
8013 This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to
8014 memset zero. For example, the loop
8015 @smallexample
8016 DO I = 1, N
8017 A(I) = 0
8018 B(I) = A(I) + I
8019 ENDDO
8020 @end smallexample
8021 is transformed to
8022 @smallexample
8023 DO I = 1, N
8024 A(I) = 0
8025 ENDDO
8026 DO I = 1, N
8027 B(I) = A(I) + I
8028 ENDDO
8029 @end smallexample
8030 and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.
8031
8032 @item -ftree-loop-im
8033 @opindex ftree-loop-im
8034 Perform loop invariant motion on trees. This pass moves only invariants that
8035 are hard to handle at RTL level (function calls, operations that expand to
8036 nontrivial sequences of insns). With @option{-funswitch-loops} it also moves
8037 operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we can use
8038 just trivial invariantness analysis in loop unswitching. The pass also includes
8039 store motion.
8040
8041 @item -ftree-loop-ivcanon
8042 @opindex ftree-loop-ivcanon
8043 Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in loops for which
8044 determining number of iterations requires complicated analysis. Later
8045 optimizations then may determine the number easily. Useful especially
8046 in connection with unrolling.
8047
8048 @item -fivopts
8049 @opindex fivopts
8050 Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction, induction
8051 variable merging and induction variable elimination) on trees.
8052
8053 @item -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
8054 @opindex ftree-parallelize-loops
8055 Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.
8056 This is only possible for loops whose iterations are independent
8057 and can be arbitrarily reordered. The optimization is only
8058 profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive,
8059 rather than constrained e.g.@: by memory bandwidth. This option
8060 implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets
8061 that have support for @option{-pthread}.
8062
8063 @item -ftree-pta
8064 @opindex ftree-pta
8065 Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees. This flag is
8066 enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
8067
8068 @item -ftree-sra
8069 @opindex ftree-sra
8070 Perform scalar replacement of aggregates. This pass replaces structure
8071 references with scalars to prevent committing structures to memory too
8072 early. This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
8073
8074 @item -ftree-copyrename
8075 @opindex ftree-copyrename
8076 Perform copy renaming on trees. This pass attempts to rename compiler
8077 temporaries to other variables at copy locations, usually resulting in
8078 variable names which more closely resemble the original variables. This flag
8079 is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
8080
8081 @item -ftree-coalesce-inlined-vars
8082 @opindex ftree-coalesce-inlined-vars
8083 Tell the copyrename pass (see @option{-ftree-copyrename}) to attempt to
8084 combine small user-defined variables too, but only if they were inlined
8085 from other functions. It is a more limited form of
8086 @option{-ftree-coalesce-vars}. This may harm debug information of such
8087 inlined variables, but it will keep variables of the inlined-into
8088 function apart from each other, such that they are more likely to
8089 contain the expected values in a debugging session. This was the
8090 default in GCC versions older than 4.7.
8091
8092 @item -ftree-coalesce-vars
8093 @opindex ftree-coalesce-vars
8094 Tell the copyrename pass (see @option{-ftree-copyrename}) to attempt to
8095 combine small user-defined variables too, instead of just compiler
8096 temporaries. This may severely limit the ability to debug an optimized
8097 program compiled with @option{-fno-var-tracking-assignments}. In the
8098 negated form, this flag prevents SSA coalescing of user variables,
8099 including inlined ones. This option is enabled by default.
8100
8101 @item -ftree-ter
8102 @opindex ftree-ter
8103 Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal phase. Single
8104 use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use location with their
8105 defining expression. This results in non-GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders
8106 much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL generation. This is
8107 enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
8108
8109 @item -ftree-slsr
8110 @opindex ftree-slsr
8111 Perform straight-line strength reduction on trees. This recognizes related
8112 expressions involving multiplications and replaces them by less expensive
8113 calculations when possible. This is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
8114 higher.
8115
8116 @item -ftree-vectorize
8117 @opindex ftree-vectorize
8118 Perform vectorization on trees. This flag enables @option{-ftree-loop-vectorize}
8119 and @option{-ftree-slp-vectorize} if not explicitly specified.
8120
8121 @item -ftree-loop-vectorize
8122 @opindex ftree-loop-vectorize
8123 Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
8124 @option{-O3} and when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is enabled.
8125
8126 @item -ftree-slp-vectorize
8127 @opindex ftree-slp-vectorize
8128 Perform basic block vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
8129 @option{-O3} and when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is enabled.
8130
8131 @item -fvect-cost-model=@var{model}
8132 @opindex fvect-cost-model
8133 Alter the cost model used for vectorization. The @var{model} argument
8134 should be one of @code{unlimited}, @code{dynamic} or @code{cheap}.
8135 With the @code{unlimited} model the vectorized code-path is assumed
8136 to be profitable while with the @code{dynamic} model a runtime check
8137 will guard the vectorized code-path to enable it only for iteration
8138 counts that will likely execute faster than when executing the original
8139 scalar loop. The @code{cheap} model will disable vectorization of
8140 loops where doing so would be cost prohibitive for example due to
8141 required runtime checks for data dependence or alignment but otherwise
8142 is equal to the @code{dynamic} model.
8143 The default cost model depends on other optimization flags and is
8144 either @code{dynamic} or @code{cheap}.
8145
8146 @item -fsimd-cost-model=@var{model}
8147 @opindex fsimd-cost-model
8148 Alter the cost model used for vectorization of loops marked with the OpenMP
8149 or Cilk Plus simd directive. The @var{model} argument should be one of
8150 @code{unlimited}, @code{dynamic}, @code{cheap}. All values of @var{model}
8151 have the same meaning as described in @option{-fvect-cost-model} and by
8152 default a cost model defined with @option{-fvect-cost-model} is used.
8153
8154 @item -ftree-vrp
8155 @opindex ftree-vrp
8156 Perform Value Range Propagation on trees. This is similar to the
8157 constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values are
8158 propagated. This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary range
8159 checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks. This is
8160 enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher. Null pointer check
8161 elimination is only done if @option{-fdelete-null-pointer-checks} is
8162 enabled.
8163
8164 @item -ftracer
8165 @opindex ftracer
8166 Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size. This transformation
8167 simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
8168 a better job.
8169
8170 @item -funroll-loops
8171 @opindex funroll-loops
8172 Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
8173 time or upon entry to the loop. @option{-funroll-loops} implies
8174 @option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}. This option makes code larger,
8175 and may or may not make it run faster.
8176
8177 @item -funroll-all-loops
8178 @opindex funroll-all-loops
8179 Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
8180 the loop is entered. This usually makes programs run more slowly.
8181 @option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
8182 @option{-funroll-loops},
8183
8184 @item -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
8185 @opindex fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
8186 Enables expression of values of induction variables in later iterations
8187 of the unrolled loop using the value in the first iteration. This breaks
8188 long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of the scheduling passes.
8189
8190 A combination of @option{-fweb} and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
8191 same effect. However, that is not reliable in cases where the loop body
8192 is more complicated than a single basic block. It also does not work at all
8193 on some architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.
8194
8195 This optimization is enabled by default.
8196
8197 @item -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
8198 @opindex fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
8199 With this option, the compiler creates multiple copies of some
8200 local variables when unrolling a loop, which can result in superior code.
8201
8202 @item -fpartial-inlining
8203 @opindex fpartial-inlining
8204 Inline parts of functions. This option has any effect only
8205 when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
8206 or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
8207
8208 Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
8209
8210 @item -fpredictive-commoning
8211 @opindex fpredictive-commoning
8212 Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing computations
8213 (especially memory loads and stores) performed in previous
8214 iterations of loops.
8215
8216 This option is enabled at level @option{-O3}.
8217
8218 @item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
8219 @opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
8220 If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
8221 memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
8222
8223 This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
8224 dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
8225
8226 Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
8227
8228 @item -fno-peephole
8229 @itemx -fno-peephole2
8230 @opindex fno-peephole
8231 @opindex fno-peephole2
8232 Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations. The difference
8233 between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
8234 are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
8235 other, a few use both.
8236
8237 @option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
8238 @option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8239
8240 @item -fno-guess-branch-probability
8241 @opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
8242 Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
8243
8244 GCC uses heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are
8245 not provided by profiling feedback (@option{-fprofile-arcs}). These
8246 heuristics are based on the control flow graph. If some branch probabilities
8247 are specified by @samp{__builtin_expect}, then the heuristics are
8248 used to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph,
8249 taking the @samp{__builtin_expect} info into account. The interactions
8250 between the heuristics and @samp{__builtin_expect} can be complex, and in
8251 some cases, it may be useful to disable the heuristics so that the effects
8252 of @samp{__builtin_expect} are easier to understand.
8253
8254 The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
8255 @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8256
8257 @item -freorder-blocks
8258 @opindex freorder-blocks
8259 Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
8260 taken branches and improve code locality.
8261
8262 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8263
8264 @item -freorder-blocks-and-partition
8265 @opindex freorder-blocks-and-partition
8266 In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order
8267 to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks
8268 into separate sections of the assembly and .o files, to improve
8269 paging and cache locality performance.
8270
8271 This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
8272 exception handling, for linkonce sections, for functions with a user-defined
8273 section attribute and on any architecture that does not support named
8274 sections.
8275
8276 Enabled for x86 at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8277
8278 @item -freorder-functions
8279 @opindex freorder-functions
8280 Reorder functions in the object file in order to
8281 improve code locality. This is implemented by using special
8282 subsections @code{.text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
8283 @code{.text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions. Reordering is done by
8284 the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
8285 place them in a reasonable way.
8286
8287 Also profile feedback must be available to make this option effective. See
8288 @option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
8289
8290 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8291
8292 @item -fstrict-aliasing
8293 @opindex fstrict-aliasing
8294 Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
8295 the language being compiled. For C (and C++), this activates
8296 optimizations based on the type of expressions. In particular, an
8297 object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
8298 object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same. For
8299 example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
8300 @code{void*} or a @code{double}. A character type may alias any other
8301 type.
8302
8303 @anchor{Type-punning}Pay special attention to code like this:
8304 @smallexample
8305 union a_union @{
8306 int i;
8307 double d;
8308 @};
8309
8310 int f() @{
8311 union a_union t;
8312 t.d = 3.0;
8313 return t.i;
8314 @}
8315 @end smallexample
8316 The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
8317 recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common. Even with
8318 @option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
8319 is accessed through the union type. So, the code above works as
8320 expected. @xref{Structures unions enumerations and bit-fields
8321 implementation}. However, this code might not:
8322 @smallexample
8323 int f() @{
8324 union a_union t;
8325 int* ip;
8326 t.d = 3.0;
8327 ip = &t.i;
8328 return *ip;
8329 @}
8330 @end smallexample
8331
8332 Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer
8333 and dereferencing the result has undefined behavior, even if the cast
8334 uses a union type, e.g.:
8335 @smallexample
8336 int f() @{
8337 double d = 3.0;
8338 return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
8339 @}
8340 @end smallexample
8341
8342 The @option{-fstrict-aliasing} option is enabled at levels
8343 @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8344
8345 @item -fstrict-overflow
8346 @opindex fstrict-overflow
8347 Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending
8348 on the language being compiled. For C (and C++) this means that
8349 overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined, which
8350 means that the compiler may assume that it does not happen. This
8351 permits various optimizations. For example, the compiler assumes
8352 that an expression like @code{i + 10 > i} is always true for
8353 signed @code{i}. This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is
8354 undefined, as the expression is false if @code{i + 10} overflows when
8355 using twos complement arithmetic. When this option is in effect any
8356 attempt to determine whether an operation on signed numbers
8357 overflows must be written carefully to not actually involve overflow.
8358
8359 This option also allows the compiler to assume strict pointer
8360 semantics: given a pointer to an object, if adding an offset to that
8361 pointer does not produce a pointer to the same object, the addition is
8362 undefined. This permits the compiler to conclude that @code{p + u >
8363 p} is always true for a pointer @code{p} and unsigned integer
8364 @code{u}. This assumption is only valid because pointer wraparound is
8365 undefined, as the expression is false if @code{p + u} overflows using
8366 twos complement arithmetic.
8367
8368 See also the @option{-fwrapv} option. Using @option{-fwrapv} means
8369 that integer signed overflow is fully defined: it wraps. When
8370 @option{-fwrapv} is used, there is no difference between
8371 @option{-fstrict-overflow} and @option{-fno-strict-overflow} for
8372 integers. With @option{-fwrapv} certain types of overflow are
8373 permitted. For example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing
8374 arithmetic on constants, the overflowed value can still be used with
8375 @option{-fwrapv}, but not otherwise.
8376
8377 The @option{-fstrict-overflow} option is enabled at levels
8378 @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8379
8380 @item -falign-functions
8381 @itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
8382 @opindex falign-functions
8383 Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
8384 @var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes. For instance,
8385 @option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
8386 boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} aligns to the next
8387 32-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
8388
8389 @option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
8390 equivalent and mean that functions are not aligned.
8391
8392 Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
8393 in that case, it is rounded up.
8394
8395 If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8396
8397 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8398
8399 @item -falign-labels
8400 @itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
8401 @opindex falign-labels
8402 Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
8403 @var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}. This option can easily
8404 make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
8405 branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
8406
8407 @option{-fno-align-labels} and @option{-falign-labels=1} are
8408 equivalent and mean that labels are not aligned.
8409
8410 If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
8411 are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
8412
8413 If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
8414 which is very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
8415
8416 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8417
8418 @item -falign-loops
8419 @itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
8420 @opindex falign-loops
8421 Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
8422 like @option{-falign-functions}. If the loops are
8423 executed many times, this makes up for any execution of the dummy
8424 operations.
8425
8426 @option{-fno-align-loops} and @option{-falign-loops=1} are
8427 equivalent and mean that loops are not aligned.
8428
8429 If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8430
8431 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8432
8433 @item -falign-jumps
8434 @itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
8435 @opindex falign-jumps
8436 Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
8437 where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
8438 bytes like @option{-falign-functions}. In this case, no dummy operations
8439 need be executed.
8440
8441 @option{-fno-align-jumps} and @option{-falign-jumps=1} are
8442 equivalent and mean that loops are not aligned.
8443
8444 If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
8445
8446 Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
8447
8448 @item -funit-at-a-time
8449 @opindex funit-at-a-time
8450 This option is left for compatibility reasons. @option{-funit-at-a-time}
8451 has no effect, while @option{-fno-unit-at-a-time} implies
8452 @option{-fno-toplevel-reorder} and @option{-fno-section-anchors}.
8453
8454 Enabled by default.
8455
8456 @item -fno-toplevel-reorder
8457 @opindex fno-toplevel-reorder
8458 Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and @code{asm}
8459 statements. Output them in the same order that they appear in the
8460 input file. When this option is used, unreferenced static variables
8461 are not removed. This option is intended to support existing code
8462 that relies on a particular ordering. For new code, it is better to
8463 use attributes when possible.
8464
8465 Enabled at level @option{-O0}. When disabled explicitly, it also implies
8466 @option{-fno-section-anchors}, which is otherwise enabled at @option{-O0} on some
8467 targets.
8468
8469 @item -fweb
8470 @opindex fweb
8471 Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes and assign
8472 each web individual pseudo register. This allows the register allocation pass
8473 to operate on pseudos directly, but also strengthens several other optimization
8474 passes, such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code remover. It can,
8475 however, make debugging impossible, since variables no longer stay in a
8476 ``home register''.
8477
8478 Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
8479
8480 @item -fwhole-program
8481 @opindex fwhole-program
8482 Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole program being
8483 compiled. All public functions and variables with the exception of @code{main}
8484 and those merged by attribute @code{externally_visible} become static functions
8485 and in effect are optimized more aggressively by interprocedural optimizers.
8486
8487 This option should not be used in combination with @code{-flto}.
8488 Instead relying on a linker plugin should provide safer and more precise
8489 information.
8490
8491 @item -flto[=@var{n}]
8492 @opindex flto
8493 This option runs the standard link-time optimizer. When invoked
8494 with source code, it generates GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal
8495 representations) and writes it to special ELF sections in the object
8496 file. When the object files are linked together, all the function
8497 bodies are read from these ELF sections and instantiated as if they
8498 had been part of the same translation unit.
8499
8500 To use the link-time optimizer, @option{-flto} needs to be specified at
8501 compile time and during the final link. For example:
8502
8503 @smallexample
8504 gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
8505 gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
8506 gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 The first two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation
8510 of GIMPLE into special ELF sections inside @file{foo.o} and
8511 @file{bar.o}. The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from
8512 @file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o}, merges the two files into a single
8513 internal image, and compiles the result as usual. Since both
8514 @file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o} are merged into a single image, this
8515 causes all the interprocedural analyses and optimizations in GCC to
8516 work across the two files as if they were a single one. This means,
8517 for example, that the inliner is able to inline functions in
8518 @file{bar.o} into functions in @file{foo.o} and vice-versa.
8519
8520 Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:
8521
8522 @smallexample
8523 gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 The above generates bytecode for @file{foo.c} and @file{bar.c},
8527 merges them together into a single GIMPLE representation and optimizes
8528 them as usual to produce @file{myprog}.
8529
8530 The only important thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time
8531 optimizations the @option{-flto} flag needs to be passed to both the
8532 compile and the link commands.
8533
8534 To make whole program optimization effective, it is necessary to make
8535 certain whole program assumptions. The compiler needs to know
8536 what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries and runtime
8537 outside of the link-time optimized unit. When supported by the linker,
8538 the linker plugin (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}) passes information
8539 to the compiler about used and externally visible symbols. When
8540 the linker plugin is not available, @option{-fwhole-program} should be
8541 used to allow the compiler to make these assumptions, which leads
8542 to more aggressive optimization decisions.
8543
8544 Note that when a file is compiled with @option{-flto}, the generated
8545 object file is larger than a regular object file because it
8546 contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code. This means that
8547 object files with LTO information can be linked as normal object
8548 files; if @option{-flto} is not passed to the linker, no
8549 interprocedural optimizations are applied.
8550
8551 Additionally, the optimization flags used to compile individual files
8552 are not necessarily related to those used at link time. For instance,
8553
8554 @smallexample
8555 gcc -c -O0 -flto foo.c
8556 gcc -c -O0 -flto bar.c
8557 gcc -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 This produces individual object files with unoptimized assembler
8561 code, but the resulting binary @file{myprog} is optimized at
8562 @option{-O3}. If, instead, the final binary is generated without
8563 @option{-flto}, then @file{myprog} is not optimized.
8564
8565 When producing the final binary with @option{-flto}, GCC only
8566 applies link-time optimizations to those files that contain bytecode.
8567 Therefore, you can mix and match object files and libraries with
8568 GIMPLE bytecodes and final object code. GCC automatically selects
8569 which files to optimize in LTO mode and which files to link without
8570 further processing.
8571
8572 There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when
8573 generating bytecodes, as they need to be used during the final link
8574 stage. Currently, the following options are saved into the GIMPLE
8575 bytecode files: @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fcommon} and all the
8576 @option{-m} target flags.
8577
8578 At link time, these options are read in and reapplied. Note that the
8579 current implementation makes no attempt to recognize conflicting
8580 values for these options. If different files have conflicting option
8581 values (e.g., one file is compiled with @option{-fPIC} and another
8582 isn't), the compiler simply uses the last value read from the
8583 bytecode files. It is recommended, then, that you compile all the files
8584 participating in the same link with the same options.
8585
8586 If LTO encounters objects with C linkage declared with incompatible
8587 types in separate translation units to be linked together (undefined
8588 behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a non-fatal diagnostic may be
8589 issued. The behavior is still undefined at run time.
8590
8591 Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural
8592 optimizations on files written in different languages. This requires
8593 support in the language front end. Currently, the C, C++ and
8594 Fortran front ends are capable of emitting GIMPLE bytecodes, so
8595 something like this should work:
8596
8597 @smallexample
8598 gcc -c -flto foo.c
8599 g++ -c -flto bar.cc
8600 gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
8601 g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran
8602 @end smallexample
8603
8604 Notice that the final link is done with @command{g++} to get the C++
8605 runtime libraries and @option{-lgfortran} is added to get the Fortran
8606 runtime libraries. In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you
8607 should use the same link command options as when mixing languages in a
8608 regular (non-LTO) compilation; all you need to add is @option{-flto} to
8609 all the compile and link commands.
8610
8611 If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a library archive, say
8612 @file{libfoo.a}, it is possible to extract and use them in an LTO link if you
8613 are using a linker with plugin support. To enable this feature, use
8614 the flag @option{-fuse-linker-plugin} at link time:
8615
8616 @smallexample
8617 gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo
8618 @end smallexample
8619
8620 With the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed
8621 GIMPLE files from @file{libfoo.a} and passes them on to the running GCC
8622 to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.
8623
8624 If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not
8625 enable the linker plugin, then the objects inside @file{libfoo.a}
8626 are extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate
8627 in the LTO optimization process.
8628
8629 Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to
8630 operate. If the program does not require any symbols to be exported, it is
8631 possible to combine @option{-flto} and @option{-fwhole-program} to allow
8632 the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may
8633 lead to improved optimization opportunities.
8634 Use of @option{-fwhole-program} is not needed when linker plugin is
8635 active (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}).
8636
8637 The current implementation of LTO makes no
8638 attempt to generate bytecode that is portable between different
8639 types of hosts. The bytecode files are versioned and there is a
8640 strict version check, so bytecode files generated in one version of
8641 GCC will not work with an older/newer version of GCC@.
8642
8643 Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging
8644 information. Combining @option{-flto} with
8645 @option{-g} is currently experimental and expected to produce wrong
8646 results.
8647
8648 If you specify the optional @var{n}, the optimization and code
8649 generation done at link time is executed in parallel using @var{n}
8650 parallel jobs by utilizing an installed @command{make} program. The
8651 environment variable @env{MAKE} may be used to override the program
8652 used. The default value for @var{n} is 1.
8653
8654 You can also specify @option{-flto=jobserver} to use GNU make's
8655 job server mode to determine the number of parallel jobs. This
8656 is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.
8657 You must prepend a @samp{+} to the command recipe in the parent Makefile
8658 for this to work. This option likely only works if @env{MAKE} is
8659 GNU make.
8660
8661 This option is disabled by default.
8662
8663 @item -flto-partition=@var{alg}
8664 @opindex flto-partition
8665 Specify the partitioning algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.
8666 The value is either @code{1to1} to specify a partitioning mirroring
8667 the original source files or @code{balanced} to specify partitioning
8668 into equally sized chunks (whenever possible) or @code{max} to create
8669 new partition for every symbol where possible. Specifying @code{none}
8670 as an algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely.
8671 The default value is @code{balanced}. While @code{1to1} can be used
8672 as an workaround for various code ordering issues, the @code{max}
8673 partitioning is intended for internal testing only.
8674
8675 @item -flto-compression-level=@var{n}
8676 This option specifies the level of compression used for intermediate
8677 language written to LTO object files, and is only meaningful in
8678 conjunction with LTO mode (@option{-flto}). Valid
8679 values are 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression). Values
8680 outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9. If the option is not
8681 given, a default balanced compression setting is used.
8682
8683 @item -flto-report
8684 Prints a report with internal details on the workings of the link-time
8685 optimizer. The contents of this report vary from version to version.
8686 It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing object
8687 files in LTO mode (via @option{-flto}).
8688
8689 Disabled by default.
8690
8691 @item -flto-report-wpa
8692 Like @option{-flto-report}, but only print for the WPA phase of Link
8693 Time Optimization.
8694
8695 @item -fuse-linker-plugin
8696 Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization. This
8697 option relies on plugin support in the linker, which is available in gold
8698 or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.
8699
8700 This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out
8701 of library archives. This improves the quality of optimization by exposing
8702 more code to the link-time optimizer. This information specifies what
8703 symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object or during dynamic
8704 linking). Resulting code quality improvements on binaries (and shared
8705 libraries that use hidden visibility) are similar to @code{-fwhole-program}.
8706 See @option{-flto} for a description of the effect of this flag and how to
8707 use it.
8708
8709 This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled
8710 and GCC was configured for use with
8711 a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).
8712
8713 @item -ffat-lto-objects
8714 @opindex ffat-lto-objects
8715 Fat LTO objects are object files that contain both the intermediate language
8716 and the object code. This makes them usable for both LTO linking and normal
8717 linking. This option is effective only when compiling with @option{-flto}
8718 and is ignored at link time.
8719
8720 @option{-fno-fat-lto-objects} improves compilation time over plain LTO, but
8721 requires the complete toolchain to be aware of LTO. It requires a linker with
8722 linker plugin support for basic functionality. Additionally,
8723 @command{nm}, @command{ar} and @command{ranlib}
8724 need to support linker plugins to allow a full-featured build environment
8725 (capable of building static libraries etc). GCC provides the @command{gcc-ar},
8726 @command{gcc-nm}, @command{gcc-ranlib} wrappers to pass the right options
8727 to these tools. With non fat LTO makefiles need to be modified to use them.
8728
8729 The default is @option{-fno-fat-lto-objects} on targets with linker plugin
8730 support.
8731
8732 @item -fcompare-elim
8733 @opindex fcompare-elim
8734 After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8735 identify arithmetic instructions that compute processor flags similar to a
8736 comparison operation based on that arithmetic. If possible, eliminate the
8737 explicit comparison operation.
8738
8739 This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent
8740 the comparison operation before register allocation is complete.
8741
8742 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8743
8744 @item -fuse-ld=bfd
8745 @opindex fuse-ld=bfd
8746 Use the @command{bfd} linker instead of the default linker.
8747
8748 @item -fuse-ld=gold
8749 @opindex fuse-ld=gold
8750 Use the @command{gold} linker instead of the default linker.
8751
8752 @item -fcprop-registers
8753 @opindex fcprop-registers
8754 After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8755 perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
8756 and occasionally eliminate the copy.
8757
8758 Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8759
8760 @item -fprofile-correction
8761 @opindex fprofile-correction
8762 Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may
8763 be inconsistent due to missed counter updates. When this option is specified,
8764 GCC uses heuristics to correct or smooth out such inconsistencies. By
8765 default, GCC emits an error message when an inconsistent profile is detected.
8766
8767 @item -fprofile-dir=@var{path}
8768 @opindex fprofile-dir
8769
8770 Set the directory to search for the profile data files in to @var{path}.
8771 This option affects only the profile data generated by
8772 @option{-fprofile-generate}, @option{-ftest-coverage}, @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8773 and used by @option{-fprofile-use} and @option{-fbranch-probabilities}
8774 and its related options. Both absolute and relative paths can be used.
8775 By default, GCC uses the current directory as @var{path}, thus the
8776 profile data file appears in the same directory as the object file.
8777
8778 @item -fprofile-generate
8779 @itemx -fprofile-generate=@var{path}
8780 @opindex fprofile-generate
8781
8782 Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to produce
8783 profile useful for later recompilation with profile feedback based
8784 optimization. You must use @option{-fprofile-generate} both when
8785 compiling and when linking your program.
8786
8787 The following options are enabled: @code{-fprofile-arcs}, @code{-fprofile-values}, @code{-fvpt}.
8788
8789 If @var{path} is specified, GCC looks at the @var{path} to find
8790 the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8791
8792 @item -fprofile-use
8793 @itemx -fprofile-use=@var{path}
8794 @opindex fprofile-use
8795 Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and optimizations
8796 generally profitable only with profile feedback available.
8797
8798 The following options are enabled: @code{-fbranch-probabilities}, @code{-fvpt},
8799 @code{-funroll-loops}, @code{-fpeel-loops}, @code{-ftracer}, @code{-ftree-vectorize},
8800 @code{ftree-loop-distribute-patterns}
8801
8802 By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not
8803 match the source code. This error can be turned into a warning by using
8804 @option{-Wcoverage-mismatch}. Note this may result in poorly optimized
8805 code.
8806
8807 If @var{path} is specified, GCC looks at the @var{path} to find
8808 the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8809 @end table
8810
8811 The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-point
8812 arithmetic. These options trade off between speed and
8813 correctness. All must be specifically enabled.
8814
8815 @table @gcctabopt
8816 @item -ffloat-store
8817 @opindex ffloat-store
8818 Do not store floating-point variables in registers, and inhibit other
8819 options that might change whether a floating-point value is taken from a
8820 register or memory.
8821
8822 @cindex floating-point precision
8823 This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
8824 the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
8825 precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have. Similarly for the
8826 x86 architecture. For most programs, the excess precision does only
8827 good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
8828 point. Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
8829 them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
8830
8831 @item -fexcess-precision=@var{style}
8832 @opindex fexcess-precision
8833 This option allows further control over excess precision on machines
8834 where floating-point registers have more precision than the IEEE
8835 @code{float} and @code{double} types and the processor does not
8836 support operations rounding to those types. By default,
8837 @option{-fexcess-precision=fast} is in effect; this means that
8838 operations are carried out in the precision of the registers and that
8839 it is unpredictable when rounding to the types specified in the source
8840 code takes place. When compiling C, if
8841 @option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is specified then excess
8842 precision follows the rules specified in ISO C99; in particular,
8843 both casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their
8844 semantic types (whereas @option{-ffloat-store} only affects
8845 assignments). This option is enabled by default for C if a strict
8846 conformance option such as @option{-std=c99} is used.
8847
8848 @opindex mfpmath
8849 @option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is not implemented for languages
8850 other than C, and has no effect if
8851 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} or @option{-ffast-math} is
8852 specified. On the x86, it also has no effect if @option{-mfpmath=sse}
8853 or @option{-mfpmath=sse+387} is specified; in the former case, IEEE
8854 semantics apply without excess precision, and in the latter, rounding
8855 is unpredictable.
8856
8857 @item -ffast-math
8858 @opindex ffast-math
8859 Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
8860 @option{-ffinite-math-only}, @option{-fno-rounding-math},
8861 @option{-fno-signaling-nans} and @option{-fcx-limited-range}.
8862
8863 This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
8864
8865 This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option besides
8866 @option{-Ofast} since it can result in incorrect output for programs
8867 that depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications
8868 for math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8869 that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8870
8871 @item -fno-math-errno
8872 @opindex fno-math-errno
8873 Do not set @code{errno} after calling math functions that are executed
8874 with a single instruction, e.g., @code{sqrt}. A program that relies on
8875 IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
8876 for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
8877
8878 This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8879 it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8880 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8881 math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8882 that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8883
8884 The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
8885
8886 On Darwin systems, the math library never sets @code{errno}. There is
8887 therefore no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility that
8888 it might, and @option{-fno-math-errno} is the default.
8889
8890 @item -funsafe-math-optimizations
8891 @opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
8892
8893 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
8894 that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
8895 ANSI standards. When used at link-time, it may include libraries
8896 or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
8897 similar optimizations.
8898
8899 This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8900 it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8901 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8902 math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8903 that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8904 Enables @option{-fno-signed-zeros}, @option{-fno-trapping-math},
8905 @option{-fassociative-math} and @option{-freciprocal-math}.
8906
8907 The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
8908
8909 @item -fassociative-math
8910 @opindex fassociative-math
8911
8912 Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.
8913 This violates the ISO C and C++ language standard by possibly changing
8914 computation result. NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign of zero as
8915 well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and
8916 thus cannot be used on code that relies on rounding behavior like
8917 @code{(x + 2**52) - 2**52}. May also reorder floating-point comparisons
8918 and thus may not be used when ordered comparisons are required.
8919 This option requires that both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8920 @option{-fno-trapping-math} be in effect. Moreover, it doesn't make
8921 much sense with @option{-frounding-math}. For Fortran the option
8922 is automatically enabled when both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8923 @option{-fno-trapping-math} are in effect.
8924
8925 The default is @option{-fno-associative-math}.
8926
8927 @item -freciprocal-math
8928 @opindex freciprocal-math
8929
8930 Allow the reciprocal of a value to be used instead of dividing by
8931 the value if this enables optimizations. For example @code{x / y}
8932 can be replaced with @code{x * (1/y)}, which is useful if @code{(1/y)}
8933 is subject to common subexpression elimination. Note that this loses
8934 precision and increases the number of flops operating on the value.
8935
8936 The default is @option{-fno-reciprocal-math}.
8937
8938 @item -ffinite-math-only
8939 @opindex ffinite-math-only
8940 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
8941 that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
8942
8943 This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8944 it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8945 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8946 math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8947 that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8948
8949 The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
8950
8951 @item -fno-signed-zeros
8952 @opindex fno-signed-zeros
8953 Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that ignore the
8954 signedness of zero. IEEE arithmetic specifies the behavior of
8955 distinct +0.0 and @minus{}0.0 values, which then prohibits simplification
8956 of expressions such as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with @option{-ffinite-math-only}).
8957 This option implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.
8958
8959 The default is @option{-fsigned-zeros}.
8960
8961 @item -fno-trapping-math
8962 @opindex fno-trapping-math
8963 Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
8964 user-visible traps. These traps include division by zero, overflow,
8965 underflow, inexact result and invalid operation. This option requires
8966 that @option{-fno-signaling-nans} be in effect. Setting this option may
8967 allow faster code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
8968
8969 This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8970 it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8971 an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8972 math functions.
8973
8974 The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8975
8976 @item -frounding-math
8977 @opindex frounding-math
8978 Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating-point
8979 rounding behavior. This is round-to-zero for all floating point
8980 to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all other arithmetic
8981 truncations. This option should be specified for programs that change
8982 the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a
8983 non-default rounding mode. This option disables constant folding of
8984 floating-point expressions at compile time (which may be affected by
8985 rounding mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe in the
8986 presence of sign-dependent rounding modes.
8987
8988 The default is @option{-fno-rounding-math}.
8989
8990 This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8991 disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
8992 Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
8993 using C99's @code{FENV_ACCESS} pragma. This command-line option
8994 will be used to specify the default state for @code{FENV_ACCESS}.
8995
8996 @item -fsignaling-nans
8997 @opindex fsignaling-nans
8998 Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
8999 traps during floating-point operations. Setting this option disables
9000 optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
9001 signaling NaNs. This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
9002
9003 This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
9004 be defined.
9005
9006 The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
9007
9008 This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
9009 disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
9010
9011 @item -fsingle-precision-constant
9012 @opindex fsingle-precision-constant
9013 Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of
9014 implicitly converting them to double-precision constants.
9015
9016 @item -fcx-limited-range
9017 @opindex fcx-limited-range
9018 When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
9019 needed when performing complex division. Also, there is no checking
9020 whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
9021 + I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case. The
9022 default is @option{-fno-cx-limited-range}, but is enabled by
9023 @option{-ffast-math}.
9024
9025 This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
9026 @code{CX_LIMITED_RANGE} pragma. Nevertheless, the option applies to
9027 all languages.
9028
9029 @item -fcx-fortran-rules
9030 @opindex fcx-fortran-rules
9031 Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules. Range
9032 reduction is done as part of complex division, but there is no checking
9033 whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
9034 + I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.
9035
9036 The default is @option{-fno-cx-fortran-rules}.
9037
9038 @end table
9039
9040 The following options control optimizations that may improve
9041 performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options. This
9042 section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
9043
9044 @table @gcctabopt
9045 @item -fbranch-probabilities
9046 @opindex fbranch-probabilities
9047 After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
9048 (@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
9049 @command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
9050 @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
9051 the number of times each branch was taken. When a program
9052 compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits, it saves arc execution
9053 counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.gcda} for each source
9054 file. The information in this data file is very dependent on the
9055 structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
9056 and the same optimization options for both compilations.
9057
9058 With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a
9059 @samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
9060 These can be used to improve optimization. Currently, they are only
9061 used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
9062 branch is most likely to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
9063 exactly determine which path is taken more often.
9064
9065 @item -fprofile-values
9066 @opindex fprofile-values
9067 If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it adds code so that some
9068 data about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
9069
9070 With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
9071 from profiling values of expressions for usage in optimizations.
9072
9073 Enabled with @option{-fprofile-generate} and @option{-fprofile-use}.
9074
9075 @item -fprofile-reoder-functions
9076 @opindex fprofile-reorder-functions
9077 Function reordering based on profile instrumentation collects
9078 first time of execution of a function and orders these functions
9079 in ascending order.
9080
9081 Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
9082
9083 @item -fvpt
9084 @opindex fvpt
9085 If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, this option instructs the compiler
9086 to add code to gather information about values of expressions.
9087
9088 With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
9089 and actually performs the optimizations based on them.
9090 Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operations
9091 using the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
9092
9093 @item -frename-registers
9094 @opindex frename-registers
9095 Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
9096 of registers left over after register allocation. This optimization
9097 most benefits processors with lots of registers. Depending on the
9098 debug information format adopted by the target, however, it can
9099 make debugging impossible, since variables no longer stay in
9100 a ``home register''.
9101
9102 Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops} and @option{-fpeel-loops}.
9103
9104 @item -ftracer
9105 @opindex ftracer
9106 Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size. This transformation
9107 simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
9108 a better job.
9109
9110 Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
9111
9112 @item -funroll-loops
9113 @opindex funroll-loops
9114 Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or
9115 upon entry to the loop. @option{-funroll-loops} implies
9116 @option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}, @option{-fweb} and @option{-frename-registers}.
9117 It also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with
9118 a small constant number of iterations). This option makes code larger, and may
9119 or may not make it run faster.
9120
9121 Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
9122
9123 @item -funroll-all-loops
9124 @opindex funroll-all-loops
9125 Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
9126 the loop is entered. This usually makes programs run more slowly.
9127 @option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
9128 @option{-funroll-loops}.
9129
9130 @item -fpeel-loops
9131 @opindex fpeel-loops
9132 Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not
9133 roll much (from profile feedback). It also turns on complete loop peeling
9134 (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with small constant number of iterations).
9135
9136 Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
9137
9138 @item -fmove-loop-invariants
9139 @opindex fmove-loop-invariants
9140 Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer. Enabled
9141 at level @option{-O1}
9142
9143 @item -funswitch-loops
9144 @opindex funswitch-loops
9145 Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates
9146 of the loop on both branches (modified according to result of the condition).
9147
9148 @item -ffunction-sections
9149 @itemx -fdata-sections
9150 @opindex ffunction-sections
9151 @opindex fdata-sections
9152 Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
9153 file if the target supports arbitrary sections. The name of the
9154 function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
9155 in the output file.
9156
9157 Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
9158 to improve locality of reference in the instruction space. Most systems
9159 using the ELF object format and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
9160 linkers with such optimizations. AIX may have these optimizations in
9161 the future.
9162
9163 Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
9164 so. When you specify these options, the assembler and linker
9165 create larger object and executable files and are also slower.
9166 You cannot use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
9167 specify this option, and you may have problems with debugging if
9168 you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
9169
9170 @item -fbranch-target-load-optimize
9171 @opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize
9172 Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue
9173 threading.
9174 The use of target registers can typically be exposed only during reload,
9175 thus hoisting loads out of loops and doing inter-block scheduling needs
9176 a separate optimization pass.
9177
9178 @item -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
9179 @opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize2
9180 Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue
9181 threading.
9182
9183 @item -fbtr-bb-exclusive
9184 @opindex fbtr-bb-exclusive
9185 When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse
9186 branch target registers within any basic block.
9187
9188 @item -fstack-protector
9189 @opindex fstack-protector
9190 Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack smashing
9191 attacks. This is done by adding a guard variable to functions with
9192 vulnerable objects. This includes functions that call @code{alloca}, and
9193 functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes. The guards are initialized
9194 when a function is entered and then checked when the function exits.
9195 If a guard check fails, an error message is printed and the program exits.
9196
9197 @item -fstack-protector-all
9198 @opindex fstack-protector-all
9199 Like @option{-fstack-protector} except that all functions are protected.
9200
9201 @item -fstack-protector-strong
9202 @opindex fstack-protector-strong
9203 Like @option{-fstack-protector} but includes additional functions to
9204 be protected --- those that have local array definitions, or have
9205 references to local frame addresses.
9206
9207 @item -fsection-anchors
9208 @opindex fsection-anchors
9209 Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
9210 shared ``anchor'' symbols to address nearby objects. This transformation
9211 can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on some
9212 targets.
9213
9214 For example, the implementation of the following function @code{foo}:
9215
9216 @smallexample
9217 static int a, b, c;
9218 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
9219 @end smallexample
9220
9221 @noindent
9222 usually calculates the addresses of all three variables, but if you
9223 compile it with @option{-fsection-anchors}, it accesses the variables
9224 from a common anchor point instead. The effect is similar to the
9225 following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
9226
9227 @smallexample
9228 int foo (void)
9229 @{
9230 register int *xr = &x;
9231 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
9232 @}
9233 @end smallexample
9234
9235 Not all targets support this option.
9236
9237 @item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
9238 @opindex param
9239 In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
9240 optimization that is done. For example, GCC does not inline functions
9241 that contain more than a certain number of instructions. You can
9242 control some of these constants on the command line using the
9243 @option{--param} option.
9244
9245 The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are
9246 tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to change
9247 without notice in future releases.
9248
9249 In each case, the @var{value} is an integer. The allowable choices for
9250 @var{name} are:
9251
9252 @table @gcctabopt
9253 @item predictable-branch-outcome
9254 When branch is predicted to be taken with probability lower than this threshold
9255 (in percent), then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.
9256
9257 @item max-crossjump-edges
9258 The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for cross-jumping.
9259 The algorithm used by @option{-fcrossjumping} is @math{O(N^2)} in
9260 the number of edges incoming to each block. Increasing values mean
9261 more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with
9262 probably small improvement in executable size.
9263
9264 @item min-crossjump-insns
9265 The minimum number of instructions that must be matched at the end
9266 of two blocks before cross-jumping is performed on them. This
9267 value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the block being
9268 cross-jumped from are matched. The default value is 5.
9269
9270 @item max-grow-copy-bb-insns
9271 The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic blocks
9272 instead of jumping. The expansion is relative to a jump instruction.
9273 The default value is 8.
9274
9275 @item max-goto-duplication-insns
9276 The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps
9277 to a computed goto. To avoid @math{O(N^2)} behavior in a number of
9278 passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation process,
9279 and unfactors them as late as possible. Only computed jumps at the
9280 end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are
9281 unfactored. The default value is 8.
9282
9283 @item max-delay-slot-insn-search
9284 The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
9285 instruction to fill a delay slot. If more than this arbitrary number of
9286 instructions are searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
9287 are minimal, so stop searching. Increasing values mean more
9288 aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably
9289 small improvement in execution time.
9290
9291 @item max-delay-slot-live-search
9292 When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
9293 consider when searching for a block with valid live register
9294 information. Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
9295 aggressive optimization, increasing the compilation time. This parameter
9296 should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
9297 control-flow graph.
9298
9299 @item max-gcse-memory
9300 The approximate maximum amount of memory that can be allocated in
9301 order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
9302 optimization. If more memory than specified is required, the
9303 optimization is not done.
9304
9305 @item max-gcse-insertion-ratio
9306 If the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value
9307 for any expression, then RTL PRE inserts or removes the expression and thus
9308 leaves partially redundant computations in the instruction stream. The default value is 20.
9309
9310 @item max-pending-list-length
9311 The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling allows
9312 before flushing the current state and starting over. Large functions
9313 with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
9314 needlessly consume memory and resources.
9315
9316 @item max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
9317 The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should make
9318 when modulo scheduling a loop. Larger values can exponentially increase
9319 compilation time.
9320
9321 @item max-inline-insns-single
9322 Several parameters control the tree inliner used in GCC@.
9323 This number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in GCC's
9324 internal representation) in a single function that the tree inliner
9325 considers for inlining. This only affects functions declared
9326 inline and methods implemented in a class declaration (C++).
9327 The default value is 400.
9328
9329 @item max-inline-insns-auto
9330 When you use @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}),
9331 a lot of functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
9332 by the compiler are investigated. To those functions, a different
9333 (more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can
9334 be applied.
9335 The default value is 40.
9336
9337 @item inline-min-speedup
9338 When estimated performance improvement of caller + callee runtime exceeds this
9339 threshold (in precent), the function can be inlined regardless the limit on
9340 @option{--param max-inline-insns-single} and @option{--param
9341 max-inline-insns-auto}.
9342
9343 @item large-function-insns
9344 The limit specifying really large functions. For functions larger than this
9345 limit after inlining, inlining is constrained by
9346 @option{--param large-function-growth}. This parameter is useful primarily
9347 to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the
9348 back end.
9349 The default value is 2700.
9350
9351 @item large-function-growth
9352 Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.
9353 The default value is 100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times
9354 the original size.
9355
9356 @item large-unit-insns
9357 The limit specifying large translation unit. Growth caused by inlining of
9358 units larger than this limit is limited by @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.
9359 For small units this might be too tight.
9360 For example, consider a unit consisting of function A
9361 that is inline and B that just calls A three times. If B is small relative to
9362 A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane. For very
9363 large units consisting of small inlineable functions, however, the overall unit
9364 growth limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size. Thus for
9365 smaller units, the size is increased to @option{--param large-unit-insns}
9366 before applying @option{--param inline-unit-growth}. The default is 10000.
9367
9368 @item inline-unit-growth
9369 Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.
9370 The default value is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original
9371 size.
9372
9373 @item ipcp-unit-growth
9374 Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by
9375 interprocedural constant propagation. The default value is 10 which limits
9376 unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.
9377
9378 @item large-stack-frame
9379 The limit specifying large stack frames. While inlining the algorithm is trying
9380 to not grow past this limit too much. The default value is 256 bytes.
9381
9382 @item large-stack-frame-growth
9383 Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.
9384 The default value is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times
9385 the original size.
9386
9387 @item max-inline-insns-recursive
9388 @itemx max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
9389 Specifies the maximum number of instructions an out-of-line copy of a
9390 self-recursive inline
9391 function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.
9392
9393 For functions declared inline, @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive} is
9394 taken into account. For functions not declared inline, recursive inlining
9395 happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
9396 enabled and @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto} is used. The
9397 default value is 450.
9398
9399 @item max-inline-recursive-depth
9400 @itemx max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
9401 Specifies the maximum recursion depth used for recursive inlining.
9402
9403 For functions declared inline, @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth} is
9404 taken into account. For functions not declared inline, recursive inlining
9405 happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
9406 enabled and @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto} is used. The
9407 default value is 8.
9408
9409 @item min-inline-recursive-probability
9410 Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion
9411 in average and can hurt for function having little recursion depth by
9412 increasing the prologue size or complexity of function body to other
9413 optimizers.
9414
9415 When profile feedback is available (see @option{-fprofile-generate}) the actual
9416 recursion depth can be guessed from probability that function recurses via a
9417 given call expression. This parameter limits inlining only to call expressions
9418 whose probability exceeds the given threshold (in percents).
9419 The default value is 10.
9420
9421 @item early-inlining-insns
9422 Specify growth that the early inliner can make. In effect it increases
9423 the amount of inlining for code having a large abstraction penalty.
9424 The default value is 10.
9425
9426 @item max-early-inliner-iterations
9427 @itemx max-early-inliner-iterations
9428 Limit of iterations of the early inliner. This basically bounds
9429 the number of nested indirect calls the early inliner can resolve.
9430 Deeper chains are still handled by late inlining.
9431
9432 @item comdat-sharing-probability
9433 @itemx comdat-sharing-probability
9434 Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat visibility
9435 are shared across multiple compilation units. The default value is 20.
9436
9437 @item min-vect-loop-bound
9438 The minimum number of iterations under which loops are not vectorized
9439 when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is used. The number of iterations after
9440 vectorization needs to be greater than the value specified by this option
9441 to allow vectorization. The default value is 0.
9442
9443 @item gcse-cost-distance-ratio
9444 Scaling factor in calculation of maximum distance an expression
9445 can be moved by GCSE optimizations. This is currently supported only in the
9446 code hoisting pass. The bigger the ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting
9447 is with simple expressions, i.e., the expressions that have cost
9448 less than @option{gcse-unrestricted-cost}. Specifying 0 disables
9449 hoisting of simple expressions. The default value is 10.
9450
9451 @item gcse-unrestricted-cost
9452 Cost, roughly measured as the cost of a single typical machine
9453 instruction, at which GCSE optimizations do not constrain
9454 the distance an expression can travel. This is currently
9455 supported only in the code hoisting pass. The lesser the cost,
9456 the more aggressive code hoisting is. Specifying 0
9457 allows all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.
9458 The default value is 3.
9459
9460 @item max-hoist-depth
9461 The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions to hoist.
9462 This is used to avoid quadratic behavior in hoisting algorithm.
9463 The value of 0 does not limit on the search, but may slow down compilation
9464 of huge functions. The default value is 30.
9465
9466 @item max-tail-merge-comparisons
9467 The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with. This is used to
9468 avoid quadratic behavior in tree tail merging. The default value is 10.
9469
9470 @item max-tail-merge-iterations
9471 The maximum amount of iterations of the pass over the function. This is used to
9472 limit compilation time in tree tail merging. The default value is 2.
9473
9474 @item max-unrolled-insns
9475 The maximum number of instructions that a loop may have to be unrolled.
9476 If a loop is unrolled, this parameter also determines how many times
9477 the loop code is unrolled.
9478
9479 @item max-average-unrolled-insns
9480 The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution
9481 that a loop may have to be unrolled. If a loop is unrolled,
9482 this parameter also determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
9483
9484 @item max-unroll-times
9485 The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
9486
9487 @item max-peeled-insns
9488 The maximum number of instructions that a loop may have to be peeled.
9489 If a loop is peeled, this parameter also determines how many times
9490 the loop code is peeled.
9491
9492 @item max-peel-times
9493 The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
9494
9495 @item max-peel-branches
9496 The maximum number of branches on the hot path through the peeled sequence.
9497
9498 @item max-completely-peeled-insns
9499 The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
9500
9501 @item max-completely-peel-times
9502 The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.
9503
9504 @item max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
9505 The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.
9506
9507 @item max-unswitch-insns
9508 The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
9509
9510 @item max-unswitch-level
9511 The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
9512
9513 @item lim-expensive
9514 The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.
9515
9516 @item iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
9517 Bound on number of candidates for induction variables, below which
9518 all candidates are considered for each use in induction variable
9519 optimizations. If there are more candidates than this,
9520 only the most relevant ones are considered to avoid quadratic time complexity.
9521
9522 @item iv-max-considered-uses
9523 The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more
9524 induction variable uses.
9525
9526 @item iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
9527 If the number of candidates in the set is smaller than this value,
9528 always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set
9529 when adding a new one.
9530
9531 @item scev-max-expr-size
9532 Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
9533 Large expressions slow the analyzer.
9534
9535 @item scev-max-expr-complexity
9536 Bound on the complexity of the expressions in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
9537 Complex expressions slow the analyzer.
9538
9539 @item omega-max-vars
9540 The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.
9541 The default value is 128.
9542
9543 @item omega-max-geqs
9544 The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.
9545 The default value is 256.
9546
9547 @item omega-max-eqs
9548 The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.
9549 The default value is 128.
9550
9551 @item omega-max-wild-cards
9552 The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver is
9553 able to insert. The default value is 18.
9554
9555 @item omega-hash-table-size
9556 The size of the hash table in the Omega solver. The default value is
9557 550.
9558
9559 @item omega-max-keys
9560 The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver. The default
9561 value is 500.
9562
9563 @item omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
9564 When set to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant
9565 constraints. The default value is 0.
9566
9567 @item vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
9568 The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
9569 doing loop versioning for alignment in the vectorizer.
9570
9571 @item vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
9572 The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
9573 doing loop versioning for alias in the vectorizer.
9574
9575 @item vect-max-peeling-for-alignment
9576 The maximum number of loop peels to enhance access alignment
9577 for vectorizer. Value -1 means 'no limit'.
9578
9579 @item max-iterations-to-track
9580 The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute-force algorithm
9581 for analysis of the number of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.
9582
9583 @item hot-bb-count-ws-permille
9584 A basic block profile count is considered hot if it contributes to
9585 the given permillage (i.e. 0...1000) of the entire profiled execution.
9586
9587 @item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
9588 Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in
9589 function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
9590
9591 @item max-predicted-iterations
9592 The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically. This is useful
9593 in cases where a function contains a single loop with known bound and
9594 another loop with unknown bound.
9595 The known number of iterations is predicted correctly, while
9596 the unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10. This means that the
9597 loop without bounds appears artificially cold relative to the other one.
9598
9599 @item builtin-expect-probability
9600 Control the probability of the expression having the specified value. This
9601 parameter takes a percentage (i.e. 0 ... 100) as input.
9602 The default probability of 90 is obtained empirically.
9603
9604 @item align-threshold
9605
9606 Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of a basic block in
9607 a function to align the basic block.
9608
9609 @item align-loop-iterations
9610
9611 A loop expected to iterate at least the selected number of iterations is
9612 aligned.
9613
9614 @item tracer-dynamic-coverage
9615 @itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
9616
9617 This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
9618 executed instructions is covered. This limits unnecessary code size
9619 expansion.
9620
9621 The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
9622 feedback is available. The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
9623 ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
9624
9625 @item tracer-max-code-growth
9626 Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage. This is
9627 a rather artificial limit, as most of the duplicates are eliminated later in
9628 cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
9629 growth.
9630
9631 @item tracer-min-branch-ratio
9632
9633 Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
9634 threshold (in percent).
9635
9636 @item tracer-min-branch-ratio
9637 @itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
9638
9639 Stop forward growth if the best edge has probability lower than this
9640 threshold.
9641
9642 Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
9643 compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without. The value
9644 for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
9645 order to make tracer effective.
9646
9647 @item max-cse-path-length
9648
9649 The maximum number of basic blocks on path that CSE considers.
9650 The default is 10.
9651
9652 @item max-cse-insns
9653 The maximum number of instructions CSE processes before flushing.
9654 The default is 1000.
9655
9656 @item ggc-min-expand
9657
9658 GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation. This
9659 parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
9660 collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
9661 Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
9662 generation.
9663
9664 The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when
9665 RAM >= 1GB@. If @code{getrlimit} is available, the notion of ``RAM'' is
9666 the smallest of actual RAM and @code{RLIMIT_DATA} or @code{RLIMIT_AS}. If
9667 GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower
9668 bound of 30% is used. Setting this parameter and
9669 @option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
9670 every opportunity. This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
9671 debugging.
9672
9673 @item ggc-min-heapsize
9674
9675 Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
9676 to collect garbage. The first collection occurs after the heap expands
9677 by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}. Again,
9678 tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
9679 generation.
9680
9681 The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit that
9682 tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but
9683 with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound of
9684 131072 (128 megabytes). If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
9685 particular platform, the lower bound is used. Setting this parameter
9686 very large effectively disables garbage collection. Setting this
9687 parameter and @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection
9688 to occur at every opportunity.
9689
9690 @item max-reload-search-insns
9691 The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward for equivalent
9692 register. Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
9693 compilation time increase with probably slightly better performance.
9694 The default value is 100.
9695
9696 @item max-cselib-memory-locations
9697 The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.
9698 Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time
9699 increase with probably slightly better performance. The default value is 500.
9700
9701 @item reorder-blocks-duplicate
9702 @itemx reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
9703
9704 Used by the basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional
9705 branch or duplicate the code on its destination. Code is duplicated when its
9706 estimated size is smaller than this value multiplied by the estimated size of
9707 unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.
9708
9709 The @option{reorder-block-duplicate-feedback} is used only when profile
9710 feedback is available. It may be set to higher values than
9711 @option{reorder-block-duplicate} since information about the hot spots is more
9712 accurate.
9713
9714 @item max-sched-ready-insns
9715 The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should
9716 consider at any given time during the first scheduling pass. Increasing
9717 values mean more thorough searches, making the compilation time increase
9718 with probably little benefit. The default value is 100.
9719
9720 @item max-sched-region-blocks
9721 The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
9722 interblock scheduling. The default value is 10.
9723
9724 @item max-pipeline-region-blocks
9725 The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
9726 pipelining in the selective scheduler. The default value is 15.
9727
9728 @item max-sched-region-insns
9729 The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
9730 interblock scheduling. The default value is 100.
9731
9732 @item max-pipeline-region-insns
9733 The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
9734 pipelining in the selective scheduler. The default value is 200.
9735
9736 @item min-spec-prob
9737 The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source block
9738 for interblock speculative scheduling. The default value is 40.
9739
9740 @item max-sched-extend-regions-iters
9741 The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
9742 A value of 0 (the default) disables region extensions.
9743
9744 @item max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
9745 The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for speculative motion.
9746 The default value is 3.
9747
9748 @item sched-spec-prob-cutoff
9749 The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents), so that
9750 speculative insns are scheduled.
9751 The default value is 40.
9752
9753 @item sched-spec-state-edge-prob-cutoff
9754 The minimum probability an edge must have for the scheduler to save its
9755 state across it.
9756 The default value is 10.
9757
9758 @item sched-mem-true-dep-cost
9759 Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load targeting same
9760 memory locations. The default value is 1.
9761
9762 @item selsched-max-lookahead
9763 The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective scheduling. It is a
9764 depth of search for available instructions.
9765 The default value is 50.
9766
9767 @item selsched-max-sched-times
9768 The maximum number of times that an instruction is scheduled during
9769 selective scheduling. This is the limit on the number of iterations
9770 through which the instruction may be pipelined. The default value is 2.
9771
9772 @item selsched-max-insns-to-rename
9773 The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered
9774 for renaming in the selective scheduler. The default value is 2.
9775
9776 @item sms-min-sc
9777 The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler
9778 generates. The default value is 2.
9779
9780 @item max-last-value-rtl
9781 The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression
9782 in combiner for a pseudo register as last known value of that register. The default
9783 is 10000.
9784
9785 @item integer-share-limit
9786 Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the
9787 compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed. This sets the maximum
9788 value of a shared integer constant. The default value is 256.
9789
9790 @item ssp-buffer-size
9791 The minimum size of buffers (i.e.@: arrays) that receive stack smashing
9792 protection when @option{-fstack-protection} is used.
9793
9794 @item min-size-for-stack-sharing
9795 The minimum size of variables taking part in stack slot sharing when not
9796 optimizing. The default value is 32.
9797
9798 @item max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
9799 Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be
9800 duplicated when threading jumps.
9801
9802 @item max-fields-for-field-sensitive
9803 Maximum number of fields in a structure treated in
9804 a field sensitive manner during pointer analysis. The default is zero
9805 for @option{-O0} and @option{-O1},
9806 and 100 for @option{-Os}, @option{-O2}, and @option{-O3}.
9807
9808 @item prefetch-latency
9809 Estimate on average number of instructions that are executed before
9810 prefetch finishes. The distance prefetched ahead is proportional
9811 to this constant. Increasing this number may also lead to less
9812 streams being prefetched (see @option{simultaneous-prefetches}).
9813
9814 @item simultaneous-prefetches
9815 Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.
9816
9817 @item l1-cache-line-size
9818 The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.
9819
9820 @item l1-cache-size
9821 The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.
9822
9823 @item l2-cache-size
9824 The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.
9825
9826 @item min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
9827 The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9828 number of prefetches to enable prefetching in a loop.
9829
9830 @item prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
9831 The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9832 number of memory references to enable prefetching in a loop.
9833
9834 @item use-canonical-types
9835 Whether the compiler should use the ``canonical'' type system. By
9836 default, this should always be 1, which uses a more efficient internal
9837 mechanism for comparing types in C++ and Objective-C++. However, if
9838 bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures,
9839 set this value to 0 to disable canonical types.
9840
9841 @item switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
9842 Switch initialization conversion refuses to create arrays that are
9843 bigger than @option{switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio} times the number of
9844 branches in the switch.
9845
9846 @item max-partial-antic-length
9847 Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the tree
9848 partial redundancy elimination optimization (@option{-ftree-pre}) when
9849 optimizing at @option{-O3} and above. For some sorts of source code
9850 the enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization can run away,
9851 consuming all of the memory available on the host machine. This
9852 parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets that are computed,
9853 which prevents the runaway behavior. Setting a value of 0 for
9854 this parameter allows an unlimited set length.
9855
9856 @item sccvn-max-scc-size
9857 Maximum size of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN
9858 processing. If this limit is hit, SCCVN processing for the whole
9859 function is not done and optimizations depending on it are
9860 disabled. The default maximum SCC size is 10000.
9861
9862 @item sccvn-max-alias-queries-per-access
9863 Maximum number of alias-oracle queries we perform when looking for
9864 redundancies for loads and stores. If this limit is hit the search
9865 is aborted and the load or store is not considered redundant. The
9866 number of queries is algorithmically limited to the number of
9867 stores on all paths from the load to the function entry.
9868 The default maxmimum number of queries is 1000.
9869
9870 @item ira-max-loops-num
9871 IRA uses regional register allocation by default. If a function
9872 contains more loops than the number given by this parameter, only at most
9873 the given number of the most frequently-executed loops form regions
9874 for regional register allocation. The default value of the
9875 parameter is 100.
9876
9877 @item ira-max-conflict-table-size
9878 Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the conflict
9879 table, the table can still require excessive amounts of memory for
9880 huge functions. If the conflict table for a function could be more
9881 than the size in MB given by this parameter, the register allocator
9882 instead uses a faster, simpler, and lower-quality
9883 algorithm that does not require building a pseudo-register conflict table.
9884 The default value of the parameter is 2000.
9885
9886 @item ira-loop-reserved-regs
9887 IRA can be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops
9888 for decisions to move loop invariants (see @option{-O3}). The number
9889 of available registers reserved for some other purposes is given
9890 by this parameter. The default value of the parameter is 2, which is
9891 the minimal number of registers needed by typical instructions.
9892 This value is the best found from numerous experiments.
9893
9894 @item loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
9895 Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compilation time and
9896 in amount of needed compile-time memory, with very large loops. Loops
9897 with more basic blocks than this parameter won't have loop invariant
9898 motion optimization performed on them. The default value of the
9899 parameter is 1000 for @option{-O1} and 10000 for @option{-O2} and above.
9900
9901 @item loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
9902 Building data dapendencies is expensive for very large loops. This
9903 parameter limits the number of data references in loops that are
9904 considered for data dependence analysis. These large loops are no
9905 handled by the optimizations using loop data dependencies.
9906 The default value is 1000.
9907
9908 @item max-vartrack-size
9909 Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during variable
9910 tracking dataflow analysis of any function. If this limit is exceeded
9911 with variable tracking at assignments enabled, analysis for that
9912 function is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from
9913 the function. If the limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var
9914 tracking analysis is completely disabled for the function. Setting
9915 the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.
9916
9917 @item max-vartrack-expr-depth
9918 Sets a maximum number of recursion levels when attempting to map
9919 variable names or debug temporaries to value expressions. This trades
9920 compilation time for more complete debug information. If this is set too
9921 low, value expressions that are available and could be represented in
9922 debug information may end up not being used; setting this higher may
9923 enable the compiler to find more complex debug expressions, but compile
9924 time and memory use may grow. The default is 12.
9925
9926 @item min-nondebug-insn-uid
9927 Use uids starting at this parameter for nondebug insns. The range below
9928 the parameter is reserved exclusively for debug insns created by
9929 @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, but debug insns may get
9930 (non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.
9931
9932 @item ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
9933 IPA-SRA replaces a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new
9934 parameters only when their cumulative size is less or equal to
9935 @option{ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor} times the size of the original
9936 pointer parameter.
9937
9938 @item tm-max-aggregate-size
9939 When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction, this
9940 parameter specifies the size in bytes after which variables are
9941 saved with the logging functions as opposed to save/restore code
9942 sequence pairs. This option only applies when using
9943 @option{-fgnu-tm}.
9944
9945 @item graphite-max-nb-scop-params
9946 To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms, the
9947 number of parameters in a Static Control Part (SCoP) is bounded. The
9948 default value is 10 parameters. A variable whose value is unknown at
9949 compilation time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.
9950
9951 @item graphite-max-bbs-per-function
9952 To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of
9953 the functions analyzed by Graphite is bounded. The default value is
9954 100 basic blocks.
9955
9956 @item loop-block-tile-size
9957 Loop blocking or strip mining transforms, enabled with
9958 @option{-floop-block} or @option{-floop-strip-mine}, strip mine each
9959 loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations. The strip
9960 length can be changed using the @option{loop-block-tile-size}
9961 parameter. The default value is 51 iterations.
9962
9963 @item ipa-cp-value-list-size
9964 IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed to a function's
9965 parameter in order to propagate them and perform devirtualization.
9966 @option{ipa-cp-value-list-size} is the maximum number of values and types it
9967 stores per one formal parameter of a function.
9968
9969 @item lto-partitions
9970 Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.
9971 The number of partitions should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.
9972 The default value is 32.
9973
9974 @item lto-minpartition
9975 Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in estimated instructions).
9976 This prevents expenses of splitting very small programs into too many
9977 partitions.
9978
9979 @item cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
9980 The maximum number of namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++
9981 name lookup fails for an identifier. The default is 1000.
9982
9983 @item sink-frequency-threshold
9984 The maximum relative execution frequency (in percents) of the target block
9985 relative to a statement's original block to allow statement sinking of a
9986 statement. Larger numbers result in more aggressive statement sinking.
9987 The default value is 75. A small positive adjustment is applied for
9988 statements with memory operands as those are even more profitable so sink.
9989
9990 @item max-stores-to-sink
9991 The maximum number of conditional stores paires that can be sunk. Set to 0
9992 if either vectorization (@option{-ftree-vectorize}) or if-conversion
9993 (@option{-ftree-loop-if-convert}) is disabled. The default is 2.
9994
9995 @item allow-load-data-races
9996 Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on loads.
9997 Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0. This option is enabled by default
9998 unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9999
10000 @item allow-store-data-races
10001 Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores.
10002 Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0. This option is enabled by default
10003 unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
10004
10005 @item allow-packed-load-data-races
10006 Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data loads.
10007 Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0. This option is enabled by default
10008 unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
10009
10010 @item allow-packed-store-data-races
10011 Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data stores.
10012 Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0. This option is enabled by default
10013 unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
10014
10015 @item case-values-threshold
10016 The smallest number of different values for which it is best to use a
10017 jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches. If the value is
10018 0, use the default for the machine. The default is 0.
10019
10020 @item tree-reassoc-width
10021 Set the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in
10022 reassociated tree. This parameter overrides target dependent
10023 heuristics used by default if has non zero value.
10024
10025 @item sched-pressure-algorithm
10026 Choose between the two available implementations of
10027 @option{-fsched-pressure}. Algorithm 1 is the original implementation
10028 and is the more likely to prevent instructions from being reordered.
10029 Algorithm 2 was designed to be a compromise between the relatively
10030 conservative approach taken by algorithm 1 and the rather aggressive
10031 approach taken by the default scheduler. It relies more heavily on
10032 having a regular register file and accurate register pressure classes.
10033 See @file{haifa-sched.c} in the GCC sources for more details.
10034
10035 The default choice depends on the target.
10036
10037 @item max-slsr-cand-scan
10038 Set the maximum number of existing candidates that will be considered when
10039 seeking a basis for a new straight-line strength reduction candidate.
10040
10041 @end table
10042 @end table
10043
10044 @node Preprocessor Options
10045 @section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
10046 @cindex preprocessor options
10047 @cindex options, preprocessor
10048
10049 These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
10050 file before actual compilation.
10051
10052 If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
10053 Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
10054 they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
10055 compilation.
10056
10057 @table @gcctabopt
10058 @item -Wp,@var{option}
10059 @opindex Wp
10060 You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
10061 and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor. If
10062 @var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
10063 commas. However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
10064 by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
10065 @option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase. The preprocessor's direct
10066 interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
10067 you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
10068 options instead.
10069
10070 @item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
10071 @opindex Xpreprocessor
10072 Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor. You can use this to
10073 supply system-specific preprocessor options that GCC does not
10074 recognize.
10075
10076 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
10077 @option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
10078
10079 @item -no-integrated-cpp
10080 @opindex no-integrated-cpp
10081 Perform preprocessing as a separate pass before compilation.
10082 By default, GCC performs preprocessing as an integrated part of
10083 input tokenization and parsing.
10084 If this option is provided, the appropriate language front end
10085 (@command{cc1}, @command{cc1plus}, or @command{cc1obj} for C, C++,
10086 and Objective-C, respectively) is instead invoked twice,
10087 once for preprocessing only and once for actual compilation
10088 of the preprocessed input.
10089 This option may be useful in conjunction with the @option{-B} or
10090 @option{-wrapper} options to specify an alternate preprocessor or
10091 perform additional processing of the program source between
10092 normal preprocessing and compilation.
10093 @end table
10094
10095 @include cppopts.texi
10096
10097 @node Assembler Options
10098 @section Passing Options to the Assembler
10099
10100 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10101 You can pass options to the assembler.
10102
10103 @table @gcctabopt
10104 @item -Wa,@var{option}
10105 @opindex Wa
10106 Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler. If @var{option}
10107 contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
10108
10109 @item -Xassembler @var{option}
10110 @opindex Xassembler
10111 Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler. You can use this to
10112 supply system-specific assembler options that GCC does not
10113 recognize.
10114
10115 If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
10116 @option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
10117
10118 @end table
10119
10120 @node Link Options
10121 @section Options for Linking
10122 @cindex link options
10123 @cindex options, linking
10124
10125 These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
10126 an executable output file. They are meaningless if the compiler is
10127 not doing a link step.
10128
10129 @table @gcctabopt
10130 @cindex file names
10131 @item @var{object-file-name}
10132 A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
10133 considered to name an object file or library. (Object files are
10134 distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
10135 contents.) If linking is done, these object files are used as input
10136 to the linker.
10137
10138 @item -c
10139 @itemx -S
10140 @itemx -E
10141 @opindex c
10142 @opindex S
10143 @opindex E
10144 If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
10145 object file names should not be used as arguments. @xref{Overall
10146 Options}.
10147
10148 @cindex Libraries
10149 @item -l@var{library}
10150 @itemx -l @var{library}
10151 @opindex l
10152 Search the library named @var{library} when linking. (The second
10153 alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
10154 POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
10155
10156 It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
10157 linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
10158 are specified. Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
10159 after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}. If @file{bar.o} refers
10160 to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
10161
10162 The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
10163 which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}. The linker
10164 then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
10165
10166 The directories searched include several standard system directories
10167 plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
10168
10169 Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
10170 whose members are object files. The linker handles an archive file by
10171 scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
10172 been referenced but not defined. But if the file that is found is an
10173 ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion. The only
10174 difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
10175 is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
10176 and searches several directories.
10177
10178 @item -lobjc
10179 @opindex lobjc
10180 You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
10181 link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
10182
10183 @item -nostartfiles
10184 @opindex nostartfiles
10185 Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
10186 The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
10187 or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
10188
10189 @item -nodefaultlibs
10190 @opindex nodefaultlibs
10191 Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
10192 Only the libraries you specify are passed to the linker, and options
10193 specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as @code{-static-libgcc}
10194 or @code{-shared-libgcc}, are ignored.
10195 The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
10196 is used.
10197
10198 The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp},
10199 @code{memset}, @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
10200 These entries are usually resolved by entries in
10201 libc. These entry points should be supplied through some other
10202 mechanism when this option is specified.
10203
10204 @item -nostdlib
10205 @opindex nostdlib
10206 Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
10207 No startup files and only the libraries you specify are passed to
10208 the linker, and options specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as
10209 @code{-static-libgcc} or @code{-shared-libgcc}, are ignored.
10210
10211 The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp}, @code{memset},
10212 @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
10213 These entries are usually resolved by entries in
10214 libc. These entry points should be supplied through some other
10215 mechanism when this option is specified.
10216
10217 @cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
10218 @cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
10219 @cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
10220 @cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
10221 @cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
10222 @cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
10223 One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
10224 @option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
10225 which GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
10226 needs for some languages.
10227 (@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
10228 Collection (GCC) Internals},
10229 for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
10230 In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
10231 other standard libraries. In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
10232 or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
10233 This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
10234 library subroutines.
10235 (An example of such an internal subroutine is @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
10236 constructors are called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
10237 GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
10238
10239 @item -pie
10240 @opindex pie
10241 Produce a position independent executable on targets that support it.
10242 For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
10243 used for compilation (@option{-fpie}, @option{-fPIE},
10244 or model suboptions) when you specify this linker option.
10245
10246 @item -rdynamic
10247 @opindex rdynamic
10248 Pass the flag @option{-export-dynamic} to the ELF linker, on targets
10249 that support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not
10250 only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed
10251 for some uses of @code{dlopen} or to allow obtaining backtraces
10252 from within a program.
10253
10254 @item -s
10255 @opindex s
10256 Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
10257
10258 @item -static
10259 @opindex static
10260 On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
10261 libraries. On other systems, this option has no effect.
10262
10263 @item -shared
10264 @opindex shared
10265 Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
10266 form an executable. Not all systems support this option. For predictable
10267 results, you must also specify the same set of options used for compilation
10268 (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions) when
10269 you specify this linker option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
10270 needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work. On
10271 multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
10272 libraries to link against. Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
10273 to subtle defects. Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
10274 is innocuous.}
10275
10276 @item -shared-libgcc
10277 @itemx -static-libgcc
10278 @opindex shared-libgcc
10279 @opindex static-libgcc
10280 On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
10281 force the use of either the shared or static version, respectively.
10282 If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
10283 configured, these options have no effect.
10284
10285 There are several situations in which an application should use the
10286 shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version. The most common
10287 of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
10288 across different shared libraries. In that case, each of the libraries
10289 as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
10290
10291 Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
10292 @option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
10293 executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
10294 this is the right thing to do.
10295
10296 If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
10297 find that they are not always linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
10298 If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU linker
10299 or a GNU linker that does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr},
10300 it links the shared version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries
10301 by default. Otherwise, it takes advantage of the linker and optimizes
10302 away the linking with the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with
10303 the static version of libgcc by default. This allows exceptions to
10304 propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring relocation
10305 costs at library load time.
10306
10307 However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
10308 exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
10309 for the languages used in the program, or using the option
10310 @option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
10311 @file{libgcc}.
10312
10313 @item -static-libasan
10314 @opindex static-libasan
10315 When the @option{-fsanitize=address} option is used to link a program,
10316 the GCC driver automatically links against @option{libasan}. If
10317 @file{libasan} is available as a shared library, and the @option{-static}
10318 option is not used, then this links against the shared version of
10319 @file{libasan}. The @option{-static-libasan} option directs the GCC
10320 driver to link @file{libasan} statically, without necessarily linking
10321 other libraries statically.
10322
10323 @item -static-libtsan
10324 @opindex static-libtsan
10325 When the @option{-fsanitize=thread} option is used to link a program,
10326 the GCC driver automatically links against @option{libtsan}. If
10327 @file{libtsan} is available as a shared library, and the @option{-static}
10328 option is not used, then this links against the shared version of
10329 @file{libtsan}. The @option{-static-libtsan} option directs the GCC
10330 driver to link @file{libtsan} statically, without necessarily linking
10331 other libraries statically.
10332
10333 @item -static-liblsan
10334 @opindex static-liblsan
10335 When the @option{-fsanitize=leak} option is used to link a program,
10336 the GCC driver automatically links against @option{liblsan}. If
10337 @file{liblsan} is available as a shared library, and the @option{-static}
10338 option is not used, then this links against the shared version of
10339 @file{liblsan}. The @option{-static-liblsan} option directs the GCC
10340 driver to link @file{liblsan} statically, without necessarily linking
10341 other libraries statically.
10342
10343 @item -static-libubsan
10344 @opindex static-libubsan
10345 When the @option{-fsanitize=undefined} option is used to link a program,
10346 the GCC driver automatically links against @option{libubsan}. If
10347 @file{libubsan} is available as a shared library, and the @option{-static}
10348 option is not used, then this links against the shared version of
10349 @file{libubsan}. The @option{-static-libubsan} option directs the GCC
10350 driver to link @file{libubsan} statically, without necessarily linking
10351 other libraries statically.
10352
10353 @item -static-libstdc++
10354 @opindex static-libstdc++
10355 When the @command{g++} program is used to link a C++ program, it
10356 normally automatically links against @option{libstdc++}. If
10357 @file{libstdc++} is available as a shared library, and the
10358 @option{-static} option is not used, then this links against the
10359 shared version of @file{libstdc++}. That is normally fine. However, it
10360 is sometimes useful to freeze the version of @file{libstdc++} used by
10361 the program without going all the way to a fully static link. The
10362 @option{-static-libstdc++} option directs the @command{g++} driver to
10363 link @file{libstdc++} statically, without necessarily linking other
10364 libraries statically.
10365
10366 @item -symbolic
10367 @opindex symbolic
10368 Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object. Warn
10369 about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
10370 option @option{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}). Only a few systems support
10371 this option.
10372
10373 @item -T @var{script}
10374 @opindex T
10375 @cindex linker script
10376 Use @var{script} as the linker script. This option is supported by most
10377 systems using the GNU linker. On some targets, such as bare-board
10378 targets without an operating system, the @option{-T} option may be required
10379 when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.
10380
10381 @item -Xlinker @var{option}
10382 @opindex Xlinker
10383 Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker. You can use this to
10384 supply system-specific linker options that GCC does not recognize.
10385
10386 If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use
10387 @option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
10388 For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
10389 @option{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}. It does not work to write
10390 @option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
10391 string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
10392
10393 When using the GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass
10394 arguments to linker options using the @option{@var{option}=@var{value}}
10395 syntax than as separate arguments. For example, you can specify
10396 @option{-Xlinker -Map=output.map} rather than
10397 @option{-Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map}. Other linkers may not support
10398 this syntax for command-line options.
10399
10400 @item -Wl,@var{option}
10401 @opindex Wl
10402 Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker. If @var{option} contains
10403 commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas. You can use this
10404 syntax to pass an argument to the option.
10405 For example, @option{-Wl,-Map,output.map} passes @option{-Map output.map} to the
10406 linker. When using the GNU linker, you can also get the same effect with
10407 @option{-Wl,-Map=output.map}.
10408
10409 @item -u @var{symbol}
10410 @opindex u
10411 Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
10412 library modules to define it. You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
10413 different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
10414 @end table
10415
10416 @node Directory Options
10417 @section Options for Directory Search
10418 @cindex directory options
10419 @cindex options, directory search
10420 @cindex search path
10421
10422 These options specify directories to search for header files, for
10423 libraries and for parts of the compiler:
10424
10425 @table @gcctabopt
10426 @item -I@var{dir}
10427 @opindex I
10428 Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
10429 searched for header files. This can be used to override a system header
10430 file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
10431 searched before the system header file directories. However, you should
10432 not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
10433 system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that). If you use more than
10434 one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
10435 order; the standard system directories come after.
10436
10437 If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
10438 @option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
10439 option is ignored. The directory is still searched but as a
10440 system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
10441 This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
10442 the ordering for the @code{include_next} directive are not inadvertently changed.
10443 If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
10444 use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
10445
10446 @item -iplugindir=@var{dir}
10447 @opindex iplugindir=
10448 Set the directory to search for plugins that are passed
10449 by @option{-fplugin=@var{name}} instead of
10450 @option{-fplugin=@var{path}/@var{name}.so}. This option is not meant
10451 to be used by the user, but only passed by the driver.
10452
10453 @item -iquote@var{dir}
10454 @opindex iquote
10455 Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to
10456 be searched for header files only for the case of @samp{#include
10457 "@var{file}"}; they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>},
10458 otherwise just like @option{-I}.
10459
10460 @item -L@var{dir}
10461 @opindex L
10462 Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
10463 for @option{-l}.
10464
10465 @item -B@var{prefix}
10466 @opindex B
10467 This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
10468 include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
10469
10470 The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
10471 @command{cpp}, @command{cc1}, @command{as} and @command{ld}. It tries
10472 @var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
10473 without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
10474
10475 For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
10476 @option{-B} prefix, if any. If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
10477 is not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes,
10478 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc/}. If neither of
10479 those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
10480 name is searched for using the directories specified in your
10481 @env{PATH} environment variable.
10482
10483 The compiler checks to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
10484 refers to a directory, and if necessary it adds a directory
10485 separator character at the end of the path.
10486
10487 @option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
10488 to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
10489 options into @option{-L} options for the linker. They also apply to
10490 include files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
10491 options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor. In this case,
10492 the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
10493
10494 The runtime support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
10495 the @option{-B} prefix, if needed. If it is not found there, the two
10496 standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all. The file is left
10497 out of the link if it is not found by those means.
10498
10499 Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
10500 the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}. @xref{Environment
10501 Variables}.
10502
10503 As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
10504 @file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
10505 9, then it is replaced by @file{[dir/]include}. This is to help
10506 with boot-strapping the compiler.
10507
10508 @item -specs=@var{file}
10509 @opindex specs
10510 Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
10511 file, in order to override the defaults which the @command{gcc} driver
10512 program uses when determining what switches to pass to @command{cc1},
10513 @command{cc1plus}, @command{as}, @command{ld}, etc. More than one
10514 @option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
10515 are processed in order, from left to right.
10516
10517 @item --sysroot=@var{dir}
10518 @opindex sysroot
10519 Use @var{dir} as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
10520 For example, if the compiler normally searches for headers in
10521 @file{/usr/include} and libraries in @file{/usr/lib}, it instead
10522 searches @file{@var{dir}/usr/include} and @file{@var{dir}/usr/lib}.
10523
10524 If you use both this option and the @option{-isysroot} option, then
10525 the @option{--sysroot} option applies to libraries, but the
10526 @option{-isysroot} option applies to header files.
10527
10528 The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support
10529 for this option. If your linker does not support this option, the
10530 header file aspect of @option{--sysroot} still works, but the
10531 library aspect does not.
10532
10533 @item --no-sysroot-suffix
10534 @opindex no-sysroot-suffix
10535 For some targets, a suffix is added to the root directory specified
10536 with @option{--sysroot}, depending on the other options used, so that
10537 headers may for example be found in
10538 @file{@var{dir}/@var{suffix}/usr/include} instead of
10539 @file{@var{dir}/usr/include}. This option disables the addition of
10540 such a suffix.
10541
10542 @item -I-
10543 @opindex I-
10544 This option has been deprecated. Please use @option{-iquote} instead for
10545 @option{-I} directories before the @option{-I-} and remove the @option{-I-}.
10546 Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
10547 option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
10548 they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
10549
10550 If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
10551 the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
10552 directives. (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
10553 this way.)
10554
10555 In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
10556 directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
10557 directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}. There is no way to
10558 override this effect of @option{-I-}. With @option{-I.} you can specify
10559 searching the directory that is current when the compiler is
10560 invoked. That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
10561 by default, but it is often satisfactory.
10562
10563 @option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
10564 for header files. Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
10565 independent.
10566 @end table
10567
10568 @c man end
10569
10570 @node Spec Files
10571 @section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
10572 @cindex Spec Files
10573
10574 @command{gcc} is a driver program. It performs its job by invoking a
10575 sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
10576 linking. GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
10577 deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
10578 it ought to place on their command lines. This behavior is controlled
10579 by @dfn{spec strings}. In most cases there is one spec string for each
10580 program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
10581 strings to control their behavior. The spec strings built into GCC can
10582 be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
10583 a spec file.
10584
10585 @dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
10586 strings. They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
10587 lines. The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
10588 character on the line, which can be one of the following:
10589
10590 @table @code
10591 @item %@var{command}
10592 Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor. The commands that can
10593 appear here are:
10594
10595 @table @code
10596 @item %include <@var{file}>
10597 @cindex @code{%include}
10598 Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
10599 specs file.
10600
10601 @item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
10602 @cindex @code{%include_noerr}
10603 Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
10604 file cannot be found.
10605
10606 @item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
10607 @cindex @code{%rename}
10608 Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
10609
10610 @end table
10611
10612 @item *[@var{spec_name}]:
10613 This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
10614 string. All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
10615 blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string. If this
10616 results in an empty string then the spec is deleted. (Or, if the
10617 spec did not exist, then nothing happens.) Otherwise, if the spec
10618 does not currently exist a new spec is created. If the spec does
10619 exist then its contents are overridden by the text of this
10620 directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
10621 character, in which case the text is appended to the spec.
10622
10623 @item [@var{suffix}]:
10624 Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair. All lines after this directive
10625 and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
10626 spec string for the indicated suffix. When the compiler encounters an
10627 input file with the named suffix, it processes the spec string in
10628 order to work out how to compile that file. For example:
10629
10630 @smallexample
10631 .ZZ:
10632 z-compile -input %i
10633 @end smallexample
10634
10635 This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
10636 passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
10637 command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
10638 @samp{%i} substitution. (See below.)
10639
10640 As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text following a
10641 suffix directive can be one of the following:
10642
10643 @table @code
10644 @item @@@var{language}
10645 This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}. This is
10646 similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
10647 language explicitly. For example:
10648
10649 @smallexample
10650 .ZZ:
10651 @@c++
10652 @end smallexample
10653
10654 Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
10655
10656 @item #@var{name}
10657 This causes an error messages saying:
10658
10659 @smallexample
10660 @var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
10661 @end smallexample
10662 @end table
10663
10664 GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
10665 This directive adds an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
10666 since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
10667 possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
10668
10669 @end table
10670
10671 GCC has the following spec strings built into it. Spec files can
10672 override these strings or create their own. Note that individual
10673 targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676 asm Options to pass to the assembler
10677 asm_final Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
10678 cpp Options to pass to the C preprocessor
10679 cc1 Options to pass to the C compiler
10680 cc1plus Options to pass to the C++ compiler
10681 endfile Object files to include at the end of the link
10682 link Options to pass to the linker
10683 lib Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
10684 libgcc Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
10685 linker Sets the name of the linker
10686 predefines Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
10687 signed_char Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
10688 by default
10689 startfile Object files to include at the start of the link
10690 @end smallexample
10691
10692 Here is a small example of a spec file:
10693
10694 @smallexample
10695 %rename lib old_lib
10696
10697 *lib:
10698 --start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
10699 @end smallexample
10700
10701 This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
10702 then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
10703 The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
10704 including the text of the old definition.
10705
10706 @dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
10707 corresponding program. In addition, the spec strings can contain
10708 @samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
10709 conditionally insert text into the command line. Using these constructs
10710 it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
10711
10712 Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
10713 strings. Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
10714 results of expanding these sequences. Therefore you can concatenate them
10715 together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @item %%
10719 Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
10720
10721 @item %i
10722 Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
10723
10724 @item %b
10725 Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
10726 This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
10727 and not including the directory.
10728
10729 @item %B
10730 This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
10731 the last period).
10732
10733 @item %d
10734 Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
10735 temporary file name, so that that file is deleted if GCC exits
10736 successfully. Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
10737 argument.
10738
10739 @item %g@var{suffix}
10740 Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
10741 once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
10742 @samp{%d}. To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
10743 name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
10744 chosen file names are known. For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
10745 might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}. @var{suffix} matches
10746 the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
10747 treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed. Previously, @samp{%g}
10748 was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
10749 without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
10750 just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
10751
10752 @item %u@var{suffix}
10753 Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name
10754 each time it appears instead of once per compilation.
10755
10756 @item %U@var{suffix}
10757 Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
10758 new one if there is no such last file name. In the absence of any
10759 @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
10760 the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
10761 involves the generation of two distinct file names, one
10762 for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}. Previously, @samp{%U} was
10763 simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
10764 without regard to any appended suffix.
10765
10766 @item %j@var{suffix}
10767 Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
10768 writable, and if @option{-save-temps} is not used;
10769 otherwise, substitute the name
10770 of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}. This temporary file is not
10771 meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
10772 disposal mechanism.
10773
10774 @item %|@var{suffix}
10775 @itemx %m@var{suffix}
10776 Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect. In that case
10777 @samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
10778 all. These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
10779 should read from standard input or write to standard output. If you
10780 need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
10781 construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
10782
10783 @item %.@var{SUFFIX}
10784 Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
10785 when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}. @var{SUFFIX} is
10786 terminated by the next space or %.
10787
10788 @item %w
10789 Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
10790 designated output file of this compilation. This puts the argument
10791 into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} substitutes.
10792
10793 @item %o
10794 Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
10795 automatically placed around them. You should write spaces
10796 around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
10797 @samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
10798 Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
10799 at all, but they are included among the output files, so they are
10800 linked.
10801
10802 @item %O
10803 Substitutes the suffix for object files. Note that this is
10804 handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
10805 because of the need for those to form complete file names. The
10806 handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
10807 been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
10808 support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they do
10809 following, for example, @samp{.o}.
10810
10811 @item %p
10812 Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
10813 current target machine. Use this when running @code{cpp}.
10814
10815 @item %P
10816 Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
10817 predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
10818 @samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter. This is for ISO
10819 C@.
10820
10821 @item %I
10822 Substitute any of @option{-iprefix} (made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}),
10823 @option{-isysroot} (made from @env{TARGET_SYSTEM_ROOT}),
10824 @option{-isystem} (made from @env{COMPILER_PATH} and @option{-B} options)
10825 and @option{-imultilib} as necessary.
10826
10827 @item %s
10828 Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
10829 Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
10830 the full name found. The current working directory is included in the
10831 list of directories scanned.
10832
10833 @item %T
10834 Current argument is the name of a linker script. Search for that file
10835 in the current list of directories to scan for libraries. If the file
10836 is located insert a @option{--script} option into the command line
10837 followed by the full path name found. If the file is not found then
10838 generate an error message. Note: the current working directory is not
10839 searched.
10840
10841 @item %e@var{str}
10842 Print @var{str} as an error message. @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
10843 Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
10844
10845 @item %(@var{name})
10846 Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
10847
10848 @item %x@{@var{option}@}
10849 Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
10850
10851 @item %X
10852 Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
10853 spec string.
10854
10855 @item %Y
10856 Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
10857
10858 @item %Z
10859 Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
10860
10861 @item %a
10862 Process the @code{asm} spec. This is used to compute the
10863 switches to be passed to the assembler.
10864
10865 @item %A
10866 Process the @code{asm_final} spec. This is a spec string for
10867 passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
10868 needed.
10869
10870 @item %l
10871 Process the @code{link} spec. This is the spec for computing the
10872 command line passed to the linker. Typically it makes use of the
10873 @samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
10874
10875 @item %D
10876 Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
10877 contain startup files. If the target supports multilibs then the
10878 current multilib directory is prepended to each of these paths.
10879
10880 @item %L
10881 Process the @code{lib} spec. This is a spec string for deciding which
10882 libraries are included on the command line to the linker.
10883
10884 @item %G
10885 Process the @code{libgcc} spec. This is a spec string for deciding
10886 which GCC support library is included on the command line to the linker.
10887
10888 @item %S
10889 Process the @code{startfile} spec. This is a spec for deciding which
10890 object files are the first ones passed to the linker. Typically
10891 this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
10892
10893 @item %E
10894 Process the @code{endfile} spec. This is a spec string that specifies
10895 the last object files that are passed to the linker.
10896
10897 @item %C
10898 Process the @code{cpp} spec. This is used to construct the arguments
10899 to be passed to the C preprocessor.
10900
10901 @item %1
10902 Process the @code{cc1} spec. This is used to construct the options to be
10903 passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
10904
10905 @item %2
10906 Process the @code{cc1plus} spec. This is used to construct the options to be
10907 passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
10908
10909 @item %*
10910 Substitute the variable part of a matched option. See below.
10911 Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
10912 a single space.
10913
10914 @item %<@code{S}
10915 Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line. Note---this
10916 command is position dependent. @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10917 before this one see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10918 after this one do not.
10919
10920 @item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
10921 Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
10922 @var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
10923 into an argument vector in the usual fashion. The function returns
10924 a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
10925 of the current spec.
10926
10927 The following built-in spec functions are provided:
10928
10929 @table @code
10930 @item @code{getenv}
10931 The @code{getenv} spec function takes two arguments: an environment
10932 variable name and a string. If the environment variable is not
10933 defined, a fatal error is issued. Otherwise, the return value is the
10934 value of the environment variable concatenated with the string. For
10935 example, if @env{TOPDIR} is defined as @file{/path/to/top}, then:
10936
10937 @smallexample
10938 %:getenv(TOPDIR /include)
10939 @end smallexample
10940
10941 expands to @file{/path/to/top/include}.
10942
10943 @item @code{if-exists}
10944 The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
10945 pathname to a file. If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
10946 pathname. Here is a small example of its usage:
10947
10948 @smallexample
10949 *startfile:
10950 crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 @item @code{if-exists-else}
10954 The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
10955 spec function, except that it takes two arguments. The first argument is
10956 an absolute pathname to a file. If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
10957 returns the pathname. If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
10958 This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
10959 based on the existence of the first. Here is a small example of its usage:
10960
10961 @smallexample
10962 *startfile:
10963 crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) \
10964 %:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
10965 @end smallexample
10966
10967 @item @code{replace-outfile}
10968 The @code{replace-outfile} spec function takes two arguments. It looks for the
10969 first argument in the outfiles array and replaces it with the second argument. Here
10970 is a small example of its usage:
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 %@{fgnu-runtime:%:replace-outfile(-lobjc -lobjc-gnu)@}
10974 @end smallexample
10975
10976 @item @code{remove-outfile}
10977 The @code{remove-outfile} spec function takes one argument. It looks for the
10978 first argument in the outfiles array and removes it. Here is a small example
10979 its usage:
10980
10981 @smallexample
10982 %:remove-outfile(-lm)
10983 @end smallexample
10984
10985 @item @code{pass-through-libs}
10986 The @code{pass-through-libs} spec function takes any number of arguments. It
10987 finds any @option{-l} options and any non-options ending in @file{.a} (which it
10988 assumes are the names of linker input library archive files) and returns a
10989 result containing all the found arguments each prepended by
10990 @option{-plugin-opt=-pass-through=} and joined by spaces. This list is
10991 intended to be passed to the LTO linker plugin.
10992
10993 @smallexample
10994 %:pass-through-libs(%G %L %G)
10995 @end smallexample
10996
10997 @item @code{print-asm-header}
10998 The @code{print-asm-header} function takes no arguments and simply
10999 prints a banner like:
11000
11001 @smallexample
11002 Assembler options
11003 =================
11004
11005 Use "-Wa,OPTION" to pass "OPTION" to the assembler.
11006 @end smallexample
11007
11008 It is used to separate compiler options from assembler options
11009 in the @option{--target-help} output.
11010 @end table
11011
11012 @item %@{@code{S}@}
11013 Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch is given to GCC@.
11014 If that switch is not specified, this substitutes nothing. Note that
11015 the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
11016 automatically inserted if the substitution is performed. Thus the spec
11017 string @samp{%@{foo@}} matches the command-line option @option{-foo}
11018 and outputs the command-line option @option{-foo}.
11019
11020 @item %W@{@code{S}@}
11021 Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
11022 deleted on failure.
11023
11024 @item %@{@code{S}*@}
11025 Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
11026 with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument. This is used for
11027 switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
11028 GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
11029 one switch whose name starts with @samp{o}. %@{o*@} substitutes this
11030 text, including the space. Thus two arguments are generated.
11031
11032 @item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
11033 Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
11034 (the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
11035 There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
11036 wild card is optional. Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
11037
11038 @item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11039 Substitutes @code{X}, if the @option{-S} switch is given to GCC@.
11040
11041 @item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11042 Substitutes @code{X}, if the @option{-S} switch is @emph{not} given to GCC@.
11043
11044 @item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
11045 Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
11046 @code{-S} are specified to GCC@. Normally @code{X} is substituted only
11047 once, no matter how many such switches appeared. However, if @code{%*}
11048 appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} is substituted once
11049 for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
11050 that switch matching the @code{*}.
11051
11052 If @code{%*} appears as the last part of a spec sequence then a space
11053 will be added after the end of the last substitution. If there is more
11054 text in the sequence however then a space will not be generated. This
11055 allows the @code{%*} substitution to be used as part of a larger
11056 string. For example, a spec string like this:
11057
11058 @smallexample
11059 %@{mcu=*:--script=%*/memory.ld@}
11060 @end smallexample
11061
11062 when matching an option like @code{-mcu=newchip} will produce:
11063
11064 @smallexample
11065 --script=newchip/memory.ld
11066 @end smallexample
11067
11068 @item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11069 Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
11070
11071 @item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11072 Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
11073
11074 @item %@{,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11075 Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file for language @code{S}.
11076
11077 @item %@{!,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
11078 Substitutes @code{X}, if not processing a file for language @code{S}.
11079
11080 @item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
11081 Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} is given to
11082 GCC@. This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, @samp{,}, and
11083 @code{*} sequences as well, although they have a stronger binding than
11084 the @samp{|}. If @code{%*} appears in @code{X}, all of the
11085 alternatives must be starred, and only the first matching alternative
11086 is substituted.
11087
11088 For example, a spec string like this:
11089
11090 @smallexample
11091 %@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 @noindent
11095 outputs the following command-line options from the following input
11096 command-line options:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 fred.c -foo -baz
11100 jim.d -bar -boggle
11101 -d fred.c -foo -baz -boggle
11102 -d jim.d -bar -baz -boggle
11103 @end smallexample
11104
11105 @item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
11106
11107 If @code{S} is given to GCC, substitutes @code{X}; else if @code{T} is
11108 given to GCC, substitutes @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}. There can
11109 be as many clauses as you need. This may be combined with @code{.},
11110 @code{,}, @code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
11111
11112
11113 @end table
11114
11115 The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
11116 construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
11117 even newlines. They are processed as usual, as described above.
11118 Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored. White space may also
11119 appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
11120 except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
11121
11122 The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
11123 handled specifically in these constructs. If another value of
11124 @option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
11125 @option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
11126 switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
11127 just one letter, which passes all matching options.
11128
11129 The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
11130 indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
11131 only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
11132
11133 It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
11134 (You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
11135 compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments. But this cannot
11136 be done in a consistent fashion. GCC cannot even decide which input
11137 files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
11138 and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
11139 compilers to run).
11140
11141 GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
11142 treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
11143 proper position among the other output files.
11144
11145 @c man begin OPTIONS
11146
11147 @node Target Options
11148 @section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
11149 @cindex target options
11150 @cindex cross compiling
11151 @cindex specifying machine version
11152 @cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
11153 @cindex compiler version, specifying
11154 @cindex target machine, specifying
11155
11156 The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @command{gcc}, or
11157 @command{@var{machine}-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
11158 @command{@var{machine}-gcc-@var{version}} to run a version other than the
11159 one that was installed last.
11160
11161 @node Submodel Options
11162 @section Hardware Models and Configurations
11163 @cindex submodel options
11164 @cindex specifying hardware config
11165 @cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
11166 @cindex machine dependent options
11167
11168 Each target machine types can have its own
11169 special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
11170 hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
11171 floating coprocessor or none. A single installed version of the
11172 compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
11173 options specified.
11174
11175 Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
11176 options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
11177 platform.
11178
11179 @c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
11180 @c It should be the same order and spelling as these options are listed
11181 @c in Machine Dependent Options
11182
11183 @menu
11184 * AArch64 Options::
11185 * Adapteva Epiphany Options::
11186 * ARC Options::
11187 * ARM Options::
11188 * AVR Options::
11189 * Blackfin Options::
11190 * C6X Options::
11191 * CRIS Options::
11192 * CR16 Options::
11193 * Darwin Options::
11194 * DEC Alpha Options::
11195 * FR30 Options::
11196 * FRV Options::
11197 * GNU/Linux Options::
11198 * H8/300 Options::
11199 * HPPA Options::
11200 * i386 and x86-64 Options::
11201 * i386 and x86-64 Windows Options::
11202 * IA-64 Options::
11203 * LM32 Options::
11204 * M32C Options::
11205 * M32R/D Options::
11206 * M680x0 Options::
11207 * MCore Options::
11208 * MeP Options::
11209 * MicroBlaze Options::
11210 * MIPS Options::
11211 * MMIX Options::
11212 * MN10300 Options::
11213 * Moxie Options::
11214 * MSP430 Options::
11215 * NDS32 Options::
11216 * PDP-11 Options::
11217 * picoChip Options::
11218 * PowerPC Options::
11219 * RL78 Options::
11220 * RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
11221 * RX Options::
11222 * S/390 and zSeries Options::
11223 * Score Options::
11224 * SH Options::
11225 * Solaris 2 Options::
11226 * SPARC Options::
11227 * SPU Options::
11228 * System V Options::
11229 * TILE-Gx Options::
11230 * TILEPro Options::
11231 * V850 Options::
11232 * VAX Options::
11233 * VMS Options::
11234 * VxWorks Options::
11235 * x86-64 Options::
11236 * Xstormy16 Options::
11237 * Xtensa Options::
11238 * zSeries Options::
11239 @end menu
11240
11241 @node AArch64 Options
11242 @subsection AArch64 Options
11243 @cindex AArch64 Options
11244
11245 These options are defined for AArch64 implementations:
11246
11247 @table @gcctabopt
11248
11249 @item -mabi=@var{name}
11250 @opindex mabi
11251 Generate code for the specified data model. Permissible values
11252 are @samp{ilp32} for SysV-like data model where int, long int and pointer
11253 are 32-bit, and @samp{lp64} for SysV-like data model where int is 32-bit,
11254 but long int and pointer are 64-bit.
11255
11256 The default depends on the specific target configuration. Note that
11257 the LP64 and ILP32 ABIs are not link-compatible; you must compile your
11258 entire program with the same ABI, and link with a compatible set of libraries.
11259
11260 @item -mbig-endian
11261 @opindex mbig-endian
11262 Generate big-endian code. This is the default when GCC is configured for an
11263 @samp{aarch64_be-*-*} target.
11264
11265 @item -mgeneral-regs-only
11266 @opindex mgeneral-regs-only
11267 Generate code which uses only the general registers.
11268
11269 @item -mlittle-endian
11270 @opindex mlittle-endian
11271 Generate little-endian code. This is the default when GCC is configured for an
11272 @samp{aarch64-*-*} but not an @samp{aarch64_be-*-*} target.
11273
11274 @item -mcmodel=tiny
11275 @opindex mcmodel=tiny
11276 Generate code for the tiny code model. The program and its statically defined
11277 symbols must be within 1GB of each other. Pointers are 64 bits. Programs can
11278 be statically or dynamically linked. This model is not fully implemented and
11279 mostly treated as @samp{small}.
11280
11281 @item -mcmodel=small
11282 @opindex mcmodel=small
11283 Generate code for the small code model. The program and its statically defined
11284 symbols must be within 4GB of each other. Pointers are 64 bits. Programs can
11285 be statically or dynamically linked. This is the default code model.
11286
11287 @item -mcmodel=large
11288 @opindex mcmodel=large
11289 Generate code for the large code model. This makes no assumptions about
11290 addresses and sizes of sections. Pointers are 64 bits. Programs can be
11291 statically linked only.
11292
11293 @item -mstrict-align
11294 @opindex mstrict-align
11295 Do not assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
11296
11297 @item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11298 @itemx -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
11299 @opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11300 @opindex mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer
11301 Omit or keep the frame pointer in leaf functions. The former behaviour is the
11302 default.
11303
11304 @item -mtls-dialect=desc
11305 @opindex mtls-dialect=desc
11306 Use TLS descriptors as the thread-local storage mechanism for dynamic accesses
11307 of TLS variables. This is the default.
11308
11309 @item -mtls-dialect=traditional
11310 @opindex mtls-dialect=traditional
11311 Use traditional TLS as the thread-local storage mechanism for dynamic accesses
11312 of TLS variables.
11313
11314 @item -march=@var{name}
11315 @opindex march
11316 Specify the name of the target architecture, optionally suffixed by one or
11317 more feature modifiers. This option has the form
11318 @option{-march=@var{arch}@r{@{}+@r{[}no@r{]}@var{feature}@r{@}*}}, where the
11319 only value for @var{arch} is @samp{armv8-a}. The possible values for
11320 @var{feature} are documented in the sub-section below.
11321
11322 Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most feature is
11323 used.
11324
11325 GCC uses this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when
11326 generating assembly code. This option can be used in conjunction with or
11327 instead of the @option{-mcpu=} option.
11328
11329 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
11330 @opindex mcpu
11331 Specify the name of the target processor, optionally suffixed by one or more
11332 feature modifiers. This option has the form
11333 @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{@{}+@r{[}no@r{]}@var{feature}@r{@}*}}, where the
11334 possible values for @var{cpu} are @samp{generic}, @samp{cortex-a53},
11335 @samp{cortex-a57}. The possible values for @var{feature} are documented
11336 in the sub-section below.
11337
11338 Additionally, this option can specify that the target is a big.LITTLE system.
11339 The only possible value is @samp{cortex-a57.cortex-a53}.
11340
11341 Where conflicting feature modifiers are specified, the right-most feature is
11342 used.
11343
11344 GCC uses this name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when
11345 generating assembly code.
11346
11347 @item -mtune=@var{name}
11348 @opindex mtune
11349 Specify the name of the processor to tune the performance for. The code will
11350 be tuned as if the target processor were of the type specified in this option,
11351 but still using instructions compatible with the target processor specified
11352 by a @option{-mcpu=} option. Where no @option{-mtune=} option is
11353 specified, the code will be tuned to perform well on the target processor
11354 given by @option{-mcpu=} or @option{-march=}. Where none of
11355 @option{-mtune=}, @option{-mcpu=} or @option{-march=} are specified,
11356 the code will be tuned to perform well across a range of target
11357 processors. This option cannot be suffixed by feature modifiers.
11358
11359 @end table
11360
11361 @subsubsection @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu} feature modifiers
11362 @cindex @option{-march} feature modifiers
11363 @cindex @option{-mcpu} feature modifiers
11364 Feature modifiers used with @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu} can be one
11365 the following:
11366
11367 @table @samp
11368 @item crc
11369 Enable CRC extension.
11370 @item crypto
11371 Enable Crypto extension. This implies Advanced SIMD is enabled.
11372 @item fp
11373 Enable floating-point instructions.
11374 @item simd
11375 Enable Advanced SIMD instructions. This implies floating-point instructions
11376 are enabled. This is the default for all current possible values for options
11377 @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu=}.
11378 @end table
11379
11380 @node Adapteva Epiphany Options
11381 @subsection Adapteva Epiphany Options
11382
11383 These @samp{-m} options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:
11384
11385 @table @gcctabopt
11386 @item -mhalf-reg-file
11387 @opindex mhalf-reg-file
11388 Don't allocate any register in the range @code{r32}@dots{}@code{r63}.
11389 That allows code to run on hardware variants that lack these registers.
11390
11391 @item -mprefer-short-insn-regs
11392 @opindex mprefer-short-insn-regs
11393 Preferrentially allocate registers that allow short instruction generation.
11394 This can result in increased instruction count, so this may either reduce or
11395 increase overall code size.
11396
11397 @item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
11398 @opindex mbranch-cost
11399 Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
11400 This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
11401 consistent results across releases.
11402
11403 @item -mcmove
11404 @opindex mcmove
11405 Enable the generation of conditional moves.
11406
11407 @item -mnops=@var{num}
11408 @opindex mnops
11409 Emit @var{num} NOPs before every other generated instruction.
11410
11411 @item -mno-soft-cmpsf
11412 @opindex mno-soft-cmpsf
11413 For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an @code{fsub} instruction
11414 and test the flags. This is faster than a software comparison, but can
11415 get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs, or when two different small
11416 numbers are compared such that their difference is calculated as zero.
11417 The default is @option{-msoft-cmpsf}, which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant,
11418 software comparisons.
11419
11420 @item -mstack-offset=@var{num}
11421 @opindex mstack-offset
11422 Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.
11423 E.g., a value of 8 means that the eight bytes in the range @code{sp+0@dots{}sp+7}
11424 can be used by leaf functions without stack allocation.
11425 Values other than @samp{8} or @samp{16} are untested and unlikely to work.
11426 Note also that this option changes the ABI; compiling a program with a
11427 different stack offset than the libraries have been compiled with
11428 generally does not work.
11429 This option can be useful if you want to evaluate if a different stack
11430 offset would give you better code, but to actually use a different stack
11431 offset to build working programs, it is recommended to configure the
11432 toolchain with the appropriate @option{--with-stack-offset=@var{num}} option.
11433
11434 @item -mno-round-nearest
11435 @opindex mno-round-nearest
11436 Make the scheduler assume that the rounding mode has been set to
11437 truncating. The default is @option{-mround-nearest}.
11438
11439 @item -mlong-calls
11440 @opindex mlong-calls
11441 If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might be beyond
11442 the offset range of the @code{b} / @code{bl} instructions, and therefore load the
11443 function address into a register before performing a (otherwise direct) call.
11444 This is the default.
11445
11446 @item -mshort-calls
11447 @opindex short-calls
11448 If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls are
11449 in the range of the @code{b} / @code{bl} instructions, so use these instructions
11450 for direct calls. The default is @option{-mlong-calls}.
11451
11452 @item -msmall16
11453 @opindex msmall16
11454 Assume addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values. This does not
11455 apply to function addresses for which @option{-mlong-calls} semantics
11456 are in effect.
11457
11458 @item -mfp-mode=@var{mode}
11459 @opindex mfp-mode
11460 Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit.
11461 This determines the floating-point mode that is provided and expected
11462 at function call and return time. Making this mode match the mode you
11463 predominantly need at function start can make your programs smaller and
11464 faster by avoiding unnecessary mode switches.
11465
11466 @var{mode} can be set to one the following values:
11467
11468 @table @samp
11469 @item caller
11470 Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored when
11471 the function returns, and when it calls other functions.
11472 This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other compilation units
11473 you might want to incorporate into different programs with different
11474 prevailing FPU modes, and the convenience of being able to use a single
11475 object file outweighs the size and speed overhead for any extra
11476 mode switching that might be needed, compared with what would be needed
11477 with a more specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.
11478
11479 @item truncate
11480 This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
11481 truncating (i.e.@: round towards zero) rounding mode. That includes
11482 conversion from floating point to integer.
11483
11484 @item round-nearest
11485 This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
11486 round-to-nearest-or-even rounding mode.
11487
11488 @item int
11489 This is the mode used to perform integer calculations in the FPU, e.g.@:
11490 integer multiply, or integer multiply-and-accumulate.
11491 @end table
11492
11493 The default is @option{-mfp-mode=caller}
11494
11495 @item -mnosplit-lohi
11496 @itemx -mno-postinc
11497 @itemx -mno-postmodify
11498 @opindex mnosplit-lohi
11499 @opindex mno-postinc
11500 @opindex mno-postmodify
11501 Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of 32-bit
11502 loads, generation of post-increment addresses, and generation of
11503 post-modify addresses. The defaults are @option{msplit-lohi},
11504 @option{-mpost-inc}, and @option{-mpost-modify}.
11505
11506 @item -mnovect-double
11507 @opindex mno-vect-double
11508 Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode. The default is
11509 @option{-mvect-double}, which uses DImode as preferred SIMD mode.
11510
11511 @item -max-vect-align=@var{num}
11512 @opindex max-vect-align
11513 The maximum alignment for SIMD vector mode types.
11514 @var{num} may be 4 or 8. The default is 8.
11515 Note that this is an ABI change, even though many library function
11516 interfaces are unaffected if they don't use SIMD vector modes
11517 in places that affect size and/or alignment of relevant types.
11518
11519 @item -msplit-vecmove-early
11520 @opindex msplit-vecmove-early
11521 Split vector moves into single word moves before reload. In theory this
11522 can give better register allocation, but so far the reverse seems to be
11523 generally the case.
11524
11525 @item -m1reg-@var{reg}
11526 @opindex m1reg-
11527 Specify a register to hold the constant @minus{}1, which makes loading small negative
11528 constants and certain bitmasks faster.
11529 Allowable values for @var{reg} are @samp{r43} and @samp{r63},
11530 which specify use of that register as a fixed register,
11531 and @samp{none}, which means that no register is used for this
11532 purpose. The default is @option{-m1reg-none}.
11533
11534 @end table
11535
11536 @node ARC Options
11537 @subsection ARC Options
11538 @cindex ARC options
11539
11540 The following options control the architecture variant for which code
11541 is being compiled:
11542
11543 @c architecture variants
11544 @table @gcctabopt
11545
11546 @item -mbarrel-shifter
11547 @opindex mbarrel-shifter
11548 Generate instructions supported by barrel shifter. This is the default
11549 unless @samp{-mcpu=ARC601} is in effect.
11550
11551 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
11552 @opindex mcpu
11553 Set architecture type, register usage, and instruction scheduling
11554 parameters for @var{cpu}. There are also shortcut alias options
11555 available for backward compatibility and convenience. Supported
11556 values for @var{cpu} are
11557
11558 @table @samp
11559 @opindex mA6
11560 @opindex mARC600
11561 @item ARC600
11562 Compile for ARC600. Aliases: @option{-mA6}, @option{-mARC600}.
11563
11564 @item ARC601
11565 @opindex mARC601
11566 Compile for ARC601. Alias: @option{-mARC601}.
11567
11568 @item ARC700
11569 @opindex mA7
11570 @opindex mARC700
11571 Compile for ARC700. Aliases: @option{-mA7}, @option{-mARC700}.
11572 This is the default when configured with @samp{--with-cpu=arc700}@.
11573 @end table
11574
11575 @item -mdpfp
11576 @opindex mdpfp
11577 @itemx -mdpfp-compact
11578 @opindex mdpfp-compact
11579 FPX: Generate Double Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact
11580 implementation.
11581
11582 @item -mdpfp-fast
11583 @opindex mdpfp-fast
11584 FPX: Generate Double Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast
11585 implementation.
11586
11587 @item -mno-dpfp-lrsr
11588 @opindex mno-dpfp-lrsr
11589 Disable LR and SR instructions from using FPX extension aux registers.
11590
11591 @item -mea
11592 @opindex mea
11593 Generate Extended arithmetic instructions. Currently only
11594 @code{divaw}, @code{adds}, @code{subs}, and @code{sat16} are
11595 supported. This is always enabled for @samp{-mcpu=ARC700}.
11596
11597 @item -mno-mpy
11598 @opindex mno-mpy
11599 Do not generate mpy instructions for ARC700.
11600
11601 @item -mmul32x16
11602 @opindex mmul32x16
11603 Generate 32x16 bit multiply and mac instructions.
11604
11605 @item -mmul64
11606 @opindex mmul64
11607 Generate mul64 and mulu64 instructions. Only valid for @samp{-mcpu=ARC600}.
11608
11609 @item -mnorm
11610 @opindex mnorm
11611 Generate norm instruction. This is the default if @samp{-mcpu=ARC700}
11612 is in effect.
11613
11614 @item -mspfp
11615 @opindex mspfp
11616 @itemx -mspfp-compact
11617 @opindex mspfp-compact
11618 FPX: Generate Single Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the compact
11619 implementation.
11620
11621 @item -mspfp-fast
11622 @opindex mspfp-fast
11623 FPX: Generate Single Precision FPX instructions, tuned for the fast
11624 implementation.
11625
11626 @item -msimd
11627 @opindex msimd
11628 Enable generation of ARC SIMD instructions via target-specific
11629 builtins. Only valid for @samp{-mcpu=ARC700}.
11630
11631 @item -msoft-float
11632 @opindex msoft-float
11633 This option ignored; it is provided for compatibility purposes only.
11634 Software floating point code is emitted by default, and this default
11635 can overridden by FPX options; @samp{mspfp}, @samp{mspfp-compact}, or
11636 @samp{mspfp-fast} for single precision, and @samp{mdpfp},
11637 @samp{mdpfp-compact}, or @samp{mdpfp-fast} for double precision.
11638
11639 @item -mswap
11640 @opindex mswap
11641 Generate swap instructions.
11642
11643 @end table
11644
11645 The following options are passed through to the assembler, and also
11646 define preprocessor macro symbols.
11647
11648 @c Flags used by the assembler, but for which we define preprocessor
11649 @c macro symbols as well.
11650 @table @gcctabopt
11651 @item -mdsp-packa
11652 @opindex mdsp-packa
11653 Passed down to the assembler to enable the DSP Pack A extensions.
11654 Also sets the preprocessor symbol @code{__Xdsp_packa}.
11655
11656 @item -mdvbf
11657 @opindex mdvbf
11658 Passed down to the assembler to enable the dual viterbi butterfly
11659 extension. Also sets the preprocessor symbol @code{__Xdvbf}.
11660
11661 @c ARC700 4.10 extension instruction
11662 @item -mlock
11663 @opindex mlock
11664 Passed down to the assembler to enable the Locked Load/Store
11665 Conditional extension. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11666 @code{__Xlock}.
11667
11668 @item -mmac-d16
11669 @opindex mmac-d16
11670 Passed down to the assembler. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11671 @code{__Xxmac_d16}.
11672
11673 @item -mmac-24
11674 @opindex mmac-24
11675 Passed down to the assembler. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11676 @code{__Xxmac_24}.
11677
11678 @c ARC700 4.10 extension instruction
11679 @item -mrtsc
11680 @opindex mrtsc
11681 Passed down to the assembler to enable the 64-bit Time-Stamp Counter
11682 extension instruction. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11683 @code{__Xrtsc}.
11684
11685 @c ARC700 4.10 extension instruction
11686 @item -mswape
11687 @opindex mswape
11688 Passed down to the assembler to enable the swap byte ordering
11689 extension instruction. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11690 @code{__Xswape}.
11691
11692 @item -mtelephony
11693 @opindex mtelephony
11694 Passed down to the assembler to enable dual and single operand
11695 instructions for telephony. Also sets the preprocessor symbol
11696 @code{__Xtelephony}.
11697
11698 @item -mxy
11699 @opindex mxy
11700 Passed down to the assembler to enable the XY Memory extension. Also
11701 sets the preprocessor symbol @code{__Xxy}.
11702
11703 @end table
11704
11705 The following options control how the assembly code is annotated:
11706
11707 @c Assembly annotation options
11708 @table @gcctabopt
11709 @item -misize
11710 @opindex misize
11711 Annotate assembler instructions with estimated addresses.
11712
11713 @item -mannotate-align
11714 @opindex mannotate-align
11715 Explain what alignment considerations lead to the decision to make an
11716 instruction short or long.
11717
11718 @end table
11719
11720 The following options are passed through to the linker:
11721
11722 @c options passed through to the linker
11723 @table @gcctabopt
11724 @item -marclinux
11725 @opindex marclinux
11726 Passed through to the linker, to specify use of the @code{arclinux} emulation.
11727 This option is enabled by default in tool chains built for
11728 @w{@code{arc-linux-uclibc}} and @w{@code{arceb-linux-uclibc}} targets
11729 when profiling is not requested.
11730
11731 @item -marclinux_prof
11732 @opindex marclinux_prof
11733 Passed through to the linker, to specify use of the
11734 @code{arclinux_prof} emulation. This option is enabled by default in
11735 tool chains built for @w{@code{arc-linux-uclibc}} and
11736 @w{@code{arceb-linux-uclibc}} targets when profiling is requested.
11737
11738 @end table
11739
11740 The following options control the semantics of generated code:
11741
11742 @c semantically relevant code generation options
11743 @table @gcctabopt
11744 @item -mepilogue-cfi
11745 @opindex mepilogue-cfi
11746 Enable generation of call frame information for epilogues.
11747
11748 @item -mno-epilogue-cfi
11749 @opindex mno-epilogue-cfi
11750 Disable generation of call frame information for epilogues.
11751
11752 @item -mlong-calls
11753 @opindex mlong-calls
11754 Generate call insns as register indirect calls, thus providing access
11755 to the full 32-bit address range.
11756
11757 @item -mmedium-calls
11758 @opindex mmedium-calls
11759 Don't use less than 25 bit addressing range for calls, which is the
11760 offset available for an unconditional branch-and-link
11761 instruction. Conditional execution of function calls is suppressed, to
11762 allow use of the 25-bit range, rather than the 21-bit range with
11763 conditional branch-and-link. This is the default for tool chains built
11764 for @w{@code{arc-linux-uclibc}} and @w{@code{arceb-linux-uclibc}} targets.
11765
11766 @item -mno-sdata
11767 @opindex mno-sdata
11768 Do not generate sdata references. This is the default for tool chains
11769 built for @w{@code{arc-linux-uclibc}} and @w{@code{arceb-linux-uclibc}}
11770 targets.
11771
11772 @item -mucb-mcount
11773 @opindex mucb-mcount
11774 Instrument with mcount calls as used in UCB code. I.e. do the
11775 counting in the callee, not the caller. By default ARC instrumentation
11776 counts in the caller.
11777
11778 @item -mvolatile-cache
11779 @opindex mvolatile-cache
11780 Use ordinarily cached memory accesses for volatile references. This is the
11781 default.
11782
11783 @item -mno-volatile-cache
11784 @opindex mno-volatile-cache
11785 Enable cache bypass for volatile references.
11786
11787 @end table
11788
11789 The following options fine tune code generation:
11790 @c code generation tuning options
11791 @table @gcctabopt
11792 @item -malign-call
11793 @opindex malign-call
11794 Do alignment optimizations for call instructions.
11795
11796 @item -mauto-modify-reg
11797 @opindex mauto-modify-reg
11798 Enable the use of pre/post modify with register displacement.
11799
11800 @item -mbbit-peephole
11801 @opindex mbbit-peephole
11802 Enable bbit peephole2.
11803
11804 @item -mno-brcc
11805 @opindex mno-brcc
11806 This option disables a target-specific pass in @file{arc_reorg} to
11807 generate @code{BRcc} instructions. It has no effect on @code{BRcc}
11808 generation driven by the combiner pass.
11809
11810 @item -mcase-vector-pcrel
11811 @opindex mcase-vector-pcrel
11812 Use pc-relative switch case tables - this enables case table shortening.
11813 This is the default for @option{-Os}.
11814
11815 @item -mcompact-casesi
11816 @opindex mcompact-casesi
11817 Enable compact casesi pattern.
11818 This is the default for @option{-Os}.
11819
11820 @item -mno-cond-exec
11821 @opindex mno-cond-exec
11822 Disable ARCompact specific pass to generate conditional execution instructions.
11823 Due to delay slot scheduling and interactions between operand numbers,
11824 literal sizes, instruction lengths, and the support for conditional execution,
11825 the target-independent pass to generate conditional execution is often lacking,
11826 so the ARC port has kept a special pass around that tries to find more
11827 conditional execution generating opportunities after register allocation,
11828 branch shortening, and delay slot scheduling have been done. This pass
11829 generally, but not always, improves performance and code size, at the cost of
11830 extra compilation time, which is why there is an option to switch it off.
11831 If you have a problem with call instructions exceeding their allowable
11832 offset range because they are conditionalized, you should consider using
11833 @option{-mmedium-calls} instead.
11834
11835 @item -mearly-cbranchsi
11836 @opindex mearly-cbranchsi
11837 Enable pre-reload use of the cbranchsi pattern.
11838
11839 @item -mexpand-adddi
11840 @opindex mexpand-adddi
11841 Expand @code{adddi3} and @code{subdi3} at rtl generation time into
11842 @code{add.f}, @code{adc} etc.
11843
11844 @item -mindexed-loads
11845 @opindex mindexed-loads
11846 Enable the use of indexed loads. This can be problematic because some
11847 optimizers will then assume the that indexed stores exist, which is not
11848 the case.
11849
11850 @item -mlra
11851 @opindex mlra
11852 Enable Local Register Allocation. This is still experimental for ARC,
11853 so by default the compiler uses standard reload
11854 (i.e. @samp{-mno-lra}).
11855
11856 @item -mlra-priority-none
11857 @opindex mlra-priority-none
11858 Don't indicate any priority for target registers.
11859
11860 @item -mlra-priority-compact
11861 @opindex mlra-priority-compact
11862 Indicate target register priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.
11863
11864 @item -mlra-priority-noncompact
11865 @opindex mlra-priority-noncompact
11866 Reduce target regsiter priority for r0..r3 / r12..r15.
11867
11868 @item -mno-millicode
11869 @opindex mno-millicode
11870 When optimizing for size (using @option{-Os}), prologues and epilogues
11871 that have to save or restore a large number of registers are often
11872 shortened by using call to a special function in libgcc; this is
11873 referred to as a @emph{millicode} call. As these calls can pose
11874 performance issues, and/or cause linking issues when linking in a
11875 nonstandard way, this option is provided to turn off millicode call
11876 generation.
11877
11878 @item -mmixed-code
11879 @opindex mmixed-code
11880 Tweak register allocation to help 16-bit instruction generation.
11881 This generally has the effect of decreasing the average instruction size
11882 while increasing the instruction count.
11883
11884 @item -mq-class
11885 @opindex mq-class
11886 Enable 'q' instruction alternatives.
11887 This is the default for @option{-Os}.
11888
11889 @item -mRcq
11890 @opindex mRcq
11891 Enable Rcq constraint handling - most short code generation depends on this.
11892 This is the default.
11893
11894 @item -mRcw
11895 @opindex mRcw
11896 Enable Rcw constraint handling - ccfsm condexec mostly depends on this.
11897 This is the default.
11898
11899 @item -msize-level=@var{level}
11900 @opindex msize-level
11901 Fine-tune size optimization with regards to instruction lengths and alignment.
11902 The recognized values for @var{level} are:
11903 @table @samp
11904 @item 0
11905 No size optimization. This level is deprecated and treated like @samp{1}.
11906
11907 @item 1
11908 Short instructions are used opportunistically.
11909
11910 @item 2
11911 In addition, alignment of loops and of code after barriers are dropped.
11912
11913 @item 3
11914 In addition, optional data alignment is dropped, and the option @option{Os} is enabled.
11915
11916 @end table
11917
11918 This defaults to @samp{3} when @option{-Os} is in effect. Otherwise,
11919 the behavior when this is not set is equivalent to level @samp{1}.
11920
11921 @item -mtune=@var{cpu}
11922 @opindex mtune
11923 Set instruction scheduling parameters for @var{cpu}, overriding any implied
11924 by @option{-mcpu=}.
11925
11926 Supported values for @var{cpu} are
11927
11928 @table @samp
11929 @item ARC600
11930 Tune for ARC600 cpu.
11931
11932 @item ARC601
11933 Tune for ARC601 cpu.
11934
11935 @item ARC700
11936 Tune for ARC700 cpu with standard multiplier block.
11937
11938 @item ARC700-xmac
11939 Tune for ARC700 cpu with XMAC block.
11940
11941 @item ARC725D
11942 Tune for ARC725D cpu.
11943
11944 @item ARC750D
11945 Tune for ARC750D cpu.
11946
11947 @end table
11948
11949 @item -mmultcost=@var{num}
11950 @opindex mmultcost
11951 Cost to assume for a multiply instruction, with @samp{4} being equal to a
11952 normal instruction.
11953
11954 @item -munalign-prob-threshold=@var{probability}
11955 @opindex munalign-prob-threshold
11956 Set probability threshold for unaligning branches.
11957 When tuning for @samp{ARC700} and optimizing for speed, branches without
11958 filled delay slot are preferably emitted unaligned and long, unless
11959 profiling indicates that the probability for the branch to be taken
11960 is below @var{probability}. @xref{Cross-profiling}.
11961 The default is (REG_BR_PROB_BASE/2), i.e.@: 5000.
11962
11963 @end table
11964
11965 The following options are maintained for backward compatibility, but
11966 are now deprecated and will be removed in a future release:
11967
11968 @c Deprecated options
11969 @table @gcctabopt
11970
11971 @item -margonaut
11972 @opindex margonaut
11973 Obsolete FPX.
11974
11975 @item -mbig-endian
11976 @opindex mbig-endian
11977 @itemx -EB
11978 @opindex EB
11979 Compile code for big endian targets. Use of these options is now
11980 deprecated. Users wanting big-endian code, should use the
11981 @w{@code{arceb-elf32}} and @w{@code{arceb-linux-uclibc}} targets when
11982 building the tool chain, for which big-endian is the default.
11983
11984 @item -mlittle-endian
11985 @opindex mlittle-endian
11986 @itemx -EL
11987 @opindex EL
11988 Compile code for little endian targets. Use of these options is now
11989 deprecated. Users wanting little-endian code should use the
11990 @w{@code{arc-elf32}} and @w{@code{arc-linux-uclibc}} targets when
11991 building the tool chain, for which little-endian is the default.
11992
11993 @item -mbarrel_shifter
11994 @opindex mbarrel_shifter
11995 Replaced by @samp{-mbarrel-shifter}
11996
11997 @item -mdpfp_compact
11998 @opindex mdpfp_compact
11999 Replaced by @samp{-mdpfp-compact}
12000
12001 @item -mdpfp_fast
12002 @opindex mdpfp_fast
12003 Replaced by @samp{-mdpfp-fast}
12004
12005 @item -mdsp_packa
12006 @opindex mdsp_packa
12007 Replaced by @samp{-mdsp-packa}
12008
12009 @item -mEA
12010 @opindex mEA
12011 Replaced by @samp{-mea}
12012
12013 @item -mmac_24
12014 @opindex mmac_24
12015 Replaced by @samp{-mmac-24}
12016
12017 @item -mmac_d16
12018 @opindex mmac_d16
12019 Replaced by @samp{-mmac-d16}
12020
12021 @item -mspfp_compact
12022 @opindex mspfp_compact
12023 Replaced by @samp{-mspfp-compact}
12024
12025 @item -mspfp_fast
12026 @opindex mspfp_fast
12027 Replaced by @samp{-mspfp-fast}
12028
12029 @item -mtune=@var{cpu}
12030 @opindex mtune
12031 Values @samp{arc600}, @samp{arc601}, @samp{arc700} and
12032 @samp{arc700-xmac} for @var{cpu} are replaced by @samp{ARC600},
12033 @samp{ARC601}, @samp{ARC700} and @samp{ARC700-xmac} respectively
12034
12035 @item -multcost=@var{num}
12036 @opindex multcost
12037 Replaced by @samp{-mmultcost}.
12038
12039 @end table
12040
12041 @node ARM Options
12042 @subsection ARM Options
12043 @cindex ARM options
12044
12045 These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
12046 architectures:
12047
12048 @table @gcctabopt
12049 @item -mabi=@var{name}
12050 @opindex mabi
12051 Generate code for the specified ABI@. Permissible values are: @samp{apcs-gnu},
12052 @samp{atpcs}, @samp{aapcs}, @samp{aapcs-linux} and @samp{iwmmxt}.
12053
12054 @item -mapcs-frame
12055 @opindex mapcs-frame
12056 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
12057 Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
12058 correct execution of the code. Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
12059 with this option causes the stack frames not to be generated for
12060 leaf functions. The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
12061
12062 @item -mapcs
12063 @opindex mapcs
12064 This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
12065
12066 @ignore
12067 @c not currently implemented
12068 @item -mapcs-stack-check
12069 @opindex mapcs-stack-check
12070 Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
12071 every function (that actually uses some stack space). If there is
12072 insufficient space available then either the function
12073 @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} is
12074 called, depending upon the amount of stack space required. The runtime
12075 system is required to provide these functions. The default is
12076 @option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
12077
12078 @c not currently implemented
12079 @item -mapcs-float
12080 @opindex mapcs-float
12081 Pass floating-point arguments using the floating-point registers. This is
12082 one of the variants of the APCS@. This option is recommended if the
12083 target hardware has a floating-point unit or if a lot of floating-point
12084 arithmetic is going to be performed by the code. The default is
12085 @option{-mno-apcs-float}, since the size of integer-only code is
12086 slightly increased if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
12087
12088 @c not currently implemented
12089 @item -mapcs-reentrant
12090 @opindex mapcs-reentrant
12091 Generate reentrant, position-independent code. The default is
12092 @option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
12093 @end ignore
12094
12095 @item -mthumb-interwork
12096 @opindex mthumb-interwork
12097 Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
12098 instruction sets. Without this option, on pre-v5 architectures, the
12099 two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside one program. The
12100 default is @option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code
12101 is generated when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified. In AAPCS
12102 configurations this option is meaningless.
12103
12104 @item -mno-sched-prolog
12105 @opindex mno-sched-prolog
12106 Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or the
12107 merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
12108 body. This means that all functions start with a recognizable set
12109 of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
12110 different function prologues), and this information can be used to
12111 locate the start of functions inside an executable piece of code. The
12112 default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
12113
12114 @item -mfloat-abi=@var{name}
12115 @opindex mfloat-abi
12116 Specifies which floating-point ABI to use. Permissible values
12117 are: @samp{soft}, @samp{softfp} and @samp{hard}.
12118
12119 Specifying @samp{soft} causes GCC to generate output containing
12120 library calls for floating-point operations.
12121 @samp{softfp} allows the generation of code using hardware floating-point
12122 instructions, but still uses the soft-float calling conventions.
12123 @samp{hard} allows generation of floating-point instructions
12124 and uses FPU-specific calling conventions.
12125
12126 The default depends on the specific target configuration. Note that
12127 the hard-float and soft-float ABIs are not link-compatible; you must
12128 compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
12129 compatible set of libraries.
12130
12131 @item -mlittle-endian
12132 @opindex mlittle-endian
12133 Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode. This is
12134 the default for all standard configurations.
12135
12136 @item -mbig-endian
12137 @opindex mbig-endian
12138 Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
12139 to compile code for a little-endian processor.
12140
12141 @item -mwords-little-endian
12142 @opindex mwords-little-endian
12143 This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
12144 Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
12145 order. That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}. Note: this
12146 option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
12147 big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
12148 2.8. This option is now deprecated.
12149
12150 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
12151 @opindex mcpu
12152 This specifies the name of the target ARM processor. GCC uses this name
12153 to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
12154 assembly code. Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
12155 @samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
12156 @samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
12157 @samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
12158 @samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
12159 @samp{arm720},
12160 @samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm7tdmi-s},
12161 @samp{arm710t}, @samp{arm720t}, @samp{arm740t},
12162 @samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
12163 @samp{strongarm1110},
12164 @samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
12165 @samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm922t}, @samp{arm946e-s}, @samp{arm966e-s},
12166 @samp{arm968e-s}, @samp{arm926ej-s}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi},
12167 @samp{arm10tdmi}, @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{arm1026ej-s},
12168 @samp{arm10e}, @samp{arm1020e}, @samp{arm1022e},
12169 @samp{arm1136j-s}, @samp{arm1136jf-s}, @samp{mpcore}, @samp{mpcorenovfp},
12170 @samp{arm1156t2-s}, @samp{arm1156t2f-s}, @samp{arm1176jz-s}, @samp{arm1176jzf-s},
12171 @samp{cortex-a5}, @samp{cortex-a7}, @samp{cortex-a8}, @samp{cortex-a9},
12172 @samp{cortex-a12}, @samp{cortex-a15}, @samp{cortex-a53}, @samp{cortex-a57},
12173 @samp{cortex-r4},
12174 @samp{cortex-r4f}, @samp{cortex-r5}, @samp{cortex-r7}, @samp{cortex-m4},
12175 @samp{cortex-m3},
12176 @samp{cortex-m1},
12177 @samp{cortex-m0},
12178 @samp{cortex-m0plus},
12179 @samp{marvell-pj4},
12180 @samp{xscale}, @samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312},
12181 @samp{fa526}, @samp{fa626},
12182 @samp{fa606te}, @samp{fa626te}, @samp{fmp626}, @samp{fa726te}.
12183
12184 Additionally, this option can specify that GCC should tune the performance
12185 of the code for a big.LITTLE system. Permissible names are:
12186 @samp{cortex-a15.cortex-a7}, @samp{cortex-a57.cortex-a53}.
12187
12188 @option{-mcpu=generic-@var{arch}} is also permissible, and is
12189 equivalent to @option{-march=@var{arch} -mtune=generic-@var{arch}}.
12190 See @option{-mtune} for more information.
12191
12192 @option{-mcpu=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
12193 of the build computer. At present, this feature is only supported on
12194 Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the auto-detect is
12195 unsuccessful the option has no effect.
12196
12197 @item -mtune=@var{name}
12198 @opindex mtune
12199 This option is very similar to the @option{-mcpu=} option, except that
12200 instead of specifying the actual target processor type, and hence
12201 restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies that GCC should
12202 tune the performance of the code as if the target were of the type
12203 specified in this option, but still choosing the instructions it
12204 generates based on the CPU specified by a @option{-mcpu=} option.
12205 For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
12206 this option.
12207
12208 @option{-mtune=generic-@var{arch}} specifies that GCC should tune the
12209 performance for a blend of processors within architecture @var{arch}.
12210 The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular
12211 processors, balancing between optimizations that benefit some CPUs in the
12212 range, and avoiding performance pitfalls of other CPUs. The effects of
12213 this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models come and go.
12214
12215 @option{-mtune=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
12216 of the build computer. At present, this feature is only supported on
12217 Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the auto-detect is
12218 unsuccessful the option has no effect.
12219
12220 @item -march=@var{name}
12221 @opindex march
12222 This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture. GCC uses this
12223 name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
12224 assembly code. This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
12225 of the @option{-mcpu=} option. Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
12226 @samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
12227 @samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5e}, @samp{armv5te},
12228 @samp{armv6}, @samp{armv6j},
12229 @samp{armv6t2}, @samp{armv6z}, @samp{armv6zk}, @samp{armv6-m},
12230 @samp{armv7}, @samp{armv7-a}, @samp{armv7-r}, @samp{armv7-m},
12231 @samp{armv8-a}, @samp{armv8-a+crc},
12232 @samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312}.
12233
12234 @option{-march=armv8-a+crc} enables code generation for the ARMv8-A
12235 architecture together with the optional CRC32 extensions.
12236
12237 @option{-march=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture
12238 of the build computer. At present, this feature is only supported on
12239 Linux, and not all architectures are recognized. If the auto-detect is
12240 unsuccessful the option has no effect.
12241
12242 @item -mfpu=@var{name}
12243 @opindex mfpu
12244 This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware emulation) is
12245 available on the target. Permissible names are: @samp{vfp}, @samp{vfpv3},
12246 @samp{vfpv3-fp16}, @samp{vfpv3-d16}, @samp{vfpv3-d16-fp16}, @samp{vfpv3xd},
12247 @samp{vfpv3xd-fp16}, @samp{neon}, @samp{neon-fp16}, @samp{vfpv4},
12248 @samp{vfpv4-d16}, @samp{fpv4-sp-d16}, @samp{neon-vfpv4},
12249 @samp{fp-armv8}, @samp{neon-fp-armv8}, and @samp{crypto-neon-fp-armv8}.
12250
12251 If @option{-msoft-float} is specified this specifies the format of
12252 floating-point values.
12253
12254 If the selected floating-point hardware includes the NEON extension
12255 (e.g. @option{-mfpu}=@samp{neon}), note that floating-point
12256 operations are not generated by GCC's auto-vectorization pass unless
12257 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also specified. This is
12258 because NEON hardware does not fully implement the IEEE 754 standard for
12259 floating-point arithmetic (in particular denormal values are treated as
12260 zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.
12261
12262 @item -mfp16-format=@var{name}
12263 @opindex mfp16-format
12264 Specify the format of the @code{__fp16} half-precision floating-point type.
12265 Permissible names are @samp{none}, @samp{ieee}, and @samp{alternative};
12266 the default is @samp{none}, in which case the @code{__fp16} type is not
12267 defined. @xref{Half-Precision}, for more information.
12268
12269 @item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
12270 @opindex mstructure-size-boundary
12271 The sizes of all structures and unions are rounded up to a multiple
12272 of the number of bits set by this option. Permissible values are 8, 32
12273 and 64. The default value varies for different toolchains. For the COFF
12274 targeted toolchain the default value is 8. A value of 64 is only allowed
12275 if the underlying ABI supports it.
12276
12277 Specifying a larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but
12278 can also increase the size of the program. Different values are potentially
12279 incompatible. Code compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to
12280 work with code or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
12281 information using structures or unions.
12282
12283 @item -mabort-on-noreturn
12284 @opindex mabort-on-noreturn
12285 Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
12286 @code{noreturn} function. It is executed if the function tries to
12287 return.
12288
12289 @item -mlong-calls
12290 @itemx -mno-long-calls
12291 @opindex mlong-calls
12292 @opindex mno-long-calls
12293 Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
12294 address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
12295 call on this register. This switch is needed if the target function
12296 lies outside of the 64-megabyte addressing range of the offset-based
12297 version of subroutine call instruction.
12298
12299 Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls are turned
12300 into long calls. The heuristic is that static functions, functions
12301 that have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
12302 the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive, and functions whose
12303 definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
12304 unit are not turned into long calls. The exceptions to this rule are
12305 that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
12306 attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
12307 the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive are always
12308 turned into long calls.
12309
12310 This feature is not enabled by default. Specifying
12311 @option{-mno-long-calls} restores the default behavior, as does
12312 placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
12313 long_calls_off} directive. Note these switches have no effect on how
12314 the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
12315 pointers.
12316
12317 @item -msingle-pic-base
12318 @opindex msingle-pic-base
12319 Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
12320 loading it in the prologue for each function. The runtime system is
12321 responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
12322 before execution begins.
12323
12324 @item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
12325 @opindex mpic-register
12326 Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.
12327 For standard PIC base case, the default will be any suitable register
12328 determined by compiler. For single PIC base case, the default is
12329 @samp{R9} if target is EABI based or stack-checking is enabled,
12330 otherwise the default is @samp{R10}.
12331
12332 @item -mpic-data-is-text-relative
12333 @opindex mpic-data-is-text-relative
12334 Assume that each data segments are relative to text segment at load time.
12335 Therefore, it permits addressing data using PC-relative operations.
12336 This option is on by default for targets other than VxWorks RTP.
12337
12338 @item -mpoke-function-name
12339 @opindex mpoke-function-name
12340 Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
12341 preceding the function prologue. The generated code is similar to this:
12342
12343 @smallexample
12344 t0
12345 .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
12346 .align
12347 t1
12348 .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
12349 arm_poke_function_name
12350 mov ip, sp
12351 stmfd sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
12352 sub fp, ip, #4
12353 @end smallexample
12354
12355 When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
12356 @code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}. If the trace function then looks at
12357 location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
12358 there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
12359 and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
12360
12361 @item -mthumb
12362 @itemx -marm
12363 @opindex marm
12364 @opindex mthumb
12365
12366 Select between generating code that executes in ARM and Thumb
12367 states. The default for most configurations is to generate code
12368 that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
12369 configuring GCC with the @option{--with-mode=}@var{state}
12370 configure option.
12371
12372 @item -mtpcs-frame
12373 @opindex mtpcs-frame
12374 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
12375 Standard for all non-leaf functions. (A leaf function is one that does
12376 not call any other functions.) The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
12377
12378 @item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
12379 @opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
12380 Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
12381 Standard for all leaf functions. (A leaf function is one that does
12382 not call any other functions.) The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
12383
12384 @item -mcallee-super-interworking
12385 @opindex mcallee-super-interworking
12386 Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
12387 instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
12388 rest of the function. This allows these functions to be called from
12389 non-interworking code. This option is not valid in AAPCS configurations
12390 because interworking is enabled by default.
12391
12392 @item -mcaller-super-interworking
12393 @opindex mcaller-super-interworking
12394 Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
12395 execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
12396 compiled for interworking or not. There is a small overhead in the cost
12397 of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled. This option
12398 is not valid in AAPCS configurations because interworking is enabled
12399 by default.
12400
12401 @item -mtp=@var{name}
12402 @opindex mtp
12403 Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer. The valid
12404 models are @option{soft}, which generates calls to @code{__aeabi_read_tp},
12405 @option{cp15}, which fetches the thread pointer from @code{cp15} directly
12406 (supported in the arm6k architecture), and @option{auto}, which uses the
12407 best available method for the selected processor. The default setting is
12408 @option{auto}.
12409
12410 @item -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect}
12411 @opindex mtls-dialect
12412 Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage. Two
12413 @var{dialect}s are supported---@samp{gnu} and @samp{gnu2}. The
12414 @samp{gnu} dialect selects the original GNU scheme for supporting
12415 local and global dynamic TLS models. The @samp{gnu2} dialect
12416 selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which provides better performance
12417 for shared libraries. The GNU descriptor scheme is compatible with
12418 the original scheme, but does require new assembler, linker and
12419 library support. Initial and local exec TLS models are unaffected by
12420 this option and always use the original scheme.
12421
12422 @item -mword-relocations
12423 @opindex mword-relocations
12424 Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values (i.e. R_ARM_ABS32).
12425 This is enabled by default on targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime
12426 loader imposes this restriction, and when @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}
12427 is specified.
12428
12429 @item -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
12430 @opindex mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
12431 Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when @code{ldrd} instructions
12432 with overlapping destination and base registers are used. This option avoids
12433 generating these instructions. This option is enabled by default when
12434 @option{-mcpu=cortex-m3} is specified.
12435
12436 @item -munaligned-access
12437 @itemx -mno-unaligned-access
12438 @opindex munaligned-access
12439 @opindex mno-unaligned-access
12440 Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values
12441 from addresses that are not 16- or 32- bit aligned. By default
12442 unaligned access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6 and all ARMv6-M
12443 architectures, and enabled for all other architectures. If unaligned
12444 access is not enabled then words in packed data structures will be
12445 accessed a byte at a time.
12446
12447 The ARM attribute @code{Tag_CPU_unaligned_access} will be set in the
12448 generated object file to either true or false, depending upon the
12449 setting of this option. If unaligned access is enabled then the
12450 preprocessor symbol @code{__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED} will also be
12451 defined.
12452
12453 @item -mneon-for-64bits
12454 @opindex mneon-for-64bits
12455 Enables using Neon to handle scalar 64-bits operations. This is
12456 disabled by default since the cost of moving data from core registers
12457 to Neon is high.
12458
12459 @item -mslow-flash-data
12460 @opindex mslow-flash-data
12461 Assume loading data from flash is slower than fetching instruction.
12462 Therefore literal load is minimized for better performance.
12463 This option is only supported when compiling for ARMv7 M-profile and
12464 off by default.
12465
12466 @item -mrestrict-it
12467 @opindex mrestrict-it
12468 Restricts generation of IT blocks to conform to the rules of ARMv8.
12469 IT blocks can only contain a single 16-bit instruction from a select
12470 set of instructions. This option is on by default for ARMv8 Thumb mode.
12471 @end table
12472
12473 @node AVR Options
12474 @subsection AVR Options
12475 @cindex AVR Options
12476
12477 These options are defined for AVR implementations:
12478
12479 @table @gcctabopt
12480 @item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
12481 @opindex mmcu
12482 Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.
12483
12484 The default for this option is@tie{}@code{avr2}.
12485
12486 GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:
12487
12488 @include avr-mmcu.texi
12489
12490 @item -maccumulate-args
12491 @opindex maccumulate-args
12492 Accumulate outgoing function arguments and acquire/release the needed
12493 stack space for outgoing function arguments once in function
12494 prologue/epilogue. Without this option, outgoing arguments are pushed
12495 before calling a function and popped afterwards.
12496
12497 Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on
12498 AVR so that accumulating the stack space might lead to smaller
12499 executables because arguments need not to be removed from the
12500 stack after such a function call.
12501
12502 This option can lead to reduced code size for functions that perform
12503 several calls to functions that get their arguments on the stack like
12504 calls to printf-like functions.
12505
12506 @item -mbranch-cost=@var{cost}
12507 @opindex mbranch-cost
12508 Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to
12509 @var{cost}. Reasonable values for @var{cost} are small, non-negative
12510 integers. The default branch cost is 0.
12511
12512 @item -mcall-prologues
12513 @opindex mcall-prologues
12514 Functions prologues/epilogues are expanded as calls to appropriate
12515 subroutines. Code size is smaller.
12516
12517 @item -mint8
12518 @opindex mint8
12519 Assume @code{int} to be 8-bit integer. This affects the sizes of all types: a
12520 @code{char} is 1 byte, an @code{int} is 1 byte, a @code{long} is 2 bytes,
12521 and @code{long long} is 4 bytes. Please note that this option does not
12522 conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code
12523 size.
12524
12525 @item -mno-interrupts
12526 @opindex mno-interrupts
12527 Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
12528 Code size is smaller.
12529
12530 @item -mrelax
12531 @opindex mrelax
12532 Try to replace @code{CALL} resp.@: @code{JMP} instruction by the shorter
12533 @code{RCALL} resp.@: @code{RJMP} instruction if applicable.
12534 Setting @code{-mrelax} just adds the @code{--relax} option to the
12535 linker command line when the linker is called.
12536
12537 Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are not
12538 known before code is located. Therefore, the assembler code generated by the
12539 compiler is the same, but the instructions in the executable may
12540 differ from instructions in the assembler code.
12541
12542 Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the
12543 section on @code{EIND} and linker stubs below.
12544
12545 @item -msp8
12546 @opindex msp8
12547 Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register,
12548 i.e.@: assume the high byte of the stack pointer is zero.
12549 In general, you don't need to set this option by hand.
12550
12551 This option is used internally by the compiler to select and
12552 build multilibs for architectures @code{avr2} and @code{avr25}.
12553 These architectures mix devices with and without @code{SPH}.
12554 For any setting other than @code{-mmcu=avr2} or @code{-mmcu=avr25}
12555 the compiler driver will add or remove this option from the compiler
12556 proper's command line, because the compiler then knows if the device
12557 or architecture has an 8-bit stack pointer and thus no @code{SPH}
12558 register or not.
12559
12560 @item -mstrict-X
12561 @opindex mstrict-X
12562 Use address register @code{X} in a way proposed by the hardware. This means
12563 that @code{X} is only used in indirect, post-increment or
12564 pre-decrement addressing.
12565
12566 Without this option, the @code{X} register may be used in the same way
12567 as @code{Y} or @code{Z} which then is emulated by additional
12568 instructions.
12569 For example, loading a value with @code{X+const} addressing with a
12570 small non-negative @code{const < 64} to a register @var{Rn} is
12571 performed as
12572
12573 @example
12574 adiw r26, const ; X += const
12575 ld @var{Rn}, X ; @var{Rn} = *X
12576 sbiw r26, const ; X -= const
12577 @end example
12578
12579 @item -mtiny-stack
12580 @opindex mtiny-stack
12581 Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.
12582
12583 @item -Waddr-space-convert
12584 @opindex Waddr-space-convert
12585 Warn about conversions between address spaces in the case where the
12586 resulting address space is not contained in the incoming address space.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 @subsubsection @code{EIND} and Devices with more than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash
12590 @cindex @code{EIND}
12591 Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide.
12592 The address of a function or label is represented as word address so
12593 that indirect jumps and calls can target any code address in the
12594 range of 64@tie{}Ki words.
12595
12596 In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than 128@tie{}Ki
12597 bytes of program memory space, there is a special function register called
12598 @code{EIND} that serves as most significant part of the target address
12599 when @code{EICALL} or @code{EIJMP} instructions are used.
12600
12601 Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by
12602 the compiler and are subject to some limitations:
12603
12604 @itemize @bullet
12605
12606 @item
12607 The compiler never sets @code{EIND}.
12608
12609 @item
12610 The compiler uses @code{EIND} implicitely in @code{EICALL}/@code{EIJMP}
12611 instructions or might read @code{EIND} directly in order to emulate an
12612 indirect call/jump by means of a @code{RET} instruction.
12613
12614 @item
12615 The compiler assumes that @code{EIND} never changes during the startup
12616 code or during the application. In particular, @code{EIND} is not
12617 saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine
12618 prologue/epilogue.
12619
12620 @item
12621 For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker
12622 generates @emph{stubs}. Stubs are jump pads sometimes also called
12623 @emph{trampolines}. Thus, the indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.
12624 The stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.
12625
12626 @item
12627 Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker will generate
12628 the stubs correctly an all situaltion. See the compiler option
12629 @code{-mrelax} and the linler option @code{--relax}.
12630 There are corner cases where the linker is supposed to generate stubs
12631 but aborts without relaxation and without a helpful error message.
12632
12633 @item
12634 The default linker script is arranged for code with @code{EIND = 0}.
12635 If code is supposed to work for a setup with @code{EIND != 0}, a custom
12636 linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
12637 name start with @code{.trampolines} into the segment where @code{EIND}
12638 points to.
12639
12640 @item
12641 The startup code from libgcc never sets @code{EIND}.
12642 Notice that startup code is a blend of code from libgcc and AVR-LibC.
12643 For the impact of AVR-LibC on @code{EIND}, see the
12644 @w{@uref{http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual/,AVR-LibC user manual}}.
12645
12646 @item
12647 It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up @code{EIND}
12648 early, for example by means of initialization code located in
12649 section @code{.init3}. Such code runs prior to general startup code
12650 that initializes RAM and calls constructors, but after the bit
12651 of startup code from AVR-LibC that sets @code{EIND} to the segment
12652 where the vector table is located.
12653 @example
12654 #include <avr/io.h>
12655
12656 static void
12657 __attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
12658 init3_set_eind (void)
12659 @{
12660 __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
12661 "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
12662 @}
12663 @end example
12664
12665 @noindent
12666 The @code{__trampolines_start} symbol is defined in the linker script.
12667
12668 @item
12669 Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if
12670 the following two conditions are met:
12671 @itemize @minus
12672
12673 @item The address of a label is taken by means of the @code{gs} modifier
12674 (short for @emph{generate stubs}) like so:
12675 @example
12676 LDI r24, lo8(gs(@var{func}))
12677 LDI r25, hi8(gs(@var{func}))
12678 @end example
12679 @item The final location of that label is in a code segment
12680 @emph{outside} the segment where the stubs are located.
12681 @end itemize
12682
12683 @item
12684 The compiler emits such @code{gs} modifiers for code labels in the
12685 following situations:
12686 @itemize @minus
12687 @item Taking address of a function or code label.
12688 @item Computed goto.
12689 @item If prologue-save function is used, see @option{-mcall-prologues}
12690 command-line option.
12691 @item Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch
12692 tables you can specify the @option{-fno-jump-tables} command-line option.
12693 @item C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.
12694 @item If the tools hit a @code{gs()} modifier explained above.
12695 @end itemize
12696
12697 @item
12698 Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is @emph{not} supported:
12699
12700 @example
12701 int main (void)
12702 @{
12703 /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
12704 return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
12705 @}
12706 @end example
12707
12708 Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e.@: the function has to be called
12709 through a symbol (@code{func_4} in the example):
12710
12711 @example
12712 int main (void)
12713 @{
12714 extern int func_4 (void);
12715
12716 /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
12717 return func_4();
12718 @}
12719 @end example
12720
12721 and the application be linked with @code{-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4}.
12722 Alternatively, @code{func_4} can be defined in the linker script.
12723 @end itemize
12724
12725 @subsubsection Handling of the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY} and @code{RAMPZ} Special Function Registers
12726 @cindex @code{RAMPD}
12727 @cindex @code{RAMPX}
12728 @cindex @code{RAMPY}
12729 @cindex @code{RAMPZ}
12730 Some AVR devices support memories larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range
12731 that can be accessed with 16-bit pointers. To access memory locations
12732 outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the contentent of a @code{RAMP}
12733 register is used as high part of the address:
12734 The @code{X}, @code{Y}, @code{Z} address register is concatenated
12735 with the @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY}, @code{RAMPZ} special function
12736 register, respectively, to get a wide address. Similarly,
12737 @code{RAMPD} is used together with direct addressing.
12738
12739 @itemize
12740 @item
12741 The startup code initializes the @code{RAMP} special function
12742 registers with zero.
12743
12744 @item
12745 If a @ref{AVR Named Address Spaces,named address space} other than
12746 generic or @code{__flash} is used, then @code{RAMPZ} is set
12747 as needed before the operation.
12748
12749 @item
12750 If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB and the compiler
12751 needs to change @code{RAMPZ} to accomplish an operation, @code{RAMPZ}
12752 is reset to zero after the operation.
12753
12754 @item
12755 If the device comes with a specific @code{RAMP} register, the ISR
12756 prologue/epilogue saves/restores that SFR and initializes it with
12757 zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.
12758
12759 @item
12760 RAM larger than 64@tie{}KiB is not supported by GCC for AVR targets.
12761 If you use inline assembler to read from locations outside the
12762 16-bit address range and change one of the @code{RAMP} registers,
12763 you must reset it to zero after the access.
12764
12765 @end itemize
12766
12767 @subsubsection AVR Built-in Macros
12768
12769 GCC defines several built-in macros so that the user code can test
12770 for the presence or absence of features. Almost any of the following
12771 built-in macros are deduced from device capabilities and thus
12772 triggered by the @code{-mmcu=} command-line option.
12773
12774 For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see
12775 @ref{AVR Named Address Spaces} and @ref{AVR Built-in Functions}.
12776
12777 @table @code
12778
12779 @item __AVR_ARCH__
12780 Build-in macro that resolves to a decimal number that identifies the
12781 architecture and depends on the @code{-mmcu=@var{mcu}} option.
12782 Possible values are:
12783
12784 @code{2}, @code{25}, @code{3}, @code{31}, @code{35},
12785 @code{4}, @code{5}, @code{51}, @code{6}, @code{102}, @code{104},
12786 @code{105}, @code{106}, @code{107}
12787
12788 for @var{mcu}=@code{avr2}, @code{avr25}, @code{avr3},
12789 @code{avr31}, @code{avr35}, @code{avr4}, @code{avr5}, @code{avr51},
12790 @code{avr6}, @code{avrxmega2}, @code{avrxmega4}, @code{avrxmega5},
12791 @code{avrxmega6}, @code{avrxmega7}, respectively.
12792 If @var{mcu} specifies a device, this built-in macro is set
12793 accordingly. For example, with @code{-mmcu=atmega8} the macro will be
12794 defined to @code{4}.
12795
12796 @item __AVR_@var{Device}__
12797 Setting @code{-mmcu=@var{device}} defines this built-in macro which reflects
12798 the device's name. For example, @code{-mmcu=atmega8} defines the
12799 built-in macro @code{__AVR_ATmega8__}, @code{-mmcu=attiny261a} defines
12800 @code{__AVR_ATtiny261A__}, etc.
12801
12802 The built-in macros' names follow
12803 the scheme @code{__AVR_@var{Device}__} where @var{Device} is
12804 the device name as from the AVR user manual. The difference between
12805 @var{Device} in the built-in macro and @var{device} in
12806 @code{-mmcu=@var{device}} is that the latter is always lowercase.
12807
12808 If @var{device} is not a device but only a core architecture like
12809 @code{avr51}, this macro will not be defined.
12810
12811 @item __AVR_XMEGA__
12812 The device / architecture belongs to the XMEGA family of devices.
12813
12814 @item __AVR_HAVE_ELPM__
12815 The device has the the @code{ELPM} instruction.
12816
12817 @item __AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__
12818 The device has the @code{ELPM R@var{n},Z} and @code{ELPM
12819 R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
12820
12821 @item __AVR_HAVE_MOVW__
12822 The device has the @code{MOVW} instruction to perform 16-bit
12823 register-register moves.
12824
12825 @item __AVR_HAVE_LPMX__
12826 The device has the @code{LPM R@var{n},Z} and
12827 @code{LPM R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
12828
12829 @item __AVR_HAVE_MUL__
12830 The device has a hardware multiplier.
12831
12832 @item __AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__
12833 The device has the @code{JMP} and @code{CALL} instructions.
12834 This is the case for devices with at least 16@tie{}KiB of program
12835 memory.
12836
12837 @item __AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__
12838 @itemx __AVR_3_BYTE_PC__
12839 The device has the @code{EIJMP} and @code{EICALL} instructions.
12840 This is the case for devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
12841 This also means that the program counter
12842 (PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.
12843
12844 @item __AVR_2_BYTE_PC__
12845 The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for devices
12846 with up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
12847
12848 @item __AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__
12849 @itemx __AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__
12850 The stack pointer (SP) register is treated as 8-bit respectively
12851 16-bit register by the compiler.
12852 The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mtiny-stack}.
12853
12854 @item __AVR_HAVE_SPH__
12855 @itemx __AVR_SP8__
12856 The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special function
12857 register or has an 8-bit stack pointer, respectively.
12858 The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mmcu=} and
12859 in the cases of @code{-mmcu=avr2} and @code{-mmcu=avr25} also
12860 by @code{-msp8}.
12861
12862 @item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__
12863 @itemx __AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__
12864 @itemx __AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__
12865 @itemx __AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__
12866 The device has the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY},
12867 @code{RAMPZ} special function register, respectively.
12868
12869 @item __NO_INTERRUPTS__
12870 This macro reflects the @code{-mno-interrupts} command line option.
12871
12872 @item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__
12873 @itemx __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__
12874 Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip 32-bit
12875 instructions because of a hardware erratum. Skip instructions are
12876 @code{SBRS}, @code{SBRC}, @code{SBIS}, @code{SBIC} and @code{CPSE}.
12877 The second macro is only defined if @code{__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__} is also
12878 set.
12879
12880 @item __AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=@var{offset}
12881 Instructions that can address I/O special function registers directly
12882 like @code{IN}, @code{OUT}, @code{SBI}, etc.@: may use a different
12883 address as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like @code{LD}
12884 or @code{STS}. This offset depends on the device architecture and has
12885 to be subtracted from the RAM address in order to get the
12886 respective I/O@tie{}address.
12887
12888 @item __WITH_AVRLIBC__
12889 The compiler is configured to be used together with AVR-Libc.
12890 See the @code{--with-avrlibc} configure option.
12891
12892 @end table
12893
12894 @node Blackfin Options
12895 @subsection Blackfin Options
12896 @cindex Blackfin Options
12897
12898 @table @gcctabopt
12899 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}
12900 @opindex mcpu=
12901 Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor. Currently, @var{cpu}
12902 can be one of @samp{bf512}, @samp{bf514}, @samp{bf516}, @samp{bf518},
12903 @samp{bf522}, @samp{bf523}, @samp{bf524}, @samp{bf525}, @samp{bf526},
12904 @samp{bf527}, @samp{bf531}, @samp{bf532}, @samp{bf533},
12905 @samp{bf534}, @samp{bf536}, @samp{bf537}, @samp{bf538}, @samp{bf539},
12906 @samp{bf542}, @samp{bf544}, @samp{bf547}, @samp{bf548}, @samp{bf549},
12907 @samp{bf542m}, @samp{bf544m}, @samp{bf547m}, @samp{bf548m}, @samp{bf549m},
12908 @samp{bf561}, @samp{bf592}.
12909
12910 The optional @var{sirevision} specifies the silicon revision of the target
12911 Blackfin processor. Any workarounds available for the targeted silicon revision
12912 are enabled. If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, no workarounds are enabled.
12913 If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, all workarounds for the targeted processor
12914 are enabled. The @code{__SILICON_REVISION__} macro is defined to two
12915 hexadecimal digits representing the major and minor numbers in the silicon
12916 revision. If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, the @code{__SILICON_REVISION__}
12917 is not defined. If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, the
12918 @code{__SILICON_REVISION__} is defined to be @code{0xffff}.
12919 If this optional @var{sirevision} is not used, GCC assumes the latest known
12920 silicon revision of the targeted Blackfin processor.
12921
12922 GCC defines a preprocessor macro for the specified @var{cpu}.
12923 For the @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain, this option causes the hardware BSP
12924 provided by libgloss to be linked in if @option{-msim} is not given.
12925
12926 Without this option, @samp{bf532} is used as the processor by default.
12927
12928 Note that support for @samp{bf561} is incomplete. For @samp{bf561},
12929 only the preprocessor macro is defined.
12930
12931 @item -msim
12932 @opindex msim
12933 Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator. This causes
12934 the simulator BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in. This option
12935 has effect only for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain.
12936 Certain other options, such as @option{-mid-shared-library} and
12937 @option{-mfdpic}, imply @option{-msim}.
12938
12939 @item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
12940 @opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
12941 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions. This
12942 avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
12943 makes an extra register available in leaf functions. The option
12944 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
12945 which might make debugging harder.
12946
12947 @item -mspecld-anomaly
12948 @opindex mspecld-anomaly
12949 When enabled, the compiler ensures that the generated code does not
12950 contain speculative loads after jump instructions. If this option is used,
12951 @code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS} is defined.
12952
12953 @item -mno-specld-anomaly
12954 @opindex mno-specld-anomaly
12955 Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.
12956
12957 @item -mcsync-anomaly
12958 @opindex mcsync-anomaly
12959 When enabled, the compiler ensures that the generated code does not
12960 contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional branches.
12961 If this option is used, @code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS} is defined.
12962
12963 @item -mno-csync-anomaly
12964 @opindex mno-csync-anomaly
12965 Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from
12966 occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
12967
12968 @item -mlow-64k
12969 @opindex mlow-64k
12970 When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that
12971 the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
12972
12973 @item -mno-low-64k
12974 @opindex mno-low-64k
12975 Assume that the program is arbitrarily large. This is the default.
12976
12977 @item -mstack-check-l1
12978 @opindex mstack-check-l1
12979 Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the
12980 uClinux kernel.
12981
12982 @item -mid-shared-library
12983 @opindex mid-shared-library
12984 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
12985 This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
12986 without virtual memory management. This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
12987 With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
12988
12989 @item -mno-id-shared-library
12990 @opindex mno-id-shared-library
12991 Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are being used.
12992 This is the default.
12993
12994 @item -mleaf-id-shared-library
12995 @opindex mleaf-id-shared-library
12996 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method,
12997 but assumes that this library or executable won't link against any other
12998 ID shared libraries. That allows the compiler to use faster code for jumps
12999 and calls.
13000
13001 @item -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
13002 @opindex mno-leaf-id-shared-library
13003 Do not assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared
13004 libraries. Slower code is generated for jump and call insns.
13005
13006 @item -mshared-library-id=n
13007 @opindex mshared-library-id
13008 Specifies the identification number of the ID-based shared library being
13009 compiled. Specifying a value of 0 generates more compact code; specifying
13010 other values forces the allocation of that number to the current
13011 library but is no more space- or time-efficient than omitting this option.
13012
13013 @item -msep-data
13014 @opindex msep-data
13015 Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
13016 area of memory from the text segment. This allows for execute in place in
13017 an environment without virtual memory management by eliminating relocations
13018 against the text section.
13019
13020 @item -mno-sep-data
13021 @opindex mno-sep-data
13022 Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
13023 This is the default.
13024
13025 @item -mlong-calls
13026 @itemx -mno-long-calls
13027 @opindex mlong-calls
13028 @opindex mno-long-calls
13029 Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
13030 address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
13031 call on this register. This switch is needed if the target function
13032 lies outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the offset-based
13033 version of subroutine call instruction.
13034
13035 This feature is not enabled by default. Specifying
13036 @option{-mno-long-calls} restores the default behavior. Note these
13037 switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle
13038 function calls via function pointers.
13039
13040 @item -mfast-fp
13041 @opindex mfast-fp
13042 Link with the fast floating-point library. This library relaxes some of
13043 the IEEE floating-point standard's rules for checking inputs against
13044 Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.
13045
13046 @item -minline-plt
13047 @opindex minline-plt
13048 Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
13049 not known to bind locally. It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
13050
13051 @item -mmulticore
13052 @opindex mmulticore
13053 Build a standalone application for multicore Blackfin processors.
13054 This option causes proper start files and link scripts supporting
13055 multicore to be used, and defines the macro @code{__BFIN_MULTICORE}.
13056 It can only be used with @option{-mcpu=bf561@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}}.
13057
13058 This option can be used with @option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}, which
13059 selects the one-application-per-core programming model. Without
13060 @option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}, the single-application/dual-core
13061 programming model is used. In this model, the main function of Core B
13062 should be named as @code{coreb_main}.
13063
13064 If this option is not used, the single-core application programming
13065 model is used.
13066
13067 @item -mcorea
13068 @opindex mcorea
13069 Build a standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using
13070 the one-application-per-core programming model. Proper start files
13071 and link scripts are used to support Core A, and the macro
13072 @code{__BFIN_COREA} is defined.
13073 This option can only be used in conjunction with @option{-mmulticore}.
13074
13075 @item -mcoreb
13076 @opindex mcoreb
13077 Build a standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using
13078 the one-application-per-core programming model. Proper start files
13079 and link scripts are used to support Core B, and the macro
13080 @code{__BFIN_COREB} is defined. When this option is used, @code{coreb_main}
13081 should be used instead of @code{main}.
13082 This option can only be used in conjunction with @option{-mmulticore}.
13083
13084 @item -msdram
13085 @opindex msdram
13086 Build a standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and
13087 link scripts are used to put the application into SDRAM, and the macro
13088 @code{__BFIN_SDRAM} is defined.
13089 The loader should initialize SDRAM before loading the application.
13090
13091 @item -micplb
13092 @opindex micplb
13093 Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time. This has an effect on certain
13094 anomaly workarounds. For Linux targets, the default is to assume ICPLBs
13095 are enabled; for standalone applications the default is off.
13096 @end table
13097
13098 @node C6X Options
13099 @subsection C6X Options
13100 @cindex C6X Options
13101
13102 @table @gcctabopt
13103 @item -march=@var{name}
13104 @opindex march
13105 This specifies the name of the target architecture. GCC uses this
13106 name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
13107 assembly code. Permissible names are: @samp{c62x},
13108 @samp{c64x}, @samp{c64x+}, @samp{c67x}, @samp{c67x+}, @samp{c674x}.
13109
13110 @item -mbig-endian
13111 @opindex mbig-endian
13112 Generate code for a big-endian target.
13113
13114 @item -mlittle-endian
13115 @opindex mlittle-endian
13116 Generate code for a little-endian target. This is the default.
13117
13118 @item -msim
13119 @opindex msim
13120 Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
13121
13122 @item -msdata=default
13123 @opindex msdata=default
13124 Put small global and static data in the @samp{.neardata} section,
13125 which is pointed to by register @code{B14}. Put small uninitialized
13126 global and static data in the @samp{.bss} section, which is adjacent
13127 to the @samp{.neardata} section. Put small read-only data into the
13128 @samp{.rodata} section. The corresponding sections used for large
13129 pieces of data are @samp{.fardata}, @samp{.far} and @samp{.const}.
13130
13131 @item -msdata=all
13132 @opindex msdata=all
13133 Put all data, not just small objects, into the sections reserved for
13134 small data, and use addressing relative to the @code{B14} register to
13135 access them.
13136
13137 @item -msdata=none
13138 @opindex msdata=none
13139 Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use absolute
13140 addresses to access all data. Put all initialized global and static
13141 data in the @samp{.fardata} section, and all uninitialized data in the
13142 @samp{.far} section. Put all constant data into the @samp{.const}
13143 section.
13144 @end table
13145
13146 @node CRIS Options
13147 @subsection CRIS Options
13148 @cindex CRIS Options
13149
13150 These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
13151
13152 @table @gcctabopt
13153 @item -march=@var{architecture-type}
13154 @itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
13155 @opindex march
13156 @opindex mcpu
13157 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
13158 @var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
13159 respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX@.
13160 Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
13161 @samp{v10}.
13162
13163 @item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
13164 @opindex mtune
13165 Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
13166 code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions. The
13167 choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
13168 @option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
13169
13170 @item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
13171 @opindex mmax-stack-frame
13172 Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
13173
13174 @item -metrax4
13175 @itemx -metrax100
13176 @opindex metrax4
13177 @opindex metrax100
13178 The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
13179 @option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
13180
13181 @item -mmul-bug-workaround
13182 @itemx -mno-mul-bug-workaround
13183 @opindex mmul-bug-workaround
13184 @opindex mno-mul-bug-workaround
13185 Work around a bug in the @code{muls} and @code{mulu} instructions for CPU
13186 models where it applies. This option is active by default.
13187
13188 @item -mpdebug
13189 @opindex mpdebug
13190 Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
13191 code. This option also has the effect of turning off the @samp{#NO_APP}
13192 formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
13193 assembly file.
13194
13195 @item -mcc-init
13196 @opindex mcc-init
13197 Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
13198 compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
13199
13200 @item -mno-side-effects
13201 @opindex mno-side-effects
13202 Do not emit instructions with side effects in addressing modes other than
13203 post-increment.
13204
13205 @item -mstack-align
13206 @itemx -mno-stack-align
13207 @itemx -mdata-align
13208 @itemx -mno-data-align
13209 @itemx -mconst-align
13210 @itemx -mno-const-align
13211 @opindex mstack-align
13212 @opindex mno-stack-align
13213 @opindex mdata-align
13214 @opindex mno-data-align
13215 @opindex mconst-align
13216 @opindex mno-const-align
13217 These options (@samp{no-} options) arrange (eliminate arrangements) for the
13218 stack frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
13219 single data access size for the chosen CPU model. The default is to
13220 arrange for 32-bit alignment. ABI details such as structure layout are
13221 not affected by these options.
13222
13223 @item -m32-bit
13224 @itemx -m16-bit
13225 @itemx -m8-bit
13226 @opindex m32-bit
13227 @opindex m16-bit
13228 @opindex m8-bit
13229 Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
13230 arrange for stack frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
13231 16-bit or 8-bit aligned. The default is 32-bit alignment.
13232
13233 @item -mno-prologue-epilogue
13234 @itemx -mprologue-epilogue
13235 @opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
13236 @opindex mprologue-epilogue
13237 With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
13238 epilogue which set up the stack frame are omitted and no return
13239 instructions or return sequences are generated in the code. Use this
13240 option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
13241 warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
13242 or storage for local variables needs to be allocated.
13243
13244 @item -mno-gotplt
13245 @itemx -mgotplt
13246 @opindex mno-gotplt
13247 @opindex mgotplt
13248 With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
13249 instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
13250 of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
13251 PLT@. The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
13252
13253 @item -melf
13254 @opindex melf
13255 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
13256 cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
13257
13258 @item -mlinux
13259 @opindex mlinux
13260 Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
13261
13262 @item -sim
13263 @opindex sim
13264 This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf, arranges
13265 to link with input-output functions from a simulator library. Code,
13266 initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
13267
13268 @item -sim2
13269 @opindex sim2
13270 Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
13271 0x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
13272 @end table
13273
13274 @node CR16 Options
13275 @subsection CR16 Options
13276 @cindex CR16 Options
13277
13278 These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.
13279
13280 @table @gcctabopt
13281
13282 @item -mmac
13283 @opindex mmac
13284 Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
13285
13286 @item -mcr16cplus
13287 @itemx -mcr16c
13288 @opindex mcr16cplus
13289 @opindex mcr16c
13290 Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture
13291 is default.
13292
13293 @item -msim
13294 @opindex msim
13295 Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator. Applicable
13296 to ELF compiler only.
13297
13298 @item -mint32
13299 @opindex mint32
13300 Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.
13301
13302 @item -mbit-ops
13303 @opindex mbit-ops
13304 Generates @code{sbit}/@code{cbit} instructions for bit manipulations.
13305
13306 @item -mdata-model=@var{model}
13307 @opindex mdata-model
13308 Choose a data model. The choices for @var{model} are @samp{near},
13309 @samp{far} or @samp{medium}. @samp{medium} is default.
13310 However, @samp{far} is not valid with @option{-mcr16c}, as the
13311 CR16C architecture does not support the far data model.
13312 @end table
13313
13314 @node Darwin Options
13315 @subsection Darwin Options
13316 @cindex Darwin options
13317
13318 These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating
13319 system.
13320
13321 FSF GCC on Darwin does not create ``fat'' object files; it creates
13322 an object file for the single architecture that GCC was built to
13323 target. Apple's GCC on Darwin does create ``fat'' files if multiple
13324 @option{-arch} options are used; it does so by running the compiler or
13325 linker multiple times and joining the results together with
13326 @file{lipo}.
13327
13328 The subtype of the file created (like @samp{ppc7400} or @samp{ppc970} or
13329 @samp{i686}) is determined by the flags that specify the ISA
13330 that GCC is targeting, like @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march}. The
13331 @option{-force_cpusubtype_ALL} option can be used to override this.
13332
13333 The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
13334 mismatch. The assembler, @file{as}, only permits instructions to
13335 be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,
13336 so you cannot put 64-bit instructions in a @samp{ppc750} object file.
13337 The linker for shared libraries, @file{/usr/bin/libtool}, fails
13338 and prints an error if asked to create a shared library with a less
13339 restrictive subtype than its input files (for instance, trying to put
13340 a @samp{ppc970} object file in a @samp{ppc7400} library). The linker
13341 for executables, @command{ld}, quietly gives the executable the most
13342 restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
13343
13344 @table @gcctabopt
13345 @item -F@var{dir}
13346 @opindex F
13347 Add the framework directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of
13348 directories to be searched for header files. These directories are
13349 interleaved with those specified by @option{-I} options and are
13350 scanned in a left-to-right order.
13351
13352 A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it. A
13353 framework is a directory with a @file{Headers} and/or
13354 @file{PrivateHeaders} directory contained directly in it that ends
13355 in @file{.framework}. The name of a framework is the name of this
13356 directory excluding the @file{.framework}. Headers associated with
13357 the framework are found in one of those two directories, with
13358 @file{Headers} being searched first. A subframework is a framework
13359 directory that is in a framework's @file{Frameworks} directory.
13360 Includes of subframework headers can only appear in a header of a
13361 framework that contains the subframework, or in a sibling subframework
13362 header. Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same
13363 framework. A subframework should not have the same name as a
13364 framework; a warning is issued if this is violated. Currently a
13365 subframework cannot have subframeworks; in the future, the mechanism
13366 may be extended to support this. The standard frameworks can be found
13367 in @file{/System/Library/Frameworks} and
13368 @file{/Library/Frameworks}. An example include looks like
13369 @code{#include <Framework/header.h>}, where @file{Framework} denotes
13370 the name of the framework and @file{header.h} is found in the
13371 @file{PrivateHeaders} or @file{Headers} directory.
13372
13373 @item -iframework@var{dir}
13374 @opindex iframework
13375 Like @option{-F} except the directory is a treated as a system
13376 directory. The main difference between this @option{-iframework} and
13377 @option{-F} is that with @option{-iframework} the compiler does not
13378 warn about constructs contained within header files found via
13379 @var{dir}. This option is valid only for the C family of languages.
13380
13381 @item -gused
13382 @opindex gused
13383 Emit debugging information for symbols that are used. For stabs
13384 debugging format, this enables @option{-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols}.
13385 This is by default ON@.
13386
13387 @item -gfull
13388 @opindex gfull
13389 Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
13390
13391 @item -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version}
13392 The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on
13393 is @var{version}. Typical values of @var{version} include @code{10.1},
13394 @code{10.2}, and @code{10.3.9}.
13395
13396 If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default,
13397 then the default for this option is the system version on which the
13398 compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices that
13399 are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.
13400
13401 @item -mkernel
13402 @opindex mkernel
13403 Enable kernel development mode. The @option{-mkernel} option sets
13404 @option{-static}, @option{-fno-common}, @option{-fno-cxa-atexit},
13405 @option{-fno-exceptions}, @option{-fno-non-call-exceptions},
13406 @option{-fapple-kext}, @option{-fno-weak} and @option{-fno-rtti} where
13407 applicable. This mode also sets @option{-mno-altivec},
13408 @option{-msoft-float}, @option{-fno-builtin} and
13409 @option{-mlong-branch} for PowerPC targets.
13410
13411 @item -mone-byte-bool
13412 @opindex mone-byte-bool
13413 Override the defaults for @samp{bool} so that @samp{sizeof(bool)==1}.
13414 By default @samp{sizeof(bool)} is @samp{4} when compiling for
13415 Darwin/PowerPC and @samp{1} when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this
13416 option has no effect on x86.
13417
13418 @strong{Warning:} The @option{-mone-byte-bool} switch causes GCC
13419 to generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated
13420 without that switch. Using this switch may require recompiling all
13421 other modules in a program, including system libraries. Use this
13422 switch to conform to a non-default data model.
13423
13424 @item -mfix-and-continue
13425 @itemx -ffix-and-continue
13426 @itemx -findirect-data
13427 @opindex mfix-and-continue
13428 @opindex ffix-and-continue
13429 @opindex findirect-data
13430 Generate code suitable for fast turnaround development, such as to
13431 allow GDB to dynamically load @code{.o} files into already-running
13432 programs. @option{-findirect-data} and @option{-ffix-and-continue}
13433 are provided for backwards compatibility.
13434
13435 @item -all_load
13436 @opindex all_load
13437 Loads all members of static archive libraries.
13438 See man ld(1) for more information.
13439
13440 @item -arch_errors_fatal
13441 @opindex arch_errors_fatal
13442 Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
13443 to be fatal.
13444
13445 @item -bind_at_load
13446 @opindex bind_at_load
13447 Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
13448 bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
13449
13450 @item -bundle
13451 @opindex bundle
13452 Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
13453 See man ld(1) for more information.
13454
13455 @item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
13456 @opindex bundle_loader
13457 This option specifies the @var{executable} that will load the build
13458 output file being linked. See man ld(1) for more information.
13459
13460 @item -dynamiclib
13461 @opindex dynamiclib
13462 When passed this option, GCC produces a dynamic library instead of
13463 an executable when linking, using the Darwin @file{libtool} command.
13464
13465 @item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
13466 @opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
13467 This causes GCC's output file to have the @var{ALL} subtype, instead of
13468 one controlled by the @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march} option.
13469
13470 @item -allowable_client @var{client_name}
13471 @itemx -client_name
13472 @itemx -compatibility_version
13473 @itemx -current_version
13474 @itemx -dead_strip
13475 @itemx -dependency-file
13476 @itemx -dylib_file
13477 @itemx -dylinker_install_name
13478 @itemx -dynamic
13479 @itemx -exported_symbols_list
13480 @itemx -filelist
13481 @need 800
13482 @itemx -flat_namespace
13483 @itemx -force_flat_namespace
13484 @itemx -headerpad_max_install_names
13485 @itemx -image_base
13486 @itemx -init
13487 @itemx -install_name
13488 @itemx -keep_private_externs
13489 @itemx -multi_module
13490 @itemx -multiply_defined
13491 @itemx -multiply_defined_unused
13492 @need 800
13493 @itemx -noall_load
13494 @itemx -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
13495 @itemx -nofixprebinding
13496 @itemx -nomultidefs
13497 @itemx -noprebind
13498 @itemx -noseglinkedit
13499 @itemx -pagezero_size
13500 @itemx -prebind
13501 @itemx -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
13502 @itemx -private_bundle
13503 @need 800
13504 @itemx -read_only_relocs
13505 @itemx -sectalign
13506 @itemx -sectobjectsymbols
13507 @itemx -whyload
13508 @itemx -seg1addr
13509 @itemx -sectcreate
13510 @itemx -sectobjectsymbols
13511 @itemx -sectorder
13512 @itemx -segaddr
13513 @itemx -segs_read_only_addr
13514 @need 800
13515 @itemx -segs_read_write_addr
13516 @itemx -seg_addr_table
13517 @itemx -seg_addr_table_filename
13518 @itemx -seglinkedit
13519 @itemx -segprot
13520 @itemx -segs_read_only_addr
13521 @itemx -segs_read_write_addr
13522 @itemx -single_module
13523 @itemx -static
13524 @itemx -sub_library
13525 @need 800
13526 @itemx -sub_umbrella
13527 @itemx -twolevel_namespace
13528 @itemx -umbrella
13529 @itemx -undefined
13530 @itemx -unexported_symbols_list
13531 @itemx -weak_reference_mismatches
13532 @itemx -whatsloaded
13533 @opindex allowable_client
13534 @opindex client_name
13535 @opindex compatibility_version
13536 @opindex current_version
13537 @opindex dead_strip
13538 @opindex dependency-file
13539 @opindex dylib_file
13540 @opindex dylinker_install_name
13541 @opindex dynamic
13542 @opindex exported_symbols_list
13543 @opindex filelist
13544 @opindex flat_namespace
13545 @opindex force_flat_namespace
13546 @opindex headerpad_max_install_names
13547 @opindex image_base
13548 @opindex init
13549 @opindex install_name
13550 @opindex keep_private_externs
13551 @opindex multi_module
13552 @opindex multiply_defined
13553 @opindex multiply_defined_unused
13554 @opindex noall_load
13555 @opindex no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
13556 @opindex nofixprebinding
13557 @opindex nomultidefs
13558 @opindex noprebind
13559 @opindex noseglinkedit
13560 @opindex pagezero_size
13561 @opindex prebind
13562 @opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
13563 @opindex private_bundle
13564 @opindex read_only_relocs
13565 @opindex sectalign
13566 @opindex sectobjectsymbols
13567 @opindex whyload
13568 @opindex seg1addr
13569 @opindex sectcreate
13570 @opindex sectobjectsymbols
13571 @opindex sectorder
13572 @opindex segaddr
13573 @opindex segs_read_only_addr
13574 @opindex segs_read_write_addr
13575 @opindex seg_addr_table
13576 @opindex seg_addr_table_filename
13577 @opindex seglinkedit
13578 @opindex segprot
13579 @opindex segs_read_only_addr
13580 @opindex segs_read_write_addr
13581 @opindex single_module
13582 @opindex static
13583 @opindex sub_library
13584 @opindex sub_umbrella
13585 @opindex twolevel_namespace
13586 @opindex umbrella
13587 @opindex undefined
13588 @opindex unexported_symbols_list
13589 @opindex weak_reference_mismatches
13590 @opindex whatsloaded
13591 These options are passed to the Darwin linker. The Darwin linker man page
13592 describes them in detail.
13593 @end table
13594
13595 @node DEC Alpha Options
13596 @subsection DEC Alpha Options
13597
13598 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
13599
13600 @table @gcctabopt
13601 @item -mno-soft-float
13602 @itemx -msoft-float
13603 @opindex mno-soft-float
13604 @opindex msoft-float
13605 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
13606 floating-point operations. When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
13607 functions in @file{libgcc.a} are used to perform floating-point
13608 operations. Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
13609 floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
13610 emulations routines, these routines issue floating-point
13611 operations. If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
13612 operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
13613 them.
13614
13615 Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
13616 required to have floating-point registers.
13617
13618 @item -mfp-reg
13619 @itemx -mno-fp-regs
13620 @opindex mfp-reg
13621 @opindex mno-fp-regs
13622 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
13623 @option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}. If the floating-point
13624 register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed in integer
13625 registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
13626 in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}. This is a non-standard calling sequence,
13627 so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
13628 compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
13629 option.
13630
13631 A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
13632 and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
13633
13634 @item -mieee
13635 @opindex mieee
13636 The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
13637 maximum performance. It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating-point
13638 standard. However, for full compliance, software assistance is
13639 required. This option generates code fully IEEE-compliant code
13640 @emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
13641 If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
13642 defined during compilation. The resulting code is less efficient but is
13643 able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
13644 values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity. Other Alpha
13645 compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
13646
13647 @item -mieee-with-inexact
13648 @opindex mieee-with-inexact
13649 This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
13650 the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}. Turning on this option causes the
13651 generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math. In addition to
13652 @code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
13653 macro. On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
13654 significantly slower than the code generated by default. Since there is
13655 very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
13656 normally not specify this option. Other Alpha compilers call this
13657 option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
13658
13659 @item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
13660 @opindex mfp-trap-mode
13661 This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
13662 Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
13663 The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
13664
13665 @table @samp
13666 @item n
13667 This is the default (normal) setting. The only traps that are enabled
13668 are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
13669 trap).
13670
13671 @item u
13672 In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
13673 as well.
13674
13675 @item su
13676 Like @samp{u}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
13677 completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
13678
13679 @item sui
13680 Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
13681 @end table
13682
13683 @item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
13684 @opindex mfp-rounding-mode
13685 Selects the IEEE rounding mode. Other Alpha compilers call this option
13686 @option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}. The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
13687 of:
13688
13689 @table @samp
13690 @item n
13691 Normal IEEE rounding mode. Floating-point numbers are rounded towards
13692 the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
13693 of a tie.
13694
13695 @item m
13696 Round towards minus infinity.
13697
13698 @item c
13699 Chopped rounding mode. Floating-point numbers are rounded towards zero.
13700
13701 @item d
13702 Dynamic rounding mode. A field in the floating-point control register
13703 (@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
13704 rounding mode in effect. The C library initializes this register for
13705 rounding towards plus infinity. Thus, unless your program modifies the
13706 @var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
13707 @end table
13708
13709 @item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
13710 @opindex mtrap-precision
13711 In the Alpha architecture, floating-point traps are imprecise. This
13712 means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
13713 floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
13714 GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
13715 in determining the exact location that caused a floating-point trap.
13716 Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
13717 precisions can be selected:
13718
13719 @table @samp
13720 @item p
13721 Program precision. This option is the default and means a trap handler
13722 can only identify which program caused a floating-point exception.
13723
13724 @item f
13725 Function precision. The trap handler can determine the function that
13726 caused a floating-point exception.
13727
13728 @item i
13729 Instruction precision. The trap handler can determine the exact
13730 instruction that caused a floating-point exception.
13731 @end table
13732
13733 Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
13734 @option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
13735
13736 @item -mieee-conformant
13737 @opindex mieee-conformant
13738 This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant. You must not
13739 use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
13740 @option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}. Its only effect
13741 is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
13742 generated assembly file.
13743
13744 @item -mbuild-constants
13745 @opindex mbuild-constants
13746 Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
13747 see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
13748 instructions. If it cannot, it outputs the constant as a literal and
13749 generates code to load it from the data segment at run time.
13750
13751 Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
13752 using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
13753
13754 You typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
13755 loader. Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
13756 before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
13757
13758 @item -mbwx
13759 @itemx -mno-bwx
13760 @itemx -mcix
13761 @itemx -mno-cix
13762 @itemx -mfix
13763 @itemx -mno-fix
13764 @itemx -mmax
13765 @itemx -mno-max
13766 @opindex mbwx
13767 @opindex mno-bwx
13768 @opindex mcix
13769 @opindex mno-cix
13770 @opindex mfix
13771 @opindex mno-fix
13772 @opindex mmax
13773 @opindex mno-max
13774 Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
13775 CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets. The default is to use the instruction
13776 sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
13777 of the CPU on which GCC was built if none is specified.
13778
13779 @item -mfloat-vax
13780 @itemx -mfloat-ieee
13781 @opindex mfloat-vax
13782 @opindex mfloat-ieee
13783 Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point
13784 arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
13785
13786 @item -mexplicit-relocs
13787 @itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
13788 @opindex mexplicit-relocs
13789 @opindex mno-explicit-relocs
13790 Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
13791 except via assembler macros. Use of these macros does not allow
13792 optimal instruction scheduling. GNU binutils as of version 2.12
13793 supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
13794 which relocations should apply to which instructions. This option
13795 is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
13796 the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
13797
13798 @item -msmall-data
13799 @itemx -mlarge-data
13800 @opindex msmall-data
13801 @opindex mlarge-data
13802 When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
13803 accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations. When @option{-msmall-data}
13804 is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
13805 (the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
13806 16-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register. This limits the
13807 size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
13808 directly accessed via a single instruction.
13809
13810 The default is @option{-mlarge-data}. With this option the data area
13811 is limited to just below 2GB@. Programs that require more than 2GB of
13812 data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
13813 heap instead of in the program's data segment.
13814
13815 When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
13816 @option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
13817
13818 @item -msmall-text
13819 @itemx -mlarge-text
13820 @opindex msmall-text
13821 @opindex mlarge-text
13822 When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
13823 code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
13824 thus reachable with a branch instruction. When @option{-msmall-data}
13825 is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
13826 same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
13827 required for a function call from 4 to 1.
13828
13829 The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
13830
13831 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
13832 @opindex mcpu
13833 Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
13834 machine type @var{cpu_type}. You can specify either the @samp{EV}
13835 style name or the corresponding chip number. GCC supports scheduling
13836 parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and
13837 chooses the default values for the instruction set from the processor
13838 you specify. If you do not specify a processor type, GCC defaults
13839 to the processor on which the compiler was built.
13840
13841 Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
13842
13843 @table @samp
13844 @item ev4
13845 @itemx ev45
13846 @itemx 21064
13847 Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
13848
13849 @item ev5
13850 @itemx 21164
13851 Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
13852
13853 @item ev56
13854 @itemx 21164a
13855 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
13856
13857 @item pca56
13858 @itemx 21164pc
13859 @itemx 21164PC
13860 Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
13861
13862 @item ev6
13863 @itemx 21264
13864 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
13865
13866 @item ev67
13867 @itemx 21264a
13868 Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
13869 @end table
13870
13871 Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
13872 which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
13873 @option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
13874 the processor.
13875
13876 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
13877 @opindex mtune
13878 Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
13879 @var{cpu_type}. The instruction set is not changed.
13880
13881 Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
13882 which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
13883 @option{-mtune=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
13884 the processor.
13885
13886 @item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
13887 @opindex mmemory-latency
13888 Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
13889 references as seen by the application. This number is highly
13890 dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
13891 and the size of the external cache on the machine.
13892
13893 Valid options for @var{time} are
13894
13895 @table @samp
13896 @item @var{number}
13897 A decimal number representing clock cycles.
13898
13899 @item L1
13900 @itemx L2
13901 @itemx L3
13902 @itemx main
13903 The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
13904 ``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
13905 (also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
13906 Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
13907
13908 @end table
13909 @end table
13910
13911 @node FR30 Options
13912 @subsection FR30 Options
13913 @cindex FR30 Options
13914
13915 These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.
13916
13917 @table @gcctabopt
13918
13919 @item -msmall-model
13920 @opindex msmall-model
13921 Use the small address space model. This can produce smaller code, but
13922 it does assume that all symbolic values and addresses fit into a
13923 20-bit range.
13924
13925 @item -mno-lsim
13926 @opindex mno-lsim
13927 Assume that runtime support has been provided and so there is no need
13928 to include the simulator library (@file{libsim.a}) on the linker
13929 command line.
13930
13931 @end table
13932
13933 @node FRV Options
13934 @subsection FRV Options
13935 @cindex FRV Options
13936
13937 @table @gcctabopt
13938 @item -mgpr-32
13939 @opindex mgpr-32
13940
13941 Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.
13942
13943 @item -mgpr-64
13944 @opindex mgpr-64
13945
13946 Use all 64 general-purpose registers.
13947
13948 @item -mfpr-32
13949 @opindex mfpr-32
13950
13951 Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.
13952
13953 @item -mfpr-64
13954 @opindex mfpr-64
13955
13956 Use all 64 floating-point registers.
13957
13958 @item -mhard-float
13959 @opindex mhard-float
13960
13961 Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.
13962
13963 @item -msoft-float
13964 @opindex msoft-float
13965
13966 Use library routines for floating-point operations.
13967
13968 @item -malloc-cc
13969 @opindex malloc-cc
13970
13971 Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
13972
13973 @item -mfixed-cc
13974 @opindex mfixed-cc
13975
13976 Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
13977 use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
13978
13979 @item -mdword
13980 @opindex mdword
13981
13982 Change ABI to use double word insns.
13983
13984 @item -mno-dword
13985 @opindex mno-dword
13986
13987 Do not use double word instructions.
13988
13989 @item -mdouble
13990 @opindex mdouble
13991
13992 Use floating-point double instructions.
13993
13994 @item -mno-double
13995 @opindex mno-double
13996
13997 Do not use floating-point double instructions.
13998
13999 @item -mmedia
14000 @opindex mmedia
14001
14002 Use media instructions.
14003
14004 @item -mno-media
14005 @opindex mno-media
14006
14007 Do not use media instructions.
14008
14009 @item -mmuladd
14010 @opindex mmuladd
14011
14012 Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
14013
14014 @item -mno-muladd
14015 @opindex mno-muladd
14016
14017 Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
14018
14019 @item -mfdpic
14020 @opindex mfdpic
14021
14022 Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent
14023 pointers to functions. Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
14024 implies @option{-fPIE}. With @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}, it
14025 assumes GOT entries and small data are within a 12-bit range from the
14026 GOT base address; with @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, GOT offsets
14027 are computed with 32 bits.
14028 With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
14029
14030 @item -minline-plt
14031 @opindex minline-plt
14032
14033 Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
14034 not known to bind locally. It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
14035 It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
14036 shared libraries (i.e., @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fpic}), or when an
14037 optimization option such as @option{-O3} or above is present in the
14038 command line.
14039
14040 @item -mTLS
14041 @opindex mTLS
14042
14043 Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
14044
14045 @item -mtls
14046 @opindex mtls
14047
14048 Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
14049
14050 @item -mgprel-ro
14051 @opindex mgprel-ro
14052
14053 Enable the use of @code{GPREL} relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
14054 that is known to be in read-only sections. It's enabled by default,
14055 except for @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}: even though it may help
14056 make the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
14057 With @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, it trades 3 instructions for 4,
14058 one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need
14059 for a GOT entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a
14060 win. If it is not, @option{-mno-gprel-ro} can be used to disable it.
14061
14062 @item -multilib-library-pic
14063 @opindex multilib-library-pic
14064
14065 Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries. It's implied by
14066 @option{-mlibrary-pic}, as well as by @option{-fPIC} and
14067 @option{-fpic} without @option{-mfdpic}. You should never have to use
14068 it explicitly.
14069
14070 @item -mlinked-fp
14071 @opindex mlinked-fp
14072
14073 Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever
14074 a stack frame is allocated. This option is enabled by default and can
14075 be disabled with @option{-mno-linked-fp}.
14076
14077 @item -mlong-calls
14078 @opindex mlong-calls
14079
14080 Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
14081 compilation unit. This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
14082 within the 32-bit address space.
14083
14084 @item -malign-labels
14085 @opindex malign-labels
14086
14087 Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting NOPs into the
14088 previous packet. This option only has an effect when VLIW packing
14089 is enabled. It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds NOPs to
14090 existing ones.
14091
14092 @item -mlibrary-pic
14093 @opindex mlibrary-pic
14094
14095 Generate position-independent EABI code.
14096
14097 @item -macc-4
14098 @opindex macc-4
14099
14100 Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
14101
14102 @item -macc-8
14103 @opindex macc-8
14104
14105 Use all eight media accumulator registers.
14106
14107 @item -mpack
14108 @opindex mpack
14109
14110 Pack VLIW instructions.
14111
14112 @item -mno-pack
14113 @opindex mno-pack
14114
14115 Do not pack VLIW instructions.
14116
14117 @item -mno-eflags
14118 @opindex mno-eflags
14119
14120 Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
14121
14122 @item -mcond-move
14123 @opindex mcond-move
14124
14125 Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
14126
14127 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14128 in a future version.
14129
14130 @item -mno-cond-move
14131 @opindex mno-cond-move
14132
14133 Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
14134
14135 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14136 in a future version.
14137
14138 @item -mscc
14139 @opindex mscc
14140
14141 Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
14142
14143 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14144 in a future version.
14145
14146 @item -mno-scc
14147 @opindex mno-scc
14148
14149 Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
14150
14151 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14152 in a future version.
14153
14154 @item -mcond-exec
14155 @opindex mcond-exec
14156
14157 Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
14158
14159 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14160 in a future version.
14161
14162 @item -mno-cond-exec
14163 @opindex mno-cond-exec
14164
14165 Disable the use of conditional execution.
14166
14167 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14168 in a future version.
14169
14170 @item -mvliw-branch
14171 @opindex mvliw-branch
14172
14173 Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
14174
14175 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14176 in a future version.
14177
14178 @item -mno-vliw-branch
14179 @opindex mno-vliw-branch
14180
14181 Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
14182
14183 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14184 in a future version.
14185
14186 @item -mmulti-cond-exec
14187 @opindex mmulti-cond-exec
14188
14189 Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
14190 (default).
14191
14192 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14193 in a future version.
14194
14195 @item -mno-multi-cond-exec
14196 @opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
14197
14198 Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
14199
14200 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14201 in a future version.
14202
14203 @item -mnested-cond-exec
14204 @opindex mnested-cond-exec
14205
14206 Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
14207
14208 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14209 in a future version.
14210
14211 @item -mno-nested-cond-exec
14212 @opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
14213
14214 Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
14215
14216 This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
14217 in a future version.
14218
14219 @item -moptimize-membar
14220 @opindex moptimize-membar
14221
14222 This switch removes redundant @code{membar} instructions from the
14223 compiler-generated code. It is enabled by default.
14224
14225 @item -mno-optimize-membar
14226 @opindex mno-optimize-membar
14227
14228 This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant @code{membar}
14229 instructions from the generated code.
14230
14231 @item -mtomcat-stats
14232 @opindex mtomcat-stats
14233
14234 Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
14235
14236 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
14237 @opindex mcpu
14238
14239 Select the processor type for which to generate code. Possible values are
14240 @samp{frv}, @samp{fr550}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr450},
14241 @samp{fr405}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300} and @samp{simple}.
14242
14243 @end table
14244
14245 @node GNU/Linux Options
14246 @subsection GNU/Linux Options
14247
14248 These @samp{-m} options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
14249
14250 @table @gcctabopt
14251 @item -mglibc
14252 @opindex mglibc
14253 Use the GNU C library. This is the default except
14254 on @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} and @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
14255
14256 @item -muclibc
14257 @opindex muclibc
14258 Use uClibc C library. This is the default on
14259 @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
14260
14261 @item -mbionic
14262 @opindex mbionic
14263 Use Bionic C library. This is the default on
14264 @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
14265
14266 @item -mandroid
14267 @opindex mandroid
14268 Compile code compatible with Android platform. This is the default on
14269 @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
14270
14271 When compiling, this option enables @option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC},
14272 @option{-fno-exceptions} and @option{-fno-rtti} by default. When linking,
14273 this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.
14274 Finally, this option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__ANDROID__}
14275 to be defined.
14276
14277 @item -tno-android-cc
14278 @opindex tno-android-cc
14279 Disable compilation effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., do not enable
14280 @option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fno-exceptions} and
14281 @option{-fno-rtti} by default.
14282
14283 @item -tno-android-ld
14284 @opindex tno-android-ld
14285 Disable linking effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., pass standard Linux
14286 linking options to the linker.
14287
14288 @end table
14289
14290 @node H8/300 Options
14291 @subsection H8/300 Options
14292
14293 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
14294
14295 @table @gcctabopt
14296 @item -mrelax
14297 @opindex mrelax
14298 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
14299 linker option @option{-relax}. @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
14300 ld, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
14301
14302 @item -mh
14303 @opindex mh
14304 Generate code for the H8/300H@.
14305
14306 @item -ms
14307 @opindex ms
14308 Generate code for the H8S@.
14309
14310 @item -mn
14311 @opindex mn
14312 Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode. This switch
14313 must be used either with @option{-mh} or @option{-ms}.
14314
14315 @item -ms2600
14316 @opindex ms2600
14317 Generate code for the H8S/2600. This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
14318
14319 @item -mexr
14320 @opindex mexr
14321 Extended registers are stored on stack before execution of function
14322 with monitor attribute. Default option is @option{-mexr}.
14323 This option is valid only for H8S targets.
14324
14325 @item -mno-exr
14326 @opindex mno-exr
14327 Extended registers are not stored on stack before execution of function
14328 with monitor attribute. Default option is @option{-mno-exr}.
14329 This option is valid only for H8S targets.
14330
14331 @item -mint32
14332 @opindex mint32
14333 Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
14334
14335 @item -malign-300
14336 @opindex malign-300
14337 On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
14338 The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on
14339 4-byte boundaries.
14340 @option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2-byte boundaries.
14341 This option has no effect on the H8/300.
14342 @end table
14343
14344 @node HPPA Options
14345 @subsection HPPA Options
14346 @cindex HPPA Options
14347
14348 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
14349
14350 @table @gcctabopt
14351 @item -march=@var{architecture-type}
14352 @opindex march
14353 Generate code for the specified architecture. The choices for
14354 @var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
14355 1.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors. Refer to
14356 @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
14357 architecture option for your machine. Code compiled for lower numbered
14358 architectures runs on higher numbered architectures, but not the
14359 other way around.
14360
14361 @item -mpa-risc-1-0
14362 @itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
14363 @itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
14364 @opindex mpa-risc-1-0
14365 @opindex mpa-risc-1-1
14366 @opindex mpa-risc-2-0
14367 Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
14368
14369 @item -mjump-in-delay
14370 @opindex mjump-in-delay
14371 Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
14372 by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
14373 of the conditional jump.
14374
14375 @item -mdisable-fpregs
14376 @opindex mdisable-fpregs
14377 Prevent floating-point registers from being used in any manner. This is
14378 necessary for compiling kernels that perform lazy context switching of
14379 floating-point registers. If you use this option and attempt to perform
14380 floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.
14381
14382 @item -mdisable-indexing
14383 @opindex mdisable-indexing
14384 Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes. This avoids some
14385 rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
14386
14387 @item -mno-space-regs
14388 @opindex mno-space-regs
14389 Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers. This allows
14390 GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
14391
14392 Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
14393
14394 @item -mfast-indirect-calls
14395 @opindex mfast-indirect-calls
14396 Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries. This
14397 allows GCC to emit code that performs faster indirect calls.
14398
14399 This option does not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
14400 functions.
14401
14402 @item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
14403 @opindex mfixed-range
14404 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
14405 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use. This is
14406 useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is specified as
14407 two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register ranges can be
14408 specified separated by a comma.
14409
14410 @item -mlong-load-store
14411 @opindex mlong-load-store
14412 Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
14413 the HP-UX 10 linker. This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
14414 the HP compilers.
14415
14416 @item -mportable-runtime
14417 @opindex mportable-runtime
14418 Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
14419
14420 @item -mgas
14421 @opindex mgas
14422 Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
14423
14424 @item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
14425 @opindex mschedule
14426 Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
14427 @var{cpu-type}. The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
14428 @samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}. Refer
14429 to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
14430 proper scheduling option for your machine. The default scheduling is
14431 @samp{8000}.
14432
14433 @item -mlinker-opt
14434 @opindex mlinker-opt
14435 Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker. Note this makes symbolic
14436 debugging impossible. It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
14437 linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
14438
14439 @item -msoft-float
14440 @opindex msoft-float
14441 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
14442 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
14443 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
14444 used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make
14445 your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
14446 cross-compilation.
14447
14448 @option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
14449 therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
14450 this option. In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
14451 library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
14452 this to work.
14453
14454 @item -msio
14455 @opindex msio
14456 Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO@. The default is
14457 @option{-mwsio}. This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
14458 @code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO@. These
14459 options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX@.
14460
14461 @item -mgnu-ld
14462 @opindex mgnu-ld
14463 Use options specific to GNU @command{ld}.
14464 This passes @option{-shared} to @command{ld} when
14465 building a shared library. It is the default when GCC is configured,
14466 explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker. This option does not
14467 affect which @command{ld} is called; it only changes what parameters
14468 are passed to that @command{ld}.
14469 The @command{ld} that is called is determined by the
14470 @option{--with-ld} configure option, GCC's program search path, and
14471 finally by the user's @env{PATH}. The linker used by GCC can be printed
14472 using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}. This option is only available
14473 on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
14474
14475 @item -mhp-ld
14476 @opindex mhp-ld
14477 Use options specific to HP @command{ld}.
14478 This passes @option{-b} to @command{ld} when building
14479 a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to @command{ld} on all
14480 links. It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
14481 implicitly, with the HP linker. This option does not affect
14482 which @command{ld} is called; it only changes what parameters are passed to that
14483 @command{ld}.
14484 The @command{ld} that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
14485 configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's
14486 @env{PATH}. The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
14487 `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}. This option is only available on the 64-bit
14488 HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
14489
14490 @item -mlong-calls
14491 @opindex mno-long-calls
14492 Generate code that uses long call sequences. This ensures that a call
14493 is always able to reach linker generated stubs. The default is to generate
14494 long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
14495 of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
14496 predefined limit set by the branch type being used. The limits for
14497 normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
14498 PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures. Sibcalls are always limited at
14499 240,000 bytes.
14500
14501 Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
14502 @option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
14503 and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
14504 the SOM linker.
14505
14506 It is normally not desirable to use this option as it degrades
14507 performance. However, it may be useful in large applications,
14508 particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
14509
14510 The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
14511 assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated. The
14512 impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
14513 symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
14514 However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
14515 and it is quite long.
14516
14517 @item -munix=@var{unix-std}
14518 @opindex march
14519 Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified
14520 UNIX standard. The choices for @var{unix-std} are @samp{93}, @samp{95}
14521 and @samp{98}. @samp{93} is supported on all HP-UX versions. @samp{95}
14522 is available on HP-UX 10.10 and later. @samp{98} is available on HP-UX
14523 11.11 and later. The default values are @samp{93} for HP-UX 10.00,
14524 @samp{95} for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and @samp{98} for HP-UX 11.11
14525 and later.
14526
14527 @option{-munix=93} provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
14528 @option{-munix=95} provides additional predefines for @code{XOPEN_UNIX}
14529 and @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, and the startfile @file{unix95.o}.
14530 @option{-munix=98} provides additional predefines for @code{_XOPEN_UNIX},
14531 @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, @code{_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE} and
14532 @code{_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500}, and the startfile @file{unix98.o}.
14533
14534 It is @emph{important} to note that this option changes the interfaces
14535 for various library routines. It also affects the operational behavior
14536 of the C library. Thus, @emph{extreme} care is needed in using this
14537 option.
14538
14539 Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
14540 standard must test, set and restore the variable @var{__xpg4_extended_mask}
14541 as appropriate. Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.
14542
14543 @item -nolibdld
14544 @opindex nolibdld
14545 Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the
14546 @option{-static} option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
14547
14548 @item -static
14549 @opindex static
14550 The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
14551 libdld.sl. There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl. Thus,
14552 when the @option{-static} option is specified, special link options
14553 are needed to resolve this dependency.
14554
14555 On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
14556 link with libdld.sl when the @option{-static} option is specified.
14557 This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic. On the 64-bit port,
14558 the linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case. The
14559 @option{-nolibdld} option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from
14560 adding these link options.
14561
14562 @item -threads
14563 @opindex threads
14564 Add support for multithreading with the @dfn{dce thread} library
14565 under HP-UX@. This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
14566 linker.
14567 @end table
14568
14569 @node i386 and x86-64 Options
14570 @subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
14571 @cindex i386 Options
14572 @cindex x86-64 Options
14573 @cindex Intel 386 Options
14574 @cindex AMD x86-64 Options
14575
14576 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
14577 computers:
14578
14579 @table @gcctabopt
14580
14581 @item -march=@var{cpu-type}
14582 @opindex march
14583 Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}. In contrast to
14584 @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}, which merely tunes the generated code
14585 for the specified @var{cpu-type}, @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} allows GCC
14586 to generate code that may not run at all on processors other than the one
14587 indicated. Specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies
14588 @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}.
14589
14590 The choices for @var{cpu-type} are:
14591
14592 @table @samp
14593 @item native
14594 This selects the CPU to generate code for at compilation time by determining
14595 the processor type of the compiling machine. Using @option{-march=native}
14596 enables all instruction subsets supported by the local machine (hence
14597 the result might not run on different machines). Using @option{-mtune=native}
14598 produces code optimized for the local machine under the constraints
14599 of the selected instruction set.
14600
14601 @item i386
14602 Original Intel i386 CPU@.
14603
14604 @item i486
14605 Intel i486 CPU@. (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
14606
14607 @item i586
14608 @itemx pentium
14609 Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
14610
14611 @item pentium-mmx
14612 Intel Pentium MMX CPU, based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.
14613
14614 @item pentiumpro
14615 Intel Pentium Pro CPU@.
14616
14617 @item i686
14618 When used with @option{-march}, the Pentium Pro
14619 instruction set is used, so the code runs on all i686 family chips.
14620 When used with @option{-mtune}, it has the same meaning as @samp{generic}.
14621
14622 @item pentium2
14623 Intel Pentium II CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX instruction set
14624 support.
14625
14626 @item pentium3
14627 @itemx pentium3m
14628 Intel Pentium III CPU, based on Pentium Pro core with MMX and SSE instruction
14629 set support.
14630
14631 @item pentium-m
14632 Intel Pentium M; low-power version of Intel Pentium III CPU
14633 with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support. Used by Centrino notebooks.
14634
14635 @item pentium4
14636 @itemx pentium4m
14637 Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.
14638
14639 @item prescott
14640 Improved version of Intel Pentium 4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
14641 set support.
14642
14643 @item nocona
14644 Improved version of Intel Pentium 4 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE,
14645 SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
14646
14647 @item core2
14648 Intel Core 2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
14649 instruction set support.
14650
14651 @item corei7
14652 Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14653 SSE4.1, SSE4.2 and POPCNT instruction set support.
14654
14655 @item corei7-avx
14656 Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14657 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.
14658
14659 @item core-avx-i
14660 Intel Core CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14661 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C
14662 instruction set support.
14663
14664 @item core-avx2
14665 Intel Core CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14666 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA,
14667 BMI, BMI2 and F16C instruction set support.
14668
14669 @item broadwell
14670 Intel Broadwell CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14671 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, FMA,
14672 BMI, BMI2, F16C, RDSEED, ADCX, PREFETCHW instruction set support.
14673
14674 @item atom
14675 Intel Atom CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
14676 instruction set support.
14677
14678 @item slm
14679 Intel Silvermont CPU with 64-bit extensions, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
14680 SSE4.1, SSE4.2, POPCNT, AES, PCLMUL and RDRND instruction set support.
14681
14682 @item k6
14683 AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
14684
14685 @item k6-2
14686 @itemx k6-3
14687 Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
14688
14689 @item athlon
14690 @itemx athlon-tbird
14691 AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and SSE prefetch instructions
14692 support.
14693
14694 @item athlon-4
14695 @itemx athlon-xp
14696 @itemx athlon-mp
14697 Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and full SSE
14698 instruction set support.
14699
14700 @item k8
14701 @itemx opteron
14702 @itemx athlon64
14703 @itemx athlon-fx
14704 Processors based on the AMD K8 core with x86-64 instruction set support,
14705 including the AMD Opteron, Athlon 64, and Athlon 64 FX processors.
14706 (This supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and 64-bit
14707 instruction set extensions.)
14708
14709 @item k8-sse3
14710 @itemx opteron-sse3
14711 @itemx athlon64-sse3
14712 Improved versions of AMD K8 cores with SSE3 instruction set support.
14713
14714 @item amdfam10
14715 @itemx barcelona
14716 CPUs based on AMD Family 10h cores with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14717 supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit
14718 instruction set extensions.)
14719
14720 @item bdver1
14721 CPUs based on AMD Family 15h cores with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14722 supersets FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A,
14723 SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
14724 @item bdver2
14725 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14726 supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX,
14727 SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set
14728 extensions.)
14729 @item bdver3
14730 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14731 supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, FSGSBASE, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES,
14732 PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and
14733 64-bit instruction set extensions.
14734 @item bdver4
14735 AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14736 supersets BMI, BMI2, TBM, F16C, FMA, FMA4, FSGSBASE, AVX, AVX2, XOP, LWP,
14737 AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MOVBE, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1,
14738 SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.
14739
14740 @item btver1
14741 CPUs based on AMD Family 14h cores with x86-64 instruction set support. (This
14742 supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A, CX16, ABM and 64-bit
14743 instruction set extensions.)
14744
14745 @item btver2
14746 CPUs based on AMD Family 16h cores with x86-64 instruction set support. This
14747 includes MOVBE, F16C, BMI, AVX, PCL_MUL, AES, SSE4.2, SSE4.1, CX16, ABM,
14748 SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE3, SSE2, SSE, MMX and 64-bit instruction set extensions.
14749
14750 @item winchip-c6
14751 IDT WinChip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction
14752 set support.
14753
14754 @item winchip2
14755 IDT WinChip 2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX and 3DNow!@:
14756 instruction set support.
14757
14758 @item c3
14759 VIA C3 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support. (No scheduling is
14760 implemented for this chip.)
14761
14762 @item c3-2
14763 VIA C3-2 (Nehemiah/C5XL) CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.
14764 (No scheduling is
14765 implemented for this chip.)
14766
14767 @item geode
14768 AMD Geode embedded processor with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
14769 @end table
14770
14771 @item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
14772 @opindex mtune
14773 Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
14774 for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
14775 While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} schedules things appropriately
14776 for that particular chip, the compiler does not generate any code that
14777 cannot run on the default machine type unless you use a
14778 @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} option.
14779 For example, if GCC is configured for i686-pc-linux-gnu
14780 then @option{-mtune=pentium4} generates code that is tuned for Pentium 4
14781 but still runs on i686 machines.
14782
14783 The choices for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-march}.
14784 In addition, @option{-mtune} supports 2 extra choices for @var{cpu-type}:
14785
14786 @table @samp
14787 @item generic
14788 Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/@/AMD64/@/EM64T processors.
14789 If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
14790 the corresponding @option{-mtune} or @option{-march} option instead of
14791 @option{-mtune=generic}. But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users
14792 of your application will have, then you should use this option.
14793
14794 As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this
14795 option will change. Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
14796 GCC, code generation controlled by this option will change to reflect
14797 the processors
14798 that are most common at the time that version of GCC is released.
14799
14800 There is no @option{-march=generic} option because @option{-march}
14801 indicates the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no
14802 generic instruction set applicable to all processors. In contrast,
14803 @option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
14804 processors) for which the code is optimized.
14805
14806 @item intel
14807 Produce code optimized for the most current Intel processors, which are
14808 Haswell and Silvermont for this version of GCC. If you know the CPU
14809 on which your code will run, then you should use the corresponding
14810 @option{-mtune} or @option{-march} option instead of @option{-mtune=intel}.
14811 But, if you want your application performs better on both Haswell and
14812 Silvermont, then you should use this option.
14813
14814 As new Intel processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of
14815 this option will change. Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
14816 GCC, code generation controlled by this option will change to reflect
14817 the most current Intel processors at the time that version of GCC is
14818 released.
14819
14820 There is no @option{-march=intel} option because @option{-march} indicates
14821 the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no common
14822 instruction set applicable to all processors. In contrast,
14823 @option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
14824 processors) for which the code is optimized.
14825 @end table
14826
14827 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
14828 @opindex mcpu
14829 A deprecated synonym for @option{-mtune}.
14830
14831 @item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
14832 @opindex mfpmath
14833 Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit @var{unit}. The choices
14834 for @var{unit} are:
14835
14836 @table @samp
14837 @item 387
14838 Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the majority of chips and
14839 emulated otherwise. Code compiled with this option runs almost everywhere.
14840 The temporary results are computed in 80-bit precision instead of the precision
14841 specified by the type, resulting in slightly different results compared to most
14842 of other chips. See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
14843
14844 This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
14845
14846 @item sse
14847 Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
14848 This instruction set is supported by Pentium III and newer chips,
14849 and in the AMD line
14850 by Athlon-4, Athlon XP and Athlon MP chips. The earlier version of the SSE
14851 instruction set supports only single-precision arithmetic, thus the double and
14852 extended-precision arithmetic are still done using 387. A later version, present
14853 only in Pentium 4 and AMD x86-64 chips, supports double-precision
14854 arithmetic too.
14855
14856 For the i386 compiler, you must use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse}
14857 or @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
14858 effective. For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
14859
14860 The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid
14861 the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
14862 code that expects temporaries to be 80 bits.
14863
14864 This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.
14865
14866 @item sse,387
14867 @itemx sse+387
14868 @itemx both
14869 Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once. This effectively doubles the
14870 amount of available registers, and on chips with separate execution units for
14871 387 and SSE the execution resources too. Use this option with care, as it is
14872 still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not model separate
14873 functional units well, resulting in unstable performance.
14874 @end table
14875
14876 @item -masm=@var{dialect}
14877 @opindex masm=@var{dialect}
14878 Output assembly instructions using selected @var{dialect}. Supported
14879 choices are @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default). Darwin does
14880 not support @samp{intel}.
14881
14882 @item -mieee-fp
14883 @itemx -mno-ieee-fp
14884 @opindex mieee-fp
14885 @opindex mno-ieee-fp
14886 Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point
14887 comparisons. These correctly handle the case where the result of a
14888 comparison is unordered.
14889
14890 @item -msoft-float
14891 @opindex msoft-float
14892 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
14893
14894 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
14895 Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
14896 this can't be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make your
14897 own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
14898 cross-compilation.
14899
14900 On machines where a function returns floating-point results in the 80387
14901 register stack, some floating-point opcodes may be emitted even if
14902 @option{-msoft-float} is used.
14903
14904 @item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
14905 @opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
14906 Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
14907
14908 The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
14909 @code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
14910 is no FPU@. The idea is that the operating system should emulate
14911 an FPU@.
14912
14913 The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
14914 in ordinary CPU registers instead.
14915
14916 @item -mno-fancy-math-387
14917 @opindex mno-fancy-math-387
14918 Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
14919 @code{sqrt} instructions for the 387. Specify this option to avoid
14920 generating those instructions. This option is the default on FreeBSD,
14921 OpenBSD and NetBSD@. This option is overridden when @option{-march}
14922 indicates that the target CPU always has an FPU and so the
14923 instruction does not need emulation. These
14924 instructions are not generated unless you also use the
14925 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
14926
14927 @item -malign-double
14928 @itemx -mno-align-double
14929 @opindex malign-double
14930 @opindex mno-align-double
14931 Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
14932 @code{long long} variables on a two-word boundary or a one-word
14933 boundary. Aligning @code{double} variables on a two-word boundary
14934 produces code that runs somewhat faster on a Pentium at the
14935 expense of more memory.
14936
14937 On x86-64, @option{-malign-double} is enabled by default.
14938
14939 @strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
14940 structures containing the above types are aligned differently than
14941 the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
14942 and are not binary compatible with structures in code compiled
14943 without that switch.
14944
14945 @item -m96bit-long-double
14946 @itemx -m128bit-long-double
14947 @opindex m96bit-long-double
14948 @opindex m128bit-long-double
14949 These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. The i386
14950 application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits,
14951 so @option{-m96bit-long-double} is the default in 32-bit mode.
14952
14953 Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer @code{long double}
14954 to be aligned to an 8- or 16-byte boundary. In arrays or structures
14955 conforming to the ABI, this is not possible. So specifying
14956 @option{-m128bit-long-double} aligns @code{long double}
14957 to a 16-byte boundary by padding the @code{long double} with an additional
14958 32-bit zero.
14959
14960 In the x86-64 compiler, @option{-m128bit-long-double} is the default choice as
14961 its ABI specifies that @code{long double} is aligned on 16-byte boundary.
14962
14963 Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87
14964 standard of 80 bits for a @code{long double}.
14965
14966 @strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, this
14967 changes the size of
14968 structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables,
14969 as well as modifying the function calling convention for functions taking
14970 @code{long double}. Hence they are not binary-compatible
14971 with code compiled without that switch.
14972
14973 @item -mlong-double-64
14974 @itemx -mlong-double-80
14975 @opindex mlong-double-64
14976 @opindex mlong-double-80
14977 These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
14978 of 64 bits makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
14979 type. This is the default for Bionic C library.
14980
14981 @strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, this
14982 changes the size of
14983 structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables,
14984 as well as modifying the function calling convention for functions taking
14985 @code{long double}. Hence they are not binary-compatible
14986 with code compiled without that switch.
14987
14988 @item -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{threshold}
14989 @opindex mlarge-data-threshold
14990 When @option{-mcmodel=medium} is specified, data objects larger than
14991 @var{threshold} are placed in the large data section. This value must be the
14992 same across all objects linked into the binary, and defaults to 65535.
14993
14994 @item -mrtd
14995 @opindex mrtd
14996 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
14997 take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret @var{num}}
14998 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This saves one
14999 instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
15000 there.
15001
15002 You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
15003 sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}. You can also
15004 override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
15005 @samp{cdecl}. @xref{Function Attributes}.
15006
15007 @strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
15008 normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
15009 libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
15010
15011 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
15012 take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
15013 otherwise incorrect code is generated for calls to those
15014 functions.
15015
15016 In addition, seriously incorrect code results if you call a
15017 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
15018 harmlessly ignored.)
15019
15020 @item -mregparm=@var{num}
15021 @opindex mregparm
15022 Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments. By
15023 default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
15024 registers can be used. You can control this behavior for a specific
15025 function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
15026 @xref{Function Attributes}.
15027
15028 @strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
15029 @var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
15030 value, including any libraries. This includes the system libraries and
15031 startup modules.
15032
15033 @item -msseregparm
15034 @opindex msseregparm
15035 Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
15036 and return values. You can control this behavior for a specific
15037 function by using the function attribute @samp{sseregparm}.
15038 @xref{Function Attributes}.
15039
15040 @strong{Warning:} if you use this switch then you must build all
15041 modules with the same value, including any libraries. This includes
15042 the system libraries and startup modules.
15043
15044 @item -mvect8-ret-in-mem
15045 @opindex mvect8-ret-in-mem
15046 Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers. This is the
15047 default on Solaris@tie{}8 and 9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun
15048 Studio compilers until version 12. Later compiler versions (starting
15049 with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used by other x86 targets, which
15050 is the default on Solaris@tie{}10 and later. @emph{Only} use this option if
15051 you need to remain compatible with existing code produced by those
15052 previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC@.
15053
15054 @item -mpc32
15055 @itemx -mpc64
15056 @itemx -mpc80
15057 @opindex mpc32
15058 @opindex mpc64
15059 @opindex mpc80
15060
15061 Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits. When @option{-mpc32}
15062 is specified, the significands of results of floating-point operations are
15063 rounded to 24 bits (single precision); @option{-mpc64} rounds the
15064 significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double
15065 precision) and @option{-mpc80} rounds the significands of results of
15066 floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision), which is
15067 the default. When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher
15068 precisions are not available to the programmer without setting the FPU
15069 control word explicitly.
15070
15071 Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the default
15072 80 bits can speed some programs by 2% or more. Note that some mathematical
15073 libraries assume that extended-precision (80-bit) floating-point operations
15074 are enabled by default; routines in such libraries could suffer significant
15075 loss of accuracy, typically through so-called ``catastrophic cancellation'',
15076 when this option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.
15077
15078 @item -mstackrealign
15079 @opindex mstackrealign
15080 Realign the stack at entry. On the Intel x86, the @option{-mstackrealign}
15081 option generates an alternate prologue and epilogue that realigns the
15082 run-time stack if necessary. This supports mixing legacy codes that keep
15083 4-byte stack alignment with modern codes that keep 16-byte stack alignment for
15084 SSE compatibility. See also the attribute @code{force_align_arg_pointer},
15085 applicable to individual functions.
15086
15087 @item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
15088 @opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
15089 Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
15090 byte boundary. If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
15091 the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
15092
15093 @strong{Warning:} When generating code for the x86-64 architecture with
15094 SSE extensions disabled, @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=3} can be
15095 used to keep the stack boundary aligned to 8 byte boundary. Since
15096 x86-64 ABI require 16 byte stack alignment, this is ABI incompatible and
15097 intended to be used in controlled environment where stack space is
15098 important limitation. This option will lead to wrong code when functions
15099 compiled with 16 byte stack alignment (such as functions from a standard
15100 library) are called with misaligned stack. In this case, SSE
15101 instructions may lead to misaligned memory access traps. In addition,
15102 variable arguments will be handled incorrectly for 16 byte aligned
15103 objects (including x87 long double and __int128), leading to wrong
15104 results. You must build all modules with
15105 @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=3}, including any libraries. This
15106 includes the system libraries and startup modules.
15107
15108 @item -mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num}
15109 @opindex mincoming-stack-boundary
15110 Assume the incoming stack is aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num} byte
15111 boundary. If @option{-mincoming-stack-boundary} is not specified,
15112 the one specified by @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is used.
15113
15114 On Pentium and Pentium Pro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
15115 should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
15116 suffer significant run time performance penalties. On Pentium III, the
15117 Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} may not work
15118 properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.
15119
15120 To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
15121 must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
15122 Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
15123 aligned. Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
15124 stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
15125 boundary most likely misaligns the stack. It is recommended that
15126 libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
15127
15128 This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
15129 increases code size. Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
15130 as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
15131 preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
15132
15133 @item -mmmx
15134 @itemx -mno-mmx
15135 @itemx -msse
15136 @itemx -mno-sse
15137 @itemx -msse2
15138 @itemx -mno-sse2
15139 @itemx -msse3
15140 @itemx -mno-sse3
15141 @itemx -mssse3
15142 @itemx -mno-ssse3
15143 @itemx -msse4.1
15144 @need 800
15145 @itemx -mno-sse4.1
15146 @itemx -msse4.2
15147 @itemx -mno-sse4.2
15148 @itemx -msse4
15149 @itemx -mno-sse4
15150 @itemx -mavx
15151 @itemx -mno-avx
15152 @itemx -mavx2
15153 @itemx -mno-avx2
15154 @itemx -mavx512f
15155 @itemx -mno-avx512f
15156 @need 800
15157 @itemx -mavx512pf
15158 @itemx -mno-avx512pf
15159 @itemx -mavx512er
15160 @itemx -mno-avx512er
15161 @itemx -mavx512cd
15162 @itemx -mno-avx512cd
15163 @itemx -maes
15164 @itemx -mno-aes
15165 @itemx -mpclmul
15166 @itemx -mno-pclmul
15167 @need 800
15168 @itemx -mfsgsbase
15169 @itemx -mno-fsgsbase
15170 @itemx -mrdrnd
15171 @itemx -mno-rdrnd
15172 @itemx -mf16c
15173 @itemx -mno-f16c
15174 @itemx -mfma
15175 @itemx -mno-fma
15176 @itemx -msse4a
15177 @itemx -mno-sse4a
15178 @itemx -mfma4
15179 @itemx -mno-fma4
15180 @need 800
15181 @itemx -mxop
15182 @itemx -mno-xop
15183 @itemx -mlwp
15184 @itemx -mno-lwp
15185 @itemx -m3dnow
15186 @itemx -mno-3dnow
15187 @itemx -mpopcnt
15188 @itemx -mno-popcnt
15189 @itemx -mabm
15190 @itemx -mno-abm
15191 @itemx -mbmi
15192 @itemx -mbmi2
15193 @itemx -mno-bmi
15194 @itemx -mno-bmi2
15195 @itemx -mlzcnt
15196 @itemx -mno-lzcnt
15197 @itemx -mfxsr
15198 @itemx -mxsave
15199 @itemx -mxsaveopt
15200 @itemx -mrtm
15201 @itemx -mtbm
15202 @itemx -mno-tbm
15203 @opindex mmmx
15204 @opindex mno-mmx
15205 @opindex msse
15206 @opindex mno-sse
15207 @opindex m3dnow
15208 @opindex mno-3dnow
15209 These switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE,
15210 SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, AVX, AVX2, AVX512F, AVX512PF, AVX512ER, AVX512CD,
15211 AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, F16C, FMA, SSE4A, FMA4, XOP, LWP, ABM, BMI, BMI2,
15212 FXSR, XSAVE, XSAVEOPT, LZCNT, RTM or 3DNow!@:
15213 extended instruction sets.
15214 These extensions are also available as built-in functions: see
15215 @ref{X86 Built-in Functions}, for details of the functions enabled and
15216 disabled by these switches.
15217
15218 To generate SSE/SSE2 instructions automatically from floating-point
15219 code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
15220
15221 GCC depresses SSEx instructions when @option{-mavx} is used. Instead, it
15222 generates new AVX instructions or AVX equivalence for all SSEx instructions
15223 when needed.
15224
15225 These options enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
15226 generated code, even without @option{-mfpmath=sse}. Applications that
15227 perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
15228 supported architecture, using the appropriate flags. In particular,
15229 the file containing the CPU detection code should be compiled without
15230 these options.
15231
15232 @item -mdump-tune-features
15233 @opindex mdump-tune-features
15234 This option instructs GCC to dump the names of the x86 performance
15235 tuning features and default settings. The names can be used in
15236 @option{-mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list}}.
15237
15238 @item -mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list}
15239 @opindex mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list}
15240 This option is used to do fine grain control of x86 code generation features.
15241 @var{feature-list} is a comma separated list of @var{feature} names. See also
15242 @option{-mdump-tune-features}. When specified, the @var{feature} will be turned
15243 on if it is not preceded with @code{^}, otherwise, it will be turned off.
15244 @option{-mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list}} is intended to be used by GCC
15245 developers. Using it may lead to code paths not covered by testing and can
15246 potentially result in compiler ICEs or runtime errors.
15247
15248 @item -mno-default
15249 @opindex mno-default
15250 This option instructs GCC to turn off all tunable features. See also
15251 @option{-mtune-ctrl=@var{feature-list}} and @option{-mdump-tune-features}.
15252
15253 @item -mcld
15254 @opindex mcld
15255 This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{cld} instruction in the prologue
15256 of functions that use string instructions. String instructions depend on
15257 the DF flag to select between autoincrement or autodecrement mode. While the
15258 ABI specifies the DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some operating
15259 systems violate this specification by not clearing the DF flag in their
15260 exception dispatchers. The exception handler can be invoked with the DF flag
15261 set, which leads to wrong direction mode when string instructions are used.
15262 This option can be enabled by default on 32-bit x86 targets by configuring
15263 GCC with the @option{--enable-cld} configure option. Generation of @code{cld}
15264 instructions can be suppressed with the @option{-mno-cld} compiler option
15265 in this case.
15266
15267 @item -mvzeroupper
15268 @opindex mvzeroupper
15269 This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{vzeroupper} instruction
15270 before a transfer of control flow out of the function to minimize
15271 the AVX to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary @code{zeroupper}
15272 intrinsics.
15273
15274 @item -mprefer-avx128
15275 @opindex mprefer-avx128
15276 This option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead of
15277 256-bit AVX instructions in the auto-vectorizer.
15278
15279 @item -mcx16
15280 @opindex mcx16
15281 This option enables GCC to generate @code{CMPXCHG16B} instructions.
15282 @code{CMPXCHG16B} allows for atomic operations on 128-bit double quadword
15283 (or oword) data types.
15284 This is useful for high-resolution counters that can be updated
15285 by multiple processors (or cores). This instruction is generated as part of
15286 atomic built-in functions: see @ref{__sync Builtins} or
15287 @ref{__atomic Builtins} for details.
15288
15289 @item -msahf
15290 @opindex msahf
15291 This option enables generation of @code{SAHF} instructions in 64-bit code.
15292 Early Intel Pentium 4 CPUs with Intel 64 support,
15293 prior to the introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December 2005,
15294 lacked the @code{LAHF} and @code{SAHF} instructions
15295 which were supported by AMD64.
15296 These are load and store instructions, respectively, for certain status flags.
15297 In 64-bit mode, the @code{SAHF} instruction is used to optimize @code{fmod},
15298 @code{drem}, and @code{remainder} built-in functions;
15299 see @ref{Other Builtins} for details.
15300
15301 @item -mmovbe
15302 @opindex mmovbe
15303 This option enables use of the @code{movbe} instruction to implement
15304 @code{__builtin_bswap32} and @code{__builtin_bswap64}.
15305
15306 @item -mcrc32
15307 @opindex mcrc32
15308 This option enables built-in functions @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32qi},
15309 @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32hi}, @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32si} and
15310 @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32di} to generate the @code{crc32} machine instruction.
15311
15312 @item -mrecip
15313 @opindex mrecip
15314 This option enables use of @code{RCPSS} and @code{RSQRTSS} instructions
15315 (and their vectorized variants @code{RCPPS} and @code{RSQRTPS})
15316 with an additional Newton-Raphson step
15317 to increase precision instead of @code{DIVSS} and @code{SQRTSS}
15318 (and their vectorized
15319 variants) for single-precision floating-point arguments. These instructions
15320 are generated only when @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is enabled
15321 together with @option{-finite-math-only} and @option{-fno-trapping-math}.
15322 Note that while the throughput of the sequence is higher than the throughput
15323 of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
15324 decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).
15325
15326 Note that GCC implements @code{1.0f/sqrtf(@var{x})} in terms of @code{RSQRTSS}
15327 (or @code{RSQRTPS}) already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option
15328 combination), and doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
15329
15330 Also note that GCC emits the above sequence with additional Newton-Raphson step
15331 for vectorized single-float division and vectorized @code{sqrtf(@var{x})}
15332 already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option combination), and
15333 doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
15334
15335 @item -mrecip=@var{opt}
15336 @opindex mrecip=opt
15337 This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions
15338 may be used. @var{opt} is a comma-separated list of options, which may
15339 be preceded by a @samp{!} to invert the option:
15340
15341 @table @samp
15342 @item all
15343 Enable all estimate instructions.
15344
15345 @item default
15346 Enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip}.
15347
15348 @item none
15349 Disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip}.
15350
15351 @item div
15352 Enable the approximation for scalar division.
15353
15354 @item vec-div
15355 Enable the approximation for vectorized division.
15356
15357 @item sqrt
15358 Enable the approximation for scalar square root.
15359
15360 @item vec-sqrt
15361 Enable the approximation for vectorized square root.
15362 @end table
15363
15364 So, for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!sqrt} enables
15365 all of the reciprocal approximations, except for square root.
15366
15367 @item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
15368 @opindex mveclibabi
15369 Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
15370 external library. Supported values for @var{type} are @samp{svml}
15371 for the Intel short
15372 vector math library and @samp{acml} for the AMD math core library.
15373 To use this option, both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
15374 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled, and an SVML or ACML
15375 ABI-compatible library must be specified at link time.
15376
15377 GCC currently emits calls to @code{vmldExp2},
15378 @code{vmldLn2}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldPow2},
15379 @code{vmldTanh2}, @code{vmldTan2}, @code{vmldAtan2}, @code{vmldAtanh2},
15380 @code{vmldCbrt2}, @code{vmldSinh2}, @code{vmldSin2}, @code{vmldAsinh2},
15381 @code{vmldAsin2}, @code{vmldCosh2}, @code{vmldCos2}, @code{vmldAcosh2},
15382 @code{vmldAcos2}, @code{vmlsExp4}, @code{vmlsLn4}, @code{vmlsLog104},
15383 @code{vmlsLog104}, @code{vmlsPow4}, @code{vmlsTanh4}, @code{vmlsTan4},
15384 @code{vmlsAtan4}, @code{vmlsAtanh4}, @code{vmlsCbrt4}, @code{vmlsSinh4},
15385 @code{vmlsSin4}, @code{vmlsAsinh4}, @code{vmlsAsin4}, @code{vmlsCosh4},
15386 @code{vmlsCos4}, @code{vmlsAcosh4} and @code{vmlsAcos4} for corresponding
15387 function type when @option{-mveclibabi=svml} is used, and @code{__vrd2_sin},
15388 @code{__vrd2_cos}, @code{__vrd2_exp}, @code{__vrd2_log}, @code{__vrd2_log2},
15389 @code{__vrd2_log10}, @code{__vrs4_sinf}, @code{__vrs4_cosf},
15390 @code{__vrs4_expf}, @code{__vrs4_logf}, @code{__vrs4_log2f},
15391 @code{__vrs4_log10f} and @code{__vrs4_powf} for the corresponding function type
15392 when @option{-mveclibabi=acml} is used.
15393
15394 @item -mabi=@var{name}
15395 @opindex mabi
15396 Generate code for the specified calling convention. Permissible values
15397 are @samp{sysv} for the ABI used on GNU/Linux and other systems, and
15398 @samp{ms} for the Microsoft ABI. The default is to use the Microsoft
15399 ABI when targeting Microsoft Windows and the SysV ABI on all other systems.
15400 You can control this behavior for a specific function by
15401 using the function attribute @samp{ms_abi}/@samp{sysv_abi}.
15402 @xref{Function Attributes}.
15403
15404 @item -mtls-dialect=@var{type}
15405 @opindex mtls-dialect
15406 Generate code to access thread-local storage using the @samp{gnu} or
15407 @samp{gnu2} conventions. @samp{gnu} is the conservative default;
15408 @samp{gnu2} is more efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time
15409 requirements that cannot be satisfied on all systems.
15410
15411 @item -mpush-args
15412 @itemx -mno-push-args
15413 @opindex mpush-args
15414 @opindex mno-push-args
15415 Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters. This method is shorter
15416 and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
15417 by default. In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
15418 improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
15419
15420 @item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
15421 @opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
15422 If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments is
15423 computed in the function prologue. This is faster on most modern CPUs
15424 because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
15425 when the preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2. The drawback is a notable
15426 increase in code size. This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
15427
15428 @item -mthreads
15429 @opindex mthreads
15430 Support thread-safe exception handling on MinGW. Programs that rely
15431 on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
15432 @option{-mthreads} option. When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
15433 @code{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
15434 @option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per-thread exception-handling data.
15435
15436 @item -mno-align-stringops
15437 @opindex mno-align-stringops
15438 Do not align the destination of inlined string operations. This switch reduces
15439 code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
15440 but GCC doesn't know about it.
15441
15442 @item -minline-all-stringops
15443 @opindex minline-all-stringops
15444 By default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination is
15445 known to be aligned to least a 4-byte boundary.
15446 This enables more inlining and increases code
15447 size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast
15448 @code{memcpy}, @code{strlen},
15449 and @code{memset} for short lengths.
15450
15451 @item -minline-stringops-dynamically
15452 @opindex minline-stringops-dynamically
15453 For string operations of unknown size, use run-time checks with
15454 inline code for small blocks and a library call for large blocks.
15455
15456 @item -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
15457 @opindex mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
15458 Override the internal decision heuristic for the particular algorithm to use
15459 for inlining string operations. The allowed values for @var{alg} are:
15460
15461 @table @samp
15462 @item rep_byte
15463 @itemx rep_4byte
15464 @itemx rep_8byte
15465 Expand using i386 @code{rep} prefix of the specified size.
15466
15467 @item byte_loop
15468 @itemx loop
15469 @itemx unrolled_loop
15470 Expand into an inline loop.
15471
15472 @item libcall
15473 Always use a library call.
15474 @end table
15475
15476 @item -mmemcpy-strategy=@var{strategy}
15477 @opindex mmemcpy-strategy=@var{strategy}
15478 Override the internal decision heuristic to decide if @code{__builtin_memcpy}
15479 should be inlined and what inline algorithm to use when the expected size
15480 of the copy operation is known. @var{strategy}
15481 is a comma-separated list of @var{alg}:@var{max_size}:@var{dest_align} triplets.
15482 @var{alg} is specified in @option{-mstringop-strategy}, @var{max_size} specifies
15483 the max byte size with which inline algorithm @var{alg} is allowed. For the last
15484 triplet, the @var{max_size} must be @code{-1}. The @var{max_size} of the triplets
15485 in the list must be specified in increasing order. The minimal byte size for
15486 @var{alg} is @code{0} for the first triplet and @code{@var{max_size} + 1} of the
15487 preceding range.
15488
15489 @item -mmemset-strategy=@var{strategy}
15490 @opindex mmemset-strategy=@var{strategy}
15491 The option is similar to @option{-mmemcpy-strategy=} except that it is to control
15492 @code{__builtin_memset} expansion.
15493
15494 @item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
15495 @opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
15496 Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions. This
15497 avoids the instructions to save, set up, and restore frame pointers and
15498 makes an extra register available in leaf functions. The option
15499 @option{-fomit-leaf-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for leaf functions,
15500 which might make debugging harder.
15501
15502 @item -mtls-direct-seg-refs
15503 @itemx -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
15504 @opindex mtls-direct-seg-refs
15505 Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from the
15506 TLS segment register (@code{%gs} for 32-bit, @code{%fs} for 64-bit),
15507 or whether the thread base pointer must be added. Whether or not this
15508 is valid depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
15509 segment to cover the entire TLS area.
15510
15511 For systems that use the GNU C Library, the default is on.
15512
15513 @item -msse2avx
15514 @itemx -mno-sse2avx
15515 @opindex msse2avx
15516 Specify that the assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX
15517 prefix. The option @option{-mavx} turns this on by default.
15518
15519 @item -mfentry
15520 @itemx -mno-fentry
15521 @opindex mfentry
15522 If profiling is active (@option{-pg}), put the profiling
15523 counter call before the prologue.
15524 Note: On x86 architectures the attribute @code{ms_hook_prologue}
15525 isn't possible at the moment for @option{-mfentry} and @option{-pg}.
15526
15527 @item -m8bit-idiv
15528 @itemx -mno-8bit-idiv
15529 @opindex 8bit-idiv
15530 On some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is
15531 much faster than 32-bit/64-bit integer divide. This option generates a
15532 run-time check. If both dividend and divisor are within range of 0
15533 to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used instead of
15534 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.
15535
15536 @item -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
15537 @itemx -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
15538 @opindex avx256-split-unaligned-load
15539 @opindex avx256-split-unaligned-store
15540 Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.
15541
15542 @item -mstack-protector-guard=@var{guard}
15543 @opindex mstack-protector-guard=@var{guard}
15544 Generate stack protection code using canary at @var{guard}. Supported
15545 locations are @samp{global} for global canary or @samp{tls} for per-thread
15546 canary in the TLS block (the default). This option has effect only when
15547 @option{-fstack-protector} or @option{-fstack-protector-all} is specified.
15548
15549 @end table
15550
15551 These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
15552 on x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
15553
15554 @table @gcctabopt
15555 @item -m32
15556 @itemx -m64
15557 @itemx -mx32
15558 @opindex m32
15559 @opindex m64
15560 @opindex mx32
15561 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
15562 The @option{-m32} option sets @code{int}, @code{long}, and pointer types
15563 to 32 bits, and
15564 generates code that runs on any i386 system.
15565
15566 The @option{-m64} option sets @code{int} to 32 bits and @code{long} and pointer
15567 types to 64 bits, and generates code for the x86-64 architecture.
15568 For Darwin only the @option{-m64} option also turns off the @option{-fno-pic}
15569 and @option{-mdynamic-no-pic} options.
15570
15571 The @option{-mx32} option sets @code{int}, @code{long}, and pointer types
15572 to 32 bits, and
15573 generates code for the x86-64 architecture.
15574
15575 @item -mno-red-zone
15576 @opindex mno-red-zone
15577 Do not use a so-called ``red zone'' for x86-64 code. The red zone is mandated
15578 by the x86-64 ABI; it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
15579 stack pointer that is not modified by signal or interrupt handlers
15580 and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
15581 pointer. The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
15582
15583 @item -mcmodel=small
15584 @opindex mcmodel=small
15585 Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
15586 be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space. Pointers are 64 bits.
15587 Programs can be statically or dynamically linked. This is the default
15588 code model.
15589
15590 @item -mcmodel=kernel
15591 @opindex mcmodel=kernel
15592 Generate code for the kernel code model. The kernel runs in the
15593 negative 2 GB of the address space.
15594 This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
15595
15596 @item -mcmodel=medium
15597 @opindex mcmodel=medium
15598 Generate code for the medium model: the program is linked in the lower 2
15599 GB of the address space. Small symbols are also placed there. Symbols
15600 with sizes larger than @option{-mlarge-data-threshold} are put into
15601 large data or BSS sections and can be located above 2GB. Programs can
15602 be statically or dynamically linked.
15603
15604 @item -mcmodel=large
15605 @opindex mcmodel=large
15606 Generate code for the large model. This model makes no assumptions
15607 about addresses and sizes of sections.
15608
15609 @item -maddress-mode=long
15610 @opindex maddress-mode=long
15611 Generate code for long address mode. This is only supported for 64-bit
15612 and x32 environments. It is the default address mode for 64-bit
15613 environments.
15614
15615 @item -maddress-mode=short
15616 @opindex maddress-mode=short
15617 Generate code for short address mode. This is only supported for 32-bit
15618 and x32 environments. It is the default address mode for 32-bit and
15619 x32 environments.
15620 @end table
15621
15622 @node i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
15623 @subsection i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
15624 @cindex i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
15625
15626 These additional options are available for Microsoft Windows targets:
15627
15628 @table @gcctabopt
15629 @item -mconsole
15630 @opindex mconsole
15631 This option
15632 specifies that a console application is to be generated, by
15633 instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
15634 required for console applications.
15635 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets and is
15636 enabled by default on those targets.
15637
15638 @item -mdll
15639 @opindex mdll
15640 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
15641 specifies that a DLL---a dynamic link library---is to be
15642 generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime
15643 startup object and entry point.
15644
15645 @item -mnop-fun-dllimport
15646 @opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
15647 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
15648 specifies that the @code{dllimport} attribute should be ignored.
15649
15650 @item -mthread
15651 @opindex mthread
15652 This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies
15653 that MinGW-specific thread support is to be used.
15654
15655 @item -municode
15656 @opindex municode
15657 This option is available for MinGW-w64 targets. It causes
15658 the @code{UNICODE} preprocessor macro to be predefined, and
15659 chooses Unicode-capable runtime startup code.
15660
15661 @item -mwin32
15662 @opindex mwin32
15663 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
15664 specifies that the typical Microsoft Windows predefined macros are to
15665 be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice
15666 of runtime library/startup code.
15667
15668 @item -mwindows
15669 @opindex mwindows
15670 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
15671 specifies that a GUI application is to be generated by
15672 instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
15673 appropriately.
15674
15675 @item -fno-set-stack-executable
15676 @opindex fno-set-stack-executable
15677 This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that
15678 the executable flag for the stack used by nested functions isn't
15679 set. This is necessary for binaries running in kernel mode of
15680 Microsoft Windows, as there the User32 API, which is used to set executable
15681 privileges, isn't available.
15682
15683 @item -fwritable-relocated-rdata
15684 @opindex fno-writable-relocated-rdata
15685 This option is available for MinGW and Cygwin targets. It specifies
15686 that relocated-data in read-only section is put into .data
15687 section. This is a necessary for older runtimes not supporting
15688 modification of .rdata sections for pseudo-relocation.
15689
15690 @item -mpe-aligned-commons
15691 @opindex mpe-aligned-commons
15692 This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets. It
15693 specifies that the GNU extension to the PE file format that
15694 permits the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be
15695 used when generating code. It is enabled by default if
15696 GCC detects that the target assembler found during configuration
15697 supports the feature.
15698 @end table
15699
15700 See also under @ref{i386 and x86-64 Options} for standard options.
15701
15702 @node IA-64 Options
15703 @subsection IA-64 Options
15704 @cindex IA-64 Options
15705
15706 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
15707
15708 @table @gcctabopt
15709 @item -mbig-endian
15710 @opindex mbig-endian
15711 Generate code for a big-endian target. This is the default for HP-UX@.
15712
15713 @item -mlittle-endian
15714 @opindex mlittle-endian
15715 Generate code for a little-endian target. This is the default for AIX5
15716 and GNU/Linux.
15717
15718 @item -mgnu-as
15719 @itemx -mno-gnu-as
15720 @opindex mgnu-as
15721 @opindex mno-gnu-as
15722 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler. This is the default.
15723 @c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
15724 @c is used.
15725
15726 @item -mgnu-ld
15727 @itemx -mno-gnu-ld
15728 @opindex mgnu-ld
15729 @opindex mno-gnu-ld
15730 Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker. This is the default.
15731 @c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
15732 @c is used.
15733
15734 @item -mno-pic
15735 @opindex mno-pic
15736 Generate code that does not use a global pointer register. The result
15737 is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
15738
15739 @item -mvolatile-asm-stop
15740 @itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
15741 @opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
15742 @opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
15743 Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
15744 statements.
15745
15746 @item -mregister-names
15747 @itemx -mno-register-names
15748 @opindex mregister-names
15749 @opindex mno-register-names
15750 Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
15751 the stacked registers. This may make assembler output more readable.
15752
15753 @item -mno-sdata
15754 @itemx -msdata
15755 @opindex mno-sdata
15756 @opindex msdata
15757 Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section. This may
15758 be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
15759
15760 @item -mconstant-gp
15761 @opindex mconstant-gp
15762 Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value. This is
15763 useful when compiling kernel code.
15764
15765 @item -mauto-pic
15766 @opindex mauto-pic
15767 Generate code that is self-relocatable. This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
15768 This is useful when compiling firmware code.
15769
15770 @item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
15771 @opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
15772 Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
15773 using the minimum latency algorithm.
15774
15775 @item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
15776 @opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
15777 Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
15778 using the maximum throughput algorithm.
15779
15780 @item -mno-inline-float-divide
15781 @opindex mno-inline-float-divide
15782 Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.
15783
15784 @item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
15785 @opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
15786 Generate code for inline divides of integer values
15787 using the minimum latency algorithm.
15788
15789 @item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
15790 @opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
15791 Generate code for inline divides of integer values
15792 using the maximum throughput algorithm.
15793
15794 @item -mno-inline-int-divide
15795 @opindex mno-inline-int-divide
15796 Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.
15797
15798 @item -minline-sqrt-min-latency
15799 @opindex minline-sqrt-min-latency
15800 Generate code for inline square roots
15801 using the minimum latency algorithm.
15802
15803 @item -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
15804 @opindex minline-sqrt-max-throughput
15805 Generate code for inline square roots
15806 using the maximum throughput algorithm.
15807
15808 @item -mno-inline-sqrt
15809 @opindex mno-inline-sqrt
15810 Do not generate inline code for @code{sqrt}.
15811
15812 @item -mfused-madd
15813 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
15814 @opindex mfused-madd
15815 @opindex mno-fused-madd
15816 Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add or multiply/subtract
15817 instructions. The default is to use these instructions.
15818
15819 @item -mno-dwarf2-asm
15820 @itemx -mdwarf2-asm
15821 @opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
15822 @opindex mdwarf2-asm
15823 Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF 2 line number debugging
15824 info. This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
15825
15826 @item -mearly-stop-bits
15827 @itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
15828 @opindex mearly-stop-bits
15829 @opindex mno-early-stop-bits
15830 Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
15831 instruction that triggered the stop bit. This can improve instruction
15832 scheduling, but does not always do so.
15833
15834 @item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
15835 @opindex mfixed-range
15836 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
15837 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use. This is
15838 useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is specified as
15839 two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register ranges can be
15840 specified separated by a comma.
15841
15842 @item -mtls-size=@var{tls-size}
15843 @opindex mtls-size
15844 Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets. Valid values are 14, 22, and
15845 64.
15846
15847 @item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
15848 @opindex mtune
15849 Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values are
15850 @samp{itanium}, @samp{itanium1}, @samp{merced}, @samp{itanium2},
15851 and @samp{mckinley}.
15852
15853 @item -milp32
15854 @itemx -mlp64
15855 @opindex milp32
15856 @opindex mlp64
15857 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
15858 The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
15859 The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
15860 to 64 bits. These are HP-UX specific flags.
15861
15862 @item -mno-sched-br-data-spec
15863 @itemx -msched-br-data-spec
15864 @opindex mno-sched-br-data-spec
15865 @opindex msched-br-data-spec
15866 (Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload.
15867 This results in generation of @code{ld.a} instructions and
15868 the corresponding check instructions (@code{ld.c} / @code{chk.a}).
15869 The default is 'disable'.
15870
15871 @item -msched-ar-data-spec
15872 @itemx -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
15873 @opindex msched-ar-data-spec
15874 @opindex mno-sched-ar-data-spec
15875 (En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.
15876 This results in generation of @code{ld.a} instructions and
15877 the corresponding check instructions (@code{ld.c} / @code{chk.a}).
15878 The default is 'enable'.
15879
15880 @item -mno-sched-control-spec
15881 @itemx -msched-control-spec
15882 @opindex mno-sched-control-spec
15883 @opindex msched-control-spec
15884 (Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling. This feature is
15885 available only during region scheduling (i.e.@: before reload).
15886 This results in generation of the @code{ld.s} instructions and
15887 the corresponding check instructions @code{chk.s}.
15888 The default is 'disable'.
15889
15890 @item -msched-br-in-data-spec
15891 @itemx -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
15892 @opindex msched-br-in-data-spec
15893 @opindex mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
15894 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
15895 are dependent on the data speculative loads before reload.
15896 This is effective only with @option{-msched-br-data-spec} enabled.
15897 The default is 'enable'.
15898
15899 @item -msched-ar-in-data-spec
15900 @itemx -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
15901 @opindex msched-ar-in-data-spec
15902 @opindex mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
15903 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
15904 are dependent on the data speculative loads after reload.
15905 This is effective only with @option{-msched-ar-data-spec} enabled.
15906 The default is 'enable'.
15907
15908 @item -msched-in-control-spec
15909 @itemx -mno-sched-in-control-spec
15910 @opindex msched-in-control-spec
15911 @opindex mno-sched-in-control-spec
15912 (En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
15913 are dependent on the control speculative loads.
15914 This is effective only with @option{-msched-control-spec} enabled.
15915 The default is 'enable'.
15916
15917 @item -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
15918 @itemx -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
15919 @opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
15920 @opindex msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
15921 If enabled, data-speculative instructions are chosen for schedule
15922 only if there are no other choices at the moment. This makes
15923 the use of the data speculation much more conservative.
15924 The default is 'disable'.
15925
15926 @item -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
15927 @itemx -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
15928 @opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
15929 @opindex msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
15930 If enabled, control-speculative instructions are chosen for schedule
15931 only if there are no other choices at the moment. This makes
15932 the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
15933 The default is 'disable'.
15934
15935 @item -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
15936 @itemx -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
15937 @opindex mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
15938 @opindex msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
15939 If enabled, speculative dependencies are considered during
15940 computation of the instructions priorities. This makes the use of the
15941 speculation a bit more conservative.
15942 The default is 'disable'.
15943
15944 @item -msched-spec-ldc
15945 @opindex msched-spec-ldc
15946 Use a simple data speculation check. This option is on by default.
15947
15948 @item -msched-control-spec-ldc
15949 @opindex msched-spec-ldc
15950 Use a simple check for control speculation. This option is on by default.
15951
15952 @item -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
15953 @opindex msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
15954 Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling. This option is on
15955 by default.
15956
15957 @item -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
15958 @opindex msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
15959 Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict
15960 when placed into the same instruction group. This option is disabled by
15961 default.
15962
15963 @item -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
15964 @opindex msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
15965 Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.
15966 This flag is disabled by default.
15967
15968 @item -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}
15969 @opindex msched-max-memory-insns
15970 Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower
15971 priority to subsequent memory insns attempting to schedule in the same
15972 instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank conflicts.
15973 The default value is 1.
15974
15975 @item -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
15976 @opindex msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
15977 Makes the limit specified by @option{msched-max-memory-insns} a hard limit,
15978 disallowing more than that number in an instruction group.
15979 Otherwise, the limit is ``soft'', meaning that non-memory operations
15980 are preferred when the limit is reached, but memory operations may still
15981 be scheduled.
15982
15983 @end table
15984
15985 @node LM32 Options
15986 @subsection LM32 Options
15987 @cindex LM32 options
15988
15989 These @option{-m} options are defined for the LatticeMico32 architecture:
15990
15991 @table @gcctabopt
15992 @item -mbarrel-shift-enabled
15993 @opindex mbarrel-shift-enabled
15994 Enable barrel-shift instructions.
15995
15996 @item -mdivide-enabled
15997 @opindex mdivide-enabled
15998 Enable divide and modulus instructions.
15999
16000 @item -mmultiply-enabled
16001 @opindex multiply-enabled
16002 Enable multiply instructions.
16003
16004 @item -msign-extend-enabled
16005 @opindex msign-extend-enabled
16006 Enable sign extend instructions.
16007
16008 @item -muser-enabled
16009 @opindex muser-enabled
16010 Enable user-defined instructions.
16011
16012 @end table
16013
16014 @node M32C Options
16015 @subsection M32C Options
16016 @cindex M32C options
16017
16018 @table @gcctabopt
16019 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
16020 @opindex mcpu=
16021 Select the CPU for which code is generated. @var{name} may be one of
16022 @samp{r8c} for the R8C/Tiny series, @samp{m16c} for the M16C (up to
16023 /60) series, @samp{m32cm} for the M16C/80 series, or @samp{m32c} for
16024 the M32C/80 series.
16025
16026 @item -msim
16027 @opindex msim
16028 Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator. This causes
16029 an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports, for
16030 example, file I/O@. You must not use this option when generating
16031 programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own
16032 runtime library for whatever I/O functions are needed.
16033
16034 @item -memregs=@var{number}
16035 @opindex memregs=
16036 Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC uses
16037 during code generation. These pseudo-registers are used like real
16038 registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
16039 code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
16040 memory instead of registers. Note that all modules in a program must
16041 be compiled with the same value for this option. Because of that, you
16042 must not use this option with GCC's default runtime libraries.
16043
16044 @end table
16045
16046 @node M32R/D Options
16047 @subsection M32R/D Options
16048 @cindex M32R/D options
16049
16050 These @option{-m} options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
16051
16052 @table @gcctabopt
16053 @item -m32r2
16054 @opindex m32r2
16055 Generate code for the M32R/2@.
16056
16057 @item -m32rx
16058 @opindex m32rx
16059 Generate code for the M32R/X@.
16060
16061 @item -m32r
16062 @opindex m32r
16063 Generate code for the M32R@. This is the default.
16064
16065 @item -mmodel=small
16066 @opindex mmodel=small
16067 Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
16068 can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
16069 are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
16070 This is the default.
16071
16072 The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
16073 @code{model} attribute.
16074
16075 @item -mmodel=medium
16076 @opindex mmodel=medium
16077 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
16078 generates @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
16079 assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
16080
16081 @item -mmodel=large
16082 @opindex mmodel=large
16083 Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
16084 generates @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
16085 assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
16086 (the compiler generates the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
16087 instruction sequence).
16088
16089 @item -msdata=none
16090 @opindex msdata=none
16091 Disable use of the small data area. Variables are put into
16092 one of @samp{.data}, @samp{.bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
16093 @code{section} attribute has been specified).
16094 This is the default.
16095
16096 The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
16097 Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
16098 @code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
16099
16100 @item -msdata=sdata
16101 @opindex msdata=sdata
16102 Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
16103 generate special code to reference them.
16104
16105 @item -msdata=use
16106 @opindex msdata=use
16107 Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
16108 special instructions to reference them.
16109
16110 @item -G @var{num}
16111 @opindex G
16112 @cindex smaller data references
16113 Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
16114 into the small data or BSS sections instead of the normal data or BSS
16115 sections. The default value of @var{num} is 8.
16116 The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
16117 for this option to have any effect.
16118
16119 All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
16120 Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
16121 doesn't the linker gives an error message---incorrect code is not
16122 generated.
16123
16124 @item -mdebug
16125 @opindex mdebug
16126 Makes the M32R-specific code in the compiler display some statistics
16127 that might help in debugging programs.
16128
16129 @item -malign-loops
16130 @opindex malign-loops
16131 Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
16132
16133 @item -mno-align-loops
16134 @opindex mno-align-loops
16135 Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops. This is the default.
16136
16137 @item -missue-rate=@var{number}
16138 @opindex missue-rate=@var{number}
16139 Issue @var{number} instructions per cycle. @var{number} can only be 1
16140 or 2.
16141
16142 @item -mbranch-cost=@var{number}
16143 @opindex mbranch-cost=@var{number}
16144 @var{number} can only be 1 or 2. If it is 1 then branches are
16145 preferred over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite applies.
16146
16147 @item -mflush-trap=@var{number}
16148 @opindex mflush-trap=@var{number}
16149 Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache. The default is
16150 12. Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
16151
16152 @item -mno-flush-trap
16153 @opindex mno-flush-trap
16154 Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
16155
16156 @item -mflush-func=@var{name}
16157 @opindex mflush-func=@var{name}
16158 Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to flush
16159 the cache. The default is @emph{_flush_cache}, but a function call
16160 is only used if a trap is not available.
16161
16162 @item -mno-flush-func
16163 @opindex mno-flush-func
16164 Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
16165
16166 @end table
16167
16168 @node M680x0 Options
16169 @subsection M680x0 Options
16170 @cindex M680x0 options
16171
16172 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.
16173 The default settings depend on which architecture was selected when
16174 the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices
16175 are given below.
16176
16177 @table @gcctabopt
16178 @item -march=@var{arch}
16179 @opindex march
16180 Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set
16181 architecture. Permissible values of @var{arch} for M680x0
16182 architectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
16183 @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060} and @samp{cpu32}. ColdFire
16184 architectures are selected according to Freescale's ISA classification
16185 and the permissible values are: @samp{isaa}, @samp{isaaplus},
16186 @samp{isab} and @samp{isac}.
16187
16188 GCC defines a macro @samp{__mcf@var{arch}__} whenever it is generating
16189 code for a ColdFire target. The @var{arch} in this macro is one of the
16190 @option{-march} arguments given above.
16191
16192 When used together, @option{-march} and @option{-mtune} select code
16193 that runs on a family of similar processors but that is optimized
16194 for a particular microarchitecture.
16195
16196 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
16197 @opindex mcpu
16198 Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.
16199 The M680x0 @var{cpu}s are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
16200 @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}, @samp{68302}, @samp{68332}
16201 and @samp{cpu32}. The ColdFire @var{cpu}s are given by the table
16202 below, which also classifies the CPUs into families:
16203
16204 @multitable @columnfractions 0.20 0.80
16205 @item @strong{Family} @tab @strong{@samp{-mcpu} arguments}
16206 @item @samp{51} @tab @samp{51} @samp{51ac} @samp{51ag} @samp{51cn} @samp{51em} @samp{51je} @samp{51jf} @samp{51jg} @samp{51jm} @samp{51mm} @samp{51qe} @samp{51qm}
16207 @item @samp{5206} @tab @samp{5202} @samp{5204} @samp{5206}
16208 @item @samp{5206e} @tab @samp{5206e}
16209 @item @samp{5208} @tab @samp{5207} @samp{5208}
16210 @item @samp{5211a} @tab @samp{5210a} @samp{5211a}
16211 @item @samp{5213} @tab @samp{5211} @samp{5212} @samp{5213}
16212 @item @samp{5216} @tab @samp{5214} @samp{5216}
16213 @item @samp{52235} @tab @samp{52230} @samp{52231} @samp{52232} @samp{52233} @samp{52234} @samp{52235}
16214 @item @samp{5225} @tab @samp{5224} @samp{5225}
16215 @item @samp{52259} @tab @samp{52252} @samp{52254} @samp{52255} @samp{52256} @samp{52258} @samp{52259}
16216 @item @samp{5235} @tab @samp{5232} @samp{5233} @samp{5234} @samp{5235} @samp{523x}
16217 @item @samp{5249} @tab @samp{5249}
16218 @item @samp{5250} @tab @samp{5250}
16219 @item @samp{5271} @tab @samp{5270} @samp{5271}
16220 @item @samp{5272} @tab @samp{5272}
16221 @item @samp{5275} @tab @samp{5274} @samp{5275}
16222 @item @samp{5282} @tab @samp{5280} @samp{5281} @samp{5282} @samp{528x}
16223 @item @samp{53017} @tab @samp{53011} @samp{53012} @samp{53013} @samp{53014} @samp{53015} @samp{53016} @samp{53017}
16224 @item @samp{5307} @tab @samp{5307}
16225 @item @samp{5329} @tab @samp{5327} @samp{5328} @samp{5329} @samp{532x}
16226 @item @samp{5373} @tab @samp{5372} @samp{5373} @samp{537x}
16227 @item @samp{5407} @tab @samp{5407}
16228 @item @samp{5475} @tab @samp{5470} @samp{5471} @samp{5472} @samp{5473} @samp{5474} @samp{5475} @samp{547x} @samp{5480} @samp{5481} @samp{5482} @samp{5483} @samp{5484} @samp{5485}
16229 @end multitable
16230
16231 @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu}} overrides @option{-march=@var{arch}} if
16232 @var{arch} is compatible with @var{cpu}. Other combinations of
16233 @option{-mcpu} and @option{-march} are rejected.
16234
16235 GCC defines the macro @samp{__mcf_cpu_@var{cpu}} when ColdFire target
16236 @var{cpu} is selected. It also defines @samp{__mcf_family_@var{family}},
16237 where the value of @var{family} is given by the table above.
16238
16239 @item -mtune=@var{tune}
16240 @opindex mtune
16241 Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture within the
16242 constraints set by @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu}.
16243 The M680x0 microarchitectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010},
16244 @samp{68020}, @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}
16245 and @samp{cpu32}. The ColdFire microarchitectures
16246 are: @samp{cfv1}, @samp{cfv2}, @samp{cfv3}, @samp{cfv4} and @samp{cfv4e}.
16247
16248 You can also use @option{-mtune=68020-40} for code that needs
16249 to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040 targets.
16250 @option{-mtune=68020-60} is similar but includes 68060 targets
16251 as well. These two options select the same tuning decisions as
16252 @option{-m68020-40} and @option{-m68020-60} respectively.
16253
16254 GCC defines the macros @samp{__mc@var{arch}} and @samp{__mc@var{arch}__}
16255 when tuning for 680x0 architecture @var{arch}. It also defines
16256 @samp{mc@var{arch}} unless either @option{-ansi} or a non-GNU @option{-std}
16257 option is used. If GCC is tuning for a range of architectures,
16258 as selected by @option{-mtune=68020-40} or @option{-mtune=68020-60},
16259 it defines the macros for every architecture in the range.
16260
16261 GCC also defines the macro @samp{__m@var{uarch}__} when tuning for
16262 ColdFire microarchitecture @var{uarch}, where @var{uarch} is one
16263 of the arguments given above.
16264
16265 @item -m68000
16266 @itemx -mc68000
16267 @opindex m68000
16268 @opindex mc68000
16269 Generate output for a 68000. This is the default
16270 when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
16271 It is equivalent to @option{-march=68000}.
16272
16273 Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
16274 including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
16275
16276 @item -m68010
16277 @opindex m68010
16278 Generate output for a 68010. This is the default
16279 when the compiler is configured for 68010-based systems.
16280 It is equivalent to @option{-march=68010}.
16281
16282 @item -m68020
16283 @itemx -mc68020
16284 @opindex m68020
16285 @opindex mc68020
16286 Generate output for a 68020. This is the default
16287 when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
16288 It is equivalent to @option{-march=68020}.
16289
16290 @item -m68030
16291 @opindex m68030
16292 Generate output for a 68030. This is the default when the compiler is
16293 configured for 68030-based systems. It is equivalent to
16294 @option{-march=68030}.
16295
16296 @item -m68040
16297 @opindex m68040
16298 Generate output for a 68040. This is the default when the compiler is
16299 configured for 68040-based systems. It is equivalent to
16300 @option{-march=68040}.
16301
16302 This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
16303 emulated by software on the 68040. Use this option if your 68040 does not
16304 have code to emulate those instructions.
16305
16306 @item -m68060
16307 @opindex m68060
16308 Generate output for a 68060. This is the default when the compiler is
16309 configured for 68060-based systems. It is equivalent to
16310 @option{-march=68060}.
16311
16312 This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
16313 have to be emulated by software on the 68060. Use this option if your 68060
16314 does not have code to emulate those instructions.
16315
16316 @item -mcpu32
16317 @opindex mcpu32
16318 Generate output for a CPU32. This is the default
16319 when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
16320 It is equivalent to @option{-march=cpu32}.
16321
16322 Use this option for microcontrollers with a
16323 CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
16324 68336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
16325
16326 @item -m5200
16327 @opindex m5200
16328 Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU@. This is the default
16329 when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
16330 It is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=5206}, and is now deprecated
16331 in favor of that option.
16332
16333 Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
16334 the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5206.
16335
16336 @item -m5206e
16337 @opindex m5206e
16338 Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU@. The option is now
16339 deprecated in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5206e}.
16340
16341 @item -m528x
16342 @opindex m528x
16343 Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.
16344 The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
16345 @option{-mcpu=528x}.
16346
16347 @item -m5307
16348 @opindex m5307
16349 Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU@. The option is now deprecated
16350 in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5307}.
16351
16352 @item -m5407
16353 @opindex m5407
16354 Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU@. The option is now deprecated
16355 in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5407}.
16356
16357 @item -mcfv4e
16358 @opindex mcfv4e
16359 Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU (e.g.@: 547x/548x).
16360 This includes use of hardware floating-point instructions.
16361 The option is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=547x}, and is now
16362 deprecated in favor of that option.
16363
16364 @item -m68020-40
16365 @opindex m68020-40
16366 Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
16367 This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
16368 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The generated code does use the
16369 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
16370
16371 The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-40}.
16372
16373 @item -m68020-60
16374 @opindex m68020-60
16375 Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
16376 This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
16377 68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040. The generated code does use the
16378 68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
16379
16380 The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-60}.
16381
16382 @item -mhard-float
16383 @itemx -m68881
16384 @opindex mhard-float
16385 @opindex m68881
16386 Generate floating-point instructions. This is the default for 68020
16387 and above, and for ColdFire devices that have an FPU@. It defines the
16388 macro @samp{__HAVE_68881__} on M680x0 targets and @samp{__mcffpu__}
16389 on ColdFire targets.
16390
16391 @item -msoft-float
16392 @opindex msoft-float
16393 Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls instead.
16394 This is the default for 68000, 68010, and 68832 targets. It is also
16395 the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.
16396
16397 @item -mdiv
16398 @itemx -mno-div
16399 @opindex mdiv
16400 @opindex mno-div
16401 Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder
16402 instructions. If @option{-march} is used without @option{-mcpu},
16403 the default is ``on'' for ColdFire architectures and ``off'' for M680x0
16404 architectures. Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU
16405 (either the default CPU, or the one specified by @option{-mcpu}). For
16406 example, the default is ``off'' for @option{-mcpu=5206} and ``on'' for
16407 @option{-mcpu=5206e}.
16408
16409 GCC defines the macro @samp{__mcfhwdiv__} when this option is enabled.
16410
16411 @item -mshort
16412 @opindex mshort
16413 Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
16414 Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
16415 16-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.
16416
16417 @item -mno-short
16418 @opindex mno-short
16419 Do not consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide. This is the default.
16420
16421 @item -mnobitfield
16422 @itemx -mno-bitfield
16423 @opindex mnobitfield
16424 @opindex mno-bitfield
16425 Do not use the bit-field instructions. The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
16426 and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
16427
16428 @item -mbitfield
16429 @opindex mbitfield
16430 Do use the bit-field instructions. The @option{-m68020} option implies
16431 @option{-mbitfield}. This is the default if you use a configuration
16432 designed for a 68020.
16433
16434 @item -mrtd
16435 @opindex mrtd
16436 Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
16437 that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
16438 instruction, which pops their arguments while returning. This
16439 saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
16440 the arguments there.
16441
16442 This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
16443 used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
16444 compiled with the Unix compiler.
16445
16446 Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
16447 take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
16448 otherwise incorrect code is generated for calls to those
16449 functions.
16450
16451 In addition, seriously incorrect code results if you call a
16452 function with too many arguments. (Normally, extra arguments are
16453 harmlessly ignored.)
16454
16455 The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
16456 68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
16457
16458 @item -mno-rtd
16459 @opindex mno-rtd
16460 Do not use the calling conventions selected by @option{-mrtd}.
16461 This is the default.
16462
16463 @item -malign-int
16464 @itemx -mno-align-int
16465 @opindex malign-int
16466 @opindex mno-align-int
16467 Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
16468 @code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
16469 boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
16470 Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
16471 faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
16472
16473 @strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC
16474 aligns structures containing the above types differently than
16475 most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
16476
16477 @item -mpcrel
16478 @opindex mpcrel
16479 Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
16480 using a global offset table. At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
16481 allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing. @option{-fPIC} is
16482 not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
16483 68020 and higher processors.
16484
16485 @item -mno-strict-align
16486 @itemx -mstrict-align
16487 @opindex mno-strict-align
16488 @opindex mstrict-align
16489 Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references are handled by
16490 the system.
16491
16492 @item -msep-data
16493 Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
16494 area of memory from the text segment. This allows for execute-in-place in
16495 an environment without virtual memory management. This option implies
16496 @option{-fPIC}.
16497
16498 @item -mno-sep-data
16499 Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
16500 This is the default.
16501
16502 @item -mid-shared-library
16503 Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
16504 This allows for execute-in-place and shared libraries in an environment
16505 without virtual memory management. This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
16506
16507 @item -mno-id-shared-library
16508 Generate code that doesn't assume ID-based shared libraries are being used.
16509 This is the default.
16510
16511 @item -mshared-library-id=n
16512 Specifies the identification number of the ID-based shared library being
16513 compiled. Specifying a value of 0 generates more compact code; specifying
16514 other values forces the allocation of that number to the current
16515 library, but is no more space- or time-efficient than omitting this option.
16516
16517 @item -mxgot
16518 @itemx -mno-xgot
16519 @opindex mxgot
16520 @opindex mno-xgot
16521 When generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code
16522 that works if the GOT has more than 8192 entries. This code is
16523 larger and slower than code generated without this option. On M680x0
16524 processors, this option is not needed; @option{-fPIC} suffices.
16525
16526 GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
16527 While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT
16528 is smaller than about 64k. Anything larger causes the linker
16529 to report an error such as:
16530
16531 @cindex relocation truncated to fit (ColdFire)
16532 @smallexample
16533 relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar
16534 @end smallexample
16535
16536 If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
16537 It should then work with very large GOTs. However, code generated with
16538 @option{-mxgot} is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to fetch
16539 the value of a global symbol.
16540
16541 Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker,
16542 can create multiple GOTs and sort GOT entries. If you have such a linker,
16543 you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when compiling a single
16544 object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries. Very few do.
16545
16546 These options have no effect unless GCC is generating
16547 position-independent code.
16548
16549 @end table
16550
16551 @node MCore Options
16552 @subsection MCore Options
16553 @cindex MCore options
16554
16555 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
16556 processors.
16557
16558 @table @gcctabopt
16559
16560 @item -mhardlit
16561 @itemx -mno-hardlit
16562 @opindex mhardlit
16563 @opindex mno-hardlit
16564 Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
16565 instructions or less.
16566
16567 @item -mdiv
16568 @itemx -mno-div
16569 @opindex mdiv
16570 @opindex mno-div
16571 Use the divide instruction. (Enabled by default).
16572
16573 @item -mrelax-immediate
16574 @itemx -mno-relax-immediate
16575 @opindex mrelax-immediate
16576 @opindex mno-relax-immediate
16577 Allow arbitrary-sized immediates in bit operations.
16578
16579 @item -mwide-bitfields
16580 @itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
16581 @opindex mwide-bitfields
16582 @opindex mno-wide-bitfields
16583 Always treat bit-fields as @code{int}-sized.
16584
16585 @item -m4byte-functions
16586 @itemx -mno-4byte-functions
16587 @opindex m4byte-functions
16588 @opindex mno-4byte-functions
16589 Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.
16590
16591 @item -mcallgraph-data
16592 @itemx -mno-callgraph-data
16593 @opindex mcallgraph-data
16594 @opindex mno-callgraph-data
16595 Emit callgraph information.
16596
16597 @item -mslow-bytes
16598 @itemx -mno-slow-bytes
16599 @opindex mslow-bytes
16600 @opindex mno-slow-bytes
16601 Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
16602
16603 @item -mlittle-endian
16604 @itemx -mbig-endian
16605 @opindex mlittle-endian
16606 @opindex mbig-endian
16607 Generate code for a little-endian target.
16608
16609 @item -m210
16610 @itemx -m340
16611 @opindex m210
16612 @opindex m340
16613 Generate code for the 210 processor.
16614
16615 @item -mno-lsim
16616 @opindex mno-lsim
16617 Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the
16618 simulator library (@file{libsim.a)} from the linker command line.
16619
16620 @item -mstack-increment=@var{size}
16621 @opindex mstack-increment
16622 Set the maximum amount for a single stack increment operation. Large
16623 values can increase the speed of programs that contain functions
16624 that need a large amount of stack space, but they can also trigger a
16625 segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much. The default
16626 value is 0x1000.
16627
16628 @end table
16629
16630 @node MeP Options
16631 @subsection MeP Options
16632 @cindex MeP options
16633
16634 @table @gcctabopt
16635
16636 @item -mabsdiff
16637 @opindex mabsdiff
16638 Enables the @code{abs} instruction, which is the absolute difference
16639 between two registers.
16640
16641 @item -mall-opts
16642 @opindex mall-opts
16643 Enables all the optional instructions---average, multiply, divide, bit
16644 operations, leading zero, absolute difference, min/max, clip, and
16645 saturation.
16646
16647
16648 @item -maverage
16649 @opindex maverage
16650 Enables the @code{ave} instruction, which computes the average of two
16651 registers.
16652
16653 @item -mbased=@var{n}
16654 @opindex mbased=
16655 Variables of size @var{n} bytes or smaller are placed in the
16656 @code{.based} section by default. Based variables use the @code{$tp}
16657 register as a base register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the
16658 @code{.based} section.
16659
16660 @item -mbitops
16661 @opindex mbitops
16662 Enables the bit operation instructions---bit test (@code{btstm}), set
16663 (@code{bsetm}), clear (@code{bclrm}), invert (@code{bnotm}), and
16664 test-and-set (@code{tas}).
16665
16666 @item -mc=@var{name}
16667 @opindex mc=
16668 Selects which section constant data is placed in. @var{name} may
16669 be @code{tiny}, @code{near}, or @code{far}.
16670
16671 @item -mclip
16672 @opindex mclip
16673 Enables the @code{clip} instruction. Note that @code{-mclip} is not
16674 useful unless you also provide @code{-mminmax}.
16675
16676 @item -mconfig=@var{name}
16677 @opindex mconfig=
16678 Selects one of the built-in core configurations. Each MeP chip has
16679 one or more modules in it; each module has a core CPU and a variety of
16680 coprocessors, optional instructions, and peripherals. The
16681 @code{MeP-Integrator} tool, not part of GCC, provides these
16682 configurations through this option; using this option is the same as
16683 using all the corresponding command-line options. The default
16684 configuration is @code{default}.
16685
16686 @item -mcop
16687 @opindex mcop
16688 Enables the coprocessor instructions. By default, this is a 32-bit
16689 coprocessor. Note that the coprocessor is normally enabled via the
16690 @code{-mconfig=} option.
16691
16692 @item -mcop32
16693 @opindex mcop32
16694 Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.
16695
16696 @item -mcop64
16697 @opindex mcop64
16698 Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.
16699
16700 @item -mivc2
16701 @opindex mivc2
16702 Enables IVC2 scheduling. IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.
16703
16704 @item -mdc
16705 @opindex mdc
16706 Causes constant variables to be placed in the @code{.near} section.
16707
16708 @item -mdiv
16709 @opindex mdiv
16710 Enables the @code{div} and @code{divu} instructions.
16711
16712 @item -meb
16713 @opindex meb
16714 Generate big-endian code.
16715
16716 @item -mel
16717 @opindex mel
16718 Generate little-endian code.
16719
16720 @item -mio-volatile
16721 @opindex mio-volatile
16722 Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the @code{io}
16723 attribute is to be considered volatile.
16724
16725 @item -ml
16726 @opindex ml
16727 Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.far} section by default.
16728
16729 @item -mleadz
16730 @opindex mleadz
16731 Enables the @code{leadz} (leading zero) instruction.
16732
16733 @item -mm
16734 @opindex mm
16735 Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.near} section by default.
16736
16737 @item -mminmax
16738 @opindex mminmax
16739 Enables the @code{min} and @code{max} instructions.
16740
16741 @item -mmult
16742 @opindex mmult
16743 Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.
16744
16745 @item -mno-opts
16746 @opindex mno-opts
16747 Disables all the optional instructions enabled by @code{-mall-opts}.
16748
16749 @item -mrepeat
16750 @opindex mrepeat
16751 Enables the @code{repeat} and @code{erepeat} instructions, used for
16752 low-overhead looping.
16753
16754 @item -ms
16755 @opindex ms
16756 Causes all variables to default to the @code{.tiny} section. Note
16757 that there is a 65536-byte limit to this section. Accesses to these
16758 variables use the @code{%gp} base register.
16759
16760 @item -msatur
16761 @opindex msatur
16762 Enables the saturation instructions. Note that the compiler does not
16763 currently generate these itself, but this option is included for
16764 compatibility with other tools, like @code{as}.
16765
16766 @item -msdram
16767 @opindex msdram
16768 Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.
16769
16770 @item -msim
16771 @opindex msim
16772 Link the simulator run-time libraries.
16773
16774 @item -msimnovec
16775 @opindex msimnovec
16776 Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support
16777 for reset and exception vectors and tables.
16778
16779 @item -mtf
16780 @opindex mtf
16781 Causes all functions to default to the @code{.far} section. Without
16782 this option, functions default to the @code{.near} section.
16783
16784 @item -mtiny=@var{n}
16785 @opindex mtiny=
16786 Variables that are @var{n} bytes or smaller are allocated to the
16787 @code{.tiny} section. These variables use the @code{$gp} base
16788 register. The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a
16789 65536-byte limit to the @code{.tiny} section.
16790
16791 @end table
16792
16793 @node MicroBlaze Options
16794 @subsection MicroBlaze Options
16795 @cindex MicroBlaze Options
16796
16797 @table @gcctabopt
16798
16799 @item -msoft-float
16800 @opindex msoft-float
16801 Use software emulation for floating point (default).
16802
16803 @item -mhard-float
16804 @opindex mhard-float
16805 Use hardware floating-point instructions.
16806
16807 @item -mmemcpy
16808 @opindex mmemcpy
16809 Do not optimize block moves, use @code{memcpy}.
16810
16811 @item -mno-clearbss
16812 @opindex mno-clearbss
16813 This option is deprecated. Use @option{-fno-zero-initialized-in-bss} instead.
16814
16815 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
16816 @opindex mcpu=
16817 Use features of, and schedule code for, the given CPU.
16818 Supported values are in the format @samp{v@var{X}.@var{YY}.@var{Z}},
16819 where @var{X} is a major version, @var{YY} is the minor version, and
16820 @var{Z} is compatibility code. Example values are @samp{v3.00.a},
16821 @samp{v4.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.a}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v6.00.a}.
16822
16823 @item -mxl-soft-mul
16824 @opindex mxl-soft-mul
16825 Use software multiply emulation (default).
16826
16827 @item -mxl-soft-div
16828 @opindex mxl-soft-div
16829 Use software emulation for divides (default).
16830
16831 @item -mxl-barrel-shift
16832 @opindex mxl-barrel-shift
16833 Use the hardware barrel shifter.
16834
16835 @item -mxl-pattern-compare
16836 @opindex mxl-pattern-compare
16837 Use pattern compare instructions.
16838
16839 @item -msmall-divides
16840 @opindex msmall-divides
16841 Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.
16842
16843 @item -mxl-stack-check
16844 @opindex mxl-stack-check
16845 This option is deprecated. Use @option{-fstack-check} instead.
16846
16847 @item -mxl-gp-opt
16848 @opindex mxl-gp-opt
16849 Use GP-relative @code{.sdata}/@code{.sbss} sections.
16850
16851 @item -mxl-multiply-high
16852 @opindex mxl-multiply-high
16853 Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.
16854
16855 @item -mxl-float-convert
16856 @opindex mxl-float-convert
16857 Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.
16858
16859 @item -mxl-float-sqrt
16860 @opindex mxl-float-sqrt
16861 Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.
16862
16863 @item -mbig-endian
16864 @opindex mbig-endian
16865 Generate code for a big-endian target.
16866
16867 @item -mlittle-endian
16868 @opindex mlittle-endian
16869 Generate code for a little-endian target.
16870
16871 @item -mxl-reorder
16872 @opindex mxl-reorder
16873 Use reorder instructions (swap and byte reversed load/store).
16874
16875 @item -mxl-mode-@var{app-model}
16876 Select application model @var{app-model}. Valid models are
16877 @table @samp
16878 @item executable
16879 normal executable (default), uses startup code @file{crt0.o}.
16880
16881 @item xmdstub
16882 for use with Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based
16883 software intrusive debug agent called xmdstub. This uses startup file
16884 @file{crt1.o} and sets the start address of the program to 0x800.
16885
16886 @item bootstrap
16887 for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.
16888 This model uses startup file @file{crt2.o} which does not contain a processor
16889 reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
16890 processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.
16891
16892 @item novectors
16893 for applications that do not require any of the
16894 MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for applications running
16895 within a monitoring application. This model uses @file{crt3.o} as a startup file.
16896 @end table
16897
16898 Option @option{-xl-mode-@var{app-model}} is a deprecated alias for
16899 @option{-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}.
16900
16901 @end table
16902
16903 @node MIPS Options
16904 @subsection MIPS Options
16905 @cindex MIPS options
16906
16907 @table @gcctabopt
16908
16909 @item -EB
16910 @opindex EB
16911 Generate big-endian code.
16912
16913 @item -EL
16914 @opindex EL
16915 Generate little-endian code. This is the default for @samp{mips*el-*-*}
16916 configurations.
16917
16918 @item -march=@var{arch}
16919 @opindex march
16920 Generate code that runs on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
16921 generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
16922 The ISA names are:
16923 @samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
16924 @samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, @samp{mips64} and @samp{mips64r2}.
16925 The processor names are:
16926 @samp{4kc}, @samp{4km}, @samp{4kp}, @samp{4ksc},
16927 @samp{4kec}, @samp{4kem}, @samp{4kep}, @samp{4ksd},
16928 @samp{5kc}, @samp{5kf},
16929 @samp{20kc},
16930 @samp{24kc}, @samp{24kf2_1}, @samp{24kf1_1},
16931 @samp{24kec}, @samp{24kef2_1}, @samp{24kef1_1},
16932 @samp{34kc}, @samp{34kf2_1}, @samp{34kf1_1}, @samp{34kn},
16933 @samp{74kc}, @samp{74kf2_1}, @samp{74kf1_1}, @samp{74kf3_2},
16934 @samp{1004kc}, @samp{1004kf2_1}, @samp{1004kf1_1},
16935 @samp{loongson2e}, @samp{loongson2f}, @samp{loongson3a},
16936 @samp{m4k},
16937 @samp{m14k}, @samp{m14kc}, @samp{m14ke}, @samp{m14kec},
16938 @samp{octeon}, @samp{octeon+}, @samp{octeon2},
16939 @samp{orion},
16940 @samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
16941 @samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r4700}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
16942 @samp{rm7000}, @samp{rm9000},
16943 @samp{r10000}, @samp{r12000}, @samp{r14000}, @samp{r16000},
16944 @samp{sb1},
16945 @samp{sr71000},
16946 @samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4111}, @samp{vr4120}, @samp{vr4130}, @samp{vr4300},
16947 @samp{vr5000}, @samp{vr5400}, @samp{vr5500},
16948 @samp{xlr} and @samp{xlp}.
16949 The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
16950 most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
16951 @samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
16952
16953 The native Linux/GNU toolchain also supports the value @samp{native},
16954 which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
16955 @option{-march=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
16956 the processor.
16957
16958 In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
16959 (for example, @option{-march=r2k}). Prefixes are optional, and
16960 @samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
16961
16962 Names of the form @samp{@var{n}f2_1} refer to processors with
16963 FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of the form
16964 @samp{@var{n}f1_1} refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same
16965 rate as the core, and names of the form @samp{@var{n}f3_2} refer to
16966 processors with FPUs clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.
16967 For compatibility reasons, @samp{@var{n}f} is accepted as a synonym
16968 for @samp{@var{n}f2_1} while @samp{@var{n}x} and @samp{@var{b}fx} are
16969 accepted as synonyms for @samp{@var{n}f1_1}.
16970
16971 GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option. The first
16972 is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
16973 a string. The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
16974 where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
16975 For example, @option{-march=r2000} sets @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
16976 to @samp{"r2000"} and defines the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
16977
16978 Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
16979 above. In other words, it has the full prefix and does not
16980 abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}. In the case of @samp{from-abi},
16981 the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
16982 @samp{"mips3"}). It names the default architecture when no
16983 @option{-march} option is given.
16984
16985 @item -mtune=@var{arch}
16986 @opindex mtune
16987 Optimize for @var{arch}. Among other things, this option controls
16988 the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
16989 operations. The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
16990 @option{-march}.
16991
16992 When this option is not used, GCC optimizes for the processor
16993 specified by @option{-march}. By using @option{-march} and
16994 @option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that
16995 runs on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
16996 particular member of that family.
16997
16998 @option{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
16999 @samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
17000 @option{-march} ones described above.
17001
17002 @item -mips1
17003 @opindex mips1
17004 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips1}.
17005
17006 @item -mips2
17007 @opindex mips2
17008 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips2}.
17009
17010 @item -mips3
17011 @opindex mips3
17012 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips3}.
17013
17014 @item -mips4
17015 @opindex mips4
17016 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips4}.
17017
17018 @item -mips32
17019 @opindex mips32
17020 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips32}.
17021
17022 @item -mips32r2
17023 @opindex mips32r2
17024 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips32r2}.
17025
17026 @item -mips64
17027 @opindex mips64
17028 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips64}.
17029
17030 @item -mips64r2
17031 @opindex mips64r2
17032 Equivalent to @option{-march=mips64r2}.
17033
17034 @item -mips16
17035 @itemx -mno-mips16
17036 @opindex mips16
17037 @opindex mno-mips16
17038 Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code. If GCC is targeting a
17039 MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it makes use of the MIPS16e ASE@.
17040
17041 MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis
17042 by means of @code{mips16} and @code{nomips16} attributes.
17043 @xref{Function Attributes}, for more information.
17044
17045 @item -mflip-mips16
17046 @opindex mflip-mips16
17047 Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions. This option is provided
17048 for regression testing of mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is
17049 not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.
17050
17051 @item -minterlink-compressed
17052 @item -mno-interlink-compressed
17053 @opindex minterlink-compressed
17054 @opindex mno-interlink-compressed
17055 Require (do not require) that code using the standard (uncompressed) MIPS ISA
17056 be link-compatible with MIPS16 and microMIPS code, and vice versa.
17057
17058 For example, code using the standard ISA encoding cannot jump directly
17059 to MIPS16 or microMIPS code; it must either use a call or an indirect jump.
17060 @option{-minterlink-compressed} therefore disables direct jumps unless GCC
17061 knows that the target of the jump is not compressed.
17062
17063 @item -minterlink-mips16
17064 @itemx -mno-interlink-mips16
17065 @opindex minterlink-mips16
17066 @opindex mno-interlink-mips16
17067 Aliases of @option{-minterlink-compressed} and
17068 @option{-mno-interlink-compressed}. These options predate the microMIPS ASE
17069 and are retained for backwards compatibility.
17070
17071 @item -mabi=32
17072 @itemx -mabi=o64
17073 @itemx -mabi=n32
17074 @itemx -mabi=64
17075 @itemx -mabi=eabi
17076 @opindex mabi=32
17077 @opindex mabi=o64
17078 @opindex mabi=n32
17079 @opindex mabi=64
17080 @opindex mabi=eabi
17081 Generate code for the given ABI@.
17082
17083 Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant. GCC normally
17084 generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
17085 can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
17086
17087 For information about the O64 ABI, see
17088 @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/projects/@/mipso64-abi.html}.
17089
17090 GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers
17091 are 64 rather than 32 bits wide. You can select this combination with
17092 @option{-mabi=32} @option{-mfp64}. This ABI relies on the @code{mthc1}
17093 and @code{mfhc1} instructions and is therefore only supported for
17094 MIPS32R2 processors.
17095
17096 The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the
17097 same, but each scalar value is passed in a single 64-bit register
17098 rather than a pair of 32-bit registers. For example, scalar
17099 floating-point values are returned in @samp{$f0} only, not a
17100 @samp{$f0}/@samp{$f1} pair. The set of call-saved registers also
17101 remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.
17102
17103 @item -mabicalls
17104 @itemx -mno-abicalls
17105 @opindex mabicalls
17106 @opindex mno-abicalls
17107 Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
17108 dynamic objects. @option{-mabicalls} is the default for SVR4-based
17109 systems.
17110
17111 @item -mshared
17112 @itemx -mno-shared
17113 Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
17114 and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries. This option
17115 only affects @option{-mabicalls}.
17116
17117 All @option{-mabicalls} code has traditionally been position-independent,
17118 regardless of options like @option{-fPIC} and @option{-fpic}. However,
17119 as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
17120 accesses for locally-binding symbols. It can also use shorter GP
17121 initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-defined
17122 functions. This mode is selected by @option{-mno-shared}.
17123
17124 @option{-mno-shared} depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
17125 objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker. However, the option
17126 does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the ABI
17127 of relocatable objects. Using @option{-mno-shared} generally makes
17128 executables both smaller and quicker.
17129
17130 @option{-mshared} is the default.
17131
17132 @item -mplt
17133 @itemx -mno-plt
17134 @opindex mplt
17135 @opindex mno-plt
17136 Assume (do not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers
17137 support PLTs and copy relocations. This option only affects
17138 @option{-mno-shared -mabicalls}. For the n64 ABI, this option
17139 has no effect without @option{-msym32}.
17140
17141 You can make @option{-mplt} the default by configuring
17142 GCC with @option{--with-mips-plt}. The default is
17143 @option{-mno-plt} otherwise.
17144
17145 @item -mxgot
17146 @itemx -mno-xgot
17147 @opindex mxgot
17148 @opindex mno-xgot
17149 Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
17150 offset table.
17151
17152 GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
17153 While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT
17154 is smaller than about 64k. Anything larger causes the linker
17155 to report an error such as:
17156
17157 @cindex relocation truncated to fit (MIPS)
17158 @smallexample
17159 relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
17160 @end smallexample
17161
17162 If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
17163 This works with very large GOTs, although the code is also
17164 less efficient, since it takes three instructions to fetch the
17165 value of a global symbol.
17166
17167 Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs. If you have such a
17168 linker, you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when a single object
17169 file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries. Very few do.
17170
17171 These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
17172 independent code.
17173
17174 @item -mgp32
17175 @opindex mgp32
17176 Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
17177
17178 @item -mgp64
17179 @opindex mgp64
17180 Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
17181
17182 @item -mfp32
17183 @opindex mfp32
17184 Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
17185
17186 @item -mfp64
17187 @opindex mfp64
17188 Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
17189
17190 @item -mhard-float
17191 @opindex mhard-float
17192 Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
17193
17194 @item -msoft-float
17195 @opindex msoft-float
17196 Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions. Implement
17197 floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
17198
17199 @item -mno-float
17200 @opindex mno-float
17201 Equivalent to @option{-msoft-float}, but additionally asserts that the
17202 program being compiled does not perform any floating-point operations.
17203 This option is presently supported only by some bare-metal MIPS
17204 configurations, where it may select a special set of libraries
17205 that lack all floating-point support (including, for example, the
17206 floating-point @code{printf} formats).
17207 If code compiled with @code{-mno-float} accidentally contains
17208 floating-point operations, it is likely to suffer a link-time
17209 or run-time failure.
17210
17211 @item -msingle-float
17212 @opindex msingle-float
17213 Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision
17214 operations.
17215
17216 @item -mdouble-float
17217 @opindex mdouble-float
17218 Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-precision
17219 operations. This is the default.
17220
17221 @item -mabs=2008
17222 @itemx -mabs=legacy
17223 @opindex mabs=2008
17224 @opindex mabs=legacy
17225 These options control the treatment of the special not-a-number (NaN)
17226 IEEE 754 floating-point data with the @code{abs.@i{fmt}} and
17227 @code{neg.@i{fmt}} machine instructions.
17228
17229 By default or when the @option{-mabs=legacy} is used the legacy
17230 treatment is selected. In this case these instructions are considered
17231 arithmetic and avoided where correct operation is required and the
17232 input operand might be a NaN. A longer sequence of instructions that
17233 manipulate the sign bit of floating-point datum manually is used
17234 instead unless the @option{-ffinite-math-only} option has also been
17235 specified.
17236
17237 The @option{-mabs=2008} option selects the IEEE 754-2008 treatment. In
17238 this case these instructions are considered non-arithmetic and therefore
17239 operating correctly in all cases, including in particular where the
17240 input operand is a NaN. These instructions are therefore always used
17241 for the respective operations.
17242
17243 @item -mnan=2008
17244 @itemx -mnan=legacy
17245 @opindex mnan=2008
17246 @opindex mnan=legacy
17247 These options control the encoding of the special not-a-number (NaN)
17248 IEEE 754 floating-point data.
17249
17250 The @option{-mnan=legacy} option selects the legacy encoding. In this
17251 case quiet NaNs (qNaNs) are denoted by the first bit of their trailing
17252 significand field being 0, whereas signalling NaNs (sNaNs) are denoted
17253 by the first bit of their trailing significand field being 1.
17254
17255 The @option{-mnan=2008} option selects the IEEE 754-2008 encoding. In
17256 this case qNaNs are denoted by the first bit of their trailing
17257 significand field being 1, whereas sNaNs are denoted by the first bit of
17258 their trailing significand field being 0.
17259
17260 The default is @option{-mnan=legacy} unless GCC has been configured with
17261 @option{--with-nan=2008}.
17262
17263 @item -mllsc
17264 @itemx -mno-llsc
17265 @opindex mllsc
17266 @opindex mno-llsc
17267 Use (do not use) @samp{ll}, @samp{sc}, and @samp{sync} instructions to
17268 implement atomic memory built-in functions. When neither option is
17269 specified, GCC uses the instructions if the target architecture
17270 supports them.
17271
17272 @option{-mllsc} is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the
17273 instructions and @option{-mno-llsc} can be useful when compiling for
17274 nonstandard ISAs. You can make either option the default by
17275 configuring GCC with @option{--with-llsc} and @option{--without-llsc}
17276 respectively. @option{--with-llsc} is the default for some
17277 configurations; see the installation documentation for details.
17278
17279 @item -mdsp
17280 @itemx -mno-dsp
17281 @opindex mdsp
17282 @opindex mno-dsp
17283 Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
17284 @xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}. This option defines the
17285 preprocessor macro @samp{__mips_dsp}. It also defines
17286 @samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 1.
17287
17288 @item -mdspr2
17289 @itemx -mno-dspr2
17290 @opindex mdspr2
17291 @opindex mno-dspr2
17292 Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
17293 @xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}. This option defines the
17294 preprocessor macros @samp{__mips_dsp} and @samp{__mips_dspr2}.
17295 It also defines @samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 2.
17296
17297 @item -msmartmips
17298 @itemx -mno-smartmips
17299 @opindex msmartmips
17300 @opindex mno-smartmips
17301 Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.
17302
17303 @item -mpaired-single
17304 @itemx -mno-paired-single
17305 @opindex mpaired-single
17306 @opindex mno-paired-single
17307 Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
17308 @xref{MIPS Paired-Single Support}. This option requires
17309 hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
17310
17311 @item -mdmx
17312 @itemx -mno-mdmx
17313 @opindex mdmx
17314 @opindex mno-mdmx
17315 Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions.
17316 This option can only be used when generating 64-bit code and requires
17317 hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
17318
17319 @item -mips3d
17320 @itemx -mno-mips3d
17321 @opindex mips3d
17322 @opindex mno-mips3d
17323 Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE@. @xref{MIPS-3D Built-in Functions}.
17324 The option @option{-mips3d} implies @option{-mpaired-single}.
17325
17326 @item -mmicromips
17327 @itemx -mno-micromips
17328 @opindex mmicromips
17329 @opindex mno-mmicromips
17330 Generate (do not generate) microMIPS code.
17331
17332 MicroMIPS code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis
17333 by means of @code{micromips} and @code{nomicromips} attributes.
17334 @xref{Function Attributes}, for more information.
17335
17336 @item -mmt
17337 @itemx -mno-mt
17338 @opindex mmt
17339 @opindex mno-mt
17340 Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.
17341
17342 @item -mmcu
17343 @itemx -mno-mcu
17344 @opindex mmcu
17345 @opindex mno-mcu
17346 Use (do not use) the MIPS MCU ASE instructions.
17347
17348 @item -meva
17349 @itemx -mno-eva
17350 @opindex meva
17351 @opindex mno-eva
17352 Use (do not use) the MIPS Enhanced Virtual Addressing instructions.
17353
17354 @item -mlong64
17355 @opindex mlong64
17356 Force @code{long} types to be 64 bits wide. See @option{-mlong32} for
17357 an explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
17358 determined.
17359
17360 @item -mlong32
17361 @opindex mlong32
17362 Force @code{long}, @code{int}, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
17363
17364 The default size of @code{int}s, @code{long}s and pointers depends on
17365 the ABI@. All the supported ABIs use 32-bit @code{int}s. The n64 ABI
17366 uses 64-bit @code{long}s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use
17367 32-bit @code{long}s. Pointers are the same size as @code{long}s,
17368 or the same size as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
17369
17370 @item -msym32
17371 @itemx -mno-sym32
17372 @opindex msym32
17373 @opindex mno-sym32
17374 Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless
17375 of the selected ABI@. This option is useful in combination with
17376 @option{-mabi=64} and @option{-mno-abicalls} because it allows GCC
17377 to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
17378
17379 @item -G @var{num}
17380 @opindex G
17381 Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
17382 if that data is no bigger than @var{num} bytes. GCC can then generate
17383 more efficient accesses to the data; see @option{-mgpopt} for details.
17384
17385 The default @option{-G} option depends on the configuration.
17386
17387 @item -mlocal-sdata
17388 @itemx -mno-local-sdata
17389 @opindex mlocal-sdata
17390 @opindex mno-local-sdata
17391 Extend (do not extend) the @option{-G} behavior to local data too,
17392 such as to static variables in C@. @option{-mlocal-sdata} is the
17393 default for all configurations.
17394
17395 If the linker complains that an application is using too much small data,
17396 you might want to try rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with
17397 @option{-mno-local-sdata}. You might also want to build large
17398 libraries with @option{-mno-local-sdata}, so that the libraries leave
17399 more room for the main program.
17400
17401 @item -mextern-sdata
17402 @itemx -mno-extern-sdata
17403 @opindex mextern-sdata
17404 @opindex mno-extern-sdata
17405 Assume (do not assume) that externally-defined data is in
17406 a small data section if the size of that data is within the @option{-G} limit.
17407 @option{-mextern-sdata} is the default for all configurations.
17408
17409 If you compile a module @var{Mod} with @option{-mextern-sdata} @option{-G
17410 @var{num}} @option{-mgpopt}, and @var{Mod} references a variable @var{Var}
17411 that is no bigger than @var{num} bytes, you must make sure that @var{Var}
17412 is placed in a small data section. If @var{Var} is defined by another
17413 module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough
17414 @option{-G} setting or attach a @code{section} attribute to @var{Var}'s
17415 definition. If @var{Var} is common, you must link the application
17416 with a high-enough @option{-G} setting.
17417
17418 The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile
17419 and link every module with the same @option{-G} option. However,
17420 you may wish to build a library that supports several different
17421 small data limits. You can do this by compiling the library with
17422 the highest supported @option{-G} setting and additionally using
17423 @option{-mno-extern-sdata} to stop the library from making assumptions
17424 about externally-defined data.
17425
17426 @item -mgpopt
17427 @itemx -mno-gpopt
17428 @opindex mgpopt
17429 @opindex mno-gpopt
17430 Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be
17431 in a small data section; see @option{-G}, @option{-mlocal-sdata} and
17432 @option{-mextern-sdata}. @option{-mgpopt} is the default for all
17433 configurations.
17434
17435 @option{-mno-gpopt} is useful for cases where the @code{$gp} register
17436 might not hold the value of @code{_gp}. For example, if the code is
17437 part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor, programs that
17438 call boot monitor routines pass an unknown value in @code{$gp}.
17439 (In such situations, the boot monitor itself is usually compiled
17440 with @option{-G0}.)
17441
17442 @option{-mno-gpopt} implies @option{-mno-local-sdata} and
17443 @option{-mno-extern-sdata}.
17444
17445 @item -membedded-data
17446 @itemx -mno-embedded-data
17447 @opindex membedded-data
17448 @opindex mno-embedded-data
17449 Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
17450 next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data. This gives
17451 slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
17452 when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
17453
17454 @item -muninit-const-in-rodata
17455 @itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
17456 @opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
17457 @opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
17458 Put uninitialized @code{const} variables in the read-only data section.
17459 This option is only meaningful in conjunction with @option{-membedded-data}.
17460
17461 @item -mcode-readable=@var{setting}
17462 @opindex mcode-readable
17463 Specify whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.
17464 There are three possible settings:
17465
17466 @table @gcctabopt
17467 @item -mcode-readable=yes
17468 Instructions may freely access executable sections. This is the
17469 default setting.
17470
17471 @item -mcode-readable=pcrel
17472 MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections,
17473 but other instructions must not do so. This option is useful on 4KSc
17474 and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read Inhibit bit set.
17475 It is also useful on processors that can be configured to have a dual
17476 instruction/data SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically
17477 redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
17478
17479 @item -mcode-readable=no
17480 Instructions must not access executable sections. This option can be
17481 useful on targets that are configured to have a dual instruction/data
17482 SRAM interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not automatically redirect
17483 PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
17484 @end table
17485
17486 @item -msplit-addresses
17487 @itemx -mno-split-addresses
17488 @opindex msplit-addresses
17489 @opindex mno-split-addresses
17490 Enable (disable) use of the @code{%hi()} and @code{%lo()} assembler
17491 relocation operators. This option has been superseded by
17492 @option{-mexplicit-relocs} but is retained for backwards compatibility.
17493
17494 @item -mexplicit-relocs
17495 @itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
17496 @opindex mexplicit-relocs
17497 @opindex mno-explicit-relocs
17498 Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with symbolic
17499 addresses. The alternative, selected by @option{-mno-explicit-relocs},
17500 is to use assembler macros instead.
17501
17502 @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is the default if GCC was configured
17503 to use an assembler that supports relocation operators.
17504
17505 @item -mcheck-zero-division
17506 @itemx -mno-check-zero-division
17507 @opindex mcheck-zero-division
17508 @opindex mno-check-zero-division
17509 Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.
17510
17511 The default is @option{-mcheck-zero-division}.
17512
17513 @item -mdivide-traps
17514 @itemx -mdivide-breaks
17515 @opindex mdivide-traps
17516 @opindex mdivide-breaks
17517 MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
17518 conditional trap or a break instruction. Using traps results in
17519 smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later. Also, some
17520 versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from
17521 generating the proper signal (@code{SIGFPE}). Use @option{-mdivide-traps} to
17522 allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
17523 @option{-mdivide-breaks} to force the use of breaks.
17524
17525 The default is usually @option{-mdivide-traps}, but this can be
17526 overridden at configure time using @option{--with-divide=breaks}.
17527 Divide-by-zero checks can be completely disabled using
17528 @option{-mno-check-zero-division}.
17529
17530 @item -mmemcpy
17531 @itemx -mno-memcpy
17532 @opindex mmemcpy
17533 @opindex mno-memcpy
17534 Force (do not force) the use of @code{memcpy()} for non-trivial block
17535 moves. The default is @option{-mno-memcpy}, which allows GCC to inline
17536 most constant-sized copies.
17537
17538 @item -mlong-calls
17539 @itemx -mno-long-calls
17540 @opindex mlong-calls
17541 @opindex mno-long-calls
17542 Disable (do not disable) use of the @code{jal} instruction. Calling
17543 functions using @code{jal} is more efficient but requires the caller
17544 and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
17545
17546 This option has no effect on abicalls code. The default is
17547 @option{-mno-long-calls}.
17548
17549 @item -mmad
17550 @itemx -mno-mad
17551 @opindex mmad
17552 @opindex mno-mad
17553 Enable (disable) use of the @code{mad}, @code{madu} and @code{mul}
17554 instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA@.
17555
17556 @item -mimadd
17557 @itemx -mno-imadd
17558 @opindex mimadd
17559 @opindex mno-imadd
17560 Enable (disable) use of the @code{madd} and @code{msub} integer
17561 instructions. The default is @option{-mimadd} on architectures
17562 that support @code{madd} and @code{msub} except for the 74k
17563 architecture where it was found to generate slower code.
17564
17565 @item -mfused-madd
17566 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
17567 @opindex mfused-madd
17568 @opindex mno-fused-madd
17569 Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate
17570 instructions, when they are available. The default is
17571 @option{-mfused-madd}.
17572
17573 On the R8000 CPU when multiply-accumulate instructions are used,
17574 the intermediate product is calculated to infinite precision
17575 and is not subject to the FCSR Flush to Zero bit. This may be
17576 undesirable in some circumstances. On other processors the result
17577 is numerically identical to the equivalent computation using
17578 separate multiply, add, subtract and negate instructions.
17579
17580 @item -nocpp
17581 @opindex nocpp
17582 Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
17583 assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
17584
17585 @item -mfix-24k
17586 @item -mno-fix-24k
17587 @opindex mfix-24k
17588 @opindex mno-fix-24k
17589 Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.
17590 The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC@.
17591
17592 @item -mfix-r4000
17593 @itemx -mno-fix-r4000
17594 @opindex mfix-r4000
17595 @opindex mno-fix-r4000
17596 Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
17597 @itemize @minus
17598 @item
17599 A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
17600 immediately after starting an integer division.
17601 @item
17602 A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
17603 while an integer multiplication is in progress.
17604 @item
17605 An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot
17606 of a taken branch or a jump.
17607 @end itemize
17608
17609 @item -mfix-r4400
17610 @itemx -mno-fix-r4400
17611 @opindex mfix-r4400
17612 @opindex mno-fix-r4400
17613 Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
17614 @itemize @minus
17615 @item
17616 A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
17617 immediately after starting an integer division.
17618 @end itemize
17619
17620 @item -mfix-r10000
17621 @itemx -mno-fix-r10000
17622 @opindex mfix-r10000
17623 @opindex mno-fix-r10000
17624 Work around certain R10000 errata:
17625 @itemize @minus
17626 @item
17627 @code{ll}/@code{sc} sequences may not behave atomically on revisions
17628 prior to 3.0. They may deadlock on revisions 2.6 and earlier.
17629 @end itemize
17630
17631 This option can only be used if the target architecture supports
17632 branch-likely instructions. @option{-mfix-r10000} is the default when
17633 @option{-march=r10000} is used; @option{-mno-fix-r10000} is the default
17634 otherwise.
17635
17636 @item -mfix-rm7000
17637 @itemx -mno-fix-rm7000
17638 @opindex mfix-rm7000
17639 Work around the RM7000 @code{dmult}/@code{dmultu} errata. The
17640 workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC@.
17641
17642 @item -mfix-vr4120
17643 @itemx -mno-fix-vr4120
17644 @opindex mfix-vr4120
17645 Work around certain VR4120 errata:
17646 @itemize @minus
17647 @item
17648 @code{dmultu} does not always produce the correct result.
17649 @item
17650 @code{div} and @code{ddiv} do not always produce the correct result if one
17651 of the operands is negative.
17652 @end itemize
17653 The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in
17654 @file{libgcc.a}. At present, these functions are only provided by
17655 the @code{mips64vr*-elf} configurations.
17656
17657 Other VR4120 errata require a NOP to be inserted between certain pairs of
17658 instructions. These errata are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.
17659
17660 @item -mfix-vr4130
17661 @opindex mfix-vr4130
17662 Work around the VR4130 @code{mflo}/@code{mfhi} errata. The
17663 workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC,
17664 although GCC avoids using @code{mflo} and @code{mfhi} if the
17665 VR4130 @code{macc}, @code{macchi}, @code{dmacc} and @code{dmacchi}
17666 instructions are available instead.
17667
17668 @item -mfix-sb1
17669 @itemx -mno-fix-sb1
17670 @opindex mfix-sb1
17671 Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.
17672 (This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2
17673 ``F1'' and ``F2'' floating-point errata.)
17674
17675 @item -mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}
17676 @opindex mr10k-cache-barrier
17677 Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the
17678 side-effects of speculation on R10K processors.
17679
17680 In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome
17681 of a conditional branch and speculatively executes instructions from
17682 the ``taken'' branch. It later aborts these instructions if the
17683 predicted outcome is wrong. However, on the R10K, even aborted
17684 instructions can have side effects.
17685
17686 This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system,
17687 kernel loads. As an example, a speculatively-executed store may load
17688 the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as dirty, even if
17689 the store itself is later aborted. If a DMA operation writes to the
17690 same area of memory before the ``dirty'' line is flushed, the cached
17691 data overwrites the DMA-ed data. See the R10K processor manual
17692 for a full description, including other potential problems.
17693
17694 One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before every memory
17695 access that might be speculatively executed and that might have side
17696 effects even if aborted. @option{-mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}}
17697 controls GCC's implementation of this workaround. It assumes that
17698 aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions does not have
17699 side effects:
17700
17701 @enumerate
17702 @item
17703 the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;
17704
17705 @item
17706 the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;
17707
17708 @item
17709 the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.
17710 @end enumerate
17711
17712 It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative
17713 accesses to these regions are indeed safe.
17714
17715 If the input program contains a function declaration such as:
17716
17717 @smallexample
17718 void foo (void);
17719 @end smallexample
17720
17721 then the implementation of @code{foo} must allow @code{j foo} and
17722 @code{jal foo} to be executed speculatively. GCC honors this
17723 restriction for functions it compiles itself. It expects non-GCC
17724 functions (such as hand-written assembly code) to do the same.
17725
17726 The option has three forms:
17727
17728 @table @gcctabopt
17729 @item -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
17730 Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be
17731 speculatively executed and that might have side effects even
17732 if aborted.
17733
17734 @item -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
17735 Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be speculatively
17736 executed and that might have side effects even if aborted.
17737
17738 @item -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
17739 Disable the insertion of cache barriers. This is the default setting.
17740 @end table
17741
17742 @item -mflush-func=@var{func}
17743 @itemx -mno-flush-func
17744 @opindex mflush-func
17745 Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
17746 call any such function. If called, the function must take the same
17747 arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
17748 memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
17749 memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches). The default
17750 depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly is either
17751 @samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
17752
17753 @item mbranch-cost=@var{num}
17754 @opindex mbranch-cost
17755 Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
17756 This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
17757 consistent results across releases. A zero cost redundantly selects
17758 the default, which is based on the @option{-mtune} setting.
17759
17760 @item -mbranch-likely
17761 @itemx -mno-branch-likely
17762 @opindex mbranch-likely
17763 @opindex mno-branch-likely
17764 Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
17765 default for the selected architecture. By default, Branch Likely
17766 instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
17767 architecture. An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
17768 and processors that implement those architectures; for those, Branch
17769 Likely instructions are not be generated by default because the MIPS32
17770 and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
17771
17772 @item -mfp-exceptions
17773 @itemx -mno-fp-exceptions
17774 @opindex mfp-exceptions
17775 Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled. This affects how
17776 FP instructions are scheduled for some processors.
17777 The default is that FP exceptions are
17778 enabled.
17779
17780 For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting
17781 64-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes. Otherwise, we can only use one
17782 FP pipe.
17783
17784 @item -mvr4130-align
17785 @itemx -mno-vr4130-align
17786 @opindex mvr4130-align
17787 The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
17788 instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned. When this
17789 option is enabled, GCC aligns pairs of instructions that it
17790 thinks should execute in parallel.
17791
17792 This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.
17793 It normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
17794 It is enabled by default at optimization level @option{-O3}.
17795
17796 @item -msynci
17797 @itemx -mno-synci
17798 @opindex msynci
17799 Enable (disable) generation of @code{synci} instructions on
17800 architectures that support it. The @code{synci} instructions (if
17801 enabled) are generated when @code{__builtin___clear_cache()} is
17802 compiled.
17803
17804 This option defaults to @code{-mno-synci}, but the default can be
17805 overridden by configuring with @code{--with-synci}.
17806
17807 When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally safe
17808 to use @code{synci}. However, on many multi-core (SMP) systems, it
17809 does not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may lead
17810 to undefined behavior.
17811
17812 @item -mrelax-pic-calls
17813 @itemx -mno-relax-pic-calls
17814 @opindex mrelax-pic-calls
17815 Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register
17816 @code{$25} into direct calls. This is only possible if the linker can
17817 resolve the destination at link-time and if the destination is within
17818 range for a direct call.
17819
17820 @option{-mrelax-pic-calls} is the default if GCC was configured to use
17821 an assembler and a linker that support the @code{.reloc} assembly
17822 directive and @code{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect. With
17823 @code{-mno-explicit-relocs}, this optimization can be performed by the
17824 assembler and the linker alone without help from the compiler.
17825
17826 @item -mmcount-ra-address
17827 @itemx -mno-mcount-ra-address
17828 @opindex mmcount-ra-address
17829 @opindex mno-mcount-ra-address
17830 Emit (do not emit) code that allows @code{_mcount} to modify the
17831 calling function's return address. When enabled, this option extends
17832 the usual @code{_mcount} interface with a new @var{ra-address}
17833 parameter, which has type @code{intptr_t *} and is passed in register
17834 @code{$12}. @code{_mcount} can then modify the return address by
17835 doing both of the following:
17836 @itemize
17837 @item
17838 Returning the new address in register @code{$31}.
17839 @item
17840 Storing the new address in @code{*@var{ra-address}},
17841 if @var{ra-address} is nonnull.
17842 @end itemize
17843
17844 The default is @option{-mno-mcount-ra-address}.
17845
17846 @end table
17847
17848 @node MMIX Options
17849 @subsection MMIX Options
17850 @cindex MMIX Options
17851
17852 These options are defined for the MMIX:
17853
17854 @table @gcctabopt
17855 @item -mlibfuncs
17856 @itemx -mno-libfuncs
17857 @opindex mlibfuncs
17858 @opindex mno-libfuncs
17859 Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
17860 values in registers, no matter the size.
17861
17862 @item -mepsilon
17863 @itemx -mno-epsilon
17864 @opindex mepsilon
17865 @opindex mno-epsilon
17866 Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
17867 to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
17868
17869 @item -mabi=mmixware
17870 @itemx -mabi=gnu
17871 @opindex mabi=mmixware
17872 @opindex mabi=gnu
17873 Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
17874 the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
17875 the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
17876
17877 @item -mzero-extend
17878 @itemx -mno-zero-extend
17879 @opindex mzero-extend
17880 @opindex mno-zero-extend
17881 When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
17882 use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
17883 sign-extending ones.
17884
17885 @item -mknuthdiv
17886 @itemx -mno-knuthdiv
17887 @opindex mknuthdiv
17888 @opindex mno-knuthdiv
17889 Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
17890 the divisor. With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
17891 remainder follows the sign of the dividend. Both methods are
17892 arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
17893
17894 @item -mtoplevel-symbols
17895 @itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
17896 @opindex mtoplevel-symbols
17897 @opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
17898 Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
17899 code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
17900
17901 @item -melf
17902 @opindex melf
17903 Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
17904 @samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
17905
17906 @item -mbranch-predict
17907 @itemx -mno-branch-predict
17908 @opindex mbranch-predict
17909 @opindex mno-branch-predict
17910 Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
17911 prediction indicates a probable branch.
17912
17913 @item -mbase-addresses
17914 @itemx -mno-base-addresses
17915 @opindex mbase-addresses
17916 @opindex mno-base-addresses
17917 Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}. Using a
17918 base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
17919 and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register. The
17920 register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
17921 to 255 from the value held in the register. The generally leads to short
17922 and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
17923 addressed is limited. This means that a program that uses lots of static
17924 data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
17925
17926 @item -msingle-exit
17927 @itemx -mno-single-exit
17928 @opindex msingle-exit
17929 @opindex mno-single-exit
17930 Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
17931 function.
17932 @end table
17933
17934 @node MN10300 Options
17935 @subsection MN10300 Options
17936 @cindex MN10300 options
17937
17938 These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
17939
17940 @table @gcctabopt
17941 @item -mmult-bug
17942 @opindex mmult-bug
17943 Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
17944 processors. This is the default.
17945
17946 @item -mno-mult-bug
17947 @opindex mno-mult-bug
17948 Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
17949 MN10300 processors.
17950
17951 @item -mam33
17952 @opindex mam33
17953 Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
17954
17955 @item -mno-am33
17956 @opindex mno-am33
17957 Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor. This
17958 is the default.
17959
17960 @item -mam33-2
17961 @opindex mam33-2
17962 Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.
17963
17964 @item -mam34
17965 @opindex mam34
17966 Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.
17967
17968 @item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
17969 @opindex mtune
17970 Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when
17971 scheduling instructions. This does not change the targeted processor
17972 type. The CPU type must be one of @samp{mn10300}, @samp{am33},
17973 @samp{am33-2} or @samp{am34}.
17974
17975 @item -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
17976 @opindex mreturn-pointer-on-d0
17977 When generating a function that returns a pointer, return the pointer
17978 in both @code{a0} and @code{d0}. Otherwise, the pointer is returned
17979 only in @code{a0}, and attempts to call such functions without a prototype
17980 result in errors. Note that this option is on by default; use
17981 @option{-mno-return-pointer-on-d0} to disable it.
17982
17983 @item -mno-crt0
17984 @opindex mno-crt0
17985 Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
17986
17987 @item -mrelax
17988 @opindex mrelax
17989 Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
17990 to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses. This option only
17991 has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
17992
17993 This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
17994
17995 @item -mliw
17996 @opindex mliw
17997 Allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
17998 instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later. This is the
17999 default. This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__LIW__}.
18000
18001 @item -mnoliw
18002 @opindex mnoliw
18003 Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
18004 instructions. This option defines the preprocessor macro
18005 @samp{__NO_LIW__}.
18006
18007 @item -msetlb
18008 @opindex msetlb
18009 Allow the compiler to generate the @emph{SETLB} and @emph{Lcc}
18010 instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later. This is the
18011 default. This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__SETLB__}.
18012
18013 @item -mnosetlb
18014 @opindex mnosetlb
18015 Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{SETLB} or @emph{Lcc}
18016 instructions. This option defines the preprocessor macro
18017 @samp{__NO_SETLB__}.
18018
18019 @end table
18020
18021 @node Moxie Options
18022 @subsection Moxie Options
18023 @cindex Moxie Options
18024
18025 @table @gcctabopt
18026
18027 @item -meb
18028 @opindex meb
18029 Generate big-endian code. This is the default for @samp{moxie-*-*}
18030 configurations.
18031
18032 @item -mel
18033 @opindex mel
18034 Generate little-endian code.
18035
18036 @item -mno-crt0
18037 @opindex mno-crt0
18038 Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
18039
18040 @end table
18041
18042 @node MSP430 Options
18043 @subsection MSP430 Options
18044 @cindex MSP430 Options
18045
18046 These options are defined for the MSP430:
18047
18048 @table @gcctabopt
18049
18050 @item -masm-hex
18051 @opindex masm-hex
18052 Force assembly output to always use hex constants. Normally such
18053 constants are signed decimals, but this option is available for
18054 testsuite and/or aesthetic purposes.
18055
18056 @item -mmcu=
18057 @opindex mmcu=
18058 Select the MCU to target. If the MCU supports the MSP430X ISA or the
18059 MSP430Xv2 ISA then gcc will make use of the extra instructions. A C
18060 preprocessor symbol will be defined based upon the MCU name, converted
18061 to upper case and pre- and post- fixed with @code{__}.
18062
18063 In addition two scripts will be added to the linker command line:
18064 @code{memory.ld} and @code{peripherals.ld}, with a search path based
18065 upon the MCU name.
18066
18067 Note that there are three ``generic'' MCUs: @code{msp430},
18068 @code{msp430x} and @code{msp430xv2}, which can be used if a specific
18069 MCU is not being targeted.
18070
18071 This option is also passed on to the assembler.
18072
18073 @item -msim
18074 @opindex msim
18075 Link to the simulator runtime libraries and linker script. Overrides
18076 any scripts that would be selected by the @option{-mmcu=} option.
18077
18078 @item -mlarge
18079 @opindex mlarge
18080 Use large-model addressing (20-bit pointers, 32-bit @code{size_t}).
18081
18082 @item -msmall
18083 @opindex msmall
18084 Use small-model addressing (16-bit pointers, 16-bit @code{size_t}).
18085
18086 @item -mrelax
18087 @opindex mrelax
18088 This option is passed to the assembler and linker, and allows the
18089 linker to perform certain optimizations that cannot be done until
18090 the final link.
18091
18092 @end table
18093
18094 @node NDS32 Options
18095 @subsection NDS32 Options
18096 @cindex NDS32 Options
18097
18098 These options are defined for NDS32 implementations:
18099
18100 @table @gcctabopt
18101
18102 @item -mbig-endian
18103 @opindex mbig-endian
18104 Generate code in big-endian mode.
18105
18106 @item -mlittle-endian
18107 @opindex mlittle-endian
18108 Generate code in little-endian mode.
18109
18110 @item -mreduced-regs
18111 @opindex mreduced-regs
18112 Use reduced-set registers for register allocation.
18113
18114 @item -mfull-regs
18115 @opindex mfull-regs
18116 Use full-set registers for register allocation.
18117
18118 @item -mcmov
18119 @opindex mcmov
18120 Generate conditional move instructions.
18121
18122 @item -mno-cmov
18123 @opindex mno-cmov
18124 Do not generate conditional move instructions.
18125
18126 @item -mperf-ext
18127 @opindex mperf-ext
18128 Generate performance extension instructions.
18129
18130 @item -mno-perf-ext
18131 @opindex mno-perf-ext
18132 Do not generate performance extension instructions.
18133
18134 @item -mv3push
18135 @opindex mv3push
18136 Generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.
18137
18138 @item -mno-v3push
18139 @opindex mno-v3push
18140 Do not generate v3 push25/pop25 instructions.
18141
18142 @item -m16-bit
18143 @opindex m16-bit
18144 Generate 16-bit instructions.
18145
18146 @item -mno-16-bit
18147 @opindex mno-16-bit
18148 Do not generate 16-bit instructions.
18149
18150 @item -mgp-direct
18151 @opindex mgp-direct
18152 Generate GP base instructions directly.
18153
18154 @item -mno-gp-direct
18155 @opindex mno-gp-direct
18156 Do no generate GP base instructions directly.
18157
18158 @item -misr-vector-size=@var{num}
18159 @opindex misr-vector-size
18160 Specify the size of each interrupt vector, which must be 4 or 16.
18161
18162 @item -mcache-block-size=@var{num}
18163 @opindex mcache-block-size
18164 Specify the size of each cache block,
18165 which must be a power of 2 between 4 and 512.
18166
18167 @item -march=@var{arch}
18168 @opindex march
18169 Specify the name of the target architecture.
18170
18171 @item -mforce-fp-as-gp
18172 @opindex mforce-fp-as-gp
18173 Prevent $fp being allocated during register allocation so that compiler
18174 is able to force performing fp-as-gp optimization.
18175
18176 @item -mforbid-fp-as-gp
18177 @opindex mforbid-fp-as-gp
18178 Forbid using $fp to access static and global variables.
18179 This option strictly forbids fp-as-gp optimization
18180 regardless of @option{-mforce-fp-as-gp}.
18181
18182 @item -mex9
18183 @opindex mex9
18184 Use special directives to guide linker doing ex9 optimization.
18185
18186 @item -mctor-dtor
18187 @opindex mctor-dtor
18188 Enable constructor/destructor feature.
18189
18190 @item -mrelax
18191 @opindex mrelax
18192 Guide linker to relax instructions.
18193
18194 @end table
18195
18196 @node PDP-11 Options
18197 @subsection PDP-11 Options
18198 @cindex PDP-11 Options
18199
18200 These options are defined for the PDP-11:
18201
18202 @table @gcctabopt
18203 @item -mfpu
18204 @opindex mfpu
18205 Use hardware FPP floating point. This is the default. (FIS floating
18206 point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
18207
18208 @item -msoft-float
18209 @opindex msoft-float
18210 Do not use hardware floating point.
18211
18212 @item -mac0
18213 @opindex mac0
18214 Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
18215
18216 @item -mno-ac0
18217 @opindex mno-ac0
18218 Return floating-point results in memory. This is the default.
18219
18220 @item -m40
18221 @opindex m40
18222 Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
18223
18224 @item -m45
18225 @opindex m45
18226 Generate code for a PDP-11/45. This is the default.
18227
18228 @item -m10
18229 @opindex m10
18230 Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
18231
18232 @item -mbcopy-builtin
18233 @opindex mbcopy-builtin
18234 Use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory. This is the
18235 default.
18236
18237 @item -mbcopy
18238 @opindex mbcopy
18239 Do not use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.
18240
18241 @item -mint16
18242 @itemx -mno-int32
18243 @opindex mint16
18244 @opindex mno-int32
18245 Use 16-bit @code{int}. This is the default.
18246
18247 @item -mint32
18248 @itemx -mno-int16
18249 @opindex mint32
18250 @opindex mno-int16
18251 Use 32-bit @code{int}.
18252
18253 @item -mfloat64
18254 @itemx -mno-float32
18255 @opindex mfloat64
18256 @opindex mno-float32
18257 Use 64-bit @code{float}. This is the default.
18258
18259 @item -mfloat32
18260 @itemx -mno-float64
18261 @opindex mfloat32
18262 @opindex mno-float64
18263 Use 32-bit @code{float}.
18264
18265 @item -mabshi
18266 @opindex mabshi
18267 Use @code{abshi2} pattern. This is the default.
18268
18269 @item -mno-abshi
18270 @opindex mno-abshi
18271 Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
18272
18273 @item -mbranch-expensive
18274 @opindex mbranch-expensive
18275 Pretend that branches are expensive. This is for experimenting with
18276 code generation only.
18277
18278 @item -mbranch-cheap
18279 @opindex mbranch-cheap
18280 Do not pretend that branches are expensive. This is the default.
18281
18282 @item -munix-asm
18283 @opindex munix-asm
18284 Use Unix assembler syntax. This is the default when configured for
18285 @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
18286
18287 @item -mdec-asm
18288 @opindex mdec-asm
18289 Use DEC assembler syntax. This is the default when configured for any
18290 PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
18291 @end table
18292
18293 @node picoChip Options
18294 @subsection picoChip Options
18295 @cindex picoChip options
18296
18297 These @samp{-m} options are defined for picoChip implementations:
18298
18299 @table @gcctabopt
18300
18301 @item -mae=@var{ae_type}
18302 @opindex mcpu
18303 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
18304 parameters for array element type @var{ae_type}. Supported values
18305 for @var{ae_type} are @samp{ANY}, @samp{MUL}, and @samp{MAC}.
18306
18307 @option{-mae=ANY} selects a completely generic AE type. Code
18308 generated with this option runs on any of the other AE types. The
18309 code is not as efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific
18310 AE type, and some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) do not
18311 work properly on all types of AE.
18312
18313 @option{-mae=MUL} selects a MUL AE type. This is the most useful AE type
18314 for compiled code, and is the default.
18315
18316 @option{-mae=MAC} selects a DSP-style MAC AE. Code compiled with this
18317 option may suffer from poor performance of byte (char) manipulation,
18318 since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.
18319
18320 @item -msymbol-as-address
18321 Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a
18322 load/store instruction, without first loading it into a
18323 register. Typically, the use of this option generates larger
18324 programs, which run faster than when the option isn't used. However, the
18325 results vary from program to program, so it is left as a user option,
18326 rather than being permanently enabled.
18327
18328 @item -mno-inefficient-warnings
18329 Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code. These
18330 warnings can be generated, for example, when compiling code that
18331 performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type. The MAC AE has
18332 no hardware support for byte-level memory operations, so all byte
18333 load/stores must be synthesized from word load/store operations. This is
18334 inefficient and a warning is generated to indicate
18335 that you should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target
18336 an AE type that has the necessary hardware support. This option disables
18337 these warnings.
18338
18339 @end table
18340
18341 @node PowerPC Options
18342 @subsection PowerPC Options
18343 @cindex PowerPC options
18344
18345 These are listed under @xref{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}.
18346
18347 @node RL78 Options
18348 @subsection RL78 Options
18349 @cindex RL78 Options
18350
18351 @table @gcctabopt
18352
18353 @item -msim
18354 @opindex msim
18355 Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a
18356 simulator.
18357
18358 @item -mmul=none
18359 @itemx -mmul=g13
18360 @itemx -mmul=rl78
18361 @opindex mmul
18362 Specifies the type of hardware multiplication support to be used. The
18363 default is @code{none}, which uses software multiplication functions.
18364 The @code{g13} option is for the hardware multiply/divide peripheral
18365 only on the RL78/G13 targets. The @code{rl78} option is for the
18366 standard hardware multiplication defined in the RL78 software manual.
18367
18368 @end table
18369
18370 @node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
18371 @subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
18372 @cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
18373 @cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
18374
18375 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
18376 @table @gcctabopt
18377 @item -mpowerpc-gpopt
18378 @itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
18379 @itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
18380 @itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
18381 @need 800
18382 @itemx -mpowerpc64
18383 @itemx -mno-powerpc64
18384 @itemx -mmfcrf
18385 @itemx -mno-mfcrf
18386 @itemx -mpopcntb
18387 @itemx -mno-popcntb
18388 @itemx -mpopcntd
18389 @itemx -mno-popcntd
18390 @itemx -mfprnd
18391 @itemx -mno-fprnd
18392 @need 800
18393 @itemx -mcmpb
18394 @itemx -mno-cmpb
18395 @itemx -mmfpgpr
18396 @itemx -mno-mfpgpr
18397 @itemx -mhard-dfp
18398 @itemx -mno-hard-dfp
18399 @opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
18400 @opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
18401 @opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
18402 @opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
18403 @opindex mpowerpc64
18404 @opindex mno-powerpc64
18405 @opindex mmfcrf
18406 @opindex mno-mfcrf
18407 @opindex mpopcntb
18408 @opindex mno-popcntb
18409 @opindex mpopcntd
18410 @opindex mno-popcntd
18411 @opindex mfprnd
18412 @opindex mno-fprnd
18413 @opindex mcmpb
18414 @opindex mno-cmpb
18415 @opindex mmfpgpr
18416 @opindex mno-mfpgpr
18417 @opindex mhard-dfp
18418 @opindex mno-hard-dfp
18419 You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
18420 processor you are using. The default value of these options is
18421 determined when configuring GCC@. Specifying the
18422 @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
18423 options. We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
18424 rather than the options listed above.
18425
18426 Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} allows
18427 GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
18428 General Purpose group, including floating-point square root. Specifying
18429 @option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} allows GCC to
18430 use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
18431 group, including floating-point select.
18432
18433 The @option{-mmfcrf} option allows GCC to generate the move from
18434 condition register field instruction implemented on the POWER4
18435 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01
18436 architecture.
18437 The @option{-mpopcntb} option allows GCC to generate the popcount and
18438 double-precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
18439 POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.02
18440 architecture.
18441 The @option{-mpopcntd} option allows GCC to generate the popcount
18442 instruction implemented on the POWER7 processor and other processors
18443 that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.
18444 The @option{-mfprnd} option allows GCC to generate the FP round to
18445 integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
18446 processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.
18447 The @option{-mcmpb} option allows GCC to generate the compare bytes
18448 instruction implemented on the POWER6 processor and other processors
18449 that support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.
18450 The @option{-mmfpgpr} option allows GCC to generate the FP move to/from
18451 general-purpose register instructions implemented on the POWER6X
18452 processor and other processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05
18453 architecture.
18454 The @option{-mhard-dfp} option allows GCC to generate the decimal
18455 floating-point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.
18456
18457 The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
18458 64-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
18459 and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities. GCC defaults to
18460 @option{-mno-powerpc64}.
18461
18462 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
18463 @opindex mcpu
18464 Set architecture type, register usage, and
18465 instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
18466 Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{401}, @samp{403},
18467 @samp{405}, @samp{405fp}, @samp{440}, @samp{440fp}, @samp{464}, @samp{464fp},
18468 @samp{476}, @samp{476fp}, @samp{505}, @samp{601}, @samp{602}, @samp{603},
18469 @samp{603e}, @samp{604}, @samp{604e}, @samp{620}, @samp{630}, @samp{740},
18470 @samp{7400}, @samp{7450}, @samp{750}, @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823},
18471 @samp{860}, @samp{970}, @samp{8540}, @samp{a2}, @samp{e300c2},
18472 @samp{e300c3}, @samp{e500mc}, @samp{e500mc64}, @samp{e5500},
18473 @samp{e6500}, @samp{ec603e}, @samp{G3}, @samp{G4}, @samp{G5},
18474 @samp{titan}, @samp{power3}, @samp{power4}, @samp{power5}, @samp{power5+},
18475 @samp{power6}, @samp{power6x}, @samp{power7}, @samp{power8}, @samp{powerpc},
18476 @samp{powerpc64}, and @samp{rs64}.
18477
18478 @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and @option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify pure 32-bit
18479 PowerPC and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
18480 types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
18481 scheduling purposes.
18482
18483 The other options specify a specific processor. Code generated under
18484 those options runs best on that processor, and may not run at all on
18485 others.
18486
18487 The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable the
18488 following options:
18489
18490 @gccoptlist{-maltivec -mfprnd -mhard-float -mmfcrf -mmultiple @gol
18491 -mpopcntb -mpopcntd -mpowerpc64 @gol
18492 -mpowerpc-gpopt -mpowerpc-gfxopt -msingle-float -mdouble-float @gol
18493 -msimple-fpu -mstring -mmulhw -mdlmzb -mmfpgpr -mvsx @gol
18494 -mcrypto -mdirect-move -mpower8-fusion -mpower8-vector -mquad-memory}
18495
18496 The particular options set for any particular CPU varies between
18497 compiler versions, depending on what setting seems to produce optimal
18498 code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual hardware's
18499 capabilities. If you wish to set an individual option to a particular
18500 value, you may specify it after the @option{-mcpu} option, like
18501 @option{-mcpu=970 -mno-altivec}.
18502
18503 On AIX, the @option{-maltivec} and @option{-mpowerpc64} options are
18504 not enabled or disabled by the @option{-mcpu} option at present because
18505 AIX does not have full support for these options. You may still
18506 enable or disable them individually if you're sure it'll work in your
18507 environment.
18508
18509 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
18510 @opindex mtune
18511 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
18512 @var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type or register usage,
18513 as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} does. The same
18514 values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
18515 @option{-mcpu}. If both are specified, the code generated uses the
18516 architecture and registers set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
18517 scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
18518
18519 @item -mcmodel=small
18520 @opindex mcmodel=small
18521 Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to
18522 64k.
18523
18524 @item -mcmodel=medium
18525 @opindex mcmodel=medium
18526 Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static
18527 data may be up to a total of 4G in size.
18528
18529 @item -mcmodel=large
18530 @opindex mcmodel=large
18531 Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G
18532 in size. Other data and code is only limited by the 64-bit address
18533 space.
18534
18535 @item -maltivec
18536 @itemx -mno-altivec
18537 @opindex maltivec
18538 @opindex mno-altivec
18539 Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and also
18540 enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
18541 the AltiVec instruction set. You may also need to set
18542 @option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
18543 enhancements.
18544
18545 @item -mvrsave
18546 @itemx -mno-vrsave
18547 @opindex mvrsave
18548 @opindex mno-vrsave
18549 Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
18550
18551 @item -mgen-cell-microcode
18552 @opindex mgen-cell-microcode
18553 Generate Cell microcode instructions.
18554
18555 @item -mwarn-cell-microcode
18556 @opindex mwarn-cell-microcode
18557 Warn when a Cell microcode instruction is emitted. An example
18558 of a Cell microcode instruction is a variable shift.
18559
18560 @item -msecure-plt
18561 @opindex msecure-plt
18562 Generate code that allows @command{ld} and @command{ld.so}
18563 to build executables and shared
18564 libraries with non-executable @code{.plt} and @code{.got} sections.
18565 This is a PowerPC
18566 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
18567
18568 @item -mbss-plt
18569 @opindex mbss-plt
18570 Generate code that uses a BSS @code{.plt} section that @command{ld.so}
18571 fills in, and
18572 requires @code{.plt} and @code{.got}
18573 sections that are both writable and executable.
18574 This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
18575
18576 @item -misel
18577 @itemx -mno-isel
18578 @opindex misel
18579 @opindex mno-isel
18580 This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
18581
18582 @item -misel=@var{yes/no}
18583 This switch has been deprecated. Use @option{-misel} and
18584 @option{-mno-isel} instead.
18585
18586 @item -mspe
18587 @itemx -mno-spe
18588 @opindex mspe
18589 @opindex mno-spe
18590 This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd
18591 instructions.
18592
18593 @item -mpaired
18594 @itemx -mno-paired
18595 @opindex mpaired
18596 @opindex mno-paired
18597 This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd
18598 instructions.
18599
18600 @item -mspe=@var{yes/no}
18601 This option has been deprecated. Use @option{-mspe} and
18602 @option{-mno-spe} instead.
18603
18604 @item -mvsx
18605 @itemx -mno-vsx
18606 @opindex mvsx
18607 @opindex mno-vsx
18608 Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX)
18609 instructions, and also enable the use of built-in functions that allow
18610 more direct access to the VSX instruction set.
18611
18612 @item -mcrypto
18613 @itemx -mno-crypto
18614 @opindex mcrypto
18615 @opindex mno-crypto
18616 Enable the use (disable) of the built-in functions that allow direct
18617 access to the cryptographic instructions that were added in version
18618 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.
18619
18620 @item -mdirect-move
18621 @itemx -mno-direct-move
18622 @opindex mdirect-move
18623 @opindex mno-direct-move
18624 Generate code that uses (does not use) the instructions to move data
18625 between the general purpose registers and the vector/scalar (VSX)
18626 registers that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA.
18627
18628 @item -mpower8-fusion
18629 @itemx -mno-power8-fusion
18630 @opindex mpower8-fusion
18631 @opindex mno-power8-fusion
18632 Generate code that keeps (does not keeps) some integer operations
18633 adjacent so that the instructions can be fused together on power8 and
18634 later processors.
18635
18636 @item -mpower8-vector
18637 @itemx -mno-power8-vector
18638 @opindex mpower8-vector
18639 @opindex mno-power8-vector
18640 Generate code that uses (does not use) the vector and scalar
18641 instructions that were added in version 2.07 of the PowerPC ISA. Also
18642 enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
18643 the vector instructions.
18644
18645 @item -mquad-memory
18646 @itemx -mno-quad-memory
18647 @opindex mquad-memory
18648 @opindex mno-quad-memory
18649 Generate code that uses (does not use) the quad word memory
18650 instructions. The @option{-mquad-memory} option requires use of
18651 64-bit mode.
18652
18653 @item -mfloat-gprs=@var{yes/single/double/no}
18654 @itemx -mfloat-gprs
18655 @opindex mfloat-gprs
18656 This switch enables or disables the generation of floating-point
18657 operations on the general-purpose registers for architectures that
18658 support it.
18659
18660 The argument @var{yes} or @var{single} enables the use of
18661 single-precision floating-point operations.
18662
18663 The argument @var{double} enables the use of single and
18664 double-precision floating-point operations.
18665
18666 The argument @var{no} disables floating-point operations on the
18667 general-purpose registers.
18668
18669 This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.
18670
18671 @item -m32
18672 @itemx -m64
18673 @opindex m32
18674 @opindex m64
18675 Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
18676 targets (including GNU/Linux). The 32-bit environment sets int, long
18677 and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any PowerPC
18678 variant. The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and
18679 pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as for
18680 @option{-mpowerpc64}.
18681
18682 @item -mfull-toc
18683 @itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
18684 @itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
18685 @itemx -mminimal-toc
18686 @opindex mfull-toc
18687 @opindex mno-fp-in-toc
18688 @opindex mno-sum-in-toc
18689 @opindex mminimal-toc
18690 Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
18691 every executable file. The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
18692 default. In that case, GCC allocates at least one TOC entry for
18693 each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program. GCC
18694 also places floating-point constants in the TOC@. However, only
18695 16,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
18696
18697 If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
18698 the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
18699 with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
18700 @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
18701 constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
18702 generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
18703 run time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@. You may specify one
18704 or both of these options. Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
18705 slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
18706
18707 If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
18708 these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead. This option causes
18709 GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file. When you specify this
18710 option, GCC produces code that is slower and larger but which
18711 uses extremely little TOC space. You may wish to use this option
18712 only on files that contain less frequently-executed code.
18713
18714 @item -maix64
18715 @itemx -maix32
18716 @opindex maix64
18717 @opindex maix32
18718 Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
18719 @code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
18720 Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64},
18721 while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
18722 implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}. GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
18723
18724 @item -mxl-compat
18725 @itemx -mno-xl-compat
18726 @opindex mxl-compat
18727 @opindex mno-xl-compat
18728 Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics
18729 when using AIX-compatible ABI@. Pass floating-point arguments to
18730 prototyped functions beyond the register save area (RSA) on the stack
18731 in addition to argument FPRs. Do not assume that most significant
18732 double in 128-bit long double value is properly rounded when comparing
18733 values and converting to double. Use XL symbol names for long double
18734 support routines.
18735
18736 The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
18737 handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
18738 address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared. IBM XL
18739 compilers access floating-point arguments that do not fit in the
18740 RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
18741 optimization. Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
18742 stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
18743 default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by IBM
18744 XL compilers without optimization.
18745
18746 @item -mpe
18747 @opindex mpe
18748 Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@. Link an
18749 application written to use message passing with special startup code to
18750 enable the application to run. The system must have PE installed in the
18751 standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
18752 must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
18753 appropriate directory location. The Parallel Environment does not
18754 support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
18755 option are incompatible.
18756
18757 @item -malign-natural
18758 @itemx -malign-power
18759 @opindex malign-natural
18760 @opindex malign-power
18761 On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
18762 @option{-malign-natural} overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
18763 types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based boundary.
18764 The option @option{-malign-power} instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified
18765 alignment rules. GCC defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI@.
18766
18767 On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and @option{-malign-power}
18768 is not supported.
18769
18770 @item -msoft-float
18771 @itemx -mhard-float
18772 @opindex msoft-float
18773 @opindex mhard-float
18774 Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
18775 Software floating-point emulation is provided if you use the
18776 @option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
18777
18778 @item -msingle-float
18779 @itemx -mdouble-float
18780 @opindex msingle-float
18781 @opindex mdouble-float
18782 Generate code for single- or double-precision floating-point operations.
18783 @option{-mdouble-float} implies @option{-msingle-float}.
18784
18785 @item -msimple-fpu
18786 @opindex msimple-fpu
18787 Do not generate @code{sqrt} and @code{div} instructions for hardware
18788 floating-point unit.
18789
18790 @item -mfpu=@var{name}
18791 @opindex mfpu
18792 Specify type of floating-point unit. Valid values for @var{name} are
18793 @samp{sp_lite} (equivalent to @option{-msingle-float -msimple-fpu}),
18794 @samp{dp_lite} (equivalent to @option{-mdouble-float -msimple-fpu}),
18795 @samp{sp_full} (equivalent to @option{-msingle-float}),
18796 and @samp{dp_full} (equivalent to @option{-mdouble-float}).
18797
18798 @item -mxilinx-fpu
18799 @opindex mxilinx-fpu
18800 Perform optimizations for the floating-point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.
18801
18802 @item -mmultiple
18803 @itemx -mno-multiple
18804 @opindex mmultiple
18805 @opindex mno-multiple
18806 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
18807 instructions and the store multiple word instructions. These
18808 instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
18809 generated on PowerPC systems. Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little-endian
18810 PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
18811 processor is in little-endian mode. The exceptions are PPC740 and
18812 PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.
18813
18814 @item -mstring
18815 @itemx -mno-string
18816 @opindex mstring
18817 @opindex mno-string
18818 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
18819 and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
18820 do small block moves. These instructions are generated by default on
18821 POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems. Do not use
18822 @option{-mstring} on little-endian PowerPC systems, since those
18823 instructions do not work when the processor is in little-endian mode.
18824 The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit these instructions
18825 in little-endian mode.
18826
18827 @item -mupdate
18828 @itemx -mno-update
18829 @opindex mupdate
18830 @opindex mno-update
18831 Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
18832 that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
18833 location. These instructions are generated by default. If you use
18834 @option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
18835 stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
18836 stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
18837 signals may get corrupted data.
18838
18839 @item -mavoid-indexed-addresses
18840 @itemx -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
18841 @opindex mavoid-indexed-addresses
18842 @opindex mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
18843 Generate code that tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load
18844 or store instructions. These instructions can incur a performance
18845 penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
18846 stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary. This option
18847 is enabled by default when targeting Power6 and disabled otherwise.
18848
18849 @item -mfused-madd
18850 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
18851 @opindex mfused-madd
18852 @opindex mno-fused-madd
18853 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
18854 accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by default
18855 if hardware floating point is used. The machine-dependent
18856 @option{-mfused-madd} option is now mapped to the machine-independent
18857 @option{-ffp-contract=fast} option, and @option{-mno-fused-madd} is
18858 mapped to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
18859
18860 @item -mmulhw
18861 @itemx -mno-mulhw
18862 @opindex mmulhw
18863 @opindex mno-mulhw
18864 Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
18865 multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.
18866 These instructions are generated by default when targeting those
18867 processors.
18868
18869 @item -mdlmzb
18870 @itemx -mno-dlmzb
18871 @opindex mdlmzb
18872 @opindex mno-dlmzb
18873 Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search @samp{dlmzb}
18874 instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors. This instruction is
18875 generated by default when targeting those processors.
18876
18877 @item -mno-bit-align
18878 @itemx -mbit-align
18879 @opindex mno-bit-align
18880 @opindex mbit-align
18881 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
18882 and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
18883 bit-field.
18884
18885 For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
18886 @code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 is aligned to a 4-byte
18887 boundary and has a size of 4 bytes. By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
18888 the structure is aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in
18889 size.
18890
18891 @item -mno-strict-align
18892 @itemx -mstrict-align
18893 @opindex mno-strict-align
18894 @opindex mstrict-align
18895 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
18896 unaligned memory references are handled by the system.
18897
18898 @item -mrelocatable
18899 @itemx -mno-relocatable
18900 @opindex mrelocatable
18901 @opindex mno-relocatable
18902 Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be
18903 relocated to a different address at run time. A simple embedded
18904 PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of
18905 @code{.got2} and 4-byte locations listed in the @code{.fixup} section,
18906 a table of 32-bit addresses generated by this option. For this to
18907 work, all objects linked together must be compiled with
18908 @option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
18909 @option{-mrelocatable} code aligns the stack to an 8-byte boundary.
18910
18911 @item -mrelocatable-lib
18912 @itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
18913 @opindex mrelocatable-lib
18914 @opindex mno-relocatable-lib
18915 Like @option{-mrelocatable}, @option{-mrelocatable-lib} generates a
18916 @code{.fixup} section to allow static executables to be relocated at
18917 run time, but @option{-mrelocatable-lib} does not use the smaller stack
18918 alignment of @option{-mrelocatable}. Objects compiled with
18919 @option{-mrelocatable-lib} may be linked with objects compiled with
18920 any combination of the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
18921
18922 @item -mno-toc
18923 @itemx -mtoc
18924 @opindex mno-toc
18925 @opindex mtoc
18926 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
18927 register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
18928 used in the program.
18929
18930 @item -mlittle
18931 @itemx -mlittle-endian
18932 @opindex mlittle
18933 @opindex mlittle-endian
18934 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
18935 processor in little-endian mode. The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
18936 the same as @option{-mlittle}.
18937
18938 @item -mbig
18939 @itemx -mbig-endian
18940 @opindex mbig
18941 @opindex mbig-endian
18942 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
18943 processor in big-endian mode. The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
18944 the same as @option{-mbig}.
18945
18946 @item -mdynamic-no-pic
18947 @opindex mdynamic-no-pic
18948 On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
18949 relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable. The
18950 resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
18951 libraries.
18952
18953 @item -msingle-pic-base
18954 @opindex msingle-pic-base
18955 Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
18956 loading it in the prologue for each function. The runtime system is
18957 responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
18958 before execution begins.
18959
18960 @item -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority}
18961 @opindex mprioritize-restricted-insns
18962 This option controls the priority that is assigned to
18963 dispatch-slot restricted instructions during the second scheduling
18964 pass. The argument @var{priority} takes the value @samp{0}, @samp{1},
18965 or @samp{2} to assign no, highest, or second-highest (respectively)
18966 priority to dispatch-slot restricted
18967 instructions.
18968
18969 @item -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type}
18970 @opindex msched-costly-dep
18971 This option controls which dependences are considered costly
18972 by the target during instruction scheduling. The argument
18973 @var{dependence_type} takes one of the following values:
18974
18975 @table @asis
18976 @item @samp{no}
18977 No dependence is costly.
18978
18979 @item @samp{all}
18980 All dependences are costly.
18981
18982 @item @samp{true_store_to_load}
18983 A true dependence from store to load is costly.
18984
18985 @item @samp{store_to_load}
18986 Any dependence from store to load is costly.
18987
18988 @item @var{number}
18989 Any dependence for which the latency is greater than or equal to
18990 @var{number} is costly.
18991 @end table
18992
18993 @item -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme}
18994 @opindex minsert-sched-nops
18995 This option controls which NOP insertion scheme is used during
18996 the second scheduling pass. The argument @var{scheme} takes one of the
18997 following values:
18998
18999 @table @asis
19000 @item @samp{no}
19001 Don't insert NOPs.
19002
19003 @item @samp{pad}
19004 Pad with NOPs any dispatch group that has vacant issue slots,
19005 according to the scheduler's grouping.
19006
19007 @item @samp{regroup_exact}
19008 Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into
19009 separate groups. Insert exactly as many NOPs as needed to force an insn
19010 to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
19011
19012 @item @var{number}
19013 Insert NOPs to force costly dependent insns into
19014 separate groups. Insert @var{number} NOPs to force an insn to a new group.
19015 @end table
19016
19017 @item -mcall-sysv
19018 @opindex mcall-sysv
19019 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
19020 conventions that adhere to the March 1995 draft of the System V
19021 Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement. This is the
19022 default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
19023
19024 @item -mcall-sysv-eabi
19025 @itemx -mcall-eabi
19026 @opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
19027 @opindex mcall-eabi
19028 Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
19029
19030 @item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
19031 @opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
19032 Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
19033
19034 @item -mcall-aixdesc
19035 @opindex m
19036 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX
19037 operating system.
19038
19039 @item -mcall-linux
19040 @opindex mcall-linux
19041 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
19042 Linux-based GNU system.
19043
19044 @item -mcall-freebsd
19045 @opindex mcall-freebsd
19046 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
19047 FreeBSD operating system.
19048
19049 @item -mcall-netbsd
19050 @opindex mcall-netbsd
19051 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
19052 NetBSD operating system.
19053
19054 @item -mcall-openbsd
19055 @opindex mcall-netbsd
19056 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
19057 OpenBSD operating system.
19058
19059 @item -maix-struct-return
19060 @opindex maix-struct-return
19061 Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
19062
19063 @item -msvr4-struct-return
19064 @opindex msvr4-struct-return
19065 Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
19066 SVR4 ABI)@.
19067
19068 @item -mabi=@var{abi-type}
19069 @opindex mabi
19070 Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such extension.
19071 Valid values are @var{altivec}, @var{no-altivec}, @var{spe},
19072 @var{no-spe}, @var{ibmlongdouble}, @var{ieeelongdouble},
19073 @var{elfv1}, @var{elfv2}@.
19074
19075 @item -mabi=spe
19076 @opindex mabi=spe
19077 Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions. This does not change
19078 the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
19079 ABI@.
19080
19081 @item -mabi=no-spe
19082 @opindex mabi=no-spe
19083 Disable Book-E SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI@.
19084
19085 @item -mabi=ibmlongdouble
19086 @opindex mabi=ibmlongdouble
19087 Change the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.
19088 This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
19089
19090 @item -mabi=ieeelongdouble
19091 @opindex mabi=ieeelongdouble
19092 Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.
19093 This is a PowerPC 32-bit Linux ABI option.
19094
19095 @item -mabi=elfv1
19096 @opindex mabi=elfv1
19097 Change the current ABI to use the ELFv1 ABI.
19098 This is the default ABI for big-endian PowerPC 64-bit Linux.
19099 Overriding the default ABI requires special system support and is
19100 likely to fail in spectacular ways.
19101
19102 @item -mabi=elfv2
19103 @opindex mabi=elfv2
19104 Change the current ABI to use the ELFv2 ABI.
19105 This is the default ABI for little-endian PowerPC 64-bit Linux.
19106 Overriding the default ABI requires special system support and is
19107 likely to fail in spectacular ways.
19108
19109 @item -mprototype
19110 @itemx -mno-prototype
19111 @opindex mprototype
19112 @opindex mno-prototype
19113 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
19114 variable argument functions are properly prototyped. Otherwise, the
19115 compiler must insert an instruction before every non-prototyped call to
19116 set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
19117 indicate whether floating-point values are passed in the floating-point
19118 registers in case the function takes variable arguments. With
19119 @option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
19120 set or clear the bit.
19121
19122 @item -msim
19123 @opindex msim
19124 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
19125 @file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
19126 @file{libc.a}. This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}
19127 configurations.
19128
19129 @item -mmvme
19130 @opindex mmvme
19131 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
19132 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
19133 @file{libc.a}.
19134
19135 @item -mads
19136 @opindex mads
19137 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
19138 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
19139 @file{libc.a}.
19140
19141 @item -myellowknife
19142 @opindex myellowknife
19143 On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
19144 @file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
19145 @file{libc.a}.
19146
19147 @item -mvxworks
19148 @opindex mvxworks
19149 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
19150 compiling for a VxWorks system.
19151
19152 @item -memb
19153 @opindex memb
19154 On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
19155 header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
19156
19157 @item -meabi
19158 @itemx -mno-eabi
19159 @opindex meabi
19160 @opindex mno-eabi
19161 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
19162 Embedded Applications Binary Interface (EABI), which is a set of
19163 modifications to the System V.4 specifications. Selecting @option{-meabi}
19164 means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a function
19165 @code{__eabi} is called from @code{main} to set up the EABI
19166 environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
19167 @code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas. Selecting
19168 @option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16-byte boundary,
19169 no EABI initialization function is called from @code{main}, and the
19170 @option{-msdata} option only uses @code{r13} to point to a single
19171 small data area. The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
19172 configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
19173
19174 @item -msdata=eabi
19175 @opindex msdata=eabi
19176 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
19177 @code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
19178 is pointed to by register @code{r2}. Put small initialized
19179 non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
19180 which is pointed to by register @code{r13}. Put small uninitialized
19181 global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
19182 the @samp{.sdata} section. The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
19183 incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option. The
19184 @option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
19185
19186 @item -msdata=sysv
19187 @opindex msdata=sysv
19188 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
19189 data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
19190 @code{r13}. Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
19191 @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
19192 The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
19193 @option{-mrelocatable} option.
19194
19195 @item -msdata=default
19196 @itemx -msdata
19197 @opindex msdata=default
19198 @opindex msdata
19199 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
19200 compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
19201 same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
19202
19203 @item -msdata=data
19204 @opindex msdata=data
19205 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global
19206 data in the @samp{.sdata} section. Put small uninitialized global
19207 data in the @samp{.sbss} section. Do not use register @code{r13}
19208 to address small data however. This is the default behavior unless
19209 other @option{-msdata} options are used.
19210
19211 @item -msdata=none
19212 @itemx -mno-sdata
19213 @opindex msdata=none
19214 @opindex mno-sdata
19215 On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
19216 in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
19217 @samp{.bss} section.
19218
19219 @item -mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num}
19220 @opindex mblock-move-inline-limit
19221 Inline all block moves (such as calls to @code{memcpy} or structure
19222 copies) less than or equal to @var{num} bytes. The minimum value for
19223 @var{num} is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit
19224 targets. The default value is target-specific.
19225
19226 @item -G @var{num}
19227 @opindex G
19228 @cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
19229 @cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
19230 On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
19231 equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or BSS sections instead of
19232 the normal data or BSS section. By default, @var{num} is 8. The
19233 @option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
19234 All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
19235
19236 @item -mregnames
19237 @itemx -mno-regnames
19238 @opindex mregnames
19239 @opindex mno-regnames
19240 On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
19241 names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
19242
19243 @item -mlongcall
19244 @itemx -mno-longcall
19245 @opindex mlongcall
19246 @opindex mno-longcall
19247 By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer and more
19248 expensive calling sequence is required. This is required for calls
19249 farther than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current location.
19250 A short call is generated if the compiler knows
19251 the call cannot be that far away. This setting can be overridden by
19252 the @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma
19253 longcall(0)}.
19254
19255 Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
19256 glue code on the fly. On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
19257 generate slower code. As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
19258 as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64. It is planned to add this feature
19259 to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
19260
19261 On Darwin/PPC systems, @code{#pragma longcall} generates @code{jbsr
19262 callee, L42}, plus a @dfn{branch island} (glue code). The two target
19263 addresses represent the callee and the branch island. The
19264 Darwin/PPC linker prefers the first address and generates a @code{bl
19265 callee} if the PPC @code{bl} instruction reaches the callee directly;
19266 otherwise, the linker generates @code{bl L42} to call the branch
19267 island. The branch island is appended to the body of the
19268 calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the callee
19269 and jumps to it.
19270
19271 On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to
19272 the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides whether
19273 to use or discard it.
19274
19275 In the future, GCC may ignore all longcall specifications
19276 when the linker is known to generate glue.
19277
19278 @item -mtls-markers
19279 @itemx -mno-tls-markers
19280 @opindex mtls-markers
19281 @opindex mno-tls-markers
19282 Mark (do not mark) calls to @code{__tls_get_addr} with a relocation
19283 specifying the function argument. The relocation allows the linker to
19284 reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for
19285 TLS optimization, which in turn allows GCC to better schedule the
19286 sequence.
19287
19288 @item -pthread
19289 @opindex pthread
19290 Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
19291 This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
19292
19293 @item -mrecip
19294 @itemx -mno-recip
19295 @opindex mrecip
19296 This option enables use of the reciprocal estimate and
19297 reciprocal square root estimate instructions with additional
19298 Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or
19299 square root and divide for floating-point arguments. You should use
19300 the @option{-ffast-math} option when using @option{-mrecip} (or at
19301 least @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
19302 @option{-finite-math-only}, @option{-freciprocal-math} and
19303 @option{-fno-trapping-math}). Note that while the throughput of the
19304 sequence is generally higher than the throughput of the non-reciprocal
19305 instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to 2
19306 ulp (i.e.@: the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square
19307 roots.
19308
19309 @item -mrecip=@var{opt}
19310 @opindex mrecip=opt
19311 This option controls which reciprocal estimate instructions
19312 may be used. @var{opt} is a comma-separated list of options, which may
19313 be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
19314 @code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
19315 @code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
19316 @code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip};
19317 @code{div}: enable the reciprocal approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
19318 @code{divf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
19319 @code{divd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
19320 @code{rsqrt}: enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
19321 @code{rsqrtf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
19322 @code{rsqrtd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
19323
19324 So, for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!rsqrtd} enables
19325 all of the reciprocal estimate instructions, except for the
19326 @code{FRSQRTE}, @code{XSRSQRTEDP}, and @code{XVRSQRTEDP} instructions
19327 which handle the double-precision reciprocal square root calculations.
19328
19329 @item -mrecip-precision
19330 @itemx -mno-recip-precision
19331 @opindex mrecip-precision
19332 Assume (do not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions
19333 provide higher-precision estimates than is mandated by the PowerPC
19334 ABI. Selecting @option{-mcpu=power6}, @option{-mcpu=power7} or
19335 @option{-mcpu=power8} automatically selects @option{-mrecip-precision}.
19336 The double-precision square root estimate instructions are not generated by
19337 default on low-precision machines, since they do not provide an
19338 estimate that converges after three steps.
19339
19340 @item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
19341 @opindex mveclibabi
19342 Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
19343 external library. The only type supported at present is @code{mass},
19344 which specifies to use IBM's Mathematical Acceleration Subsystem
19345 (MASS) libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.
19346 GCC currently emits calls to @code{acosd2}, @code{acosf4},
19347 @code{acoshd2}, @code{acoshf4}, @code{asind2}, @code{asinf4},
19348 @code{asinhd2}, @code{asinhf4}, @code{atan2d2}, @code{atan2f4},
19349 @code{atand2}, @code{atanf4}, @code{atanhd2}, @code{atanhf4},
19350 @code{cbrtd2}, @code{cbrtf4}, @code{cosd2}, @code{cosf4},
19351 @code{coshd2}, @code{coshf4}, @code{erfcd2}, @code{erfcf4},
19352 @code{erfd2}, @code{erff4}, @code{exp2d2}, @code{exp2f4},
19353 @code{expd2}, @code{expf4}, @code{expm1d2}, @code{expm1f4},
19354 @code{hypotd2}, @code{hypotf4}, @code{lgammad2}, @code{lgammaf4},
19355 @code{log10d2}, @code{log10f4}, @code{log1pd2}, @code{log1pf4},
19356 @code{log2d2}, @code{log2f4}, @code{logd2}, @code{logf4},
19357 @code{powd2}, @code{powf4}, @code{sind2}, @code{sinf4}, @code{sinhd2},
19358 @code{sinhf4}, @code{sqrtd2}, @code{sqrtf4}, @code{tand2},
19359 @code{tanf4}, @code{tanhd2}, and @code{tanhf4} when generating code
19360 for power7. Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
19361 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} must also be enabled. The MASS
19362 libraries must be specified at link time.
19363
19364 @item -mfriz
19365 @itemx -mno-friz
19366 @opindex mfriz
19367 Generate (do not generate) the @code{friz} instruction when the
19368 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} option is used to optimize
19369 rounding of floating-point values to 64-bit integer and back to floating
19370 point. The @code{friz} instruction does not return the same value if
19371 the floating-point number is too large to fit in an integer.
19372
19373 @item -mpointers-to-nested-functions
19374 @itemx -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
19375 @opindex mpointers-to-nested-functions
19376 Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain register
19377 (@var{r11}) when calling through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux
19378 systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word descriptor giving
19379 the function address, TOC value to be loaded in register @var{r2}, and
19380 static chain value to be loaded in register @var{r11}. The
19381 @option{-mpointers-to-nested-functions} is on by default. You cannot
19382 call through pointers to nested functions or pointers
19383 to functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
19384 you use the @option{-mno-pointers-to-nested-functions}.
19385
19386 @item -msave-toc-indirect
19387 @itemx -mno-save-toc-indirect
19388 @opindex msave-toc-indirect
19389 Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the reserved
19390 stack location in the function prologue if the function calls through
19391 a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems. If the TOC value is not
19392 saved in the prologue, it is saved just before the call through the
19393 pointer. The @option{-mno-save-toc-indirect} option is the default.
19394
19395 @item -mcompat-align-parm
19396 @itemx -mno-compat-align-parm
19397 @opindex mcompat-align-parm
19398 Generate (do not generate) code to pass structure parameters with a
19399 maximum alignment of 64 bits, for compatibility with older versions
19400 of GCC.
19401
19402 Older versions of GCC (prior to 4.9.0) incorrectly did not align a
19403 structure parameter on a 128-bit boundary when that structure contained
19404 a member requiring 128-bit alignment. This is corrected in more
19405 recent versions of GCC. This option may be used to generate code
19406 that is compatible with functions compiled with older versions of
19407 GCC.
19408
19409 The @option{-mno-compat-align-parm} option is the default.
19410 @end table
19411
19412 @node RX Options
19413 @subsection RX Options
19414 @cindex RX Options
19415
19416 These command-line options are defined for RX targets:
19417
19418 @table @gcctabopt
19419 @item -m64bit-doubles
19420 @itemx -m32bit-doubles
19421 @opindex m64bit-doubles
19422 @opindex m32bit-doubles
19423 Make the @code{double} data type be 64 bits (@option{-m64bit-doubles})
19424 or 32 bits (@option{-m32bit-doubles}) in size. The default is
19425 @option{-m32bit-doubles}. @emph{Note} RX floating-point hardware only
19426 works on 32-bit values, which is why the default is
19427 @option{-m32bit-doubles}.
19428
19429 @item -fpu
19430 @itemx -nofpu
19431 @opindex fpu
19432 @opindex nofpu
19433 Enables (@option{-fpu}) or disables (@option{-nofpu}) the use of RX
19434 floating-point hardware. The default is enabled for the @var{RX600}
19435 series and disabled for the @var{RX200} series.
19436
19437 Floating-point instructions are only generated for 32-bit floating-point
19438 values, however, so the FPU hardware is not used for doubles if the
19439 @option{-m64bit-doubles} option is used.
19440
19441 @emph{Note} If the @option{-fpu} option is enabled then
19442 @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also enabled automatically.
19443 This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.
19444
19445 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
19446 @opindex -mcpu
19447 Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted. Currently three types are
19448 supported, the generic @var{RX600} and @var{RX200} series hardware and
19449 the specific @var{RX610} CPU. The default is @var{RX600}.
19450
19451 The only difference between @var{RX600} and @var{RX610} is that the
19452 @var{RX610} does not support the @code{MVTIPL} instruction.
19453
19454 The @var{RX200} series does not have a hardware floating-point unit
19455 and so @option{-nofpu} is enabled by default when this type is
19456 selected.
19457
19458 @item -mbig-endian-data
19459 @itemx -mlittle-endian-data
19460 @opindex mbig-endian-data
19461 @opindex mlittle-endian-data
19462 Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format. The default is
19463 @option{-mlittle-endian-data}, i.e.@: to store data in the little-endian
19464 format.
19465
19466 @item -msmall-data-limit=@var{N}
19467 @opindex msmall-data-limit
19468 Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables
19469 which can be placed into the small data area. Using the small data
19470 area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
19471 limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does
19472 not overflow. Also when the small data area is used one of the RX's
19473 registers (usually @code{r13}) is reserved for use pointing to this
19474 area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler. This
19475 could result in slower and/or larger code if variables are pushed onto
19476 the stack instead of being held in this register.
19477
19478 Note, common variables (variables that have not been initialized) and
19479 constants are not placed into the small data area as they are assigned
19480 to other sections in the output executable.
19481
19482 The default value is zero, which disables this feature. Note, this
19483 feature is not enabled by default with higher optimization levels
19484 (@option{-O2} etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of
19485 reserving a register. It is up to the programmer to experiment and
19486 discover whether this feature is of benefit to their program. See the
19487 description of the @option{-mpid} option for a description of how the
19488 actual register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.
19489
19490 @item -msim
19491 @itemx -mno-sim
19492 @opindex msim
19493 @opindex mno-sim
19494 Use the simulator runtime. The default is to use the libgloss
19495 board-specific runtime.
19496
19497 @item -mas100-syntax
19498 @itemx -mno-as100-syntax
19499 @opindex mas100-syntax
19500 @opindex mno-as100-syntax
19501 When generating assembler output use a syntax that is compatible with
19502 Renesas's AS100 assembler. This syntax can also be handled by the GAS
19503 assembler, but it has some restrictions so it is not generated by default.
19504
19505 @item -mmax-constant-size=@var{N}
19506 @opindex mmax-constant-size
19507 Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a constant that can be used as
19508 an operand in a RX instruction. Although the RX instruction set does
19509 allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to be used in instructions,
19510 a longer value equates to a longer instruction. Thus in some
19511 circumstances it can be beneficial to restrict the size of constants
19512 that are used in instructions. Constants that are too big are instead
19513 placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.
19514
19515 The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4. A value of 0 (the default)
19516 or 4 means that constants of any size are allowed.
19517
19518 @item -mrelax
19519 @opindex mrelax
19520 Enable linker relaxation. Linker relaxation is a process whereby the
19521 linker attempts to reduce the size of a program by finding shorter
19522 versions of various instructions. Disabled by default.
19523
19524 @item -mint-register=@var{N}
19525 @opindex mint-register
19526 Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler
19527 functions. The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4. A value of 1
19528 means that register @code{r13} is reserved for the exclusive use
19529 of fast interrupt handlers. A value of 2 reserves @code{r13} and
19530 @code{r12}. A value of 3 reserves @code{r13}, @code{r12} and
19531 @code{r11}, and a value of 4 reserves @code{r13} through @code{r10}.
19532 A value of 0, the default, does not reserve any registers.
19533
19534 @item -msave-acc-in-interrupts
19535 @opindex msave-acc-in-interrupts
19536 Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the
19537 accumulator register. This is only necessary if normal code might use
19538 the accumulator register, for example because it performs 64-bit
19539 multiplications. The default is to ignore the accumulator as this
19540 makes the interrupt handlers faster.
19541
19542 @item -mpid
19543 @itemx -mno-pid
19544 @opindex mpid
19545 @opindex mno-pid
19546 Enables the generation of position independent data. When enabled any
19547 access to constant data is done via an offset from a base address
19548 held in a register. This allows the location of constant data to be
19549 determined at run time without requiring the executable to be
19550 relocated, which is a benefit to embedded applications with tight
19551 memory constraints. Data that can be modified is not affected by this
19552 option.
19553
19554 Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually @code{r13}, for
19555 the constant data base address. This can result in slower and/or
19556 larger code, especially in complicated functions.
19557
19558 The actual register chosen to hold the constant data base address
19559 depends upon whether the @option{-msmall-data-limit} and/or the
19560 @option{-mint-register} command-line options are enabled. Starting
19561 with register @code{r13} and proceeding downwards, registers are
19562 allocated first to satisfy the requirements of @option{-mint-register},
19563 then @option{-mpid} and finally @option{-msmall-data-limit}. Thus it
19564 is possible for the small data area register to be @code{r8} if both
19565 @option{-mint-register=4} and @option{-mpid} are specified on the
19566 command line.
19567
19568 By default this feature is not enabled. The default can be restored
19569 via the @option{-mno-pid} command-line option.
19570
19571 @item -mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
19572 @itemx -mwarn-multiple-fast-interrupts
19573 @opindex mno-warn-multiple-fast-interrupts
19574 @opindex mwarn-multiple-fast-interrupts
19575 Prevents GCC from issuing a warning message if it finds more than one
19576 fast interrupt handler when it is compiling a file. The default is to
19577 issue a warning for each extra fast interrupt handler found, as the RX
19578 only supports one such interrupt.
19579
19580 @end table
19581
19582 @emph{Note:} The generic GCC command-line option @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}
19583 has special significance to the RX port when used with the
19584 @code{interrupt} function attribute. This attribute indicates a
19585 function intended to process fast interrupts. GCC ensures
19586 that it only uses the registers @code{r10}, @code{r11}, @code{r12}
19587 and/or @code{r13} and only provided that the normal use of the
19588 corresponding registers have been restricted via the
19589 @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}} or @option{-mint-register} command-line
19590 options.
19591
19592 @node S/390 and zSeries Options
19593 @subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
19594 @cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
19595
19596 These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
19597
19598 @table @gcctabopt
19599 @item -mhard-float
19600 @itemx -msoft-float
19601 @opindex mhard-float
19602 @opindex msoft-float
19603 Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
19604 for floating-point operations. When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
19605 functions in @file{libgcc.a} are used to perform floating-point
19606 operations. When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
19607 generates IEEE floating-point instructions. This is the default.
19608
19609 @item -mhard-dfp
19610 @itemx -mno-hard-dfp
19611 @opindex mhard-dfp
19612 @opindex mno-hard-dfp
19613 Use (do not use) the hardware decimal-floating-point instructions for
19614 decimal-floating-point operations. When @option{-mno-hard-dfp} is
19615 specified, functions in @file{libgcc.a} are used to perform
19616 decimal-floating-point operations. When @option{-mhard-dfp} is
19617 specified, the compiler generates decimal-floating-point hardware
19618 instructions. This is the default for @option{-march=z9-ec} or higher.
19619
19620 @item -mlong-double-64
19621 @itemx -mlong-double-128
19622 @opindex mlong-double-64
19623 @opindex mlong-double-128
19624 These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
19625 of 64 bits makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
19626 type. This is the default.
19627
19628 @item -mbackchain
19629 @itemx -mno-backchain
19630 @opindex mbackchain
19631 @opindex mno-backchain
19632 Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer
19633 into the callee's stack frame.
19634 A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand
19635 DWARF 2 call frame information.
19636 When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is in effect, the backchain pointer is stored
19637 at the bottom of the stack frame; when @option{-mpacked-stack} is in effect,
19638 the backchain is placed into the topmost word of the 96/160 byte register
19639 save area.
19640
19641 In general, code compiled with @option{-mbackchain} is call-compatible with
19642 code compiled with @option{-mmo-backchain}; however, use of the backchain
19643 for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is built with
19644 @option{-mbackchain}. Note that the combination of @option{-mbackchain},
19645 @option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported. In order
19646 to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
19647
19648 The default is to not maintain the backchain.
19649
19650 @item -mpacked-stack
19651 @itemx -mno-packed-stack
19652 @opindex mpacked-stack
19653 @opindex mno-packed-stack
19654 Use (do not use) the packed stack layout. When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is
19655 specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte register save
19656 area only for their default purpose; unused fields still take up stack space.
19657 When @option{-mpacked-stack} is specified, register save slots are densely
19658 packed at the top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other
19659 purposes, allowing for more efficient use of the available stack space.
19660 However, when @option{-mbackchain} is also in effect, the topmost word of
19661 the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address
19662 register is always saved two words below the backchain.
19663
19664 As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated with
19665 @option{-mpacked-stack} is call-compatible with code generated with
19666 @option{-mno-packed-stack}. Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
19667 S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run
19668 time, not just for debugging purposes. Such code is not call-compatible
19669 with code compiled with @option{-mpacked-stack}. Also, note that the
19670 combination of @option{-mbackchain},
19671 @option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported. In order
19672 to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
19673
19674 The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
19675
19676 @item -msmall-exec
19677 @itemx -mno-small-exec
19678 @opindex msmall-exec
19679 @opindex mno-small-exec
19680 Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
19681 to do subroutine calls.
19682 This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
19683 exceed 64k. The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
19684 which does not have this limitation.
19685
19686 @item -m64
19687 @itemx -m31
19688 @opindex m64
19689 @opindex m31
19690 When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
19691 GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI@. When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
19692 code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI@. This allows GCC in
19693 particular to generate 64-bit instructions. For the @samp{s390}
19694 targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
19695 targets default to @option{-m64}.
19696
19697 @item -mzarch
19698 @itemx -mesa
19699 @opindex mzarch
19700 @opindex mesa
19701 When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
19702 instructions available on z/Architecture.
19703 When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
19704 instructions available on ESA/390. Note that @option{-mesa} is
19705 not possible with @option{-m64}.
19706 When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,
19707 the default is @option{-mesa}. When generating code compliant
19708 to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is @option{-mzarch}.
19709
19710 @item -mmvcle
19711 @itemx -mno-mvcle
19712 @opindex mmvcle
19713 @opindex mno-mvcle
19714 Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
19715 to perform block moves. When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
19716 use a @code{mvc} loop instead. This is the default unless optimizing for
19717 size.
19718
19719 @item -mdebug
19720 @itemx -mno-debug
19721 @opindex mdebug
19722 @opindex mno-debug
19723 Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
19724 The default is to not print debug information.
19725
19726 @item -march=@var{cpu-type}
19727 @opindex march
19728 Generate code that runs on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
19729 representing a certain processor type. Possible values for
19730 @var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6}, @samp{z900}, @samp{z990},
19731 @samp{z9-109}, @samp{z9-ec} and @samp{z10}.
19732 When generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture,
19733 the default is @option{-march=z900}. Otherwise, the default is
19734 @option{-march=g5}.
19735
19736 @item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
19737 @opindex mtune
19738 Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
19739 except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
19740 The list of @var{cpu-type} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
19741 The default is the value used for @option{-march}.
19742
19743 @item -mtpf-trace
19744 @itemx -mno-tpf-trace
19745 @opindex mtpf-trace
19746 @opindex mno-tpf-trace
19747 Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace
19748 routines in the operating system. This option is off by default, even
19749 when compiling for the TPF OS@.
19750
19751 @item -mfused-madd
19752 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
19753 @opindex mfused-madd
19754 @opindex mno-fused-madd
19755 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
19756 accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by default if
19757 hardware floating point is used.
19758
19759 @item -mwarn-framesize=@var{framesize}
19760 @opindex mwarn-framesize
19761 Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size. Because
19762 this is a compile-time check it doesn't need to be a real problem when the program
19763 runs. It is intended to identify functions that most probably cause
19764 a stack overflow. It is useful to be used in an environment with limited stack
19765 size e.g.@: the linux kernel.
19766
19767 @item -mwarn-dynamicstack
19768 @opindex mwarn-dynamicstack
19769 Emit a warning if the function calls @code{alloca} or uses dynamically-sized
19770 arrays. This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack size.
19771
19772 @item -mstack-guard=@var{stack-guard}
19773 @itemx -mstack-size=@var{stack-size}
19774 @opindex mstack-guard
19775 @opindex mstack-size
19776 If these options are provided the S/390 back end emits additional instructions in
19777 the function prologue that trigger a trap if the stack size is @var{stack-guard}
19778 bytes above the @var{stack-size} (remember that the stack on S/390 grows downward).
19779 If the @var{stack-guard} option is omitted the smallest power of 2 larger than
19780 the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.
19781 These options are intended to be used to help debugging stack overflow problems.
19782 The additionally emitted code causes only little overhead and hence can also be
19783 used in production-like systems without greater performance degradation. The given
19784 values have to be exact powers of 2 and @var{stack-size} has to be greater than
19785 @var{stack-guard} without exceeding 64k.
19786 In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
19787 at an address aligned to the value given by @var{stack-size}.
19788 The @var{stack-guard} option can only be used in conjunction with @var{stack-size}.
19789
19790 @item -mhotpatch[=@var{halfwords}]
19791 @itemx -mno-hotpatch
19792 @opindex mhotpatch
19793 If the hotpatch option is enabled, a ``hot-patching'' function
19794 prologue is generated for all functions in the compilation unit.
19795 The funtion label is prepended with the given number of two-byte
19796 Nop instructions (@var{halfwords}, maximum 1000000) or 12 Nop
19797 instructions if no argument is present. Functions with a
19798 hot-patching prologue are never inlined automatically, and a
19799 hot-patching prologue is never generated for functions functions
19800 that are explicitly inline.
19801
19802 This option can be overridden for individual functions with the
19803 @code{hotpatch} attribute.
19804 @end table
19805
19806 @node Score Options
19807 @subsection Score Options
19808 @cindex Score Options
19809
19810 These options are defined for Score implementations:
19811
19812 @table @gcctabopt
19813 @item -meb
19814 @opindex meb
19815 Compile code for big-endian mode. This is the default.
19816
19817 @item -mel
19818 @opindex mel
19819 Compile code for little-endian mode.
19820
19821 @item -mnhwloop
19822 @opindex mnhwloop
19823 Disable generation of @code{bcnz} instructions.
19824
19825 @item -muls
19826 @opindex muls
19827 Enable generation of unaligned load and store instructions.
19828
19829 @item -mmac
19830 @opindex mmac
19831 Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
19832
19833 @item -mscore5
19834 @opindex mscore5
19835 Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
19836
19837 @item -mscore5u
19838 @opindex mscore5u
19839 Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
19840
19841 @item -mscore7
19842 @opindex mscore7
19843 Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
19844
19845 @item -mscore7d
19846 @opindex mscore7d
19847 Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
19848 @end table
19849
19850 @node SH Options
19851 @subsection SH Options
19852
19853 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
19854
19855 @table @gcctabopt
19856 @item -m1
19857 @opindex m1
19858 Generate code for the SH1.
19859
19860 @item -m2
19861 @opindex m2
19862 Generate code for the SH2.
19863
19864 @item -m2e
19865 Generate code for the SH2e.
19866
19867 @item -m2a-nofpu
19868 @opindex m2a-nofpu
19869 Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way
19870 that the floating-point unit is not used.
19871
19872 @item -m2a-single-only
19873 @opindex m2a-single-only
19874 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision
19875 floating-point operations are used.
19876
19877 @item -m2a-single
19878 @opindex m2a-single
19879 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
19880 single-precision mode by default.
19881
19882 @item -m2a
19883 @opindex m2a
19884 Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
19885 double-precision mode by default.
19886
19887 @item -m3
19888 @opindex m3
19889 Generate code for the SH3.
19890
19891 @item -m3e
19892 @opindex m3e
19893 Generate code for the SH3e.
19894
19895 @item -m4-nofpu
19896 @opindex m4-nofpu
19897 Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
19898
19899 @item -m4-single-only
19900 @opindex m4-single-only
19901 Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
19902 supports single-precision arithmetic.
19903
19904 @item -m4-single
19905 @opindex m4-single
19906 Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
19907 single-precision mode by default.
19908
19909 @item -m4
19910 @opindex m4
19911 Generate code for the SH4.
19912
19913 @item -m4a-nofpu
19914 @opindex m4a-nofpu
19915 Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that the
19916 floating-point unit is not used.
19917
19918 @item -m4a-single-only
19919 @opindex m4a-single-only
19920 Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
19921 floating-point operations are used.
19922
19923 @item -m4a-single
19924 @opindex m4a-single
19925 Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
19926 single-precision mode by default.
19927
19928 @item -m4a
19929 @opindex m4a
19930 Generate code for the SH4a.
19931
19932 @item -m4al
19933 @opindex m4al
19934 Same as @option{-m4a-nofpu}, except that it implicitly passes
19935 @option{-dsp} to the assembler. GCC doesn't generate any DSP
19936 instructions at the moment.
19937
19938 @item -mb
19939 @opindex mb
19940 Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.
19941
19942 @item -ml
19943 @opindex ml
19944 Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.
19945
19946 @item -mdalign
19947 @opindex mdalign
19948 Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries. Note that this changes the calling
19949 conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library do
19950 not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
19951
19952 @item -mrelax
19953 @opindex mrelax
19954 Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
19955 linker option @option{-relax}.
19956
19957 @item -mbigtable
19958 @opindex mbigtable
19959 Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables. The default is to use
19960 16-bit offsets.
19961
19962 @item -mbitops
19963 @opindex mbitops
19964 Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.
19965
19966 @item -mfmovd
19967 @opindex mfmovd
19968 Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}. Check @option{-mdalign} for
19969 alignment constraints.
19970
19971 @item -mhitachi
19972 @opindex mhitachi
19973 Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
19974
19975 @item -mrenesas
19976 @opindex mhitachi
19977 Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
19978
19979 @item -mno-renesas
19980 @opindex mhitachi
19981 Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas
19982 conventions were available. This option is the default for all
19983 targets of the SH toolchain.
19984
19985 @item -mnomacsave
19986 @opindex mnomacsave
19987 Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
19988 @option{-mhitachi} is given.
19989
19990 @item -mieee
19991 @itemx -mno-ieee
19992 @opindex mieee
19993 @opindex mnoieee
19994 Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the
19995 handling of cases where the result of a comparison is unordered. By default
19996 @option{-mieee} is implicitly enabled. If @option{-ffinite-math-only} is
19997 enabled @option{-mno-ieee} is implicitly set, which results in faster
19998 floating-point greater-equal and less-equal comparisons. The implcit settings
19999 can be overridden by specifying either @option{-mieee} or @option{-mno-ieee}.
20000
20001 @item -minline-ic_invalidate
20002 @opindex minline-ic_invalidate
20003 Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting up
20004 nested function trampolines.
20005 This option has no effect if @option{-musermode} is in effect and the selected
20006 code generation option (e.g. @option{-m4}) does not allow the use of the @code{icbi}
20007 instruction.
20008 If the selected code generation option does not allow the use of the @code{icbi}
20009 instruction, and @option{-musermode} is not in effect, the inlined code
20010 manipulates the instruction cache address array directly with an associative
20011 write. This not only requires privileged mode at run time, but it also
20012 fails if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB and has become unmapped.
20013
20014 @item -misize
20015 @opindex misize
20016 Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
20017
20018 @item -mpadstruct
20019 @opindex mpadstruct
20020 This option is deprecated. It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
20021 which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
20022
20023 @item -matomic-model=@var{model}
20024 @opindex matomic-model=@var{model}
20025 Sets the model of atomic operations and additional parameters as a comma
20026 separated list. For details on the atomic built-in functions see
20027 @ref{__atomic Builtins}. The following models and parameters are supported:
20028
20029 @table @samp
20030
20031 @item none
20032 Disable compiler generated atomic sequences and emit library calls for atomic
20033 operations. This is the default if the target is not @code{sh-*-linux*}.
20034
20035 @item soft-gusa
20036 Generate GNU/Linux compatible gUSA software atomic sequences for the atomic
20037 built-in functions. The generated atomic sequences require additional support
20038 from the interrupt/exception handling code of the system and are only suitable
20039 for SH3* and SH4* single-core systems. This option is enabled by default when
20040 the target is @code{sh-*-linux*} and SH3* or SH4*. When the target is SH4A,
20041 this option will also partially utilize the hardware atomic instructions
20042 @code{movli.l} and @code{movco.l} to create more efficient code, unless
20043 @samp{strict} is specified.
20044
20045 @item soft-tcb
20046 Generate software atomic sequences that use a variable in the thread control
20047 block. This is a variation of the gUSA sequences which can also be used on
20048 SH1* and SH2* targets. The generated atomic sequences require additional
20049 support from the interrupt/exception handling code of the system and are only
20050 suitable for single-core systems. When using this model, the @samp{gbr-offset=}
20051 parameter has to be specified as well.
20052
20053 @item soft-imask
20054 Generate software atomic sequences that temporarily disable interrupts by
20055 setting @code{SR.IMASK = 1111}. This model works only when the program runs
20056 in privileged mode and is only suitable for single-core systems. Additional
20057 support from the interrupt/exception handling code of the system is not
20058 required. This model is enabled by default when the target is
20059 @code{sh-*-linux*} and SH1* or SH2*.
20060
20061 @item hard-llcs
20062 Generate hardware atomic sequences using the @code{movli.l} and @code{movco.l}
20063 instructions only. This is only available on SH4A and is suitable for
20064 multi-core systems. Since the hardware instructions support only 32 bit atomic
20065 variables access to 8 or 16 bit variables is emulated with 32 bit accesses.
20066 Code compiled with this option will also be compatible with other software
20067 atomic model interrupt/exception handling systems if executed on an SH4A
20068 system. Additional support from the interrupt/exception handling code of the
20069 system is not required for this model.
20070
20071 @item gbr-offset=
20072 This parameter specifies the offset in bytes of the variable in the thread
20073 control block structure that should be used by the generated atomic sequences
20074 when the @samp{soft-tcb} model has been selected. For other models this
20075 parameter is ignored. The specified value must be an integer multiple of four
20076 and in the range 0-1020.
20077
20078 @item strict
20079 This parameter prevents mixed usage of multiple atomic models, even though they
20080 would be compatible, and will make the compiler generate atomic sequences of the
20081 specified model only.
20082
20083 @end table
20084
20085 @item -mtas
20086 @opindex mtas
20087 Generate the @code{tas.b} opcode for @code{__atomic_test_and_set}.
20088 Notice that depending on the particular hardware and software configuration
20089 this can degrade overall performance due to the operand cache line flushes
20090 that are implied by the @code{tas.b} instruction. On multi-core SH4A
20091 processors the @code{tas.b} instruction must be used with caution since it
20092 can result in data corruption for certain cache configurations.
20093
20094 @item -mspace
20095 @opindex mspace
20096 Optimize for space instead of speed. Implied by @option{-Os}.
20097
20098 @item -mprefergot
20099 @opindex mprefergot
20100 When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
20101 the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
20102
20103 @item -musermode
20104 @opindex musermode
20105 Don't generate privileged mode only code. This option
20106 implies @option{-mno-inline-ic_invalidate}
20107 if the inlined code would not work in user mode.
20108 This is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
20109
20110 @item -multcost=@var{number}
20111 @opindex multcost=@var{number}
20112 Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
20113
20114 @item -mdiv=@var{strategy}
20115 @opindex mdiv=@var{strategy}
20116 Set the division strategy to be used for integer division operations.
20117 For SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
20118
20119 @table @samp
20120
20121 @item fp
20122 Performs the operation in floating point. This has a very high latency,
20123 but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice if
20124 your code has enough easily-exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to
20125 schedule the floating-point instructions together with other instructions.
20126 Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.
20127
20128 @item inv
20129 Uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor,
20130 and then multiplies the dividend with the inverse. This strategy allows
20131 CSE and hoisting of the inverse calculation. Division by zero calculates
20132 an unspecified result, but does not trap.
20133
20134 @item inv:minlat
20135 A variant of @samp{inv} where, if no CSE or hoisting opportunities
20136 have been found, or if the entire operation has been hoisted to the same
20137 place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the
20138 final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a few
20139 more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with
20140 other code.
20141
20142 @item call
20143 Calls a library function that usually implements the @samp{inv:minlat}
20144 strategy.
20145 This gives high code density for @code{m5-*media-nofpu} compilations.
20146
20147 @item call2
20148 Uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it
20149 assumes that a pointer to a lookup table has already been set up, which
20150 exposes the pointer load to CSE and code hoisting optimizations.
20151
20152 @item inv:call
20153 @itemx inv:call2
20154 @itemx inv:fp
20155 Use the @samp{inv} algorithm for initial
20156 code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the @samp{call},
20157 @samp{call2}, or @samp{fp} strategies, respectively. Note that the
20158 potentially-trapping side effect of division by zero is carried by a
20159 separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions
20160 are hoisted out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.
20161 A recombination to floating-point operations or a call is not possible
20162 in that case.
20163
20164 @item inv20u
20165 @itemx inv20l
20166 Variants of the @samp{inv:minlat} strategy. In the case
20167 that the inverse calculation is not separated from the multiply, they speed
20168 up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where applicable)
20169 by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test
20170 slows down the case of larger dividends. @samp{inv20u} assumes the case of a such
20171 a small dividend to be unlikely, and @samp{inv20l} assumes it to be likely.
20172
20173 @end table
20174
20175 For targets other than SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
20176
20177 @table @samp
20178
20179 @item call-div1
20180 Calls a library function that uses the single-step division instruction
20181 @code{div1} to perform the operation. Division by zero calculates an
20182 unspecified result and does not trap. This is the default except for SH4,
20183 SH2A and SHcompact.
20184
20185 @item call-fp
20186 Calls a library function that performs the operation in double precision
20187 floating point. Division by zero causes a floating-point exception. This is
20188 the default for SHcompact with FPU. Specifying this for targets that do not
20189 have a double precision FPU will default to @code{call-div1}.
20190
20191 @item call-table
20192 Calls a library function that uses a lookup table for small divisors and
20193 the @code{div1} instruction with case distinction for larger divisors. Division
20194 by zero calculates an unspecified result and does not trap. This is the default
20195 for SH4. Specifying this for targets that do not have dynamic shift
20196 instructions will default to @code{call-div1}.
20197
20198 @end table
20199
20200 When a division strategy has not been specified the default strategy will be
20201 selected based on the current target. For SH2A the default strategy is to
20202 use the @code{divs} and @code{divu} instructions instead of library function
20203 calls.
20204
20205 @item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
20206 @opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
20207 Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue rather
20208 than around each call. Generally beneficial for performance and size. Also
20209 needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack frame around conditional code.
20210
20211 @item -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
20212 @opindex mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
20213 Set the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed division to
20214 @var{name}.
20215 This only affects the name used in the @samp{call} and @samp{inv:call}
20216 division strategies, and the compiler still expects the same
20217 sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option were not present.
20218
20219 @item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
20220 @opindex mfixed-range
20221 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
20222 A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use. This is
20223 useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is specified as
20224 two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register ranges can be
20225 specified separated by a comma.
20226
20227 @item -mindexed-addressing
20228 @opindex mindexed-addressing
20229 Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.
20230 This is only safe if the hardware and/or OS implement 32-bit wrap-around
20231 semantics for the indexed addressing mode. The architecture allows the
20232 implementation of processors with 64-bit MMU, which the OS could use to
20233 get 32-bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports
20234 this or any other way to make the indexed addressing mode safe to use in
20235 the 32-bit ABI, the default is @option{-mno-indexed-addressing}.
20236
20237 @item -mgettrcost=@var{number}
20238 @opindex mgettrcost=@var{number}
20239 Set the cost assumed for the @code{gettr} instruction to @var{number}.
20240 The default is 2 if @option{-mpt-fixed} is in effect, 100 otherwise.
20241
20242 @item -mpt-fixed
20243 @opindex mpt-fixed
20244 Assume @code{pt*} instructions won't trap. This generally generates
20245 better-scheduled code, but is unsafe on current hardware.
20246 The current architecture
20247 definition says that @code{ptabs} and @code{ptrel} trap when the target
20248 anded with 3 is 3.
20249 This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe to schedule these
20250 instructions before a branch, or hoist them out of a loop. For example,
20251 @code{__do_global_ctors}, a part of @file{libgcc}
20252 that runs constructors at program
20253 startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by @minus{}1. With the
20254 @option{-mpt-fixed} option, the @code{ptabs} is done before testing against @minus{}1.
20255 That means that all the constructors run a bit more quickly, but when
20256 the loop comes to the end of the list, the program crashes because @code{ptabs}
20257 loads @minus{}1 into a target register.
20258
20259 Since this option is unsafe for any
20260 hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the default
20261 is @option{-mno-pt-fixed}. Unless specified explicitly with
20262 @option{-mgettrcost}, @option{-mno-pt-fixed} also implies @option{-mgettrcost=100};
20263 this deters register allocation from using target registers for storing
20264 ordinary integers.
20265
20266 @item -minvalid-symbols
20267 @opindex minvalid-symbols
20268 Assume symbols might be invalid. Ordinary function symbols generated by
20269 the compiler are always valid to load with
20270 @code{movi}/@code{shori}/@code{ptabs} or
20271 @code{movi}/@code{shori}/@code{ptrel},
20272 but with assembler and/or linker tricks it is possible
20273 to generate symbols that cause @code{ptabs} or @code{ptrel} to trap.
20274 This option is only meaningful when @option{-mno-pt-fixed} is in effect.
20275 It prevents cross-basic-block CSE, hoisting and most scheduling
20276 of symbol loads. The default is @option{-mno-invalid-symbols}.
20277
20278 @item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
20279 @opindex mbranch-cost=@var{num}
20280 Assume @var{num} to be the cost for a branch instruction. Higher numbers
20281 make the compiler try to generate more branch-free code if possible.
20282 If not specified the value is selected depending on the processor type that
20283 is being compiled for.
20284
20285 @item -mzdcbranch
20286 @itemx -mno-zdcbranch
20287 @opindex mzdcbranch
20288 @opindex mno-zdcbranch
20289 Assume (do not assume) that zero displacement conditional branch instructions
20290 @code{bt} and @code{bf} are fast. If @option{-mzdcbranch} is specified, the
20291 compiler will try to prefer zero displacement branch code sequences. This is
20292 enabled by default when generating code for SH4 and SH4A. It can be explicitly
20293 disabled by specifying @option{-mno-zdcbranch}.
20294
20295 @item -mfused-madd
20296 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
20297 @opindex mfused-madd
20298 @opindex mno-fused-madd
20299 Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
20300 accumulate instructions. These instructions are generated by default
20301 if hardware floating point is used. The machine-dependent
20302 @option{-mfused-madd} option is now mapped to the machine-independent
20303 @option{-ffp-contract=fast} option, and @option{-mno-fused-madd} is
20304 mapped to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
20305
20306 @item -mfsca
20307 @itemx -mno-fsca
20308 @opindex mfsca
20309 @opindex mno-fsca
20310 Allow or disallow the compiler to emit the @code{fsca} instruction for sine
20311 and cosine approximations. The option @code{-mfsca} must be used in
20312 combination with @code{-funsafe-math-optimizations}. It is enabled by default
20313 when generating code for SH4A. Using @code{-mno-fsca} disables sine and cosine
20314 approximations even if @code{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is in effect.
20315
20316 @item -mfsrra
20317 @itemx -mno-fsrra
20318 @opindex mfsrra
20319 @opindex mno-fsrra
20320 Allow or disallow the compiler to emit the @code{fsrra} instruction for
20321 reciprocal square root approximations. The option @code{-mfsrra} must be used
20322 in combination with @code{-funsafe-math-optimizations} and
20323 @code{-ffinite-math-only}. It is enabled by default when generating code for
20324 SH4A. Using @code{-mno-fsrra} disables reciprocal square root approximations
20325 even if @code{-funsafe-math-optimizations} and @code{-ffinite-math-only} are
20326 in effect.
20327
20328 @item -mpretend-cmove
20329 @opindex mpretend-cmove
20330 Prefer zero-displacement conditional branches for conditional move instruction
20331 patterns. This can result in faster code on the SH4 processor.
20332
20333 @end table
20334
20335 @node Solaris 2 Options
20336 @subsection Solaris 2 Options
20337 @cindex Solaris 2 options
20338
20339 These @samp{-m} options are supported on Solaris 2:
20340
20341 @table @gcctabopt
20342 @item -mimpure-text
20343 @opindex mimpure-text
20344 @option{-mimpure-text}, used in addition to @option{-shared}, tells
20345 the compiler to not pass @option{-z text} to the linker when linking a
20346 shared object. Using this option, you can link position-dependent
20347 code into a shared object.
20348
20349 @option{-mimpure-text} suppresses the ``relocations remain against
20350 allocatable but non-writable sections'' linker error message.
20351 However, the necessary relocations trigger copy-on-write, and the
20352 shared object is not actually shared across processes. Instead of
20353 using @option{-mimpure-text}, you should compile all source code with
20354 @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}.
20355
20356 @end table
20357
20358 These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:
20359
20360 @table @gcctabopt
20361 @item -pthreads
20362 @opindex pthreads
20363 Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library. This
20364 option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker. This option does
20365 not affect the thread safety of object code produced by the compiler or
20366 that of libraries supplied with it.
20367
20368 @item -pthread
20369 @opindex pthread
20370 This is a synonym for @option{-pthreads}.
20371 @end table
20372
20373 @node SPARC Options
20374 @subsection SPARC Options
20375 @cindex SPARC options
20376
20377 These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPARC:
20378
20379 @table @gcctabopt
20380 @item -mno-app-regs
20381 @itemx -mapp-regs
20382 @opindex mno-app-regs
20383 @opindex mapp-regs
20384 Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
20385 2 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications. This
20386 is the default.
20387
20388 To be fully SVR4 ABI-compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
20389 specify @option{-mno-app-regs}. You should compile libraries and system
20390 software with this option.
20391
20392 @item -mflat
20393 @itemx -mno-flat
20394 @opindex mflat
20395 @opindex mno-flat
20396 With @option{-mflat}, the compiler does not generate save/restore instructions
20397 and uses a ``flat'' or single register window model. This model is compatible
20398 with the regular register window model. The local registers and the input
20399 registers (0--5) are still treated as ``call-saved'' registers and are
20400 saved on the stack as needed.
20401
20402 With @option{-mno-flat} (the default), the compiler generates save/restore
20403 instructions (except for leaf functions). This is the normal operating mode.
20404
20405 @item -mfpu
20406 @itemx -mhard-float
20407 @opindex mfpu
20408 @opindex mhard-float
20409 Generate output containing floating-point instructions. This is the
20410 default.
20411
20412 @item -mno-fpu
20413 @itemx -msoft-float
20414 @opindex mno-fpu
20415 @opindex msoft-float
20416 Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
20417 @strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
20418 targets. Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
20419 used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation. You must make
20420 your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
20421 cross-compilation. The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
20422 @samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating-point support.
20423
20424 @option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
20425 therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
20426 this option. In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
20427 library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
20428 this to work.
20429
20430 @item -mhard-quad-float
20431 @opindex mhard-quad-float
20432 Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point
20433 instructions.
20434
20435 @item -msoft-quad-float
20436 @opindex msoft-quad-float
20437 Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
20438 floating-point instructions. The functions called are those specified
20439 in the SPARC ABI@. This is the default.
20440
20441 As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware
20442 support for the quad-word floating-point instructions. They all invoke
20443 a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
20444 emulates the effect of the instruction. Because of the trap handler overhead,
20445 this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines. Thus the
20446 @option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
20447
20448 @item -mno-unaligned-doubles
20449 @itemx -munaligned-doubles
20450 @opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
20451 @opindex munaligned-doubles
20452 Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment. This is the default.
20453
20454 With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte
20455 alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
20456 absolute address. Otherwise, it assumes they have 4-byte alignment.
20457 Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
20458 generated by other compilers. It is not the default because it results
20459 in a performance loss, especially for floating-point code.
20460
20461 @item -mno-faster-structs
20462 @itemx -mfaster-structs
20463 @opindex mno-faster-structs
20464 @opindex mfaster-structs
20465 With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
20466 should have 8-byte alignment. This enables the use of pairs of
20467 @code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
20468 assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
20469 However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
20470 ABI@. Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
20471 acknowledges that their resulting code is not directly in line with
20472 the rules of the ABI@.
20473
20474 @item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
20475 @opindex mcpu
20476 Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
20477 for machine type @var{cpu_type}. Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
20478 @samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc},
20479 @samp{leon}, @samp{leon3}, @samp{sparclite}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
20480 @samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9},
20481 @samp{ultrasparc}, @samp{ultrasparc3}, @samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2},
20482 @samp{niagara3} and @samp{niagara4}.
20483
20484 Native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
20485 which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
20486 @option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
20487 the processor.
20488
20489 Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
20490 an architecture and not an implementation. These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
20491 @samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
20492
20493 Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
20494 implementations.
20495
20496 @table @asis
20497 @item v7
20498 cypress
20499
20500 @item v8
20501 supersparc, hypersparc, leon, leon3
20502
20503 @item sparclite
20504 f930, f934, sparclite86x
20505
20506 @item sparclet
20507 tsc701
20508
20509 @item v9
20510 ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4
20511 @end table
20512
20513 By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for the V7
20514 variant of the SPARC architecture. With @option{-mcpu=cypress}, the compiler
20515 additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the
20516 SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series. This is also appropriate for the older
20517 SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
20518
20519 With @option{-mcpu=v8}, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
20520 architecture. The only difference from V7 code is that the compiler emits
20521 the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which exist in SPARC-V8
20522 but not in SPARC-V7. With @option{-mcpu=supersparc}, the compiler additionally
20523 optimizes it for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and
20524 2000 series.
20525
20526 With @option{-mcpu=sparclite}, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of
20527 the SPARC architecture. This adds the integer multiply, integer divide step
20528 and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC-V7.
20529 With @option{-mcpu=f930}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
20530 Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original SPARClite, with no FPU@. With
20531 @option{-mcpu=f934}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu
20532 MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU@.
20533
20534 With @option{-mcpu=sparclet}, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
20535 the SPARC architecture. This adds the integer multiply, multiply/accumulate,
20536 integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClet
20537 but not in SPARC-V7. With @option{-mcpu=tsc701}, the compiler additionally
20538 optimizes it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.
20539
20540 With @option{-mcpu=v9}, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
20541 architecture. This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move instructions,
20542 3 additional floating-point condition code registers and conditional move
20543 instructions. With @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc}, the compiler additionally
20544 optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi chips. With
20545 @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
20546 Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips. With
20547 @option{-mcpu=niagara}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
20548 Sun UltraSPARC T1 chips. With @option{-mcpu=niagara2}, the compiler
20549 additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With
20550 @option{-mcpu=niagara3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
20551 UltraSPARC T3 chips. With @option{-mcpu=niagara4}, the compiler
20552 additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips.
20553
20554 @item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
20555 @opindex mtune
20556 Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
20557 @var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
20558 option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} does.
20559
20560 The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
20561 @option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
20562 that select a particular CPU implementation. Those are @samp{cypress},
20563 @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{leon}, @samp{leon3}, @samp{f930},
20564 @samp{f934}, @samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc},
20565 @samp{ultrasparc3}, @samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3} and
20566 @samp{niagara4}. With native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, @samp{native}
20567 can also be used.
20568
20569 @item -mv8plus
20570 @itemx -mno-v8plus
20571 @opindex mv8plus
20572 @opindex mno-v8plus
20573 With @option{-mv8plus}, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI@. The
20574 difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
20575 considered 64 bits wide. This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
20576 mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
20577
20578 @item -mvis
20579 @itemx -mno-vis
20580 @opindex mvis
20581 @opindex mno-vis
20582 With @option{-mvis}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
20583 Visual Instruction Set extensions. The default is @option{-mno-vis}.
20584
20585 @item -mvis2
20586 @itemx -mno-vis2
20587 @opindex mvis2
20588 @opindex mno-vis2
20589 With @option{-mvis2}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
20590 version 2.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The
20591 default is @option{-mvis2} when targeting a cpu that supports such
20592 instructions, such as UltraSPARC-III and later. Setting @option{-mvis2}
20593 also sets @option{-mvis}.
20594
20595 @item -mvis3
20596 @itemx -mno-vis3
20597 @opindex mvis3
20598 @opindex mno-vis3
20599 With @option{-mvis3}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
20600 version 3.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions. The
20601 default is @option{-mvis3} when targeting a cpu that supports such
20602 instructions, such as niagara-3 and later. Setting @option{-mvis3}
20603 also sets @option{-mvis2} and @option{-mvis}.
20604
20605 @item -mcbcond
20606 @itemx -mno-cbcond
20607 @opindex mcbcond
20608 @opindex mno-cbcond
20609 With @option{-mcbcond}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
20610 compare-and-branch instructions, as defined in the Sparc Architecture 2011.
20611 The default is @option{-mcbcond} when targeting a cpu that supports such
20612 instructions, such as niagara-4 and later.
20613
20614 @item -mpopc
20615 @itemx -mno-popc
20616 @opindex mpopc
20617 @opindex mno-popc
20618 With @option{-mpopc}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
20619 population count instruction. The default is @option{-mpopc}
20620 when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-2 and
20621 later.
20622
20623 @item -mfmaf
20624 @itemx -mno-fmaf
20625 @opindex mfmaf
20626 @opindex mno-fmaf
20627 With @option{-mfmaf}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
20628 Fused Multiply-Add Floating-point extensions. The default is @option{-mfmaf}
20629 when targeting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-3 and
20630 later.
20631
20632 @item -mfix-at697f
20633 @opindex mfix-at697f
20634 Enable the documented workaround for the single erratum of the Atmel AT697F
20635 processor (which corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).
20636
20637 @item -mfix-ut699
20638 @opindex mfix-ut699
20639 Enable the documented workarounds for the floating-point errata and the data
20640 cache nullify errata of the UT699 processor.
20641 @end table
20642
20643 These @samp{-m} options are supported in addition to the above
20644 on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:
20645
20646 @table @gcctabopt
20647 @item -m32
20648 @itemx -m64
20649 @opindex m32
20650 @opindex m64
20651 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
20652 The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
20653 The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
20654 to 64 bits.
20655
20656 @item -mcmodel=@var{which}
20657 @opindex mcmodel
20658 Set the code model to one of
20659
20660 @table @samp
20661 @item medlow
20662 The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
20663 must be linked in the low 32 bits of memory. Programs can be statically
20664 or dynamically linked.
20665
20666 @item medmid
20667 The Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
20668 must be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must
20669 be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of
20670 the text segment.
20671
20672 @item medany
20673 The Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
20674 may be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must be less
20675 than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of the
20676 text segment.
20677
20678 @item embmedany
20679 The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
20680 64-bit addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
20681 size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time). The
20682 global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment. Programs
20683 are statically linked and PIC is not supported.
20684 @end table
20685
20686 @item -mmemory-model=@var{mem-model}
20687 @opindex mmemory-model
20688 Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of
20689
20690 @table @samp
20691 @item default
20692 The default memory model for the processor and operating system.
20693
20694 @item rmo
20695 Relaxed Memory Order
20696
20697 @item pso
20698 Partial Store Order
20699
20700 @item tso
20701 Total Store Order
20702
20703 @item sc
20704 Sequential Consistency
20705 @end table
20706
20707 These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the Sparc V9
20708 architecture manual, as set in the processor's @code{PSTATE.MM} field.
20709
20710 @item -mstack-bias
20711 @itemx -mno-stack-bias
20712 @opindex mstack-bias
20713 @opindex mno-stack-bias
20714 With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
20715 frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
20716 when making stack frame references. This is the default in 64-bit mode.
20717 Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
20718 @end table
20719
20720 @node SPU Options
20721 @subsection SPU Options
20722 @cindex SPU options
20723
20724 These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPU:
20725
20726 @table @gcctabopt
20727 @item -mwarn-reloc
20728 @itemx -merror-reloc
20729 @opindex mwarn-reloc
20730 @opindex merror-reloc
20731
20732 The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations. By default, GCC
20733 gives an error when it generates code that requires a dynamic
20734 relocation. @option{-mno-error-reloc} disables the error,
20735 @option{-mwarn-reloc} generates a warning instead.
20736
20737 @item -msafe-dma
20738 @itemx -munsafe-dma
20739 @opindex msafe-dma
20740 @opindex munsafe-dma
20741
20742 Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be
20743 reordered with respect to loads and stores of the memory that is being
20744 accessed.
20745 With @option{-munsafe-dma} you must use the @code{volatile} keyword to protect
20746 memory accesses, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the
20747 memory is known to not change. Rather than mark the memory as volatile,
20748 you can use @option{-msafe-dma} to tell the compiler to treat
20749 the DMA instructions as potentially affecting all memory.
20750
20751 @item -mbranch-hints
20752 @opindex mbranch-hints
20753
20754 By default, GCC generates a branch hint instruction to avoid
20755 pipeline stalls for always-taken or probably-taken branches. A hint
20756 is not generated closer than 8 instructions away from its branch.
20757 There is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes,
20758 or to make an object a little bit smaller.
20759
20760 @item -msmall-mem
20761 @itemx -mlarge-mem
20762 @opindex msmall-mem
20763 @opindex mlarge-mem
20764
20765 By default, GCC generates code assuming that addresses are never larger
20766 than 18 bits. With @option{-mlarge-mem} code is generated that assumes
20767 a full 32-bit address.
20768
20769 @item -mstdmain
20770 @opindex mstdmain
20771
20772 By default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style
20773 main function interface (which has an unconventional parameter list).
20774 With @option{-mstdmain}, GCC links your program against startup
20775 code that assumes a C99-style interface to @code{main}, including a
20776 local copy of @code{argv} strings.
20777
20778 @item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
20779 @opindex mfixed-range
20780 Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
20781 A fixed register is one that the register allocator cannot use. This is
20782 useful when compiling kernel code. A register range is specified as
20783 two registers separated by a dash. Multiple register ranges can be
20784 specified separated by a comma.
20785
20786 @item -mea32
20787 @itemx -mea64
20788 @opindex mea32
20789 @opindex mea64
20790 Compile code assuming that pointers to the PPU address space accessed
20791 via the @code{__ea} named address space qualifier are either 32 or 64
20792 bits wide. The default is 32 bits. As this is an ABI-changing option,
20793 all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.
20794
20795 @item -maddress-space-conversion
20796 @itemx -mno-address-space-conversion
20797 @opindex maddress-space-conversion
20798 @opindex mno-address-space-conversion
20799 Allow/disallow treating the @code{__ea} address space as superset
20800 of the generic address space. This enables explicit type casts
20801 between @code{__ea} and generic pointer as well as implicit
20802 conversions of generic pointers to @code{__ea} pointers. The
20803 default is to allow address space pointer conversions.
20804
20805 @item -mcache-size=@var{cache-size}
20806 @opindex mcache-size
20807 This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
20808 executable and selects a software-managed cache for accessing variables
20809 in the @code{__ea} address space with a particular cache size. Possible
20810 options for @var{cache-size} are @samp{8}, @samp{16}, @samp{32}, @samp{64}
20811 and @samp{128}. The default cache size is 64KB.
20812
20813 @item -matomic-updates
20814 @itemx -mno-atomic-updates
20815 @opindex matomic-updates
20816 @opindex mno-atomic-updates
20817 This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
20818 executable and selects whether atomic updates to the software-managed
20819 cache of PPU-side variables are used. If you use atomic updates, changes
20820 to a PPU variable from SPU code using the @code{__ea} named address space
20821 qualifier do not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing
20822 in the same cache line from PPU code. If you do not use atomic updates,
20823 such interference may occur; however, writing back cache lines is
20824 more efficient. The default behavior is to use atomic updates.
20825
20826 @item -mdual-nops
20827 @itemx -mdual-nops=@var{n}
20828 @opindex mdual-nops
20829 By default, GCC inserts nops to increase dual issue when it expects
20830 it to increase performance. @var{n} can be a value from 0 to 10. A
20831 smaller @var{n} inserts fewer nops. 10 is the default, 0 is the
20832 same as @option{-mno-dual-nops}. Disabled with @option{-Os}.
20833
20834 @item -mhint-max-nops=@var{n}
20835 @opindex mhint-max-nops
20836 Maximum number of nops to insert for a branch hint. A branch hint must
20837 be at least 8 instructions away from the branch it is affecting. GCC
20838 inserts up to @var{n} nops to enforce this, otherwise it does not
20839 generate the branch hint.
20840
20841 @item -mhint-max-distance=@var{n}
20842 @opindex mhint-max-distance
20843 The encoding of the branch hint instruction limits the hint to be within
20844 256 instructions of the branch it is affecting. By default, GCC makes
20845 sure it is within 125.
20846
20847 @item -msafe-hints
20848 @opindex msafe-hints
20849 Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.
20850 By default, GCC inserts the @code{hbrp} instruction to make sure
20851 this stall won't happen.
20852
20853 @end table
20854
20855 @node System V Options
20856 @subsection Options for System V
20857
20858 These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
20859 compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
20860
20861 @table @gcctabopt
20862 @item -G
20863 @opindex G
20864 Create a shared object.
20865 It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
20866
20867 @item -Qy
20868 @opindex Qy
20869 Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
20870 @code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
20871
20872 @item -Qn
20873 @opindex Qn
20874 Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
20875 the default).
20876
20877 @item -YP,@var{dirs}
20878 @opindex YP
20879 Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
20880 specified with @option{-l}.
20881
20882 @item -Ym,@var{dir}
20883 @opindex Ym
20884 Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
20885 The assembler uses this option.
20886 @c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
20887 @c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
20888 @end table
20889
20890 @node TILE-Gx Options
20891 @subsection TILE-Gx Options
20892 @cindex TILE-Gx options
20893
20894 These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILE-Gx:
20895
20896 @table @gcctabopt
20897 @item -mcmodel=small
20898 @opindex mcmodel=small
20899 Generate code for the small model. The distance for direct calls is
20900 limited to 500M in either direction. PC-relative addresses are 32
20901 bits. Absolute addresses support the full address range.
20902
20903 @item -mcmodel=large
20904 @opindex mcmodel=large
20905 Generate code for the large model. There is no limitation on call
20906 distance, pc-relative addresses, or absolute addresses.
20907
20908 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
20909 @opindex mcpu
20910 Selects the type of CPU to be targeted. Currently the only supported
20911 type is @samp{tilegx}.
20912
20913 @item -m32
20914 @itemx -m64
20915 @opindex m32
20916 @opindex m64
20917 Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment. The 32-bit
20918 environment sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits. The 64-bit
20919 environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
20920 @end table
20921
20922 @node TILEPro Options
20923 @subsection TILEPro Options
20924 @cindex TILEPro options
20925
20926 These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILEPro:
20927
20928 @table @gcctabopt
20929 @item -mcpu=@var{name}
20930 @opindex mcpu
20931 Selects the type of CPU to be targeted. Currently the only supported
20932 type is @samp{tilepro}.
20933
20934 @item -m32
20935 @opindex m32
20936 Generate code for a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and
20937 pointer to 32 bits. This is the only supported behavior so the flag
20938 is essentially ignored.
20939 @end table
20940
20941 @node V850 Options
20942 @subsection V850 Options
20943 @cindex V850 Options
20944
20945 These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
20946
20947 @table @gcctabopt
20948 @item -mlong-calls
20949 @itemx -mno-long-calls
20950 @opindex mlong-calls
20951 @opindex mno-long-calls
20952 Treat all calls as being far away (near). If calls are assumed to be
20953 far away, the compiler always loads the function's address into a
20954 register, and calls indirect through the pointer.
20955
20956 @item -mno-ep
20957 @itemx -mep
20958 @opindex mno-ep
20959 @opindex mep
20960 Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
20961 pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
20962 use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions. The @option{-mep}
20963 option is on by default if you optimize.
20964
20965 @item -mno-prolog-function
20966 @itemx -mprolog-function
20967 @opindex mno-prolog-function
20968 @opindex mprolog-function
20969 Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers
20970 at the prologue and epilogue of a function. The external functions
20971 are slower, but use less code space if more than one function saves
20972 the same number of registers. The @option{-mprolog-function} option
20973 is on by default if you optimize.
20974
20975 @item -mspace
20976 @opindex mspace
20977 Try to make the code as small as possible. At present, this just turns
20978 on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
20979
20980 @item -mtda=@var{n}
20981 @opindex mtda
20982 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
20983 the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to. The tiny data
20984 area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
20985
20986 @item -msda=@var{n}
20987 @opindex msda
20988 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
20989 the small data area that register @code{gp} points to. The small data
20990 area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
20991
20992 @item -mzda=@var{n}
20993 @opindex mzda
20994 Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
20995 the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
20996
20997 @item -mv850
20998 @opindex mv850
20999 Specify that the target processor is the V850.
21000
21001 @item -mv850e3v5
21002 @opindex mv850e3v5
21003 Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5. The preprocessor
21004 constant @samp{__v850e3v5__} is defined if this option is used.
21005
21006 @item -mv850e2v4
21007 @opindex mv850e2v4
21008 Specify that the target processor is the V850E3V5. This is an alias for
21009 the @option{-mv850e3v5} option.
21010
21011 @item -mv850e2v3
21012 @opindex mv850e2v3
21013 Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3. The preprocessor
21014 constant @samp{__v850e2v3__} is defined if this option is used.
21015
21016 @item -mv850e2
21017 @opindex mv850e2
21018 Specify that the target processor is the V850E2. The preprocessor
21019 constant @samp{__v850e2__} is defined if this option is used.
21020
21021 @item -mv850e1
21022 @opindex mv850e1
21023 Specify that the target processor is the V850E1. The preprocessor
21024 constants @samp{__v850e1__} and @samp{__v850e__} are defined if
21025 this option is used.
21026
21027 @item -mv850es
21028 @opindex mv850es
21029 Specify that the target processor is the V850ES. This is an alias for
21030 the @option{-mv850e1} option.
21031
21032 @item -mv850e
21033 @opindex mv850e
21034 Specify that the target processor is the V850E@. The preprocessor
21035 constant @samp{__v850e__} is defined if this option is used.
21036
21037 If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} nor @option{-mv850e1}
21038 nor @option{-mv850e2} nor @option{-mv850e2v3} nor @option{-mv850e3v5}
21039 are defined then a default target processor is chosen and the
21040 relevant @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant is defined.
21041
21042 The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
21043 defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
21044
21045 @item -mdisable-callt
21046 @itemx -mno-disable-callt
21047 @opindex mdisable-callt
21048 @opindex mno-disable-callt
21049 This option suppresses generation of the @code{CALLT} instruction for the
21050 v850e, v850e1, v850e2, v850e2v3 and v850e3v5 flavors of the v850
21051 architecture.
21052
21053 This option is enabled by default when the RH850 ABI is
21054 in use (see @option{-mrh850-abi}), and disabled by default when the
21055 GCC ABI is in use. If @code{CALLT} instructions are being generated
21056 then the C preprocessor symbol @code{__V850_CALLT__} will be defined.
21057
21058 @item -mrelax
21059 @itemx -mno-relax
21060 @opindex mrelax
21061 @opindex mno-relax
21062 Pass on (or do not pass on) the @option{-mrelax} command line option
21063 to the assembler.
21064
21065 @item -mlong-jumps
21066 @itemx -mno-long-jumps
21067 @opindex mlong-jumps
21068 @opindex mno-long-jumps
21069 Disable (or re-enable) the generation of PC-relative jump instructions.
21070
21071 @item -msoft-float
21072 @itemx -mhard-float
21073 @opindex msoft-float
21074 @opindex mhard-float
21075 Disable (or re-enable) the generation of hardware floating point
21076 instructions. This option is only significant when the target
21077 architecture is @samp{V850E2V3} or higher. If hardware floating point
21078 instructions are being generated then the C preprocessor symbol
21079 @code{__FPU_OK__} will be defined, otherwise the symbol
21080 @code{__NO_FPU__} will be defined.
21081
21082 @item -mloop
21083 @opindex mloop
21084 Enables the use of the e3v5 LOOP instruction. The use of this
21085 instruction is not enabled by default when the e3v5 architecture is
21086 selected because its use is still experimental.
21087
21088 @item -mrh850-abi
21089 @itemx -mghs
21090 @opindex mrh850-abi
21091 @opindex mghs
21092 Enables support for the RH850 version of the V850 ABI. This is the
21093 default. With this version of the ABI the following rules apply:
21094
21095 @itemize
21096 @item
21097 Integer sized structures and unions are returned via a memory pointer
21098 rather than a register.
21099
21100 @item
21101 Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are passed by
21102 value.
21103
21104 @item
21105 Functions are aligned to 16-bit boundaries.
21106
21107 @item
21108 The @option{-m8byte-align} command line option is supported.
21109
21110 @item
21111 The @option{-mdisable-callt} command line option is enabled by
21112 default. The @option{-mno-disable-callt} command line option is not
21113 supported.
21114 @end itemize
21115
21116 When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol
21117 @code{__V850_RH850_ABI__} is defined.
21118
21119 @item -mgcc-abi
21120 @opindex mgcc-abi
21121 Enables support for the old GCC version of the V850 ABI. With this
21122 version of the ABI the following rules apply:
21123
21124 @itemize
21125 @item
21126 Integer sized structures and unions are returned in register @code{r10}.
21127
21128 @item
21129 Large structures and unions (more than 8 bytes in size) are passed by
21130 reference.
21131
21132 @item
21133 Functions are aligned to 32-bit boundaries, unless optimizing for
21134 size.
21135
21136 @item
21137 The @option{-m8byte-align} command line option is not supported.
21138
21139 @item
21140 The @option{-mdisable-callt} command line option is supported but not
21141 enabled by default.
21142 @end itemize
21143
21144 When this version of the ABI is enabled the C preprocessor symbol
21145 @code{__V850_GCC_ABI__} is defined.
21146
21147 @item -m8byte-align
21148 @itemx -mno-8byte-align
21149 @opindex m8byte-align
21150 @opindex mno-8byte-align
21151 Enables support for @code{doubles} and @code{long long} types to be
21152 aligned on 8-byte boundaries. The default is to restrict the
21153 alignment of all objects to at most 4-bytes. When
21154 @option{-m8byte-align} is in effect the C preprocessor symbol
21155 @code{__V850_8BYTE_ALIGN__} will be defined.
21156
21157 @item -mbig-switch
21158 @opindex mbig-switch
21159 Generate code suitable for big switch tables. Use this option only if
21160 the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
21161 table.
21162
21163 @item -mapp-regs
21164 @opindex mapp-regs
21165 This option causes r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
21166 the compiler. This setting is the default.
21167
21168 @item -mno-app-regs
21169 @opindex mno-app-regs
21170 This option causes r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
21171
21172 @end table
21173
21174 @node VAX Options
21175 @subsection VAX Options
21176 @cindex VAX options
21177
21178 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
21179
21180 @table @gcctabopt
21181 @item -munix
21182 @opindex munix
21183 Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
21184 that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
21185 ranges.
21186
21187 @item -mgnu
21188 @opindex mgnu
21189 Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that the
21190 GNU assembler is being used.
21191
21192 @item -mg
21193 @opindex mg
21194 Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of D-format.
21195 @end table
21196
21197 @node VMS Options
21198 @subsection VMS Options
21199
21200 These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VMS implementations:
21201
21202 @table @gcctabopt
21203 @item -mvms-return-codes
21204 @opindex mvms-return-codes
21205 Return VMS condition codes from @code{main}. The default is to return POSIX-style
21206 condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
21207
21208 @item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
21209 @opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
21210 Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
21211 routine for the debugger.
21212
21213 @item -mmalloc64
21214 @opindex mmalloc64
21215 Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
21216
21217 @item -mpointer-size=@var{size}
21218 @opindex -mpointer-size=@var{size}
21219 Set the default size of pointers. Possible options for @var{size} are
21220 @samp{32} or @samp{short} for 32 bit pointers, @samp{64} or @samp{long}
21221 for 64 bit pointers, and @samp{no} for supporting only 32 bit pointers.
21222 The later option disables @code{pragma pointer_size}.
21223 @end table
21224
21225 @node VxWorks Options
21226 @subsection VxWorks Options
21227 @cindex VxWorks Options
21228
21229 The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.
21230 Options specific to the target hardware are listed with the other
21231 options for that target.
21232
21233 @table @gcctabopt
21234 @item -mrtp
21235 @opindex mrtp
21236 GCC can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes
21237 (RTPs). This option switches from the former to the latter. It also
21238 defines the preprocessor macro @code{__RTP__}.
21239
21240 @item -non-static
21241 @opindex non-static
21242 Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static
21243 libraries. The options @option{-static} and @option{-shared} can
21244 also be used for RTPs (@pxref{Link Options}); @option{-static}
21245 is the default.
21246
21247 @item -Bstatic
21248 @itemx -Bdynamic
21249 @opindex Bstatic
21250 @opindex Bdynamic
21251 These options are passed down to the linker. They are defined for
21252 compatibility with Diab.
21253
21254 @item -Xbind-lazy
21255 @opindex Xbind-lazy
21256 Enable lazy binding of function calls. This option is equivalent to
21257 @option{-Wl,-z,now} and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
21258
21259 @item -Xbind-now
21260 @opindex Xbind-now
21261 Disable lazy binding of function calls. This option is the default and
21262 is defined for compatibility with Diab.
21263 @end table
21264
21265 @node x86-64 Options
21266 @subsection x86-64 Options
21267 @cindex x86-64 options
21268
21269 These are listed under @xref{i386 and x86-64 Options}.
21270
21271 @node Xstormy16 Options
21272 @subsection Xstormy16 Options
21273 @cindex Xstormy16 Options
21274
21275 These options are defined for Xstormy16:
21276
21277 @table @gcctabopt
21278 @item -msim
21279 @opindex msim
21280 Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
21281 @end table
21282
21283 @node Xtensa Options
21284 @subsection Xtensa Options
21285 @cindex Xtensa Options
21286
21287 These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
21288
21289 @table @gcctabopt
21290 @item -mconst16
21291 @itemx -mno-const16
21292 @opindex mconst16
21293 @opindex mno-const16
21294 Enable or disable use of @code{CONST16} instructions for loading
21295 constant values. The @code{CONST16} instruction is currently not a
21296 standard option from Tensilica. When enabled, @code{CONST16}
21297 instructions are always used in place of the standard @code{L32R}
21298 instructions. The use of @code{CONST16} is enabled by default only if
21299 the @code{L32R} instruction is not available.
21300
21301 @item -mfused-madd
21302 @itemx -mno-fused-madd
21303 @opindex mfused-madd
21304 @opindex mno-fused-madd
21305 Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
21306 instructions in the floating-point option. This has no effect if the
21307 floating-point option is not also enabled. Disabling fused multiply/add
21308 and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
21309 instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations. This may be
21310 desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
21311 required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
21312 intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
21313 precision than specified by the IEEE standard. Disabling fused multiply
21314 add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
21315 sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
21316 operations.
21317
21318 @item -mserialize-volatile
21319 @itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
21320 @opindex mserialize-volatile
21321 @opindex mno-serialize-volatile
21322 When this option is enabled, GCC inserts @code{MEMW} instructions before
21323 @code{volatile} memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
21324 The default is @option{-mserialize-volatile}. Use
21325 @option{-mno-serialize-volatile} to omit the @code{MEMW} instructions.
21326
21327 @item -mforce-no-pic
21328 @opindex mforce-no-pic
21329 For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be
21330 position-independent code (PIC), this option disables PIC for compiling
21331 kernel code.
21332
21333 @item -mtext-section-literals
21334 @itemx -mno-text-section-literals
21335 @opindex mtext-section-literals
21336 @opindex mno-text-section-literals
21337 Control the treatment of literal pools. The default is
21338 @option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
21339 section in the output file. This allows the literal pool to be placed
21340 in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
21341 pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
21342 improve code size. With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
21343 are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
21344 possible to their references. This may be necessary for large assembly
21345 files.
21346
21347 @item -mtarget-align
21348 @itemx -mno-target-align
21349 @opindex mtarget-align
21350 @opindex mno-target-align
21351 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
21352 automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
21353 expense of some code density. The assembler attempts to widen density
21354 instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
21355 instructions. If there are not enough preceding safe density
21356 instructions to align a target, no widening is performed. The
21357 default is @option{-mtarget-align}. These options do not affect the
21358 treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
21359 assembler always aligns, either by widening density instructions or
21360 by inserting NOP instructions.
21361
21362 @item -mlongcalls
21363 @itemx -mno-longcalls
21364 @opindex mlongcalls
21365 @opindex mno-longcalls
21366 When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
21367 direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
21368 of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction. This
21369 translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
21370 files. Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
21371 instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
21372 The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}. This option should be used in
21373 programs where the call target can potentially be out of range. This
21374 option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
21375 assembly code generated by GCC still shows direct call
21376 instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
21377 instructions. Note that the assembler uses an indirect call for
21378 every cross-file call, not just those that really are out of range.
21379 @end table
21380
21381 @node zSeries Options
21382 @subsection zSeries Options
21383 @cindex zSeries options
21384
21385 These are listed under @xref{S/390 and zSeries Options}.
21386
21387 @node Code Gen Options
21388 @section Options for Code Generation Conventions
21389 @cindex code generation conventions
21390 @cindex options, code generation
21391 @cindex run-time options
21392
21393 These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
21394 used in code generation.
21395
21396 Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
21397 of @option{-ffoo} is @option{-fno-foo}. In the table below, only
21398 one of the forms is listed---the one that is not the default. You
21399 can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
21400 it.
21401
21402 @table @gcctabopt
21403 @item -fbounds-check
21404 @opindex fbounds-check
21405 For front ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
21406 indices used to access arrays are within the declared range. This is
21407 currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front ends, where
21408 this option defaults to true and false respectively.
21409
21410 @item -fstack-reuse=@var{reuse-level}
21411 @opindex fstack_reuse
21412 This option controls stack space reuse for user declared local/auto variables
21413 and compiler generated temporaries. @var{reuse_level} can be @samp{all},
21414 @samp{named_vars}, or @samp{none}. @samp{all} enables stack reuse for all
21415 local variables and temporaries, @samp{named_vars} enables the reuse only for
21416 user defined local variables with names, and @samp{none} disables stack reuse
21417 completely. The default value is @samp{all}. The option is needed when the
21418 program extends the lifetime of a scoped local variable or a compiler generated
21419 temporary beyond the end point defined by the language. When a lifetime of
21420 a variable ends, and if the variable lives in memory, the optimizing compiler
21421 has the freedom to reuse its stack space with other temporaries or scoped
21422 local variables whose live range does not overlap with it. Legacy code extending
21423 local lifetime will likely to break with the stack reuse optimization.
21424
21425 For example,
21426
21427 @smallexample
21428 int *p;
21429 @{
21430 int local1;
21431
21432 p = &local1;
21433 local1 = 10;
21434 ....
21435 @}
21436 @{
21437 int local2;
21438 local2 = 20;
21439 ...
21440 @}
21441
21442 if (*p == 10) // out of scope use of local1
21443 @{
21444
21445 @}
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448 Another example:
21449 @smallexample
21450
21451 struct A
21452 @{
21453 A(int k) : i(k), j(k) @{ @}
21454 int i;
21455 int j;
21456 @};
21457
21458 A *ap;
21459
21460 void foo(const A& ar)
21461 @{
21462 ap = &ar;
21463 @}
21464
21465 void bar()
21466 @{
21467 foo(A(10)); // temp object's lifetime ends when foo returns
21468
21469 @{
21470 A a(20);
21471 ....
21472 @}
21473 ap->i+= 10; // ap references out of scope temp whose space
21474 // is reused with a. What is the value of ap->i?
21475 @}
21476
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 The lifetime of a compiler generated temporary is well defined by the C++
21480 standard. When a lifetime of a temporary ends, and if the temporary lives
21481 in memory, the optimizing compiler has the freedom to reuse its stack
21482 space with other temporaries or scoped local variables whose live range
21483 does not overlap with it. However some of the legacy code relies on
21484 the behavior of older compilers in which temporaries' stack space is
21485 not reused, the aggressive stack reuse can lead to runtime errors. This
21486 option is used to control the temporary stack reuse optimization.
21487
21488 @item -ftrapv
21489 @opindex ftrapv
21490 This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
21491 multiplication operations.
21492
21493 @item -fwrapv
21494 @opindex fwrapv
21495 This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
21496 overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
21497 using twos-complement representation. This flag enables some optimizations
21498 and disables others. This option is enabled by default for the Java
21499 front end, as required by the Java language specification.
21500
21501 @item -fexceptions
21502 @opindex fexceptions
21503 Enable exception handling. Generates extra code needed to propagate
21504 exceptions. For some targets, this implies GCC generates frame
21505 unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
21506 size overhead, although it does not affect execution. If you do not
21507 specify this option, GCC enables it by default for languages like
21508 C++ that normally require exception handling, and disables it for
21509 languages like C that do not normally require it. However, you may need
21510 to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
21511 properly with exception handlers written in C++. You may also wish to
21512 disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
21513 use exception handling.
21514
21515 @item -fnon-call-exceptions
21516 @opindex fnon-call-exceptions
21517 Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
21518 Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
21519 not exist everywhere. Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
21520 instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating-point
21521 instructions. It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
21522 arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
21523
21524 @item -fdelete-dead-exceptions
21525 @opindex fdelete-dead-exceptions
21526 Consider that instructions that may throw exceptions but don't otherwise
21527 contribute to the execution of the program can be optimized away.
21528 This option is enabled by default for the Ada front end, as permitted by
21529 the Ada language specification.
21530 Optimization passes that cause dead exceptions to be removed are enabled independently at different optimization levels.
21531
21532 @item -funwind-tables
21533 @opindex funwind-tables
21534 Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it just generates any needed
21535 static data, but does not affect the generated code in any other way.
21536 You normally do not need to enable this option; instead, a language processor
21537 that needs this handling enables it on your behalf.
21538
21539 @item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
21540 @opindex fasynchronous-unwind-tables
21541 Generate unwind table in DWARF 2 format, if supported by target machine. The
21542 table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
21543 unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
21544
21545 @item -fpcc-struct-return
21546 @opindex fpcc-struct-return
21547 Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
21548 longer ones, rather than in registers. This convention is less
21549 efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
21550 GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
21551 the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
21552
21553 The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
21554 on the target configuration macros.
21555
21556 Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
21557 that of some integer type.
21558
21559 @strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
21560 switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
21561 @option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
21562 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21563
21564 @item -freg-struct-return
21565 @opindex freg-struct-return
21566 Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
21567 This is more efficient for small structures than
21568 @option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
21569
21570 If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
21571 @option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
21572 standard for the target. If there is no standard convention, GCC
21573 defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
21574 the principal compiler. In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
21575 we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
21576
21577 @strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
21578 switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
21579 @option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
21580 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21581
21582 @item -fshort-enums
21583 @opindex fshort-enums
21584 Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
21585 declared range of possible values. Specifically, the @code{enum} type
21586 is equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.
21587
21588 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
21589 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
21590 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21591
21592 @item -fshort-double
21593 @opindex fshort-double
21594 Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
21595
21596 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
21597 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
21598 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21599
21600 @item -fshort-wchar
21601 @opindex fshort-wchar
21602 Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
21603 unsigned int} instead of the default for the target. This option is
21604 useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
21605
21606 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
21607 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
21608 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21609
21610 @item -fno-common
21611 @opindex fno-common
21612 In C code, controls the placement of uninitialized global variables.
21613 Unix C compilers have traditionally permitted multiple definitions of
21614 such variables in different compilation units by placing the variables
21615 in a common block.
21616 This is the behavior specified by @option{-fcommon}, and is the default
21617 for GCC on most targets.
21618 On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on some
21619 targets may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.
21620 The @option{-fno-common} option specifies that the compiler should place
21621 uninitialized global variables in the data section of the object file,
21622 rather than generating them as common blocks.
21623 This has the effect that if the same variable is declared
21624 (without @code{extern}) in two different compilations,
21625 you get a multiple-definition error when you link them.
21626 In this case, you must compile with @option{-fcommon} instead.
21627 Compiling with @option{-fno-common} is useful on targets for which
21628 it provides better performance, or if you wish to verify that the
21629 program will work on other systems that always treat uninitialized
21630 variable declarations this way.
21631
21632 @item -fno-ident
21633 @opindex fno-ident
21634 Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
21635
21636 @item -finhibit-size-directive
21637 @opindex finhibit-size-directive
21638 Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
21639 would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
21640 two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory. This option is
21641 used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
21642 for anything else.
21643
21644 @item -fverbose-asm
21645 @opindex fverbose-asm
21646 Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
21647 make it more readable. This option is generally only of use to those
21648 who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
21649 debugging the compiler itself).
21650
21651 @option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
21652 extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
21653 files.
21654
21655 @item -frecord-gcc-switches
21656 @opindex frecord-gcc-switches
21657 This switch causes the command line used to invoke the
21658 compiler to be recorded into the object file that is being created.
21659 This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format
21660 of the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it
21661 usually takes the form of a section containing ASCII text. This
21662 switch is related to the @option{-fverbose-asm} switch, but that
21663 switch only records information in the assembler output file as
21664 comments, so it never reaches the object file.
21665 See also @option{-grecord-gcc-switches} for another
21666 way of storing compiler options into the object file.
21667
21668 @item -fpic
21669 @opindex fpic
21670 @cindex global offset table
21671 @cindex PIC
21672 Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
21673 library, if supported for the target machine. Such code accesses all
21674 constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@. The dynamic
21675 loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
21676 loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system). If
21677 the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
21678 maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
21679 @option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
21680 instead. (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k
21681 on the m68k and RS/6000. The 386 has no such limit.)
21682
21683 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
21684 only on certain machines. For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
21685 but not for the Sun 386i. Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
21686 position-independent.
21687
21688 When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
21689 are defined to 1.
21690
21691 @item -fPIC
21692 @opindex fPIC
21693 If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
21694 suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
21695 global offset table. This option makes a difference on the m68k,
21696 PowerPC and SPARC@.
21697
21698 Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
21699 only on certain machines.
21700
21701 When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
21702 are defined to 2.
21703
21704 @item -fpie
21705 @itemx -fPIE
21706 @opindex fpie
21707 @opindex fPIE
21708 These options are similar to @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, but
21709 generated position independent code can be only linked into executables.
21710 Usually these options are used when @option{-pie} GCC option is
21711 used during linking.
21712
21713 @option{-fpie} and @option{-fPIE} both define the macros
21714 @code{__pie__} and @code{__PIE__}. The macros have the value 1
21715 for @option{-fpie} and 2 for @option{-fPIE}.
21716
21717 @item -fno-jump-tables
21718 @opindex fno-jump-tables
21719 Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
21720 more efficient than other code generation strategies. This option is
21721 of use in conjunction with @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC} for
21722 building code that forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot
21723 reference the address of a jump table. On some targets, jump tables
21724 do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.
21725
21726 @item -ffixed-@var{reg}
21727 @opindex ffixed
21728 Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
21729 should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
21730 pointer or in some other fixed role).
21731
21732 @var{reg} must be the name of a register. The register names accepted
21733 are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
21734 macro in the machine description macro file.
21735
21736 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
21737 three-way choice.
21738
21739 @item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
21740 @opindex fcall-used
21741 Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
21742 clobbered by function calls. It may be allocated for temporaries or
21743 variables that do not live across a call. Functions compiled this way
21744 do not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
21745
21746 It is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
21747 Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
21748 the machine's execution model produces disastrous results.
21749
21750 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
21751 three-way choice.
21752
21753 @item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
21754 @opindex fcall-saved
21755 Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
21756 functions. It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
21757 live across a call. Functions compiled this way save and restore
21758 the register @var{reg} if they use it.
21759
21760 It is an error to use this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
21761 Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
21762 the machine's execution model produces disastrous results.
21763
21764 A different sort of disaster results from the use of this flag for
21765 a register in which function values may be returned.
21766
21767 This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
21768 three-way choice.
21769
21770 @item -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]
21771 @opindex fpack-struct
21772 Without a value specified, pack all structure members together without
21773 holes. When a value is specified (which must be a small power of two), pack
21774 structure members according to this value, representing the maximum
21775 alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
21776 this are output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.
21777
21778 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
21779 code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
21780 Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
21781 Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21782
21783 @item -finstrument-functions
21784 @opindex finstrument-functions
21785 Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions. Just
21786 after function entry and just before function exit, the following
21787 profiling functions are called with the address of the current
21788 function and its call site. (On some platforms,
21789 @code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
21790 function, so the call site information may not be available to the
21791 profiling functions otherwise.)
21792
21793 @smallexample
21794 void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
21795 void *call_site);
21796 void __cyg_profile_func_exit (void *this_fn,
21797 void *call_site);
21798 @end smallexample
21799
21800 The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
21801 which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
21802
21803 This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
21804 functions. The profiling calls indicate where, conceptually, the
21805 inline function is entered and exited. This means that addressable
21806 versions of such functions must be available. If all your uses of a
21807 function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
21808 code size. If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
21809 addressable version of such functions must be provided. (This is
21810 normally the case anyway, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
21811 expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
21812 providing static copies.)
21813
21814 A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
21815 which case this instrumentation is not done. This can be used, for
21816 example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
21817 interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
21818 cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
21819 routines generate output or allocate memory).
21820
21821 @item -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{}
21822 @opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list
21823
21824 Set the list of functions that are excluded from instrumentation (see
21825 the description of @code{-finstrument-functions}). If the file that
21826 contains a function definition matches with one of @var{file}, then
21827 that function is not instrumented. The match is done on substrings:
21828 if the @var{file} parameter is a substring of the file name, it is
21829 considered to be a match.
21830
21831 For example:
21832
21833 @smallexample
21834 -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys
21835 @end smallexample
21836
21837 @noindent
21838 excludes any inline function defined in files whose pathnames
21839 contain @code{/bits/stl} or @code{include/sys}.
21840
21841 If, for some reason, you want to include letter @code{','} in one of
21842 @var{sym}, write @code{'\,'}. For example,
21843 @code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list='\,\,tmp'}
21844 (note the single quote surrounding the option).
21845
21846 @item -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{}
21847 @opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list
21848
21849 This is similar to @code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list},
21850 but this option sets the list of function names to be excluded from
21851 instrumentation. The function name to be matched is its user-visible
21852 name, such as @code{vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)}, not the
21853 internal mangled name (e.g., @code{_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE}). The
21854 match is done on substrings: if the @var{sym} parameter is a substring
21855 of the function name, it is considered to be a match. For C99 and C++
21856 extended identifiers, the function name must be given in UTF-8, not
21857 using universal character names.
21858
21859 @item -fstack-check
21860 @opindex fstack-check
21861 Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
21862 stack. You should specify this flag if you are running in an
21863 environment with multiple threads, but you only rarely need to specify it in
21864 a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
21865 detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
21866
21867 Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
21868 operating system or the language runtime must do that. The switch causes
21869 generation of code to ensure that they see the stack being extended.
21870
21871 You can additionally specify a string parameter: @code{no} means no
21872 checking, @code{generic} means force the use of old-style checking,
21873 @code{specific} means use the best checking method and is equivalent
21874 to bare @option{-fstack-check}.
21875
21876 Old-style checking is a generic mechanism that requires no specific
21877 target support in the compiler but comes with the following drawbacks:
21878
21879 @enumerate
21880 @item
21881 Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they are always
21882 allocated dynamically if their size exceeds a fixed threshold.
21883
21884 @item
21885 Fixed limit on the size of the static frame of functions: when it is
21886 topped by a particular function, stack checking is not reliable and
21887 a warning is issued by the compiler.
21888
21889 @item
21890 Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and the
21891 generic implementation, code performance is hampered.
21892 @end enumerate
21893
21894 Note that old-style stack checking is also the fallback method for
21895 @code{specific} if no target support has been added in the compiler.
21896
21897 @item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
21898 @itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
21899 @itemx -fno-stack-limit
21900 @opindex fstack-limit-register
21901 @opindex fstack-limit-symbol
21902 @opindex fno-stack-limit
21903 Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
21904 either the value of a register or the address of a symbol. If a larger
21905 stack is required, a signal is raised at run time. For most targets,
21906 the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
21907 it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
21908
21909 For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
21910 and grows downwards, you can use the flags
21911 @option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
21912 @option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
21913 of 128KB@. Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
21914
21915 @item -fsplit-stack
21916 @opindex fsplit-stack
21917 Generate code to automatically split the stack before it overflows.
21918 The resulting program has a discontiguous stack which can only
21919 overflow if the program is unable to allocate any more memory. This
21920 is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer
21921 necessary to calculate a good stack size to use for each thread. This
21922 is currently only implemented for the i386 and x86_64 back ends running
21923 GNU/Linux.
21924
21925 When code compiled with @option{-fsplit-stack} calls code compiled
21926 without @option{-fsplit-stack}, there may not be much stack space
21927 available for the latter code to run. If compiling all code,
21928 including library code, with @option{-fsplit-stack} is not an option,
21929 then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code compiled
21930 without @option{-fsplit-stack} always has a large stack. Support for
21931 this is implemented in the gold linker in GNU binutils release 2.21
21932 and later.
21933
21934 @item -fleading-underscore
21935 @opindex fleading-underscore
21936 This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
21937 change the way C symbols are represented in the object file. One use
21938 is to help link with legacy assembly code.
21939
21940 @strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
21941 generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
21942 switch. Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
21943 Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
21944
21945 @item -ftls-model=@var{model}
21946 @opindex ftls-model
21947 Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
21948 The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
21949 @code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
21950 Note that the choice is subject to optimization: the compiler may use
21951 a more efficient model for symbols not visible outside of the translation
21952 unit, or if @option{-fpic} is not given on the command line.
21953
21954 The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
21955 @option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
21956
21957 @item -fvisibility=@var{default|internal|hidden|protected}
21958 @opindex fvisibility
21959 Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all
21960 symbols are marked with this unless overridden within the code.
21961 Using this feature can very substantially improve linking and
21962 load times of shared object libraries, produce more optimized
21963 code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol clashes.
21964 It is @strong{strongly} recommended that you use this in any shared objects
21965 you distribute.
21966
21967 Despite the nomenclature, @code{default} always means public; i.e.,
21968 available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
21969 @code{protected} and @code{internal} are pretty useless in real-world
21970 usage so the only other commonly used option is @code{hidden}.
21971 The default if @option{-fvisibility} isn't specified is
21972 @code{default}, i.e., make every
21973 symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
21974 GCC@.
21975
21976 A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF
21977 symbols have the correct visibility is given by ``How To Write
21978 Shared Libraries'' by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
21979 @w{@uref{http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/}})---however a superior
21980 solution made possible by this option to marking things hidden when
21981 the default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
21982 public. This is the norm with DLLs on Windows and with @option{-fvisibility=hidden}
21983 and @code{__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))} instead of
21984 @code{__declspec(dllexport)} you get almost identical semantics with
21985 identical syntax. This is a great boon to those working with
21986 cross-platform projects.
21987
21988 For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
21989 @samp{#pragma GCC visibility} of use. This works by you enclosing
21990 the declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
21991 @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)} and
21992 @samp{#pragma GCC visibility pop}.
21993 Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed @strong{as
21994 part of the API interface contract} and thus all new code should
21995 always specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations
21996 only for use within the local DSO should @strong{always} be marked explicitly
21997 as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
21998 abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.
21999 Note that due to ISO C++ specification requirements, @code{operator new} and
22000 @code{operator delete} must always be of default visibility.
22001
22002 Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system
22003 headers and headers from any other library you use, may not be
22004 expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default. You
22005 may need to explicitly say @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(default)}
22006 before including any such headers.
22007
22008 @samp{extern} declarations are not affected by @option{-fvisibility}, so
22009 a lot of code can be recompiled with @option{-fvisibility=hidden} with
22010 no modifications. However, this means that calls to @code{extern}
22011 functions with no explicit visibility use the PLT, so it is more
22012 effective to use @code{__attribute ((visibility))} and/or
22013 @code{#pragma GCC visibility} to tell the compiler which @code{extern}
22014 declarations should be treated as hidden.
22015
22016 Note that @option{-fvisibility} does affect C++ vague linkage
22017 entities. This means that, for instance, an exception class that is
22018 be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default
22019 visibility so that the @samp{type_info} nodes are unified between
22020 the DSOs.
22021
22022 An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
22023 is at @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/wiki/@/Visibility}.
22024
22025 @item -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
22026 @opindex fstrict-volatile-bitfields
22027 This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or other
22028 structure fields, although the compiler usually honors those types
22029 anyway) should use a single access of the width of the
22030 field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible. For
22031 example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral registers might require
22032 all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag you can
22033 declare all peripheral bit-fields as @code{unsigned short} (assuming short
22034 is 16 bits on these targets) to force GCC to use 16-bit accesses
22035 instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.
22036
22037 If this option is disabled, the compiler uses the most efficient
22038 instruction. In the previous example, that might be a 32-bit load
22039 instruction, even though that accesses bytes that do not contain
22040 any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to
22041 the one being updated.
22042
22043 In some cases, such as when the @code{packed} attribute is applied to a
22044 structure field, it may not be possible to access the field with a single
22045 read or write that is correctly aligned for the target machine. In this
22046 case GCC falls back to generating multiple accesses rather than code that
22047 will fault or truncate the result at run time.
22048
22049 The default value of this option is determined by the application binary
22050 interface for the target processor.
22051
22052 @item -fsync-libcalls
22053 @opindex fsync-libcalls
22054 This option controls whether any out-of-line instance of the @code{__sync}
22055 family of functions may be used to implement the C++11 @code{__atomic}
22056 family of functions.
22057
22058 The default value of this option is enabled, thus the only useful form
22059 of the option is @option{-fno-sync-libcalls}. This option is used in
22060 the implementation of the @file{libatomic} runtime library.
22061
22062 @end table
22063
22064 @c man end
22065
22066 @node Environment Variables
22067 @section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
22068 @cindex environment variables
22069
22070 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
22071 This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
22072 operates. Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
22073 when searching for various kinds of files. Some are used to specify other
22074 aspects of the compilation environment.
22075
22076 Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
22077 @option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}). These
22078 take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
22079 in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
22080 @xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
22081 GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
22082
22083 @table @env
22084 @item LANG
22085 @itemx LC_CTYPE
22086 @c @itemx LC_COLLATE
22087 @itemx LC_MESSAGES
22088 @c @itemx LC_MONETARY
22089 @c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
22090 @c @itemx LC_TIME
22091 @itemx LC_ALL
22092 @findex LANG
22093 @findex LC_CTYPE
22094 @c @findex LC_COLLATE
22095 @findex LC_MESSAGES
22096 @c @findex LC_MONETARY
22097 @c @findex LC_NUMERIC
22098 @c @findex LC_TIME
22099 @findex LC_ALL
22100 @cindex locale
22101 These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
22102 localization information which allows GCC to work with different
22103 national conventions. GCC inspects the locale categories
22104 @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
22105 so. These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
22106 installation. A typical value is @samp{en_GB.UTF-8} for English in the United
22107 Kingdom encoded in UTF-8.
22108
22109 The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
22110 classification. GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
22111 a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
22112 and escape characters that are otherwise interpreted as a string
22113 end or escape.
22114
22115 The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
22116 use in diagnostic messages.
22117
22118 If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
22119 of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
22120 and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
22121 environment variable. If none of these variables are set, GCC
22122 defaults to traditional C English behavior.
22123
22124 @item TMPDIR
22125 @findex TMPDIR
22126 If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
22127 files. GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
22128 compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
22129 the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
22130 proper.
22131
22132 @item GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
22133 @findex GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
22134 Setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is nearly equivalent to passing
22135 @option{-fcompare-debug} to the compiler driver. See the documentation
22136 of this option for more details.
22137
22138 @item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
22139 @findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
22140 If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
22141 names of the subprograms executed by the compiler. No slash is added
22142 when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
22143 specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
22144
22145 If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC attempts to figure out
22146 an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it is invoked with.
22147
22148 If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
22149 tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
22150
22151 The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
22152 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc/} where @var{prefix} is the prefix to
22153 the installed compiler. In many cases @var{prefix} is the value
22154 of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
22155
22156 Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
22157
22158 This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
22159 used for linking.
22160
22161 In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
22162 directories to search for header files. For each of the standard
22163 directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc}
22164 (more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
22165 replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
22166 alternate directory name. Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC searches
22167 @file{foo/bar} just before it searches the standard directory
22168 @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
22169 If a standard directory begins with the configured
22170 @var{prefix} then the value of @var{prefix} is replaced by
22171 @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} when looking for header files.
22172
22173 @item COMPILER_PATH
22174 @findex COMPILER_PATH
22175 The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
22176 directories, much like @env{PATH}. GCC tries the directories thus
22177 specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
22178 subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
22179
22180 @item LIBRARY_PATH
22181 @findex LIBRARY_PATH
22182 The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
22183 directories, much like @env{PATH}. When configured as a native compiler,
22184 GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
22185 linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}. Linking
22186 using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
22187 libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
22188 @option{-L} come first).
22189
22190 @item LANG
22191 @findex LANG
22192 @cindex locale definition
22193 This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler. One way in
22194 which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
22195 when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
22196 When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
22197 the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
22198
22199 @table @samp
22200 @item C-JIS
22201 Recognize JIS characters.
22202 @item C-SJIS
22203 Recognize SJIS characters.
22204 @item C-EUCJP
22205 Recognize EUCJP characters.
22206 @end table
22207
22208 If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
22209 compiler uses @code{mblen} and @code{mbtowc} as defined by the default locale to
22210 recognize and translate multibyte characters.
22211 @end table
22212
22213 @noindent
22214 Some additional environment variables affect the behavior of the
22215 preprocessor.
22216
22217 @include cppenv.texi
22218
22219 @c man end
22220
22221 @node Precompiled Headers
22222 @section Using Precompiled Headers
22223 @cindex precompiled headers
22224 @cindex speed of compilation
22225
22226 Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
22227 source file. The time the compiler takes to process these header files
22228 over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
22229 build the project. To make builds faster, GCC allows you to
22230 @dfn{precompile} a header file.
22231
22232 To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
22233 other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
22234 treat it as a C or C++ header file. You may want to use a
22235 tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
22236 the headers it contains change.
22237
22238 A precompiled header file is searched for when @code{#include} is
22239 seen in the compilation. As it searches for the included file
22240 (@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp,The C Preprocessor}) the
22241 compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
22242 looks for the include file in that directory. The name searched for is
22243 the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.gch} appended. If
22244 the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
22245
22246 For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
22247 @file{all.h.gch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
22248 precompiled header file is used if possible, and the original
22249 header is used otherwise.
22250
22251 Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
22252 directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
22253 before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
22254 Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
22255 used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
22256 directory containing an @code{#error} command.
22257
22258 This also works with @option{-include}. So yet another way to use
22259 precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
22260 header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
22261 a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
22262 file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header. If the header files
22263 have guards against multiple inclusion, they are skipped because
22264 they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
22265
22266 If you need to precompile the same header file for different
22267 languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
22268 @emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.gch}, and put each precompiled
22269 header in the directory, perhaps using @option{-o}. It doesn't matter
22270 what you call the files in the directory; every precompiled header in
22271 the directory is considered. The first precompiled header
22272 encountered in the directory that is valid for this compilation is
22273 used; they're searched in no particular order.
22274
22275 There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
22276 good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
22277
22278 A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
22279
22280 @itemize
22281 @item
22282 Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
22283
22284 @item
22285 A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen. You
22286 can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you cannot
22287 include a precompiled header from inside another header.
22288
22289 @item
22290 The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
22291 the current compilation. You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
22292 compilation.
22293
22294 @item
22295 The precompiled header file must have been produced by the same compiler
22296 binary as the current compilation is using.
22297
22298 @item
22299 Any macros defined before the precompiled header is included must
22300 either be defined in the same way as when the precompiled header was
22301 generated, or must not affect the precompiled header, which usually
22302 means that they don't appear in the precompiled header at all.
22303
22304 The @option{-D} option is one way to define a macro before a
22305 precompiled header is included; using a @code{#define} can also do it.
22306 There are also some options that define macros implicitly, like
22307 @option{-O} and @option{-Wdeprecated}; the same rule applies to macros
22308 defined this way.
22309
22310 @item If debugging information is output when using the precompiled
22311 header, using @option{-g} or similar, the same kind of debugging information
22312 must have been output when building the precompiled header. However,
22313 a precompiled header built using @option{-g} can be used in a compilation
22314 when no debugging information is being output.
22315
22316 @item The same @option{-m} options must generally be used when building
22317 and using the precompiled header. @xref{Submodel Options},
22318 for any cases where this rule is relaxed.
22319
22320 @item Each of the following options must be the same when building and using
22321 the precompiled header:
22322
22323 @gccoptlist{-fexceptions}
22324
22325 @item
22326 Some other command-line options starting with @option{-f},
22327 @option{-p}, or @option{-O} must be defined in the same way as when
22328 the precompiled header was generated. At present, it's not clear
22329 which options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice
22330 is to use exactly the same options when generating and using the
22331 precompiled header. The following are known to be safe:
22332
22333 @gccoptlist{-fmessage-length= -fpreprocessed -fsched-interblock @gol
22334 -fsched-spec -fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
22335 -fsched-verbose=@var{number} -fschedule-insns -fvisibility= @gol
22336 -pedantic-errors}
22337
22338 @end itemize
22339
22340 For all of these except the last, the compiler automatically
22341 ignores the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met. If you
22342 find an option combination that doesn't work and doesn't cause the
22343 precompiled header to be ignored, please consider filing a bug report,
22344 see @ref{Bugs}.
22345
22346 If you do use differing options when generating and using the
22347 precompiled header, the actual behavior is a mixture of the
22348 behavior for the options. For instance, if you use @option{-g} to
22349 generate the precompiled header but not when using it, you may or may
22350 not get debugging information for routines in the precompiled header.